forked from OSchip/llvm-project
				
			
		
			
				
	
	
		
			18157 lines
		
	
	
		
			704 KiB
		
	
	
	
		
			C++
		
	
	
	
			
		
		
	
	
			18157 lines
		
	
	
		
			704 KiB
		
	
	
	
		
			C++
		
	
	
	
//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
 | 
						|
//
 | 
						|
// Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions.
 | 
						|
// See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information.
 | 
						|
// SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception
 | 
						|
//
 | 
						|
//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | 
						|
//
 | 
						|
//  This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
 | 
						|
//
 | 
						|
//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
#include "TreeTransform.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/AST/ExprOpenMP.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Basic/FixedPoint.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Sema/Overload.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Sema/SemaFixItUtils.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
 | 
						|
#include "llvm/Support/ConvertUTF.h"
 | 
						|
using namespace clang;
 | 
						|
using namespace sema;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, without
 | 
						|
/// emitting diagnostics.
 | 
						|
bool Sema::CanUseDecl(NamedDecl *D, bool TreatUnavailableAsInvalid) {
 | 
						|
  // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing.
 | 
						|
  if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D))
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // See if this is a deleted function.
 | 
						|
  if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
    if (FD->isDeleted())
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it,
 | 
						|
    // then we can't use it either.
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
 | 
						|
        DeduceReturnType(FD, SourceLocation(), /*Diagnose*/ false))
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // See if this is an aligned allocation/deallocation function that is
 | 
						|
    // unavailable.
 | 
						|
    if (TreatUnavailableAsInvalid &&
 | 
						|
        isUnavailableAlignedAllocationFunction(*FD))
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // See if this function is unavailable.
 | 
						|
  if (TreatUnavailableAsInvalid && D->getAvailability() == AR_Unavailable &&
 | 
						|
      cast<Decl>(CurContext)->getAvailability() != AR_Unavailable)
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return true;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
 | 
						|
  // Warn if this is used but marked unused.
 | 
						|
  if (const auto *A = D->getAttr<UnusedAttr>()) {
 | 
						|
    // [[maybe_unused]] should not diagnose uses, but __attribute__((unused))
 | 
						|
    // should diagnose them.
 | 
						|
    if (A->getSemanticSpelling() != UnusedAttr::CXX11_maybe_unused &&
 | 
						|
        A->getSemanticSpelling() != UnusedAttr::C2x_maybe_unused) {
 | 
						|
      const Decl *DC = cast_or_null<Decl>(S.getCurObjCLexicalContext());
 | 
						|
      if (DC && !DC->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
 | 
						|
        S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Emit a note explaining that this function is deleted.
 | 
						|
void Sema::NoteDeletedFunction(FunctionDecl *Decl) {
 | 
						|
  assert(Decl && Decl->isDeleted());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Decl->isDefaulted()) {
 | 
						|
    // If the method was explicitly defaulted, point at that declaration.
 | 
						|
    if (!Decl->isImplicit())
 | 
						|
      Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_implicitly_deleted);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Try to diagnose why this special member function was implicitly
 | 
						|
    // deleted. This might fail, if that reason no longer applies.
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseDeletedDefaultedFunction(Decl);
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  auto *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Decl);
 | 
						|
  if (Ctor && Ctor->isInheritingConstructor())
 | 
						|
    return NoteDeletedInheritingConstructor(Ctor);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_availability_specified_here)
 | 
						|
    << Decl << 1;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Determine whether a FunctionDecl was ever declared with an
 | 
						|
/// explicit storage class.
 | 
						|
static bool hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(const FunctionDecl *D) {
 | 
						|
  for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
 | 
						|
    if (I->getStorageClass() != SC_None)
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Check whether we're in an extern inline function and referring to a
 | 
						|
/// variable or function with internal linkage (C11 6.7.4p3).
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// This is only a warning because we used to silently accept this code, but
 | 
						|
/// in many cases it will not behave correctly. This is not enabled in C++ mode
 | 
						|
/// because the restriction language is a bit weaker (C++11 [basic.def.odr]p6)
 | 
						|
/// and so while there may still be user mistakes, most of the time we can't
 | 
						|
/// prove that there are errors.
 | 
						|
static void diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(Sema &S,
 | 
						|
                                                      const NamedDecl *D,
 | 
						|
                                                      SourceLocation Loc) {
 | 
						|
  // This is disabled under C++; there are too many ways for this to fire in
 | 
						|
  // contexts where the warning is a false positive, or where it is technically
 | 
						|
  // correct but benign.
 | 
						|
  if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check if this is an inlined function or method.
 | 
						|
  FunctionDecl *Current = S.getCurFunctionDecl();
 | 
						|
  if (!Current)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  if (!Current->isInlined())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  if (!Current->isExternallyVisible())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check if the decl has internal linkage.
 | 
						|
  if (D->getFormalLinkage() != InternalLinkage)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Downgrade from ExtWarn to Extension if
 | 
						|
  //  (1) the supposedly external inline function is in the main file,
 | 
						|
  //      and probably won't be included anywhere else.
 | 
						|
  //  (2) the thing we're referencing is a pure function.
 | 
						|
  //  (3) the thing we're referencing is another inline function.
 | 
						|
  // This last can give us false negatives, but it's better than warning on
 | 
						|
  // wrappers for simple C library functions.
 | 
						|
  const FunctionDecl *UsedFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
 | 
						|
  bool DowngradeWarning = S.getSourceManager().isInMainFile(Loc);
 | 
						|
  if (!DowngradeWarning && UsedFn)
 | 
						|
    DowngradeWarning = UsedFn->isInlined() || UsedFn->hasAttr<ConstAttr>();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(Loc, DowngradeWarning ? diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline_quiet
 | 
						|
                               : diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline)
 | 
						|
    << /*IsVar=*/!UsedFn << D;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  S.MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(Current);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(D->getCanonicalDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at)
 | 
						|
      << D;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
void Sema::MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(const FunctionDecl *Cur) {
 | 
						|
  const FunctionDecl *First = Cur->getFirstDecl();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Suggest "static" on the function, if possible.
 | 
						|
  if (!hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(First)) {
 | 
						|
    SourceLocation DeclBegin = First->getSourceRange().getBegin();
 | 
						|
    Diag(DeclBegin, diag::note_convert_inline_to_static)
 | 
						|
      << Cur << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(DeclBegin, "static ");
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
 | 
						|
/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
 | 
						|
/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
 | 
						|
/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
 | 
						|
/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
 | 
						|
/// function is being used.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
 | 
						|
/// referenced), false otherwise.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef<SourceLocation> Locs,
 | 
						|
                             const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass,
 | 
						|
                             bool ObjCPropertyAccess,
 | 
						|
                             bool AvoidPartialAvailabilityChecks,
 | 
						|
                             ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassReceiver) {
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation Loc = Locs.front();
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
    // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction,
 | 
						|
    // emit them now.
 | 
						|
    auto Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl());
 | 
						|
    if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) {
 | 
						|
      for (const PartialDiagnosticAt &Suppressed : Pos->second)
 | 
						|
        Diag(Suppressed.first, Suppressed.second);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit
 | 
						|
      // them again for this specialization. However, we don't obsolete this
 | 
						|
      // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these
 | 
						|
      // diagnostics again.
 | 
						|
      Pos->second.clear();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // C++ [basic.start.main]p3:
 | 
						|
    //   The function 'main' shall not be used within a program.
 | 
						|
    if (cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isMain())
 | 
						|
      Diag(Loc, diag::ext_main_used);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    diagnoseUnavailableAlignedAllocation(*cast<FunctionDecl>(D), Loc);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing.
 | 
						|
  if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D)) {
 | 
						|
    if (isa<BindingDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(Loc, diag::err_binding_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
 | 
						|
        << D->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
 | 
						|
        << D->getDeclName() << cast<VarDecl>(D)->getType();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // See if this is a deleted function.
 | 
						|
  if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
    if (FD->isDeleted()) {
 | 
						|
      auto *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD);
 | 
						|
      if (Ctor && Ctor->isInheritingConstructor())
 | 
						|
        Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_inherited_ctor_use)
 | 
						|
            << Ctor->getParent()
 | 
						|
            << Ctor->getInheritedConstructor().getConstructor()->getParent();
 | 
						|
      else
 | 
						|
        Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
 | 
						|
      NoteDeletedFunction(FD);
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it,
 | 
						|
    // then we can't use it either.
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
 | 
						|
        DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc))
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().CUDA && !CheckCUDACall(Loc, FD))
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
    // Lambdas are only default-constructible or assignable in C++2a onwards.
 | 
						|
    if (MD->getParent()->isLambda() &&
 | 
						|
        ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) &&
 | 
						|
          cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD)->isDefaultConstructor()) ||
 | 
						|
         MD->isCopyAssignmentOperator() || MD->isMoveAssignmentOperator())) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(Loc, diag::warn_cxx17_compat_lambda_def_ctor_assign)
 | 
						|
        << !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  auto getReferencedObjCProp = [](const NamedDecl *D) ->
 | 
						|
                                      const ObjCPropertyDecl * {
 | 
						|
    if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D))
 | 
						|
      return MD->findPropertyDecl();
 | 
						|
    return nullptr;
 | 
						|
  };
 | 
						|
  if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *ObjCPDecl = getReferencedObjCProp(D)) {
 | 
						|
    if (diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(ObjCPDecl, Loc))
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
  } else if (diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(D, Loc)) {
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // [OpenMP 4.0], 2.15 declare reduction Directive, Restrictions
 | 
						|
  // Only the variables omp_in and omp_out are allowed in the combiner.
 | 
						|
  // Only the variables omp_priv and omp_orig are allowed in the
 | 
						|
  // initializer-clause.
 | 
						|
  auto *DRD = dyn_cast<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(CurContext);
 | 
						|
  if (LangOpts.OpenMP && DRD && !CurContext->containsDecl(D) &&
 | 
						|
      isa<VarDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(Loc, diag::err_omp_wrong_var_in_declare_reduction)
 | 
						|
        << getCurFunction()->HasOMPDeclareReductionCombiner;
 | 
						|
    Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) << D;
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // [OpenMP 5.0], 2.19.7.3. declare mapper Directive, Restrictions
 | 
						|
  //  List-items in map clauses on this construct may only refer to the declared
 | 
						|
  //  variable var and entities that could be referenced by a procedure defined
 | 
						|
  //  at the same location
 | 
						|
  auto *DMD = dyn_cast<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(CurContext);
 | 
						|
  if (LangOpts.OpenMP && DMD && !CurContext->containsDecl(D) &&
 | 
						|
      isa<VarDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(Loc, diag::err_omp_declare_mapper_wrong_var)
 | 
						|
        << DMD->getVarName().getAsString();
 | 
						|
    Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) << D;
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(D, Locs, UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPropertyAccess,
 | 
						|
                             AvoidPartialAvailabilityChecks, ClassReceiver);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(*this, D, Loc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(*this, D, Loc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // [expr.prim.id]p4
 | 
						|
  //   A program that refers explicitly or implicitly to a function with a
 | 
						|
  //   trailing requires-clause whose constraint-expression is not satisfied,
 | 
						|
  //   other than to declare it, is ill-formed. [...]
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // See if this is a function with constraints that need to be satisfied.
 | 
						|
  if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
    if (FD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) {
 | 
						|
      ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
 | 
						|
      if (CheckFunctionConstraints(FD, Satisfaction, Loc))
 | 
						|
        // A diagnostic will have already been generated (non-constant
 | 
						|
        // constraint expression, for example)
 | 
						|
        return true;
 | 
						|
      if (!Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) {
 | 
						|
        Diag(Loc,
 | 
						|
             diag::err_reference_to_function_with_unsatisfied_constraints)
 | 
						|
            << D;
 | 
						|
        DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(Satisfaction);
 | 
						|
        return true;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) && isa<RequiresExprBodyDecl>(D->getDeclContext()) &&
 | 
						|
      !isUnevaluatedContext()) {
 | 
						|
    // C++ [expr.prim.req.nested] p3
 | 
						|
    //   A local parameter shall only appear as an unevaluated operand
 | 
						|
    //   (Clause 8) within the constraint-expression.
 | 
						|
    Diag(Loc, diag::err_requires_expr_parameter_referenced_in_evaluated_context)
 | 
						|
        << D;
 | 
						|
    Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) << D;
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks whether a call or
 | 
						|
/// message-send is to a declaration with the sentinel attribute, and
 | 
						|
/// if so, it checks that the requirements of the sentinel are
 | 
						|
/// satisfied.
 | 
						|
void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
 | 
						|
  const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
 | 
						|
  if (!attr)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The number of formal parameters of the declaration.
 | 
						|
  unsigned numFormalParams;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The kind of declaration.  This is also an index into a %select in
 | 
						|
  // the diagnostic.
 | 
						|
  enum CalleeType { CT_Function, CT_Method, CT_Block } calleeType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
    numFormalParams = MD->param_size();
 | 
						|
    calleeType = CT_Method;
 | 
						|
  } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
    numFormalParams = FD->param_size();
 | 
						|
    calleeType = CT_Function;
 | 
						|
  } else if (isa<VarDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
    QualType type = cast<ValueDecl>(D)->getType();
 | 
						|
    const FunctionType *fn = nullptr;
 | 
						|
    if (const PointerType *ptr = type->getAs<PointerType>()) {
 | 
						|
      fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
 | 
						|
      if (!fn) return;
 | 
						|
      calleeType = CT_Function;
 | 
						|
    } else if (const BlockPointerType *ptr = type->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
 | 
						|
      fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
 | 
						|
      calleeType = CT_Block;
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      return;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (const FunctionProtoType *proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(fn)) {
 | 
						|
      numFormalParams = proto->getNumParams();
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      numFormalParams = 0;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // "nullPos" is the number of formal parameters at the end which
 | 
						|
  // effectively count as part of the variadic arguments.  This is
 | 
						|
  // useful if you would prefer to not have *any* formal parameters,
 | 
						|
  // but the language forces you to have at least one.
 | 
						|
  unsigned nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
 | 
						|
  assert((nullPos == 0 || nullPos == 1) && "invalid null position on sentinel");
 | 
						|
  numFormalParams = (nullPos > numFormalParams ? 0 : numFormalParams - nullPos);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The number of arguments which should follow the sentinel.
 | 
						|
  unsigned numArgsAfterSentinel = attr->getSentinel();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If there aren't enough arguments for all the formal parameters,
 | 
						|
  // the sentinel, and the args after the sentinel, complain.
 | 
						|
  if (Args.size() < numFormalParams + numArgsAfterSentinel + 1) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
    Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(calleeType);
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Otherwise, find the sentinel expression.
 | 
						|
  Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[Args.size() - numArgsAfterSentinel - 1];
 | 
						|
  if (!sentinelExpr) return;
 | 
						|
  if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
 | 
						|
  if (Context.isSentinelNullExpr(sentinelExpr)) return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Pick a reasonable string to insert.  Optimistically use 'nil', 'nullptr',
 | 
						|
  // or 'NULL' if those are actually defined in the context.  Only use
 | 
						|
  // 'nil' for ObjC methods, where it's much more likely that the
 | 
						|
  // variadic arguments form a list of object pointers.
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation MissingNilLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(sentinelExpr->getEndLoc());
 | 
						|
  std::string NullValue;
 | 
						|
  if (calleeType == CT_Method && PP.isMacroDefined("nil"))
 | 
						|
    NullValue = "nil";
 | 
						|
  else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
 | 
						|
    NullValue = "nullptr";
 | 
						|
  else if (PP.isMacroDefined("NULL"))
 | 
						|
    NullValue = "NULL";
 | 
						|
  else
 | 
						|
    NullValue = "(void*) 0";
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (MissingNilLoc.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << int(calleeType);
 | 
						|
  else
 | 
						|
    Diag(MissingNilLoc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel)
 | 
						|
      << int(calleeType)
 | 
						|
      << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(MissingNilLoc, ", " + NullValue);
 | 
						|
  Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(calleeType);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(Expr *E) const {
 | 
						|
  return E ? E->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | 
						|
//  Standard Promotions and Conversions
 | 
						|
//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *E, bool Diagnose) {
 | 
						|
  // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here.
 | 
						|
  if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
 | 
						|
    ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
 | 
						|
    if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    E = result.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType Ty = E->getType();
 | 
						|
  assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Ty->isFunctionType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts()))
 | 
						|
      if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()))
 | 
						|
        if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, Diagnose, E->getExprLoc()))
 | 
						|
          return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
 | 
						|
                          CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get();
 | 
						|
  } else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
 | 
						|
    // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
 | 
						|
    // an lvalue.  The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
 | 
						|
    // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
 | 
						|
    // to type'...".  In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
 | 
						|
    // that has type 'array of type' ...".  The relevant change is "an lvalue"
 | 
						|
    // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
 | 
						|
    //
 | 
						|
    // C++ 4.2p1:
 | 
						|
    // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
 | 
						|
    // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
 | 
						|
    //
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().C99 || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || E->isLValue())
 | 
						|
      E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
 | 
						|
                            CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return E;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void CheckForNullPointerDereference(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  // Check to see if we are dereferencing a null pointer.  If so,
 | 
						|
  // and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
 | 
						|
  // optimizer will delete, so warn about it.  People sometimes try to use this
 | 
						|
  // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior.  This
 | 
						|
  // only handles the pattern "*null", which is a very syntactic check.
 | 
						|
  const auto *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParenCasts());
 | 
						|
  if (UO && UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
 | 
						|
      UO->getSubExpr()->getType()->isPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
    const LangAS AS =
 | 
						|
        UO->getSubExpr()->getType()->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
 | 
						|
    if ((!isTargetAddressSpace(AS) ||
 | 
						|
         (isTargetAddressSpace(AS) && toTargetAddressSpace(AS) == 0)) &&
 | 
						|
        UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(
 | 
						|
            S.Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
 | 
						|
        !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
 | 
						|
      S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO,
 | 
						|
                            S.PDiag(diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
 | 
						|
                                << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
      S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO,
 | 
						|
                            S.PDiag(diag::note_indirection_through_null));
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(Sema &S, const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE,
 | 
						|
                                    SourceLocation AssignLoc,
 | 
						|
                                    const Expr* RHS) {
 | 
						|
  const ObjCIvarDecl *IV = OIRE->getDecl();
 | 
						|
  if (!IV)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  DeclarationName MemberName = IV->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
  IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
 | 
						|
  if (!Member || !Member->isStr("isa"))
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  const Expr *Base = OIRE->getBase();
 | 
						|
  QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
 | 
						|
  if (OIRE->isArrow())
 | 
						|
    BaseType = BaseType->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
  if (const ObjCObjectType *OTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>())
 | 
						|
    if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = OTy->getInterface()) {
 | 
						|
      ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared = nullptr;
 | 
						|
      ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
 | 
						|
      if (!ClassDeclared->getSuperClass()
 | 
						|
          && (*ClassDeclared->ivar_begin()) == IV) {
 | 
						|
        if (RHS) {
 | 
						|
          NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass =
 | 
						|
            S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope,
 | 
						|
                               &S.Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"),
 | 
						|
                               SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName);
 | 
						|
          if (ObjectSetClass) {
 | 
						|
            SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = S.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS->getEndLoc());
 | 
						|
            S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign)
 | 
						|
                << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getBeginLoc(),
 | 
						|
                                              "object_setClass(")
 | 
						|
                << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(
 | 
						|
                       SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(), AssignLoc), ",")
 | 
						|
                << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")");
 | 
						|
          }
 | 
						|
          else
 | 
						|
            S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign);
 | 
						|
        } else {
 | 
						|
          NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass =
 | 
						|
            S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope,
 | 
						|
                               &S.Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"),
 | 
						|
                               SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName);
 | 
						|
          if (ObjectGetClass)
 | 
						|
            S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use)
 | 
						|
                << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getBeginLoc(),
 | 
						|
                                              "object_getClass(")
 | 
						|
                << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(
 | 
						|
                       SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(), OIRE->getEndLoc()), ")");
 | 
						|
          else
 | 
						|
            S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use);
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
        S.Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_ivar_decl);
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::DefaultLvalueConversion(Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here.
 | 
						|
  if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
 | 
						|
    ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
 | 
						|
    if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    E = result.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
 | 
						|
  //   A glvalue of a non-function, non-array type T can be
 | 
						|
  //   converted to a prvalue.
 | 
						|
  if (!E->isGLValue()) return E;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType T = E->getType();
 | 
						|
  assert(!T.isNull() && "r-value conversion on typeless expression?");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // We don't want to throw lvalue-to-rvalue casts on top of
 | 
						|
  // expressions of certain types in C++.
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
 | 
						|
      (E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy ||
 | 
						|
       T->isDependentType() ||
 | 
						|
       T->isRecordType()))
 | 
						|
    return E;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The C standard is actually really unclear on this point, and
 | 
						|
  // DR106 tells us what the result should be but not why.  It's
 | 
						|
  // generally best to say that void types just doesn't undergo
 | 
						|
  // lvalue-to-rvalue at all.  Note that expressions of unqualified
 | 
						|
  // 'void' type are never l-values, but qualified void can be.
 | 
						|
  if (T->isVoidType())
 | 
						|
    return E;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // OpenCL usually rejects direct accesses to values of 'half' type.
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp16") &&
 | 
						|
      T->isHalfType()) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_half_load_store)
 | 
						|
      << 0 << T;
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, E);
 | 
						|
  if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
 | 
						|
    NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope,
 | 
						|
                                     &Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"),
 | 
						|
                                     SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName);
 | 
						|
    if (ObjectGetClass)
 | 
						|
      Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use)
 | 
						|
          << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OISA->getBeginLoc(), "object_getClass(")
 | 
						|
          << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(
 | 
						|
                 SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OISA->getIsaMemberLoc()), ")");
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE =
 | 
						|
            dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts()))
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, SourceLocation(), /* Expr*/nullptr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
 | 
						|
  //   [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the prvalue is the
 | 
						|
  //   cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
 | 
						|
  //   rvalue is T.
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
 | 
						|
  //   If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
 | 
						|
  //   version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
 | 
						|
  //   type of the lvalue.
 | 
						|
  if (T.hasQualifiers())
 | 
						|
    T = T.getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now.
 | 
						|
  if (T->isMemberPointerType() &&
 | 
						|
      Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
 | 
						|
    (void)isCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), T);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ExprResult Res = CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand(E);
 | 
						|
  if (Res.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return Res;
 | 
						|
  E = Res.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Loading a __weak object implicitly retains the value, so we need a cleanup to
 | 
						|
  // balance that.
 | 
						|
  if (E->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak)
 | 
						|
    Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(true);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++ [conv.lval]p3:
 | 
						|
  //   If T is cv std::nullptr_t, the result is a null pointer constant.
 | 
						|
  CastKind CK = T->isNullPtrType() ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_LValueToRValue;
 | 
						|
  Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK, E, nullptr, VK_RValue);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
 | 
						|
  //   ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
 | 
						|
  //   of the type of the lvalue ...
 | 
						|
  if (const AtomicType *Atomic = T->getAs<AtomicType>()) {
 | 
						|
    T = Atomic->getValueType().getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
    Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_AtomicToNonAtomic, Res.get(),
 | 
						|
                                   nullptr, VK_RValue);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return Res;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *E, bool Diagnose) {
 | 
						|
  ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E, Diagnose);
 | 
						|
  if (Res.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get());
 | 
						|
  if (Res.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  return Res;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// CallExprUnaryConversions - a special case of an unary conversion
 | 
						|
/// performed on a function designator of a call expression.
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::CallExprUnaryConversions(Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  QualType Ty = E->getType();
 | 
						|
  ExprResult Res = E;
 | 
						|
  // Only do implicit cast for a function type, but not for a pointer
 | 
						|
  // to function type.
 | 
						|
  if (Ty->isFunctionType()) {
 | 
						|
    Res = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
 | 
						|
                            CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get();
 | 
						|
    if (Res.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get());
 | 
						|
  if (Res.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  return Res.get();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
 | 
						|
/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
 | 
						|
/// sometimes suppressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
 | 
						|
/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
 | 
						|
/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  // First, convert to an r-value.
 | 
						|
  ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
 | 
						|
  if (Res.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  E = Res.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType Ty = E->getType();
 | 
						|
  assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Half FP have to be promoted to float unless it is natively supported
 | 
						|
  if (Ty->isHalfType() && !getLangOpts().NativeHalfType)
 | 
						|
    return ImpCastExprToType(Res.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Try to perform integral promotions if the object has a theoretically
 | 
						|
  // promotable type.
 | 
						|
  if (Ty->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
 | 
						|
    // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
 | 
						|
    //
 | 
						|
    //   The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
 | 
						|
    //   unsigned int may be used:
 | 
						|
    //     - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
 | 
						|
    //       conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
 | 
						|
    //       and unsigned int.
 | 
						|
    //     - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
 | 
						|
    //
 | 
						|
    //   If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
 | 
						|
    //   value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
 | 
						|
    //   unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
 | 
						|
    //   other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(E);
 | 
						|
    if (!PTy.isNull()) {
 | 
						|
      E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PTy, CK_IntegralCast).get();
 | 
						|
      return E;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
 | 
						|
      QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
 | 
						|
      E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PT, CK_IntegralCast).get();
 | 
						|
      return E;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return E;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
 | 
						|
/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float or __fp16
 | 
						|
/// are promoted to double. All other argument types are converted by
 | 
						|
/// UsualUnaryConversions().
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  QualType Ty = E->getType();
 | 
						|
  assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ExprResult Res = UsualUnaryConversions(E);
 | 
						|
  if (Res.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  E = Res.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If this is a 'float'  or '__fp16' (CVR qualified or typedef)
 | 
						|
  // promote to double.
 | 
						|
  // Note that default argument promotion applies only to float (and
 | 
						|
  // half/fp16); it does not apply to _Float16.
 | 
						|
  const BuiltinType *BTy = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>();
 | 
						|
  if (BTy && (BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half ||
 | 
						|
              BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)) {
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
 | 
						|
        !getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp64")) {
 | 
						|
        if (BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half) {
 | 
						|
            E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.DoubleTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++ performs lvalue-to-rvalue conversion as a default argument
 | 
						|
  // promotion, even on class types, but note:
 | 
						|
  //   C++11 [conv.lval]p2:
 | 
						|
  //     When an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion occurs in an unevaluated
 | 
						|
  //     operand or a subexpression thereof the value contained in the
 | 
						|
  //     referenced object is not accessed. Otherwise, if the glvalue
 | 
						|
  //     has a class type, the conversion copy-initializes a temporary
 | 
						|
  //     of type T from the glvalue and the result of the conversion
 | 
						|
  //     is a prvalue for the temporary.
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: add some way to gate this entire thing for correctness in
 | 
						|
  // potentially potentially evaluated contexts.
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && E->isGLValue() && !isUnevaluatedContext()) {
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Temp = PerformCopyInitialization(
 | 
						|
                       InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(E->getType()),
 | 
						|
                                                E->getExprLoc(), E);
 | 
						|
    if (Temp.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    E = Temp.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return E;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Determine the degree of POD-ness for an expression.
 | 
						|
/// Incomplete types are considered POD, since this check can be performed
 | 
						|
/// when we're in an unevaluated context.
 | 
						|
Sema::VarArgKind Sema::isValidVarArgType(const QualType &Ty) {
 | 
						|
  if (Ty->isIncompleteType()) {
 | 
						|
    // C++11 [expr.call]p7:
 | 
						|
    //   After these conversions, if the argument does not have arithmetic,
 | 
						|
    //   enumeration, pointer, pointer to member, or class type, the program
 | 
						|
    //   is ill-formed.
 | 
						|
    //
 | 
						|
    // Since we've already performed array-to-pointer and function-to-pointer
 | 
						|
    // decay, the only such type in C++ is cv void. This also handles
 | 
						|
    // initializer lists as variadic arguments.
 | 
						|
    if (Ty->isVoidType())
 | 
						|
      return VAK_Invalid;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (Ty->isObjCObjectType())
 | 
						|
      return VAK_Invalid;
 | 
						|
    return VAK_Valid;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Ty.isDestructedType() == QualType::DK_nontrivial_c_struct)
 | 
						|
    return VAK_Invalid;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Ty.isCXX98PODType(Context))
 | 
						|
    return VAK_Valid;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++11 [expr.call]p7:
 | 
						|
  //   Passing a potentially-evaluated argument of class type (Clause 9)
 | 
						|
  //   having a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial move constructor,
 | 
						|
  //   or a non-trivial destructor, with no corresponding parameter,
 | 
						|
  //   is conditionally-supported with implementation-defined semantics.
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !Ty->isDependentType())
 | 
						|
    if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
 | 
						|
      if (!Record->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor() &&
 | 
						|
          !Record->hasNonTrivialMoveConstructor() &&
 | 
						|
          !Record->hasNonTrivialDestructor())
 | 
						|
        return VAK_ValidInCXX11;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && Ty->isObjCLifetimeType())
 | 
						|
    return VAK_Valid;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Ty->isObjCObjectType())
 | 
						|
    return VAK_Invalid;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
 | 
						|
    return VAK_MSVCUndefined;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: In C++11, these cases are conditionally-supported, meaning we're
 | 
						|
  // permitted to reject them. We should consider doing so.
 | 
						|
  return VAK_Undefined;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
void Sema::checkVariadicArgument(const Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT) {
 | 
						|
  // Don't allow one to pass an Objective-C interface to a vararg.
 | 
						|
  const QualType &Ty = E->getType();
 | 
						|
  VarArgKind VAK = isValidVarArgType(Ty);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Complain about passing non-POD types through varargs.
 | 
						|
  switch (VAK) {
 | 
						|
  case VAK_ValidInCXX11:
 | 
						|
    DiagRuntimeBehavior(
 | 
						|
        E->getBeginLoc(), nullptr,
 | 
						|
        PDiag(diag::warn_cxx98_compat_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg) << Ty << CT);
 | 
						|
    LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
 | 
						|
  case VAK_Valid:
 | 
						|
    if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
 | 
						|
      // This is unlikely to be what the user intended. If the class has a
 | 
						|
      // 'c_str' member function, the user probably meant to call that.
 | 
						|
      DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getBeginLoc(), nullptr,
 | 
						|
                          PDiag(diag::warn_pass_class_arg_to_vararg)
 | 
						|
                              << Ty << CT << hasCStrMethod(E) << ".c_str()");
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case VAK_Undefined:
 | 
						|
  case VAK_MSVCUndefined:
 | 
						|
    DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getBeginLoc(), nullptr,
 | 
						|
                        PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
 | 
						|
                            << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 << Ty << CT);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case VAK_Invalid:
 | 
						|
    if (Ty.isDestructedType() == QualType::DK_nontrivial_c_struct)
 | 
						|
      Diag(E->getBeginLoc(),
 | 
						|
           diag::err_cannot_pass_non_trivial_c_struct_to_vararg)
 | 
						|
          << Ty << CT;
 | 
						|
    else if (Ty->isObjCObjectType())
 | 
						|
      DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getBeginLoc(), nullptr,
 | 
						|
                          PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
 | 
						|
                              << Ty << CT);
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_cannot_pass_to_vararg)
 | 
						|
          << isa<InitListExpr>(E) << Ty << CT;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
 | 
						|
/// will create a trap if the resulting type is not a POD type.
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT,
 | 
						|
                                                  FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
 | 
						|
  if (const BuiltinType *PlaceholderTy = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
 | 
						|
    // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable.
 | 
						|
    if (PlaceholderTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
 | 
						|
        (CT == VariadicMethod ||
 | 
						|
         (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>()))) {
 | 
						|
      E = stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Otherwise, do normal placeholder checking.
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      ExprResult ExprRes = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
 | 
						|
      if (ExprRes.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      E = ExprRes.get();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ExprResult ExprRes = DefaultArgumentPromotion(E);
 | 
						|
  if (ExprRes.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  E = ExprRes.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Diagnostics regarding non-POD argument types are
 | 
						|
  // emitted along with format string checking in Sema::CheckFunctionCall().
 | 
						|
  if (isValidVarArgType(E->getType()) == VAK_Undefined) {
 | 
						|
    // Turn this into a trap.
 | 
						|
    CXXScopeSpec SS;
 | 
						|
    SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc;
 | 
						|
    UnqualifiedId Name;
 | 
						|
    Name.setIdentifier(PP.getIdentifierInfo("__builtin_trap"),
 | 
						|
                       E->getBeginLoc());
 | 
						|
    ExprResult TrapFn = ActOnIdExpression(TUScope, SS, TemplateKWLoc, Name,
 | 
						|
                                          /*HasTrailingLParen=*/true,
 | 
						|
                                          /*IsAddressOfOperand=*/false);
 | 
						|
    if (TrapFn.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Call = BuildCallExpr(TUScope, TrapFn.get(), E->getBeginLoc(),
 | 
						|
                                    None, E->getEndLoc());
 | 
						|
    if (Call.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Comma =
 | 
						|
        ActOnBinOp(TUScope, E->getBeginLoc(), tok::comma, Call.get(), E);
 | 
						|
    if (Comma.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    return Comma.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
 | 
						|
      RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), E->getType(),
 | 
						|
                          diag::err_call_incomplete_argument))
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return E;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Converts an integer to complex float type.  Helper function of
 | 
						|
/// UsualArithmeticConversions()
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// \return false if the integer expression is an integer type and is
 | 
						|
/// successfully converted to the complex type.
 | 
						|
static bool handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &IntExpr,
 | 
						|
                                                  ExprResult &ComplexExpr,
 | 
						|
                                                  QualType IntTy,
 | 
						|
                                                  QualType ComplexTy,
 | 
						|
                                                  bool SkipCast) {
 | 
						|
  if (IntTy->isComplexType() || IntTy->isRealFloatingType()) return true;
 | 
						|
  if (SkipCast) return false;
 | 
						|
  if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) {
 | 
						|
    QualType fpTy = cast<ComplexType>(ComplexTy)->getElementType();
 | 
						|
    IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), fpTy, CK_IntegralToFloating);
 | 
						|
    IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy,
 | 
						|
                                  CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType());
 | 
						|
    IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy,
 | 
						|
                                  CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Handle arithmetic conversion with complex types.  Helper function of
 | 
						|
/// UsualArithmeticConversions()
 | 
						|
static QualType handleComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
 | 
						|
                                             ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
 | 
						|
                                             QualType RHSType,
 | 
						|
                                             bool IsCompAssign) {
 | 
						|
  // if we have an integer operand, the result is the complex type.
 | 
						|
  if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType,
 | 
						|
                                             /*skipCast*/false))
 | 
						|
    return LHSType;
 | 
						|
  if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
 | 
						|
                                             /*skipCast*/IsCompAssign))
 | 
						|
    return RHSType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // This handles complex/complex, complex/float, or float/complex.
 | 
						|
  // When both operands are complex, the shorter operand is converted to the
 | 
						|
  // type of the longer, and that is the type of the result. This corresponds
 | 
						|
  // to what is done when combining two real floating-point operands.
 | 
						|
  // The fun begins when size promotion occur across type domains.
 | 
						|
  // From H&S 6.3.4: When one operand is complex and the other is a real
 | 
						|
  // floating-point type, the less precise type is converted, within it's
 | 
						|
  // real or complex domain, to the precision of the other type. For example,
 | 
						|
  // when combining a "long double" with a "double _Complex", the
 | 
						|
  // "double _Complex" is promoted to "long double _Complex".
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Compute the rank of the two types, regardless of whether they are complex.
 | 
						|
  int Order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  auto *LHSComplexType = dyn_cast<ComplexType>(LHSType);
 | 
						|
  auto *RHSComplexType = dyn_cast<ComplexType>(RHSType);
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSElementType =
 | 
						|
      LHSComplexType ? LHSComplexType->getElementType() : LHSType;
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSElementType =
 | 
						|
      RHSComplexType ? RHSComplexType->getElementType() : RHSType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType ResultType = S.Context.getComplexType(LHSElementType);
 | 
						|
  if (Order < 0) {
 | 
						|
    // Promote the precision of the LHS if not an assignment.
 | 
						|
    ResultType = S.Context.getComplexType(RHSElementType);
 | 
						|
    if (!IsCompAssign) {
 | 
						|
      if (LHSComplexType)
 | 
						|
        LHS =
 | 
						|
            S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResultType, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
 | 
						|
      else
 | 
						|
        LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSElementType, CK_FloatingCast);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } else if (Order > 0) {
 | 
						|
    // Promote the precision of the RHS.
 | 
						|
    if (RHSComplexType)
 | 
						|
      RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResultType, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSElementType, CK_FloatingCast);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return ResultType;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Handle arithmetic conversion from integer to float.  Helper function
 | 
						|
/// of UsualArithmeticConversions()
 | 
						|
static QualType handleIntToFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &FloatExpr,
 | 
						|
                                           ExprResult &IntExpr,
 | 
						|
                                           QualType FloatTy, QualType IntTy,
 | 
						|
                                           bool ConvertFloat, bool ConvertInt) {
 | 
						|
  if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (ConvertInt)
 | 
						|
      // Convert intExpr to the lhs floating point type.
 | 
						|
      IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), FloatTy,
 | 
						|
                                    CK_IntegralToFloating);
 | 
						|
    return FloatTy;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Convert both sides to the appropriate complex float.
 | 
						|
  assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType());
 | 
						|
  QualType result = S.Context.getComplexType(FloatTy);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // _Complex int -> _Complex float
 | 
						|
  if (ConvertInt)
 | 
						|
    IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), result,
 | 
						|
                                  CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // float -> _Complex float
 | 
						|
  if (ConvertFloat)
 | 
						|
    FloatExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(FloatExpr.get(), result,
 | 
						|
                                    CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return result;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Handle arithmethic conversion with floating point types.  Helper
 | 
						|
/// function of UsualArithmeticConversions()
 | 
						|
static QualType handleFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
 | 
						|
                                      ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
 | 
						|
                                      QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) {
 | 
						|
  bool LHSFloat = LHSType->isRealFloatingType();
 | 
						|
  bool RHSFloat = RHSType->isRealFloatingType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If we have two real floating types, convert the smaller operand
 | 
						|
  // to the bigger result.
 | 
						|
  if (LHSFloat && RHSFloat) {
 | 
						|
    int order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType);
 | 
						|
    if (order > 0) {
 | 
						|
      RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_FloatingCast);
 | 
						|
      return LHSType;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    assert(order < 0 && "illegal float comparison");
 | 
						|
    if (!IsCompAssign)
 | 
						|
      LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_FloatingCast);
 | 
						|
    return RHSType;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LHSFloat) {
 | 
						|
    // Half FP has to be promoted to float unless it is natively supported
 | 
						|
    if (LHSType->isHalfType() && !S.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType)
 | 
						|
      LHSType = S.Context.FloatTy;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
 | 
						|
                                      /*ConvertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign,
 | 
						|
                                      /*ConvertInt=*/ true);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  assert(RHSFloat);
 | 
						|
  return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType,
 | 
						|
                                    /*convertInt=*/ true,
 | 
						|
                                    /*convertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Diagnose attempts to convert between __float128 and long double if
 | 
						|
/// there is no support for such conversion. Helper function of
 | 
						|
/// UsualArithmeticConversions().
 | 
						|
static bool unsupportedTypeConversion(const Sema &S, QualType LHSType,
 | 
						|
                                      QualType RHSType) {
 | 
						|
  /*  No issue converting if at least one of the types is not a floating point
 | 
						|
      type or the two types have the same rank.
 | 
						|
  */
 | 
						|
  if (!LHSType->isFloatingType() || !RHSType->isFloatingType() ||
 | 
						|
      S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType) == 0)
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  assert(LHSType->isFloatingType() && RHSType->isFloatingType() &&
 | 
						|
         "The remaining types must be floating point types.");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  auto *LHSComplex = LHSType->getAs<ComplexType>();
 | 
						|
  auto *RHSComplex = RHSType->getAs<ComplexType>();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSElemType = LHSComplex ?
 | 
						|
    LHSComplex->getElementType() : LHSType;
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSElemType = RHSComplex ?
 | 
						|
    RHSComplex->getElementType() : RHSType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // No issue if the two types have the same representation
 | 
						|
  if (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(LHSElemType) ==
 | 
						|
      &S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(RHSElemType))
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool Float128AndLongDouble = (LHSElemType == S.Context.Float128Ty &&
 | 
						|
                                RHSElemType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy);
 | 
						|
  Float128AndLongDouble |= (LHSElemType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy &&
 | 
						|
                            RHSElemType == S.Context.Float128Ty);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // We've handled the situation where __float128 and long double have the same
 | 
						|
  // representation. We allow all conversions for all possible long double types
 | 
						|
  // except PPC's double double.
 | 
						|
  return Float128AndLongDouble &&
 | 
						|
    (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(S.Context.LongDoubleTy) ==
 | 
						|
     &llvm::APFloat::PPCDoubleDouble());
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
typedef ExprResult PerformCastFn(Sema &S, Expr *operand, QualType toType);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
namespace {
 | 
						|
/// These helper callbacks are placed in an anonymous namespace to
 | 
						|
/// permit their use as function template parameters.
 | 
						|
ExprResult doIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) {
 | 
						|
  return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, toType, CK_IntegralCast);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult doComplexIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) {
 | 
						|
  return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, S.Context.getComplexType(toType),
 | 
						|
                             CK_IntegralComplexCast);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Handle integer arithmetic conversions.  Helper function of
 | 
						|
/// UsualArithmeticConversions()
 | 
						|
template <PerformCastFn doLHSCast, PerformCastFn doRHSCast>
 | 
						|
static QualType handleIntegerConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
 | 
						|
                                        ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
 | 
						|
                                        QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) {
 | 
						|
  // The rules for this case are in C99 6.3.1.8
 | 
						|
  int order = S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType);
 | 
						|
  bool LHSSigned = LHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation();
 | 
						|
  bool RHSSigned = RHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation();
 | 
						|
  if (LHSSigned == RHSSigned) {
 | 
						|
    // Same signedness; use the higher-ranked type
 | 
						|
    if (order >= 0) {
 | 
						|
      RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType);
 | 
						|
      return LHSType;
 | 
						|
    } else if (!IsCompAssign)
 | 
						|
      LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType);
 | 
						|
    return RHSType;
 | 
						|
  } else if (order != (LHSSigned ? 1 : -1)) {
 | 
						|
    // The unsigned type has greater than or equal rank to the
 | 
						|
    // signed type, so use the unsigned type
 | 
						|
    if (RHSSigned) {
 | 
						|
      RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType);
 | 
						|
      return LHSType;
 | 
						|
    } else if (!IsCompAssign)
 | 
						|
      LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType);
 | 
						|
    return RHSType;
 | 
						|
  } else if (S.Context.getIntWidth(LHSType) != S.Context.getIntWidth(RHSType)) {
 | 
						|
    // The two types are different widths; if we are here, that
 | 
						|
    // means the signed type is larger than the unsigned type, so
 | 
						|
    // use the signed type.
 | 
						|
    if (LHSSigned) {
 | 
						|
      RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType);
 | 
						|
      return LHSType;
 | 
						|
    } else if (!IsCompAssign)
 | 
						|
      LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType);
 | 
						|
    return RHSType;
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    // The signed type is higher-ranked than the unsigned type,
 | 
						|
    // but isn't actually any bigger (like unsigned int and long
 | 
						|
    // on most 32-bit systems).  Use the unsigned type corresponding
 | 
						|
    // to the signed type.
 | 
						|
    QualType result =
 | 
						|
      S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(LHSSigned ? LHSType : RHSType);
 | 
						|
    RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), result);
 | 
						|
    if (!IsCompAssign)
 | 
						|
      LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), result);
 | 
						|
    return result;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Handle conversions with GCC complex int extension.  Helper function
 | 
						|
/// of UsualArithmeticConversions()
 | 
						|
static QualType handleComplexIntConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
 | 
						|
                                           ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
 | 
						|
                                           QualType RHSType,
 | 
						|
                                           bool IsCompAssign) {
 | 
						|
  const ComplexType *LHSComplexInt = LHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType();
 | 
						|
  const ComplexType *RHSComplexInt = RHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LHSComplexInt && RHSComplexInt) {
 | 
						|
    QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType();
 | 
						|
    QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType();
 | 
						|
    QualType ScalarType =
 | 
						|
      handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast>
 | 
						|
        (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LHSComplexInt) {
 | 
						|
    QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType();
 | 
						|
    QualType ScalarType =
 | 
						|
      handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doIntegralCast>
 | 
						|
        (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSType, IsCompAssign);
 | 
						|
    QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType);
 | 
						|
    RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ComplexType,
 | 
						|
                              CK_IntegralRealToComplex);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return ComplexType;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  assert(RHSComplexInt);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType();
 | 
						|
  QualType ScalarType =
 | 
						|
    handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast>
 | 
						|
      (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign);
 | 
						|
  QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!IsCompAssign)
 | 
						|
    LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ComplexType,
 | 
						|
                              CK_IntegralRealToComplex);
 | 
						|
  return ComplexType;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Return the rank of a given fixed point or integer type. The value itself
 | 
						|
/// doesn't matter, but the values must be increasing with proper increasing
 | 
						|
/// rank as described in N1169 4.1.1.
 | 
						|
static unsigned GetFixedPointRank(QualType Ty) {
 | 
						|
  const auto *BTy = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>();
 | 
						|
  assert(BTy && "Expected a builtin type.");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  switch (BTy->getKind()) {
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::ShortFract:
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::UShortFract:
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::SatShortFract:
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract:
 | 
						|
    return 1;
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::Fract:
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::UFract:
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::SatFract:
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::SatUFract:
 | 
						|
    return 2;
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::LongFract:
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::ULongFract:
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::SatLongFract:
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::SatULongFract:
 | 
						|
    return 3;
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::ShortAccum:
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::UShortAccum:
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::SatShortAccum:
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum:
 | 
						|
    return 4;
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::Accum:
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::UAccum:
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::SatAccum:
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::SatUAccum:
 | 
						|
    return 5;
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::LongAccum:
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::ULongAccum:
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::SatLongAccum:
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum:
 | 
						|
    return 6;
 | 
						|
  default:
 | 
						|
    if (BTy->isInteger())
 | 
						|
      return 0;
 | 
						|
    llvm_unreachable("Unexpected fixed point or integer type");
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// handleFixedPointConversion - Fixed point operations between fixed
 | 
						|
/// point types and integers or other fixed point types do not fall under
 | 
						|
/// usual arithmetic conversion since these conversions could result in loss
 | 
						|
/// of precsision (N1169 4.1.4). These operations should be calculated with
 | 
						|
/// the full precision of their result type (N1169 4.1.6.2.1).
 | 
						|
static QualType handleFixedPointConversion(Sema &S, QualType LHSTy,
 | 
						|
                                           QualType RHSTy) {
 | 
						|
  assert((LHSTy->isFixedPointType() || RHSTy->isFixedPointType()) &&
 | 
						|
         "Expected at least one of the operands to be a fixed point type");
 | 
						|
  assert((LHSTy->isFixedPointOrIntegerType() ||
 | 
						|
          RHSTy->isFixedPointOrIntegerType()) &&
 | 
						|
         "Special fixed point arithmetic operation conversions are only "
 | 
						|
         "applied to ints or other fixed point types");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If one operand has signed fixed-point type and the other operand has
 | 
						|
  // unsigned fixed-point type, then the unsigned fixed-point operand is
 | 
						|
  // converted to its corresponding signed fixed-point type and the resulting
 | 
						|
  // type is the type of the converted operand.
 | 
						|
  if (RHSTy->isSignedFixedPointType() && LHSTy->isUnsignedFixedPointType())
 | 
						|
    LHSTy = S.Context.getCorrespondingSignedFixedPointType(LHSTy);
 | 
						|
  else if (RHSTy->isUnsignedFixedPointType() && LHSTy->isSignedFixedPointType())
 | 
						|
    RHSTy = S.Context.getCorrespondingSignedFixedPointType(RHSTy);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The result type is the type with the highest rank, whereby a fixed-point
 | 
						|
  // conversion rank is always greater than an integer conversion rank; if the
 | 
						|
  // type of either of the operands is a saturating fixedpoint type, the result
 | 
						|
  // type shall be the saturating fixed-point type corresponding to the type
 | 
						|
  // with the highest rank; the resulting value is converted (taking into
 | 
						|
  // account rounding and overflow) to the precision of the resulting type.
 | 
						|
  // Same ranks between signed and unsigned types are resolved earlier, so both
 | 
						|
  // types are either signed or both unsigned at this point.
 | 
						|
  unsigned LHSTyRank = GetFixedPointRank(LHSTy);
 | 
						|
  unsigned RHSTyRank = GetFixedPointRank(RHSTy);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType ResultTy = LHSTyRank > RHSTyRank ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LHSTy->isSaturatedFixedPointType() || RHSTy->isSaturatedFixedPointType())
 | 
						|
    ResultTy = S.Context.getCorrespondingSaturatedType(ResultTy);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return ResultTy;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Check that the usual arithmetic conversions can be performed on this pair of
 | 
						|
/// expressions that might be of enumeration type.
 | 
						|
static void checkEnumArithmeticConversions(Sema &S, Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS,
 | 
						|
                                           SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                           Sema::ArithConvKind ACK) {
 | 
						|
  // C++2a [expr.arith.conv]p1:
 | 
						|
  //   If one operand is of enumeration type and the other operand is of a
 | 
						|
  //   different enumeration type or a floating-point type, this behavior is
 | 
						|
  //   deprecated ([depr.arith.conv.enum]).
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // Warn on this in all language modes. Produce a deprecation warning in C++20.
 | 
						|
  // Eventually we will presumably reject these cases (in C++23 onwards?).
 | 
						|
  QualType L = LHS->getType(), R = RHS->getType();
 | 
						|
  bool LEnum = L->isUnscopedEnumerationType(),
 | 
						|
       REnum = R->isUnscopedEnumerationType();
 | 
						|
  bool IsCompAssign = ACK == Sema::ACK_CompAssign;
 | 
						|
  if ((!IsCompAssign && LEnum && R->isFloatingType()) ||
 | 
						|
      (REnum && L->isFloatingType())) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a
 | 
						|
                    ? diag::warn_arith_conv_enum_float_cxx2a
 | 
						|
                    : diag::warn_arith_conv_enum_float)
 | 
						|
        << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
        << (int)ACK << LEnum << L << R;
 | 
						|
  } else if (!IsCompAssign && LEnum && REnum &&
 | 
						|
             !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(L, R)) {
 | 
						|
    unsigned DiagID;
 | 
						|
    if (!L->castAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->hasNameForLinkage() ||
 | 
						|
        !R->castAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->hasNameForLinkage()) {
 | 
						|
      // If either enumeration type is unnamed, it's less likely that the
 | 
						|
      // user cares about this, but this situation is still deprecated in
 | 
						|
      // C++2a. Use a different warning group.
 | 
						|
      DiagID = S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a
 | 
						|
                    ? diag::warn_arith_conv_mixed_anon_enum_types_cxx2a
 | 
						|
                    : diag::warn_arith_conv_mixed_anon_enum_types;
 | 
						|
    } else if (ACK == Sema::ACK_Conditional) {
 | 
						|
      // Conditional expressions are separated out because they have
 | 
						|
      // historically had a different warning flag.
 | 
						|
      DiagID = S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a
 | 
						|
                   ? diag::warn_conditional_mixed_enum_types_cxx2a
 | 
						|
                   : diag::warn_conditional_mixed_enum_types;
 | 
						|
    } else if (ACK == Sema::ACK_Comparison) {
 | 
						|
      // Comparison expressions are separated out because they have
 | 
						|
      // historically had a different warning flag.
 | 
						|
      DiagID = S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a
 | 
						|
                   ? diag::warn_comparison_mixed_enum_types_cxx2a
 | 
						|
                   : diag::warn_comparison_mixed_enum_types;
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      DiagID = S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a
 | 
						|
                   ? diag::warn_arith_conv_mixed_enum_types_cxx2a
 | 
						|
                   : diag::warn_arith_conv_mixed_enum_types;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
                        << (int)ACK << L << R;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
 | 
						|
/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
 | 
						|
/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
 | 
						|
/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
 | 
						|
QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                          SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                          ArithConvKind ACK) {
 | 
						|
  checkEnumArithmeticConversions(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Loc, ACK);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (ACK != ACK_CompAssign) {
 | 
						|
    LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get());
 | 
						|
    if (LHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get());
 | 
						|
  if (RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
 | 
						|
  // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSType =
 | 
						|
    Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSType =
 | 
						|
    Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // For conversion purposes, we ignore any atomic qualifier on the LHS.
 | 
						|
  if (const AtomicType *AtomicLHS = LHSType->getAs<AtomicType>())
 | 
						|
    LHSType = AtomicLHS->getValueType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
 | 
						|
  if (LHSType == RHSType)
 | 
						|
    return LHSType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
 | 
						|
  // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
 | 
						|
  if (!LHSType->isArithmeticType() || !RHSType->isArithmeticType())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Apply unary and bitfield promotions to the LHS's type.
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSUnpromotedType = LHSType;
 | 
						|
  if (LHSType->isPromotableIntegerType())
 | 
						|
    LHSType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSType);
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get());
 | 
						|
  if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
 | 
						|
    LHSType = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
 | 
						|
  if (LHSType != LHSUnpromotedType && ACK != ACK_CompAssign)
 | 
						|
    LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), LHSType, CK_IntegralCast);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
 | 
						|
  if (LHSType == RHSType)
 | 
						|
    return LHSType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // At this point, we have two different arithmetic types.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Diagnose attempts to convert between __float128 and long double where
 | 
						|
  // such conversions currently can't be handled.
 | 
						|
  if (unsupportedTypeConversion(*this, LHSType, RHSType))
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Handle complex types first (C99 6.3.1.8p1).
 | 
						|
  if (LHSType->isComplexType() || RHSType->isComplexType())
 | 
						|
    return handleComplexFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
 | 
						|
                                        ACK == ACK_CompAssign);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double).
 | 
						|
  if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType())
 | 
						|
    return handleFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
 | 
						|
                                 ACK == ACK_CompAssign);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Handle GCC complex int extension.
 | 
						|
  if (LHSType->isComplexIntegerType() || RHSType->isComplexIntegerType())
 | 
						|
    return handleComplexIntConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
 | 
						|
                                      ACK == ACK_CompAssign);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LHSType->isFixedPointType() || RHSType->isFixedPointType())
 | 
						|
    return handleFixedPointConversion(*this, LHSType, RHSType);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Finally, we have two differing integer types.
 | 
						|
  return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast>
 | 
						|
           (*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, ACK == ACK_CompAssign);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | 
						|
//  Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
 | 
						|
//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::ActOnGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc,
 | 
						|
                                SourceLocation DefaultLoc,
 | 
						|
                                SourceLocation RParenLoc,
 | 
						|
                                Expr *ControllingExpr,
 | 
						|
                                ArrayRef<ParsedType> ArgTypes,
 | 
						|
                                ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgExprs) {
 | 
						|
  unsigned NumAssocs = ArgTypes.size();
 | 
						|
  assert(NumAssocs == ArgExprs.size());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  TypeSourceInfo **Types = new TypeSourceInfo*[NumAssocs];
 | 
						|
  for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) {
 | 
						|
    if (ArgTypes[i])
 | 
						|
      (void) GetTypeFromParser(ArgTypes[i], &Types[i]);
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      Types[i] = nullptr;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ExprResult ER = CreateGenericSelectionExpr(KeyLoc, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc,
 | 
						|
                                             ControllingExpr,
 | 
						|
                                             llvm::makeArrayRef(Types, NumAssocs),
 | 
						|
                                             ArgExprs);
 | 
						|
  delete [] Types;
 | 
						|
  return ER;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::CreateGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc,
 | 
						|
                                 SourceLocation DefaultLoc,
 | 
						|
                                 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
 | 
						|
                                 Expr *ControllingExpr,
 | 
						|
                                 ArrayRef<TypeSourceInfo *> Types,
 | 
						|
                                 ArrayRef<Expr *> Exprs) {
 | 
						|
  unsigned NumAssocs = Types.size();
 | 
						|
  assert(NumAssocs == Exprs.size());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Decay and strip qualifiers for the controlling expression type, and handle
 | 
						|
  // placeholder type replacement. See committee discussion from WG14 DR423.
 | 
						|
  {
 | 
						|
    EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
 | 
						|
        *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
 | 
						|
    ExprResult R = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(ControllingExpr);
 | 
						|
    if (R.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    ControllingExpr = R.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The controlling expression is an unevaluated operand, so side effects are
 | 
						|
  // likely unintended.
 | 
						|
  if (!inTemplateInstantiation() &&
 | 
						|
      ControllingExpr->HasSideEffects(Context, false))
 | 
						|
    Diag(ControllingExpr->getExprLoc(),
 | 
						|
         diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool TypeErrorFound = false,
 | 
						|
       IsResultDependent = ControllingExpr->isTypeDependent(),
 | 
						|
       ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack
 | 
						|
         = ControllingExpr->containsUnexpandedParameterPack();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) {
 | 
						|
    if (Exprs[i]->containsUnexpandedParameterPack())
 | 
						|
      ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (Types[i]) {
 | 
						|
      if (Types[i]->getType()->containsUnexpandedParameterPack())
 | 
						|
        ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (Types[i]->getType()->isDependentType()) {
 | 
						|
        IsResultDependent = true;
 | 
						|
      } else {
 | 
						|
        // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The type name in a generic association shall specify a
 | 
						|
        // complete object type other than a variably modified type."
 | 
						|
        unsigned D = 0;
 | 
						|
        if (Types[i]->getType()->isIncompleteType())
 | 
						|
          D = diag::err_assoc_type_incomplete;
 | 
						|
        else if (!Types[i]->getType()->isObjectType())
 | 
						|
          D = diag::err_assoc_type_nonobject;
 | 
						|
        else if (Types[i]->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType())
 | 
						|
          D = diag::err_assoc_type_variably_modified;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        if (D != 0) {
 | 
						|
          Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), D)
 | 
						|
            << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
            << Types[i]->getType();
 | 
						|
          TypeErrorFound = true;
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "No two generic associations in the same generic
 | 
						|
        // selection shall specify compatible types."
 | 
						|
        for (unsigned j = i+1; j < NumAssocs; ++j)
 | 
						|
          if (Types[j] && !Types[j]->getType()->isDependentType() &&
 | 
						|
              Context.typesAreCompatible(Types[i]->getType(),
 | 
						|
                                         Types[j]->getType())) {
 | 
						|
            Diag(Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
 | 
						|
                 diag::err_assoc_compatible_types)
 | 
						|
              << Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
              << Types[j]->getType()
 | 
						|
              << Types[i]->getType();
 | 
						|
            Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
 | 
						|
                 diag::note_compat_assoc)
 | 
						|
              << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
              << Types[i]->getType();
 | 
						|
            TypeErrorFound = true;
 | 
						|
          }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (TypeErrorFound)
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If we determined that the generic selection is result-dependent, don't
 | 
						|
  // try to compute the result expression.
 | 
						|
  if (IsResultDependent)
 | 
						|
    return GenericSelectionExpr::Create(Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types,
 | 
						|
                                        Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc,
 | 
						|
                                        ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  SmallVector<unsigned, 1> CompatIndices;
 | 
						|
  unsigned DefaultIndex = -1U;
 | 
						|
  for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) {
 | 
						|
    if (!Types[i])
 | 
						|
      DefaultIndex = i;
 | 
						|
    else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(ControllingExpr->getType(),
 | 
						|
                                        Types[i]->getType()))
 | 
						|
      CompatIndices.push_back(i);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The controlling expression of a generic selection shall have
 | 
						|
  // type compatible with at most one of the types named in its generic
 | 
						|
  // association list."
 | 
						|
  if (CompatIndices.size() > 1) {
 | 
						|
    // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically
 | 
						|
    // parenthesized in macro definitions.
 | 
						|
    ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens();
 | 
						|
    Diag(ControllingExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_generic_sel_multi_match)
 | 
						|
        << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType()
 | 
						|
        << (unsigned)CompatIndices.size();
 | 
						|
    for (unsigned I : CompatIndices) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(Types[I]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
 | 
						|
           diag::note_compat_assoc)
 | 
						|
        << Types[I]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
        << Types[I]->getType();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "If a generic selection has no default generic association,
 | 
						|
  // its controlling expression shall have type compatible with exactly one of
 | 
						|
  // the types named in its generic association list."
 | 
						|
  if (DefaultIndex == -1U && CompatIndices.size() == 0) {
 | 
						|
    // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically
 | 
						|
    // parenthesized in macro definitions.
 | 
						|
    ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens();
 | 
						|
    Diag(ControllingExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_generic_sel_no_match)
 | 
						|
        << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType();
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C11 6.5.1.1p3 "If a generic selection has a generic association with a
 | 
						|
  // type name that is compatible with the type of the controlling expression,
 | 
						|
  // then the result expression of the generic selection is the expression
 | 
						|
  // in that generic association. Otherwise, the result expression of the
 | 
						|
  // generic selection is the expression in the default generic association."
 | 
						|
  unsigned ResultIndex =
 | 
						|
    CompatIndices.size() ? CompatIndices[0] : DefaultIndex;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return GenericSelectionExpr::Create(
 | 
						|
      Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types, Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc,
 | 
						|
      ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack, ResultIndex);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// getUDSuffixLoc - Create a SourceLocation for a ud-suffix, given the
 | 
						|
/// location of the token and the offset of the ud-suffix within it.
 | 
						|
static SourceLocation getUDSuffixLoc(Sema &S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
 | 
						|
                                     unsigned Offset) {
 | 
						|
  return Lexer::AdvanceToTokenCharacter(TokLoc, Offset, S.getSourceManager(),
 | 
						|
                                        S.getLangOpts());
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall - A user-defined literal was found. Look up
 | 
						|
/// the corresponding cooked (non-raw) literal operator, and build a call to it.
 | 
						|
static ExprResult BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(Sema &S, Scope *Scope,
 | 
						|
                                                 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix,
 | 
						|
                                                 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc,
 | 
						|
                                                 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
 | 
						|
                                                 SourceLocation LitEndLoc) {
 | 
						|
  assert(Args.size() <= 2 && "too many arguments for literal operator");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType ArgTy[2];
 | 
						|
  for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx != Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
 | 
						|
    ArgTy[ArgIdx] = Args[ArgIdx]->getType();
 | 
						|
    if (ArgTy[ArgIdx]->isArrayType())
 | 
						|
      ArgTy[ArgIdx] = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(ArgTy[ArgIdx]);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  DeclarationName OpName =
 | 
						|
    S.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix);
 | 
						|
  DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc);
 | 
						|
  OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  LookupResult R(S, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
 | 
						|
  if (S.LookupLiteralOperator(Scope, R, llvm::makeArrayRef(ArgTy, Args.size()),
 | 
						|
                              /*AllowRaw*/ false, /*AllowTemplate*/ false,
 | 
						|
                              /*AllowStringTemplate*/ false,
 | 
						|
                              /*DiagnoseMissing*/ true) == Sema::LOLR_Error)
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return S.BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, LitEndLoc);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
 | 
						|
/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz").  The result string has to handle string
 | 
						|
/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
 | 
						|
/// multiple tokens.  However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
 | 
						|
/// string.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(ArrayRef<Token> StringToks, Scope *UDLScope) {
 | 
						|
  assert(!StringToks.empty() && "Must have at least one string!");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, PP);
 | 
						|
  if (Literal.hadError)
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
 | 
						|
  for (const Token &Tok : StringToks)
 | 
						|
    StringTokLocs.push_back(Tok.getLocation());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType CharTy = Context.CharTy;
 | 
						|
  StringLiteral::StringKind Kind = StringLiteral::Ascii;
 | 
						|
  if (Literal.isWide()) {
 | 
						|
    CharTy = Context.getWideCharType();
 | 
						|
    Kind = StringLiteral::Wide;
 | 
						|
  } else if (Literal.isUTF8()) {
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().Char8)
 | 
						|
      CharTy = Context.Char8Ty;
 | 
						|
    Kind = StringLiteral::UTF8;
 | 
						|
  } else if (Literal.isUTF16()) {
 | 
						|
    CharTy = Context.Char16Ty;
 | 
						|
    Kind = StringLiteral::UTF16;
 | 
						|
  } else if (Literal.isUTF32()) {
 | 
						|
    CharTy = Context.Char32Ty;
 | 
						|
    Kind = StringLiteral::UTF32;
 | 
						|
  } else if (Literal.isPascal()) {
 | 
						|
    CharTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Warn on initializing an array of char from a u8 string literal; this
 | 
						|
  // becomes ill-formed in C++2a.
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a &&
 | 
						|
      !getLangOpts().Char8 && Kind == StringLiteral::UTF8) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(StringTokLocs.front(), diag::warn_cxx2a_compat_utf8_string);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Create removals for all 'u8' prefixes in the string literal(s). This
 | 
						|
    // ensures C++2a compatibility (but may change the program behavior when
 | 
						|
    // built by non-Clang compilers for which the execution character set is
 | 
						|
    // not always UTF-8).
 | 
						|
    auto RemovalDiag = PDiag(diag::note_cxx2a_compat_utf8_string_remove_u8);
 | 
						|
    SourceLocation RemovalDiagLoc;
 | 
						|
    for (const Token &Tok : StringToks) {
 | 
						|
      if (Tok.getKind() == tok::utf8_string_literal) {
 | 
						|
        if (RemovalDiagLoc.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
          RemovalDiagLoc = Tok.getLocation();
 | 
						|
        RemovalDiag << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(CharSourceRange::getCharRange(
 | 
						|
            Tok.getLocation(),
 | 
						|
            Lexer::AdvanceToTokenCharacter(Tok.getLocation(), 2,
 | 
						|
                                           getSourceManager(), getLangOpts())));
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    Diag(RemovalDiagLoc, RemovalDiag);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType StrTy =
 | 
						|
      Context.getStringLiteralArrayType(CharTy, Literal.GetNumStringChars());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
 | 
						|
  StringLiteral *Lit = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
 | 
						|
                                             Kind, Literal.Pascal, StrTy,
 | 
						|
                                             &StringTokLocs[0],
 | 
						|
                                             StringTokLocs.size());
 | 
						|
  if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty())
 | 
						|
    return Lit;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // We're building a user-defined literal.
 | 
						|
  IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix());
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc =
 | 
						|
    getUDSuffixLoc(*this, StringTokLocs[Literal.getUDSuffixToken()],
 | 
						|
                   Literal.getUDSuffixOffset());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here.
 | 
						|
  if (!UDLScope)
 | 
						|
    return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_string_udl));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++11 [lex.ext]p5: The literal L is treated as a call of the form
 | 
						|
  //   operator "" X (str, len)
 | 
						|
  QualType SizeType = Context.getSizeType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  DeclarationName OpName =
 | 
						|
    Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix);
 | 
						|
  DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc);
 | 
						|
  OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType ArgTy[] = {
 | 
						|
    Context.getArrayDecayedType(StrTy), SizeType
 | 
						|
  };
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
 | 
						|
  switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, ArgTy,
 | 
						|
                                /*AllowRaw*/ false, /*AllowTemplate*/ false,
 | 
						|
                                /*AllowStringTemplate*/ true,
 | 
						|
                                /*DiagnoseMissing*/ true)) {
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case LOLR_Cooked: {
 | 
						|
    llvm::APInt Len(Context.getIntWidth(SizeType), Literal.GetNumStringChars());
 | 
						|
    IntegerLiteral *LenArg = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Len, SizeType,
 | 
						|
                                                    StringTokLocs[0]);
 | 
						|
    Expr *Args[] = { Lit, LenArg };
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, StringTokLocs.back());
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case LOLR_StringTemplate: {
 | 
						|
    TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(CharTy);
 | 
						|
    bool CharIsUnsigned = CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType();
 | 
						|
    llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    TemplateArgument TypeArg(CharTy);
 | 
						|
    TemplateArgumentLocInfo TypeArgInfo(Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CharTy));
 | 
						|
    ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(TypeArg, TypeArgInfo));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    for (unsigned I = 0, N = Lit->getLength(); I != N; ++I) {
 | 
						|
      Value = Lit->getCodeUnit(I);
 | 
						|
      TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, CharTy);
 | 
						|
      TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo;
 | 
						|
      ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo));
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, None, StringTokLocs.back(),
 | 
						|
                                    &ExplicitArgs);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  case LOLR_Raw:
 | 
						|
  case LOLR_Template:
 | 
						|
  case LOLR_ErrorNoDiagnostic:
 | 
						|
    llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result");
 | 
						|
  case LOLR_Error:
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result");
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
DeclRefExpr *
 | 
						|
Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK,
 | 
						|
                       SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                       const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
 | 
						|
  DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
 | 
						|
  return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, VK, NameInfo, SS);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
DeclRefExpr *
 | 
						|
Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK,
 | 
						|
                       const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
 | 
						|
                       const CXXScopeSpec *SS, NamedDecl *FoundD,
 | 
						|
                       SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
 | 
						|
                       const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
 | 
						|
  NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNS =
 | 
						|
      SS ? SS->getWithLocInContext(Context) : NestedNameSpecifierLoc();
 | 
						|
  return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, VK, NameInfo, NNS, FoundD, TemplateKWLoc,
 | 
						|
                          TemplateArgs);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
NonOdrUseReason Sema::getNonOdrUseReasonInCurrentContext(ValueDecl *D) {
 | 
						|
  // A declaration named in an unevaluated operand never constitutes an odr-use.
 | 
						|
  if (isUnevaluatedContext())
 | 
						|
    return NOUR_Unevaluated;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++2a [basic.def.odr]p4:
 | 
						|
  //   A variable x whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated expression e
 | 
						|
  //   is odr-used by e unless [...] x is a reference that is usable in
 | 
						|
  //   constant expressions.
 | 
						|
  if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
    if (VD->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
 | 
						|
        !(getLangOpts().OpenMP && isOpenMPCapturedDecl(D)) &&
 | 
						|
        VD->isUsableInConstantExpressions(Context))
 | 
						|
      return NOUR_Constant;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // All remaining non-variable cases constitute an odr-use. For variables, we
 | 
						|
  // need to wait and see how the expression is used.
 | 
						|
  return NOUR_None;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build an expression that references a
 | 
						|
/// declaration that does not require a closure capture.
 | 
						|
DeclRefExpr *
 | 
						|
Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK,
 | 
						|
                       const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
 | 
						|
                       NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNS, NamedDecl *FoundD,
 | 
						|
                       SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
 | 
						|
                       const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
 | 
						|
  bool RefersToCapturedVariable =
 | 
						|
      isa<VarDecl>(D) &&
 | 
						|
      NeedToCaptureVariable(cast<VarDecl>(D), NameInfo.getLoc());
 | 
						|
  
 | 
						|
  DeclRefExpr *E = DeclRefExpr::Create(
 | 
						|
      Context, NNS, TemplateKWLoc, D, RefersToCapturedVariable, NameInfo, Ty,
 | 
						|
      VK, FoundD, TemplateArgs, getNonOdrUseReasonInCurrentContext(D));
 | 
						|
  MarkDeclRefReferenced(E);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++ [except.spec]p17:
 | 
						|
  //   An exception-specification is considered to be needed when:
 | 
						|
  //   - in an expression, the function is the unique lookup result or
 | 
						|
  //     the selected member of a set of overloaded functions.
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // We delay doing this until after we've built the function reference and
 | 
						|
  // marked it as used so that:
 | 
						|
  //  a) if the function is defaulted, we get errors from defining it before /
 | 
						|
  //     instead of errors from computing its exception specification, and
 | 
						|
  //  b) if the function is a defaulted comparison, we can use the body we
 | 
						|
  //     build when defining it as input to the exception specification
 | 
						|
  //     computation rather than computing a new body.
 | 
						|
  if (auto *FPT = Ty->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
 | 
						|
    if (isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType())) {
 | 
						|
      if (auto *NewFPT = ResolveExceptionSpec(NameInfo.getLoc(), FPT))
 | 
						|
        E->setType(Context.getQualifiedType(NewFPT, Ty.getQualifiers()));
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().ObjCWeak && isa<VarDecl>(D) &&
 | 
						|
      Ty.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak && !isUnevaluatedContext() &&
 | 
						|
      !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, E->getBeginLoc()))
 | 
						|
    getCurFunction()->recordUseOfWeak(E);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D);
 | 
						|
  if (IndirectFieldDecl *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(D))
 | 
						|
    FD = IFD->getAnonField();
 | 
						|
  if (FD) {
 | 
						|
    UnusedPrivateFields.remove(FD);
 | 
						|
    // Just in case we're building an illegal pointer-to-member.
 | 
						|
    if (FD->isBitField())
 | 
						|
      E->setObjectKind(OK_BitField);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++ [expr.prim]/8: The expression [...] is a bit-field if the identifier
 | 
						|
  // designates a bit-field.
 | 
						|
  if (auto *BD = dyn_cast<BindingDecl>(D))
 | 
						|
    if (auto *BE = BD->getBinding())
 | 
						|
      E->setObjectKind(BE->getObjectKind());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return E;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
 | 
						|
/// possibly a list of template arguments.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
 | 
						|
/// DecomposeTemplateName.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
 | 
						|
/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
 | 
						|
/// some way.
 | 
						|
void
 | 
						|
Sema::DecomposeUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Id,
 | 
						|
                             TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
 | 
						|
                             DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
 | 
						|
                             const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
 | 
						|
  if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) {
 | 
						|
    Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
 | 
						|
    Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
 | 
						|
                                       Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
 | 
						|
    translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
 | 
						|
    SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
 | 
						|
    NameInfo = Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
 | 
						|
    TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    NameInfo = GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
 | 
						|
    TemplateArgs = nullptr;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void emitEmptyLookupTypoDiagnostic(
 | 
						|
    const TypoCorrection &TC, Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
 | 
						|
    DeclarationName Typo, SourceLocation TypoLoc, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
 | 
						|
    unsigned DiagnosticID, unsigned DiagnosticSuggestID) {
 | 
						|
  DeclContext *Ctx =
 | 
						|
      SS.isEmpty() ? nullptr : SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
 | 
						|
  if (!TC) {
 | 
						|
    // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
 | 
						|
    // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
 | 
						|
    if (Ctx)
 | 
						|
      SemaRef.Diag(TypoLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Typo << Ctx
 | 
						|
                                                 << SS.getRange();
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      SemaRef.Diag(TypoLoc, DiagnosticID) << Typo;
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  std::string CorrectedStr = TC.getAsString(SemaRef.getLangOpts());
 | 
						|
  bool DroppedSpecifier =
 | 
						|
      TC.WillReplaceSpecifier() && Typo.getAsString() == CorrectedStr;
 | 
						|
  unsigned NoteID = TC.getCorrectionDeclAs<ImplicitParamDecl>()
 | 
						|
                        ? diag::note_implicit_param_decl
 | 
						|
                        : diag::note_previous_decl;
 | 
						|
  if (!Ctx)
 | 
						|
    SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(TC, SemaRef.PDiag(DiagnosticSuggestID) << Typo,
 | 
						|
                         SemaRef.PDiag(NoteID));
 | 
						|
  else
 | 
						|
    SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(TC, SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_no_member_suggest)
 | 
						|
                                 << Typo << Ctx << DroppedSpecifier
 | 
						|
                                 << SS.getRange(),
 | 
						|
                         SemaRef.PDiag(NoteID));
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
 | 
						|
bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
 | 
						|
                               CorrectionCandidateCallback &CCC,
 | 
						|
                               TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
 | 
						|
                               ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, TypoExpr **Out) {
 | 
						|
  DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
 | 
						|
  unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
 | 
						|
  if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
 | 
						|
      Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
 | 
						|
      Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
 | 
						|
    diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
 | 
						|
    diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
 | 
						|
  // unqualified lookup.  This is useful when (for example) the
 | 
						|
  // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
 | 
						|
  // dependent name.
 | 
						|
  DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : nullptr;
 | 
						|
  while (DC) {
 | 
						|
    if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
 | 
						|
      LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (!R.empty()) {
 | 
						|
        // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
 | 
						|
        R.suppressDiagnostics();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        // During a default argument instantiation the CurContext points
 | 
						|
        // to a CXXMethodDecl; but we can't apply a this-> fixit inside a
 | 
						|
        // function parameter list, hence add an explicit check.
 | 
						|
        bool isDefaultArgument =
 | 
						|
            !CodeSynthesisContexts.empty() &&
 | 
						|
            CodeSynthesisContexts.back().Kind ==
 | 
						|
                CodeSynthesisContext::DefaultFunctionArgumentInstantiation;
 | 
						|
        CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
 | 
						|
        bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
 | 
						|
                          CurMethod->isInstance() &&
 | 
						|
                          DC == CurMethod->getParent() && !isDefaultArgument;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
 | 
						|
        // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
 | 
						|
        // Actually quite difficult!
 | 
						|
        if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
 | 
						|
          diagnostic = diag::ext_found_via_dependent_bases_lookup;
 | 
						|
        if (isInstance) {
 | 
						|
          Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
 | 
						|
            << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
 | 
						|
          CheckCXXThisCapture(R.getNameLoc());
 | 
						|
        } else {
 | 
						|
          Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        // Do we really want to note all of these?
 | 
						|
        for (NamedDecl *D : R)
 | 
						|
          Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        // Return true if we are inside a default argument instantiation
 | 
						|
        // and the found name refers to an instance member function, otherwise
 | 
						|
        // the function calling DiagnoseEmptyLookup will try to create an
 | 
						|
        // implicit member call and this is wrong for default argument.
 | 
						|
        if (isDefaultArgument && ((*R.begin())->isCXXInstanceMember())) {
 | 
						|
          Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_member_call_without_object);
 | 
						|
          return true;
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        // Tell the callee to try to recover.
 | 
						|
        return false;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      R.clear();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    DC = DC->getLookupParent();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
 | 
						|
  TypoCorrection Corrected;
 | 
						|
  if (S && Out) {
 | 
						|
    SourceLocation TypoLoc = R.getNameLoc();
 | 
						|
    assert(!ExplicitTemplateArgs &&
 | 
						|
           "Diagnosing an empty lookup with explicit template args!");
 | 
						|
    *Out = CorrectTypoDelayed(
 | 
						|
        R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(), S, &SS, CCC,
 | 
						|
        [=](const TypoCorrection &TC) {
 | 
						|
          emitEmptyLookupTypoDiagnostic(TC, *this, SS, Name, TypoLoc, Args,
 | 
						|
                                        diagnostic, diagnostic_suggest);
 | 
						|
        },
 | 
						|
        nullptr, CTK_ErrorRecovery);
 | 
						|
    if (*Out)
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
  } else if (S &&
 | 
						|
             (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(),
 | 
						|
                                      S, &SS, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery))) {
 | 
						|
    std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts()));
 | 
						|
    bool DroppedSpecifier =
 | 
						|
        Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && Name.getAsString() == CorrectedStr;
 | 
						|
    R.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    bool AcceptableWithRecovery = false;
 | 
						|
    bool AcceptableWithoutRecovery = false;
 | 
						|
    NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getFoundDecl();
 | 
						|
    if (ND) {
 | 
						|
      if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) {
 | 
						|
        OverloadCandidateSet OCS(R.getNameLoc(),
 | 
						|
                                 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
 | 
						|
        OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
 | 
						|
        for (NamedDecl *CD : Corrected) {
 | 
						|
          if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD =
 | 
						|
                   dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(CD))
 | 
						|
            AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
 | 
						|
                FTD, DeclAccessPair::make(FTD, AS_none), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
 | 
						|
                Args, OCS);
 | 
						|
          else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CD))
 | 
						|
            if (!ExplicitTemplateArgs || ExplicitTemplateArgs->size() == 0)
 | 
						|
              AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none),
 | 
						|
                                   Args, OCS);
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
        switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(*this, R.getNameLoc(), Best)) {
 | 
						|
        case OR_Success:
 | 
						|
          ND = Best->FoundDecl;
 | 
						|
          Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND);
 | 
						|
          break;
 | 
						|
        default:
 | 
						|
          // FIXME: Arbitrarily pick the first declaration for the note.
 | 
						|
          Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND);
 | 
						|
          break;
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      R.addDecl(ND);
 | 
						|
      if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ND->isCXXClassMember()) {
 | 
						|
        CXXRecordDecl *Record = nullptr;
 | 
						|
        if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()) {
 | 
						|
          const Type *Ty = Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()->getAsType();
 | 
						|
          Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
        if (!Record)
 | 
						|
          Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(
 | 
						|
              ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext());
 | 
						|
        R.setNamingClass(Record);
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      auto *UnderlyingND = ND->getUnderlyingDecl();
 | 
						|
      AcceptableWithRecovery = isa<ValueDecl>(UnderlyingND) ||
 | 
						|
                               isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(UnderlyingND);
 | 
						|
      // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
 | 
						|
      // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
 | 
						|
      // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
 | 
						|
      // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
 | 
						|
      // to recover well anyway.
 | 
						|
      AcceptableWithoutRecovery = isa<TypeDecl>(UnderlyingND) ||
 | 
						|
                                  getAsTypeTemplateDecl(UnderlyingND) ||
 | 
						|
                                  isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(UnderlyingND);
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
 | 
						|
      // because we aren't able to recover.
 | 
						|
      AcceptableWithoutRecovery = true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (AcceptableWithRecovery || AcceptableWithoutRecovery) {
 | 
						|
      unsigned NoteID = Corrected.getCorrectionDeclAs<ImplicitParamDecl>()
 | 
						|
                            ? diag::note_implicit_param_decl
 | 
						|
                            : diag::note_previous_decl;
 | 
						|
      if (SS.isEmpty())
 | 
						|
        diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diagnostic_suggest) << Name,
 | 
						|
                     PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery);
 | 
						|
      else
 | 
						|
        diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::err_no_member_suggest)
 | 
						|
                                  << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
 | 
						|
                                  << DroppedSpecifier << SS.getRange(),
 | 
						|
                     PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Tell the callee whether to try to recover.
 | 
						|
      return !AcceptableWithRecovery;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  R.clear();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
 | 
						|
  if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
 | 
						|
      << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
 | 
						|
      << SS.getRange();
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Give up, we can't recover.
 | 
						|
  Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
 | 
						|
  return true;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class whose parent class has
 | 
						|
/// dependent base classes, and we can't resolve an unqualified identifier, then
 | 
						|
/// assume the identifier is a member of a dependent base class.  We can only
 | 
						|
/// recover successfully in static methods, instance methods, and other contexts
 | 
						|
/// where 'this' is available.  This doesn't precisely match MSVC's
 | 
						|
/// instantiation model, but it's close enough.
 | 
						|
static Expr *
 | 
						|
recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(Sema &S, ASTContext &Context,
 | 
						|
                               DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
 | 
						|
                               SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
 | 
						|
                               const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
 | 
						|
  // Only try to recover from lookup into dependent bases in static methods or
 | 
						|
  // contexts where 'this' is available.
 | 
						|
  QualType ThisType = S.getCurrentThisType();
 | 
						|
  const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr;
 | 
						|
  if (!ThisType.isNull())
 | 
						|
    RD = ThisType->getPointeeType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
 | 
						|
  else if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(S.CurContext))
 | 
						|
    RD = MD->getParent();
 | 
						|
  if (!RD || !RD->hasAnyDependentBases())
 | 
						|
    return nullptr;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Diagnose this as unqualified lookup into a dependent base class.  If 'this'
 | 
						|
  // is available, suggest inserting 'this->' as a fixit.
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
 | 
						|
  auto DB = S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_undeclared_unqual_id_with_dependent_base);
 | 
						|
  DB << NameInfo.getName() << RD;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!ThisType.isNull()) {
 | 
						|
    DB << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "this->");
 | 
						|
    return CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
 | 
						|
        Context, /*This=*/nullptr, ThisType, /*IsArrow=*/true,
 | 
						|
        /*Op=*/SourceLocation(), NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), TemplateKWLoc,
 | 
						|
        /*FirstQualifierFoundInScope=*/nullptr, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Synthesize a fake NNS that points to the derived class.  This will
 | 
						|
  // perform name lookup during template instantiation.
 | 
						|
  CXXScopeSpec SS;
 | 
						|
  auto *NNS =
 | 
						|
      NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, true, RD->getTypeForDecl());
 | 
						|
  SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(Loc, Loc));
 | 
						|
  return DependentScopeDeclRefExpr::Create(
 | 
						|
      Context, SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo,
 | 
						|
      TemplateArgs);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
 | 
						|
                        SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, UnqualifiedId &Id,
 | 
						|
                        bool HasTrailingLParen, bool IsAddressOfOperand,
 | 
						|
                        CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC,
 | 
						|
                        bool IsInlineAsmIdentifier, Token *KeywordReplacement) {
 | 
						|
  assert(!(IsAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
 | 
						|
         "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
 | 
						|
  if (SS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
 | 
						|
  DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
 | 
						|
  const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
 | 
						|
  DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
 | 
						|
  IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (II && II->isEditorPlaceholder()) {
 | 
						|
    // FIXME: When typed placeholders are supported we can create a typed
 | 
						|
    // placeholder expression node.
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
 | 
						|
  //   An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
 | 
						|
  //     -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
 | 
						|
  //        (note: handled after lookup)
 | 
						|
  //     -- a template-id that is dependent,
 | 
						|
  //        (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
 | 
						|
  //     -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
 | 
						|
  //     -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
 | 
						|
  //        names a dependent type.
 | 
						|
  // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
 | 
						|
  // we need to handle these differently.
 | 
						|
  bool DependentID = false;
 | 
						|
  if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
 | 
						|
      Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
 | 
						|
    DependentID = true;
 | 
						|
  } else if (SS.isSet()) {
 | 
						|
    if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) {
 | 
						|
      if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      DependentID = true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (DependentID)
 | 
						|
    return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo,
 | 
						|
                                      IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Perform the required lookup.
 | 
						|
  LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo,
 | 
						|
                 (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam)
 | 
						|
                     ? LookupObjCImplicitSelfParam
 | 
						|
                     : LookupOrdinaryName);
 | 
						|
  if (TemplateKWLoc.isValid() || TemplateArgs) {
 | 
						|
    // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
 | 
						|
    // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
 | 
						|
    // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
 | 
						|
    // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
 | 
						|
    // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
 | 
						|
    bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
 | 
						|
    AssumedTemplateKind AssumedTemplate;
 | 
						|
    if (LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
 | 
						|
                           MemberOfUnknownSpecialization, TemplateKWLoc,
 | 
						|
                           &AssumedTemplate))
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (MemberOfUnknownSpecialization ||
 | 
						|
        (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation))
 | 
						|
      return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo,
 | 
						|
                                        IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs);
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    bool IvarLookupFollowUp = II && !SS.isSet() && getCurMethodDecl();
 | 
						|
    LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // If the result might be in a dependent base class, this is a dependent
 | 
						|
    // id-expression.
 | 
						|
    if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation)
 | 
						|
      return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo,
 | 
						|
                                        IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
 | 
						|
    // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
 | 
						|
    if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
 | 
						|
      ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
 | 
						|
      if (E.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (Expr *Ex = E.getAs<Expr>())
 | 
						|
        return Ex;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (R.isAmbiguous())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // This could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal in C90,
 | 
						|
  // extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
 | 
						|
  if (R.empty() && HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
    NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
 | 
						|
    if (D) R.addDecl(D);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
 | 
						|
  // argument-dependent lookup.
 | 
						|
  bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
 | 
						|
    if (SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) {
 | 
						|
      if (Expr *E = recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(*this, Context, NameInfo,
 | 
						|
                                                   TemplateKWLoc, TemplateArgs))
 | 
						|
        return E;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Don't diagnose an empty lookup for inline assembly.
 | 
						|
    if (IsInlineAsmIdentifier)
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
 | 
						|
    // call, diagnose the problem.
 | 
						|
    TypoExpr *TE = nullptr;
 | 
						|
    DefaultFilterCCC DefaultValidator(II, SS.isValid() ? SS.getScopeRep()
 | 
						|
                                                       : nullptr);
 | 
						|
    DefaultValidator.IsAddressOfOperand = IsAddressOfOperand;
 | 
						|
    assert((!CCC || CCC->IsAddressOfOperand == IsAddressOfOperand) &&
 | 
						|
           "Typo correction callback misconfigured");
 | 
						|
    if (CCC) {
 | 
						|
      // Make sure the callback knows what the typo being diagnosed is.
 | 
						|
      CCC->setTypoName(II);
 | 
						|
      if (SS.isValid())
 | 
						|
        CCC->setTypoNNS(SS.getScopeRep());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    // FIXME: DiagnoseEmptyLookup produces bad diagnostics if we're looking for
 | 
						|
    // a template name, but we happen to have always already looked up the name
 | 
						|
    // before we get here if it must be a template name.
 | 
						|
    if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CCC ? *CCC : DefaultValidator, nullptr,
 | 
						|
                            None, &TE)) {
 | 
						|
      if (TE && KeywordReplacement) {
 | 
						|
        auto &State = getTypoExprState(TE);
 | 
						|
        auto BestTC = State.Consumer->getNextCorrection();
 | 
						|
        if (BestTC.isKeyword()) {
 | 
						|
          auto *II = BestTC.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo();
 | 
						|
          if (State.DiagHandler)
 | 
						|
            State.DiagHandler(BestTC);
 | 
						|
          KeywordReplacement->startToken();
 | 
						|
          KeywordReplacement->setKind(II->getTokenID());
 | 
						|
          KeywordReplacement->setIdentifierInfo(II);
 | 
						|
          KeywordReplacement->setLocation(BestTC.getCorrectionRange().getBegin());
 | 
						|
          // Clean up the state associated with the TypoExpr, since it has
 | 
						|
          // now been diagnosed (without a call to CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr).
 | 
						|
          clearDelayedTypo(TE);
 | 
						|
          // Signal that a correction to a keyword was performed by returning a
 | 
						|
          // valid-but-null ExprResult.
 | 
						|
          return (Expr*)nullptr;
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
        State.Consumer->resetCorrectionStream();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      return TE ? TE : ExprError();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    assert(!R.empty() &&
 | 
						|
           "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
 | 
						|
    // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
 | 
						|
    // reference the ivar.
 | 
						|
    if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
 | 
						|
      R.clear();
 | 
						|
      ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
 | 
						|
      // In a hopelessly buggy code, Objective-C instance variable
 | 
						|
      // lookup fails and no expression will be built to reference it.
 | 
						|
      if (!E.isInvalid() && !E.get())
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      return E;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // This is guaranteed from this point on.
 | 
						|
  assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
 | 
						|
  // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
 | 
						|
  //   When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
 | 
						|
  //   syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
 | 
						|
  //   body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
 | 
						|
  //   resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
 | 
						|
  //   member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
 | 
						|
  //   class member access expression using (*this) as the
 | 
						|
  //   postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
 | 
						|
  // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
 | 
						|
  // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
 | 
						|
  // non-static member function:
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
 | 
						|
  //   Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
 | 
						|
  //   [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
 | 
						|
  //   member function call.
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
 | 
						|
  // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
 | 
						|
  // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
 | 
						|
  // instance method.
 | 
						|
  if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
 | 
						|
    bool MightBeImplicitMember;
 | 
						|
    if (!IsAddressOfOperand)
 | 
						|
      MightBeImplicitMember = true;
 | 
						|
    else if (!SS.isEmpty())
 | 
						|
      MightBeImplicitMember = false;
 | 
						|
    else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
 | 
						|
      MightBeImplicitMember = false;
 | 
						|
    else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
 | 
						|
      MightBeImplicitMember = true;
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) ||
 | 
						|
                              isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) ||
 | 
						|
                              isa<MSPropertyDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (MightBeImplicitMember)
 | 
						|
      return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc,
 | 
						|
                                             R, TemplateArgs, S);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (TemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) {
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // In C++1y, if this is a variable template id, then check it
 | 
						|
    // in BuildTemplateIdExpr().
 | 
						|
    // The single lookup result must be a variable template declaration.
 | 
						|
    if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId && Id.TemplateId &&
 | 
						|
        Id.TemplateId->Kind == TNK_Var_template) {
 | 
						|
      assert(R.getAsSingle<VarTemplateDecl>() &&
 | 
						|
             "There should only be one declaration found.");
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, ADL, TemplateArgs);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
 | 
						|
/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
 | 
						|
/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
 | 
						|
/// this path.
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(
 | 
						|
    CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
 | 
						|
    bool IsAddressOfOperand, const Scope *S, TypeSourceInfo **RecoveryTSI) {
 | 
						|
  DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
 | 
						|
  if (!DC)
 | 
						|
    return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
 | 
						|
                                     NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
 | 
						|
  LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (R.isAmbiguous())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation)
 | 
						|
    return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
 | 
						|
                                     NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (R.empty()) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
 | 
						|
      << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (const TypeDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>()) {
 | 
						|
    // Diagnose a missing typename if this resolved unambiguously to a type in
 | 
						|
    // a dependent context.  If we can recover with a type, downgrade this to
 | 
						|
    // a warning in Microsoft compatibility mode.
 | 
						|
    unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing;
 | 
						|
    if (RecoveryTSI && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
 | 
						|
      DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing;
 | 
						|
    SourceLocation Loc = SS.getBeginLoc();
 | 
						|
    auto D = Diag(Loc, DiagID);
 | 
						|
    D << SS.getScopeRep() << NameInfo.getName().getAsString()
 | 
						|
      << SourceRange(Loc, NameInfo.getEndLoc());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Don't recover if the caller isn't expecting us to or if we're in a SFINAE
 | 
						|
    // context.
 | 
						|
    if (!RecoveryTSI)
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Only issue the fixit if we're prepared to recover.
 | 
						|
    D << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "typename ");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Recover by pretending this was an elaborated type.
 | 
						|
    QualType Ty = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD);
 | 
						|
    TypeLocBuilder TLB;
 | 
						|
    TLB.pushTypeSpec(Ty).setNameLoc(NameInfo.getLoc());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    QualType ET = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, SS, Ty);
 | 
						|
    ElaboratedTypeLoc QTL = TLB.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(ET);
 | 
						|
    QTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
 | 
						|
    QTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    *RecoveryTSI = TLB.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, ET);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return ExprEmpty();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Defend against this resolving to an implicit member access. We usually
 | 
						|
  // won't get here if this might be a legitimate a class member (we end up in
 | 
						|
  // BuildMemberReferenceExpr instead), but this can be valid if we're forming
 | 
						|
  // a pointer-to-member or in an unevaluated context in C++11.
 | 
						|
  if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember() && !IsAddressOfOperand)
 | 
						|
    return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS,
 | 
						|
                                           /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
 | 
						|
                                           R, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr, S);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /* ADL */ false);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// The parser has read a name in, and Sema has detected that we're currently
 | 
						|
/// inside an ObjC method. Perform some additional checks and determine if we
 | 
						|
/// should form a reference to an ivar.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
 | 
						|
/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
 | 
						|
DeclResult Sema::LookupIvarInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
 | 
						|
                                        IdentifierInfo *II) {
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
 | 
						|
  ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check for error condition which is already reported.
 | 
						|
  if (!CurMethod)
 | 
						|
    return DeclResult(true);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // There are two cases to handle here.  1) scoped lookup could have failed,
 | 
						|
  // in which case we should look for an ivar.  2) scoped lookup could have
 | 
						|
  // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
 | 
						|
  // a global variable).  In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
 | 
						|
  // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
 | 
						|
  // ivars.  But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
 | 
						|
  // ivar, that's an error.
 | 
						|
  bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool LookForIvars;
 | 
						|
  if (Lookup.empty())
 | 
						|
    LookForIvars = true;
 | 
						|
  else if (IsClassMethod)
 | 
						|
    LookForIvars = false;
 | 
						|
  else
 | 
						|
    LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
 | 
						|
                    Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
 | 
						|
  ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr;
 | 
						|
  if (LookForIvars) {
 | 
						|
    IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
 | 
						|
    ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
 | 
						|
    ObjCIvarDecl *IV = nullptr;
 | 
						|
    if (IFace && (IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared))) {
 | 
						|
      // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
 | 
						|
      if (IsClassMethod) {
 | 
						|
        Diag(Loc, diag::err_ivar_use_in_class_method) << IV->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
        return DeclResult(true);
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
 | 
						|
      if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
 | 
						|
          !declaresSameEntity(ClassDeclared, IFace) &&
 | 
						|
          !getLangOpts().DebuggerSupport)
 | 
						|
        Diag(Loc, diag::err_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Success.
 | 
						|
      return IV;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
 | 
						|
    // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
 | 
						|
    if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface()) {
 | 
						|
      ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
 | 
						|
      if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
 | 
						|
        if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
 | 
						|
            declaresSameEntity(IFace, ClassDeclared))
 | 
						|
          Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } else if (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
 | 
						|
             Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod()) {
 | 
						|
    // If accessing a stand-alone ivar in a class method, this is an error.
 | 
						|
    if (const ObjCIvarDecl *IV =
 | 
						|
            dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(Lookup.getFoundDecl())) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(Loc, diag::err_ivar_use_in_class_method) << IV->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
      return DeclResult(true);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Didn't encounter an error, didn't find an ivar.
 | 
						|
  return DeclResult(false);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::BuildIvarRefExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                  ObjCIvarDecl *IV) {
 | 
						|
  ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
 | 
						|
  assert(CurMethod && CurMethod->isInstanceMethod() &&
 | 
						|
         "should not reference ivar from this context");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
 | 
						|
  assert(IFace && "should not reference ivar from this context");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
 | 
						|
  // error node.  The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
 | 
						|
  if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
 | 
						|
  if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
 | 
						|
  // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
 | 
						|
  IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
 | 
						|
  UnqualifiedId SelfName;
 | 
						|
  SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
 | 
						|
  SelfName.setKind(UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam);
 | 
						|
  CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc;
 | 
						|
  ExprResult SelfExpr =
 | 
						|
      ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec, TemplateKWLoc, SelfName,
 | 
						|
                        /*HasTrailingLParen=*/false,
 | 
						|
                        /*IsAddressOfOperand=*/false);
 | 
						|
  if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  SelfExpr = DefaultLvalueConversion(SelfExpr.get());
 | 
						|
  if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, IV, true);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ObjCMethodFamily MF = CurMethod->getMethodFamily();
 | 
						|
  if (MF != OMF_init && MF != OMF_dealloc && MF != OMF_finalize &&
 | 
						|
      !IvarBacksCurrentMethodAccessor(IFace, CurMethod, IV))
 | 
						|
    Diag(Loc, diag::warn_direct_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ObjCIvarRefExpr *Result = new (Context)
 | 
						|
      ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getUsageType(SelfExpr.get()->getType()), Loc,
 | 
						|
                      IV->getLocation(), SelfExpr.get(), true, true);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (IV->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) {
 | 
						|
    if (!isUnevaluatedContext() &&
 | 
						|
        !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, Loc))
 | 
						|
      getCurFunction()->recordUseOfWeak(Result);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
 | 
						|
    if (const BlockDecl *BD = CurContext->getInnermostBlockDecl())
 | 
						|
      ImplicitlyRetainedSelfLocs.push_back({Loc, BD});
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return Result;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// The parser has read a name in, and Sema has detected that we're currently
 | 
						|
/// inside an ObjC method. Perform some additional checks and determine if we
 | 
						|
/// should form a reference to an ivar. If so, build an expression referencing
 | 
						|
/// that ivar.
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
 | 
						|
                         IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: Integrate this lookup step into LookupParsedName.
 | 
						|
  DeclResult Ivar = LookupIvarInObjCMethod(Lookup, S, II);
 | 
						|
  if (Ivar.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  if (Ivar.isUsable())
 | 
						|
    return BuildIvarRefExpr(S, Lookup.getNameLoc(),
 | 
						|
                            cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(Ivar.get()));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation)
 | 
						|
    LookupBuiltin(Lookup);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
 | 
						|
  return ExprResult(false);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// Logically this happens in three phases:
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
 | 
						|
///   The naming class is the class into which we were looking
 | 
						|
///   when we found the member;  it's the qualifier type if a
 | 
						|
///   qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
 | 
						|
///   If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
 | 
						|
///   a using declaration, this is that class;  otherwise it's
 | 
						|
///   the class declaring the member.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
 | 
						|
///   declaring class of the member.  This conversion does not
 | 
						|
///   obey access control.
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *From,
 | 
						|
                                    NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
 | 
						|
                                    NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
 | 
						|
                                    NamedDecl *Member) {
 | 
						|
  CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
 | 
						|
  if (!RD)
 | 
						|
    return From;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType DestRecordType;
 | 
						|
  QualType DestType;
 | 
						|
  QualType FromRecordType;
 | 
						|
  QualType FromType = From->getType();
 | 
						|
  bool PointerConversions = false;
 | 
						|
  if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
 | 
						|
    DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
 | 
						|
    auto FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
 | 
						|
    DestRecordType = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(
 | 
						|
        DestRecordType, FromPtrType
 | 
						|
                            ? FromType->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace()
 | 
						|
                            : FromType.getAddressSpace());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (FromPtrType) {
 | 
						|
      DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
 | 
						|
      FromRecordType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
      PointerConversions = true;
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      DestType = DestRecordType;
 | 
						|
      FromRecordType = FromType;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
 | 
						|
    if (Method->isStatic())
 | 
						|
      return From;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    DestType = Method->getThisType();
 | 
						|
    DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
 | 
						|
      FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
      PointerConversions = true;
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      FromRecordType = FromType;
 | 
						|
      DestType = DestRecordType;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    LangAS FromAS = FromRecordType.getAddressSpace();
 | 
						|
    LangAS DestAS = DestRecordType.getAddressSpace();
 | 
						|
    if (FromAS != DestAS) {
 | 
						|
      QualType FromRecordTypeWithoutAS =
 | 
						|
          Context.removeAddrSpaceQualType(FromRecordType);
 | 
						|
      QualType FromTypeWithDestAS =
 | 
						|
          Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(FromRecordTypeWithoutAS, DestAS);
 | 
						|
      if (PointerConversions)
 | 
						|
        FromTypeWithDestAS = Context.getPointerType(FromTypeWithDestAS);
 | 
						|
      From = ImpCastExprToType(From, FromTypeWithDestAS,
 | 
						|
                               CK_AddressSpaceConversion, From->getValueKind())
 | 
						|
                 .get();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    // No conversion necessary.
 | 
						|
    return From;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
 | 
						|
    return From;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
 | 
						|
  if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
 | 
						|
    return From;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ExprValueKind VK = From->getValueKind();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
 | 
						|
  //   [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
 | 
						|
  //   class name.
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
 | 
						|
  // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
 | 
						|
  // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
 | 
						|
  // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  //   class Base { public: int x; };
 | 
						|
  //   class Derived1 : public Base { };
 | 
						|
  //   class Derived2 : public Base { };
 | 
						|
  //   class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  //   void VeryDerived::f() {
 | 
						|
  //     x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
 | 
						|
  //     Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
 | 
						|
  //   }
 | 
						|
  if (Qualifier && Qualifier->getAsType()) {
 | 
						|
    QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
 | 
						|
    assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
 | 
						|
    // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
 | 
						|
    // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
 | 
						|
    if (IsDerivedFrom(FromLoc, FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
 | 
						|
      CXXCastPath BasePath;
 | 
						|
      if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
 | 
						|
                                       FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (PointerConversions)
 | 
						|
        QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
 | 
						|
      From = ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
 | 
						|
                               VK, &BasePath).get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      FromType = QType;
 | 
						|
      FromRecordType = QRecordType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
 | 
						|
      // we're done.
 | 
						|
      if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
 | 
						|
        return From;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool IgnoreAccess = false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
 | 
						|
  // down to the using declaration's type.
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
 | 
						|
  // class ever has member declarations.
 | 
						|
  if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
 | 
						|
    assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
 | 
						|
    QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
 | 
						|
                           cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
 | 
						|
    // conversion is non-trivial.
 | 
						|
    if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
 | 
						|
      assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromLoc, FromRecordType, URecordType));
 | 
						|
      CXXCastPath BasePath;
 | 
						|
      if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
 | 
						|
                                       FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      QualType UType = URecordType;
 | 
						|
      if (PointerConversions)
 | 
						|
        UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
 | 
						|
      From = ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
 | 
						|
                               VK, &BasePath).get();
 | 
						|
      FromType = UType;
 | 
						|
      FromRecordType = URecordType;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
 | 
						|
    // declaring class to the true declaring class.
 | 
						|
    IgnoreAccess = true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  CXXCastPath BasePath;
 | 
						|
  if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
 | 
						|
                                   FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
 | 
						|
                                   IgnoreAccess))
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
 | 
						|
                           VK, &BasePath);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
 | 
						|
                                      const LookupResult &R,
 | 
						|
                                      bool HasTrailingLParen) {
 | 
						|
  // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
 | 
						|
  if (!HasTrailingLParen)
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
 | 
						|
  if (SS.isSet())
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
 | 
						|
  if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
 | 
						|
  // normal lookup:
 | 
						|
  for (NamedDecl *D : R) {
 | 
						|
    // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
 | 
						|
    //     -- a declaration of a class member
 | 
						|
    // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
 | 
						|
    // original decl.
 | 
						|
    if (D->isCXXClassMember())
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
 | 
						|
    //     -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
 | 
						|
    //        using-declaration
 | 
						|
    // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
 | 
						|
    // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
 | 
						|
    // turn off ADL anyway).
 | 
						|
    if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
 | 
						|
      D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
 | 
						|
    else if (D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
 | 
						|
    //     -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
 | 
						|
    //        template
 | 
						|
    // And also for builtin functions.
 | 
						|
    if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
      FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // But also builtin functions.
 | 
						|
      if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
 | 
						|
        return false;
 | 
						|
    } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return true;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
 | 
						|
/// as an expression.  This is only actually called for lookups that
 | 
						|
/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
 | 
						|
/// will in fact be used.
 | 
						|
static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
 | 
						|
  if (D->isInvalidDecl())
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// Certain multiversion types should be treated as overloaded even when there is
 | 
						|
// only one result.
 | 
						|
static bool ShouldLookupResultBeMultiVersionOverload(const LookupResult &R) {
 | 
						|
  assert(R.isSingleResult() && "Expected only a single result");
 | 
						|
  const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
 | 
						|
  return FD &&
 | 
						|
         (FD->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() || FD->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion());
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
 | 
						|
                                          LookupResult &R, bool NeedsADL,
 | 
						|
                                          bool AcceptInvalidDecl) {
 | 
						|
  // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
 | 
						|
  // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
 | 
						|
  if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() &&
 | 
						|
      !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>() &&
 | 
						|
      !ShouldLookupResultBeMultiVersionOverload(R))
 | 
						|
    return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getFoundDecl(),
 | 
						|
                                    R.getRepresentativeDecl(), nullptr,
 | 
						|
                                    AcceptInvalidDecl);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
 | 
						|
  // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
 | 
						|
  // functions and function templates.
 | 
						|
  if (R.isSingleResult() && !ShouldLookupResultBeMultiVersionOverload(R) &&
 | 
						|
      CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression.  Suppress
 | 
						|
  // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
 | 
						|
  // we've picked a target.
 | 
						|
  R.suppressDiagnostics();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
 | 
						|
    = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, R.getNamingClass(),
 | 
						|
                                   SS.getWithLocInContext(Context),
 | 
						|
                                   R.getLookupNameInfo(),
 | 
						|
                                   NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
 | 
						|
                                   R.begin(), R.end());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return ULE;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void
 | 
						|
diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(Sema &S, SourceLocation loc,
 | 
						|
                                   ValueDecl *var, DeclContext *DC);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(
 | 
						|
    const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, NamedDecl *D,
 | 
						|
    NamedDecl *FoundD, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
 | 
						|
    bool AcceptInvalidDecl) {
 | 
						|
  assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
 | 
						|
  assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
 | 
						|
         "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
 | 
						|
  if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
    // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
 | 
						|
    // a template argument list.
 | 
						|
    diagnoseMissingTemplateArguments(TemplateName(Template), Loc);
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
 | 
						|
  ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
 | 
						|
  if (!VD) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
 | 
						|
      << D << SS.getRange();
 | 
						|
    Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
 | 
						|
  // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
 | 
						|
  // on this function name, because this might not be the function
 | 
						|
  // that overload resolution actually selects.
 | 
						|
  if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
 | 
						|
  if (VD->isInvalidDecl() && !AcceptInvalidDecl)
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Handle members of anonymous structs and unions.  If we got here,
 | 
						|
  // and the reference is to a class member indirect field, then this
 | 
						|
  // must be the subject of a pointer-to-member expression.
 | 
						|
  if (IndirectFieldDecl *indirectField = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD))
 | 
						|
    if (!indirectField->isCXXClassMember())
 | 
						|
      return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SS, NameInfo.getLoc(),
 | 
						|
                                                      indirectField);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  {
 | 
						|
    QualType type = VD->getType();
 | 
						|
    if (type.isNull())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    ExprValueKind valueKind = VK_RValue;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    switch (D->getKind()) {
 | 
						|
    // Ignore all the non-ValueDecl kinds.
 | 
						|
#define ABSTRACT_DECL(kind)
 | 
						|
#define VALUE(type, base)
 | 
						|
#define DECL(type, base) \
 | 
						|
    case Decl::type:
 | 
						|
#include "clang/AST/DeclNodes.inc"
 | 
						|
      llvm_unreachable("invalid value decl kind");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // These shouldn't make it here.
 | 
						|
    case Decl::ObjCAtDefsField:
 | 
						|
      llvm_unreachable("forming non-member reference to ivar?");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Enum constants are always r-values and never references.
 | 
						|
    // Unresolved using declarations are dependent.
 | 
						|
    case Decl::EnumConstant:
 | 
						|
    case Decl::UnresolvedUsingValue:
 | 
						|
    case Decl::OMPDeclareReduction:
 | 
						|
    case Decl::OMPDeclareMapper:
 | 
						|
      valueKind = VK_RValue;
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Fields and indirect fields that got here must be for
 | 
						|
    // pointer-to-member expressions; we just call them l-values for
 | 
						|
    // internal consistency, because this subexpression doesn't really
 | 
						|
    // exist in the high-level semantics.
 | 
						|
    case Decl::Field:
 | 
						|
    case Decl::IndirectField:
 | 
						|
    case Decl::ObjCIvar:
 | 
						|
      assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
 | 
						|
             "building reference to field in C?");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // These can't have reference type in well-formed programs, but
 | 
						|
      // for internal consistency we do this anyway.
 | 
						|
      type = type.getNonReferenceType();
 | 
						|
      valueKind = VK_LValue;
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Non-type template parameters are either l-values or r-values
 | 
						|
    // depending on the type.
 | 
						|
    case Decl::NonTypeTemplateParm: {
 | 
						|
      if (const ReferenceType *reftype = type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
 | 
						|
        type = reftype->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
        valueKind = VK_LValue; // even if the parameter is an r-value reference
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // For non-references, we need to strip qualifiers just in case
 | 
						|
      // the template parameter was declared as 'const int' or whatever.
 | 
						|
      valueKind = VK_RValue;
 | 
						|
      type = type.getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    case Decl::Var:
 | 
						|
    case Decl::VarTemplateSpecialization:
 | 
						|
    case Decl::VarTemplatePartialSpecialization:
 | 
						|
    case Decl::Decomposition:
 | 
						|
    case Decl::OMPCapturedExpr:
 | 
						|
      // In C, "extern void blah;" is valid and is an r-value.
 | 
						|
      if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
 | 
						|
          !type.hasQualifiers() &&
 | 
						|
          type->isVoidType()) {
 | 
						|
        valueKind = VK_RValue;
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    case Decl::ImplicitParam:
 | 
						|
    case Decl::ParmVar: {
 | 
						|
      // These are always l-values.
 | 
						|
      valueKind = VK_LValue;
 | 
						|
      type = type.getNonReferenceType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // FIXME: Does the addition of const really only apply in
 | 
						|
      // potentially-evaluated contexts? Since the variable isn't actually
 | 
						|
      // captured in an unevaluated context, it seems that the answer is no.
 | 
						|
      if (!isUnevaluatedContext()) {
 | 
						|
        QualType CapturedType = getCapturedDeclRefType(cast<VarDecl>(VD), Loc);
 | 
						|
        if (!CapturedType.isNull())
 | 
						|
          type = CapturedType;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    case Decl::Binding: {
 | 
						|
      // These are always lvalues.
 | 
						|
      valueKind = VK_LValue;
 | 
						|
      type = type.getNonReferenceType();
 | 
						|
      // FIXME: Support lambda-capture of BindingDecls, once CWG actually
 | 
						|
      // decides how that's supposed to work.
 | 
						|
      auto *BD = cast<BindingDecl>(VD);
 | 
						|
      if (BD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
 | 
						|
        auto *DD = dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(BD->getDecomposedDecl());
 | 
						|
        if (DD && DD->hasLocalStorage())
 | 
						|
          diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(*this, Loc, BD, CurContext);
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    case Decl::Function: {
 | 
						|
      if (unsigned BID = cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->getBuiltinID()) {
 | 
						|
        if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BID)) {
 | 
						|
          type = Context.BuiltinFnTy;
 | 
						|
          valueKind = VK_RValue;
 | 
						|
          break;
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      const FunctionType *fty = type->castAs<FunctionType>();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // If we're referring to a function with an __unknown_anytype
 | 
						|
      // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype.
 | 
						|
      if (fty->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
 | 
						|
        type = Context.UnknownAnyTy;
 | 
						|
        valueKind = VK_RValue;
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Functions are l-values in C++.
 | 
						|
      if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
        valueKind = VK_LValue;
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
 | 
						|
      // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
 | 
						|
      // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
 | 
						|
      // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
 | 
						|
      // type.
 | 
						|
      if (!cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->hasPrototype() &&
 | 
						|
          isa<FunctionProtoType>(fty))
 | 
						|
        type = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(fty->getReturnType(),
 | 
						|
                                              fty->getExtInfo());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Functions are r-values in C.
 | 
						|
      valueKind = VK_RValue;
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    case Decl::CXXDeductionGuide:
 | 
						|
      llvm_unreachable("building reference to deduction guide");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    case Decl::MSProperty:
 | 
						|
      valueKind = VK_LValue;
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    case Decl::CXXMethod:
 | 
						|
      // If we're referring to a method with an __unknown_anytype
 | 
						|
      // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype.
 | 
						|
      // This should only be possible with a type written directly.
 | 
						|
      if (const FunctionProtoType *proto
 | 
						|
            = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(VD->getType()))
 | 
						|
        if (proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
 | 
						|
          type = Context.UnknownAnyTy;
 | 
						|
          valueKind = VK_RValue;
 | 
						|
          break;
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // C++ methods are l-values if static, r-values if non-static.
 | 
						|
      if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isStatic()) {
 | 
						|
        valueKind = VK_LValue;
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    case Decl::CXXConversion:
 | 
						|
    case Decl::CXXDestructor:
 | 
						|
    case Decl::CXXConstructor:
 | 
						|
      valueKind = VK_RValue;
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, type, valueKind, NameInfo, &SS, FoundD,
 | 
						|
                            /*FIXME: TemplateKWLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
 | 
						|
                            TemplateArgs);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void ConvertUTF8ToWideString(unsigned CharByteWidth, StringRef Source,
 | 
						|
                                    SmallString<32> &Target) {
 | 
						|
  Target.resize(CharByteWidth * (Source.size() + 1));
 | 
						|
  char *ResultPtr = &Target[0];
 | 
						|
  const llvm::UTF8 *ErrorPtr;
 | 
						|
  bool success =
 | 
						|
      llvm::ConvertUTF8toWide(CharByteWidth, Source, ResultPtr, ErrorPtr);
 | 
						|
  (void)success;
 | 
						|
  assert(success);
 | 
						|
  Target.resize(ResultPtr - &Target[0]);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::BuildPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                     PredefinedExpr::IdentKind IK) {
 | 
						|
  // Pick the current block, lambda, captured statement or function.
 | 
						|
  Decl *currentDecl = nullptr;
 | 
						|
  if (const BlockScopeInfo *BSI = getCurBlock())
 | 
						|
    currentDecl = BSI->TheDecl;
 | 
						|
  else if (const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = getCurLambda())
 | 
						|
    currentDecl = LSI->CallOperator;
 | 
						|
  else if (const CapturedRegionScopeInfo *CSI = getCurCapturedRegion())
 | 
						|
    currentDecl = CSI->TheCapturedDecl;
 | 
						|
  else
 | 
						|
    currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!currentDecl) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
 | 
						|
    currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType ResTy;
 | 
						|
  StringLiteral *SL = nullptr;
 | 
						|
  if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext())
 | 
						|
    ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
 | 
						|
  else {
 | 
						|
    // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of
 | 
						|
    // the string.
 | 
						|
    auto Str = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IK, currentDecl);
 | 
						|
    unsigned Length = Str.length();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
 | 
						|
    if (IK == PredefinedExpr::LFunction || IK == PredefinedExpr::LFuncSig) {
 | 
						|
      ResTy =
 | 
						|
          Context.adjustStringLiteralBaseType(Context.WideCharTy.withConst());
 | 
						|
      SmallString<32> RawChars;
 | 
						|
      ConvertUTF8ToWideString(Context.getTypeSizeInChars(ResTy).getQuantity(),
 | 
						|
                              Str, RawChars);
 | 
						|
      ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, nullptr,
 | 
						|
                                           ArrayType::Normal,
 | 
						|
                                           /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0);
 | 
						|
      SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, RawChars, StringLiteral::Wide,
 | 
						|
                                 /*Pascal*/ false, ResTy, Loc);
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      ResTy = Context.adjustStringLiteralBaseType(Context.CharTy.withConst());
 | 
						|
      ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, nullptr,
 | 
						|
                                           ArrayType::Normal,
 | 
						|
                                           /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0);
 | 
						|
      SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Str, StringLiteral::Ascii,
 | 
						|
                                 /*Pascal*/ false, ResTy, Loc);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return PredefinedExpr::Create(Context, Loc, ResTy, IK, SL);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, tok::TokenKind Kind) {
 | 
						|
  PredefinedExpr::IdentKind IK;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  switch (Kind) {
 | 
						|
  default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown simple primary expr!");
 | 
						|
  case tok::kw___func__: IK = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
 | 
						|
  case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IK = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::kw___FUNCDNAME__: IK = PredefinedExpr::FuncDName; break; // [MS]
 | 
						|
  case tok::kw___FUNCSIG__: IK = PredefinedExpr::FuncSig; break; // [MS]
 | 
						|
  case tok::kw_L__FUNCTION__: IK = PredefinedExpr::LFunction; break; // [MS]
 | 
						|
  case tok::kw_L__FUNCSIG__: IK = PredefinedExpr::LFuncSig; break; // [MS]
 | 
						|
  case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IK = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return BuildPredefinedExpr(Loc, IK);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) {
 | 
						|
  SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
 | 
						|
  bool Invalid = false;
 | 
						|
  StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
 | 
						|
  if (Invalid)
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
 | 
						|
                            PP, Tok.getKind());
 | 
						|
  if (Literal.hadError())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType Ty;
 | 
						|
  if (Literal.isWide())
 | 
						|
    Ty = Context.WideCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C and C++.
 | 
						|
  else if (Literal.isUTF8() && getLangOpts().Char8)
 | 
						|
    Ty = Context.Char8Ty; // u8'x' -> char8_t when it exists.
 | 
						|
  else if (Literal.isUTF16())
 | 
						|
    Ty = Context.Char16Ty; // u'x' -> char16_t in C11 and C++11.
 | 
						|
  else if (Literal.isUTF32())
 | 
						|
    Ty = Context.Char32Ty; // U'x' -> char32_t in C11 and C++11.
 | 
						|
  else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || Literal.isMultiChar())
 | 
						|
    Ty = Context.IntTy;   // 'x' -> int in C, 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
 | 
						|
  else
 | 
						|
    Ty = Context.CharTy;  // 'x' -> char in C++
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  CharacterLiteral::CharacterKind Kind = CharacterLiteral::Ascii;
 | 
						|
  if (Literal.isWide())
 | 
						|
    Kind = CharacterLiteral::Wide;
 | 
						|
  else if (Literal.isUTF16())
 | 
						|
    Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF16;
 | 
						|
  else if (Literal.isUTF32())
 | 
						|
    Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF32;
 | 
						|
  else if (Literal.isUTF8())
 | 
						|
    Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF8;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Expr *Lit = new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(), Kind, Ty,
 | 
						|
                                             Tok.getLocation());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty())
 | 
						|
    return Lit;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // We're building a user-defined literal.
 | 
						|
  IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix());
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc =
 | 
						|
    getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here.
 | 
						|
  if (!UDLScope)
 | 
						|
    return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_character_udl));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++11 [lex.ext]p6: The literal L is treated as a call of the form
 | 
						|
  //   operator "" X (ch)
 | 
						|
  return BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(*this, UDLScope, UDSuffix, UDSuffixLoc,
 | 
						|
                                        Lit, Tok.getLocation());
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnIntegerConstant(SourceLocation Loc, uint64_t Val) {
 | 
						|
  unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth();
 | 
						|
  return IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val),
 | 
						|
                                Context.IntTy, Loc);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static Expr *BuildFloatingLiteral(Sema &S, NumericLiteralParser &Literal,
 | 
						|
                                  QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc) {
 | 
						|
  const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  using llvm::APFloat;
 | 
						|
  APFloat Val(Format);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
 | 
						|
  // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
 | 
						|
  if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
 | 
						|
      ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
 | 
						|
    unsigned diagnostic;
 | 
						|
    SmallString<20> buffer;
 | 
						|
    if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
 | 
						|
      diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
 | 
						|
      APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
 | 
						|
      APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diagnostic)
 | 
						|
      << Ty
 | 
						|
      << StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
 | 
						|
  return FloatingLiteral::Create(S.Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Loc);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
bool Sema::CheckLoopHintExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
 | 
						|
  assert(E && "Invalid expression");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (E->isValueDependent())
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType QT = E->getType();
 | 
						|
  if (!QT->isIntegerType() || QT->isBooleanType() || QT->isCharType()) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_pragma_loop_invalid_argument_type) << QT;
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  llvm::APSInt ValueAPS;
 | 
						|
  ExprResult R = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, &ValueAPS);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (R.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool ValueIsPositive = ValueAPS.isStrictlyPositive();
 | 
						|
  if (!ValueIsPositive || ValueAPS.getActiveBits() > 31) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_pragma_loop_invalid_argument_value)
 | 
						|
        << ValueAPS.toString(10) << ValueIsPositive;
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) {
 | 
						|
  // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common).  A single digit
 | 
						|
  // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or suffix.
 | 
						|
  if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
 | 
						|
    const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
 | 
						|
    return ActOnIntegerConstant(Tok.getLocation(), Val-'0');
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  SmallString<128> SpellingBuffer;
 | 
						|
  // NumericLiteralParser wants to overread by one character.  Add padding to
 | 
						|
  // the buffer in case the token is copied to the buffer.  If getSpelling()
 | 
						|
  // returns a StringRef to the memory buffer, it should have a null char at
 | 
						|
  // the EOF, so it is also safe.
 | 
						|
  SpellingBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength() + 1);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
 | 
						|
  bool Invalid = false;
 | 
						|
  StringRef TokSpelling = PP.getSpelling(Tok, SpellingBuffer, &Invalid);
 | 
						|
  if (Invalid)
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  NumericLiteralParser Literal(TokSpelling, Tok.getLocation(), PP);
 | 
						|
  if (Literal.hadError)
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Literal.hasUDSuffix()) {
 | 
						|
    // We're building a user-defined literal.
 | 
						|
    IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix());
 | 
						|
    SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc =
 | 
						|
      getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here.
 | 
						|
    if (!UDLScope)
 | 
						|
      return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_numeric_udl));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    QualType CookedTy;
 | 
						|
    if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
 | 
						|
      // C++11 [lex.ext]p4: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type
 | 
						|
      // long double, the literal is treated as a call of the form
 | 
						|
      //   operator "" X (f L)
 | 
						|
      CookedTy = Context.LongDoubleTy;
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      // C++11 [lex.ext]p3: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type
 | 
						|
      // unsigned long long, the literal is treated as a call of the form
 | 
						|
      //   operator "" X (n ULL)
 | 
						|
      CookedTy = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    DeclarationName OpName =
 | 
						|
      Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix);
 | 
						|
    DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc);
 | 
						|
    OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    SourceLocation TokLoc = Tok.getLocation();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Perform literal operator lookup to determine if we're building a raw
 | 
						|
    // literal or a cooked one.
 | 
						|
    LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
 | 
						|
    switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, CookedTy,
 | 
						|
                                  /*AllowRaw*/ true, /*AllowTemplate*/ true,
 | 
						|
                                  /*AllowStringTemplate*/ false,
 | 
						|
                                  /*DiagnoseMissing*/ !Literal.isImaginary)) {
 | 
						|
    case LOLR_ErrorNoDiagnostic:
 | 
						|
      // Lookup failure for imaginary constants isn't fatal, there's still the
 | 
						|
      // GNU extension producing _Complex types.
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    case LOLR_Error:
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    case LOLR_Cooked: {
 | 
						|
      Expr *Lit;
 | 
						|
      if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
 | 
						|
        Lit = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, CookedTy, Tok.getLocation());
 | 
						|
      } else {
 | 
						|
        llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(), 0);
 | 
						|
        if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal))
 | 
						|
          Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large)
 | 
						|
              << /* Unsigned */ 1;
 | 
						|
        Lit = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, CookedTy,
 | 
						|
                                     Tok.getLocation());
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    case LOLR_Raw: {
 | 
						|
      // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: If S contains a raw literal operator, the
 | 
						|
      // literal is treated as a call of the form
 | 
						|
      //   operator "" X ("n")
 | 
						|
      unsigned Length = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset();
 | 
						|
      QualType StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(
 | 
						|
          Context.adjustStringLiteralBaseType(Context.CharTy.withConst()),
 | 
						|
          llvm::APInt(32, Length + 1), nullptr, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
 | 
						|
      Expr *Lit = StringLiteral::Create(
 | 
						|
          Context, StringRef(TokSpelling.data(), Length), StringLiteral::Ascii,
 | 
						|
          /*Pascal*/false, StrTy, &TokLoc, 1);
 | 
						|
      return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    case LOLR_Template: {
 | 
						|
      // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: Otherwise (S contains a literal operator
 | 
						|
      // template), L is treated as a call fo the form
 | 
						|
      //   operator "" X <'c1', 'c2', ... 'ck'>()
 | 
						|
      // where n is the source character sequence c1 c2 ... ck.
 | 
						|
      TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs;
 | 
						|
      unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(Context.CharTy);
 | 
						|
      bool CharIsUnsigned = Context.CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType();
 | 
						|
      llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned);
 | 
						|
      for (unsigned I = 0, N = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset(); I != N; ++I) {
 | 
						|
        Value = TokSpelling[I];
 | 
						|
        TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, Context.CharTy);
 | 
						|
        TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo;
 | 
						|
        ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo));
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, None, TokLoc,
 | 
						|
                                      &ExplicitArgs);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    case LOLR_StringTemplate:
 | 
						|
      llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result");
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Expr *Res;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Literal.isFixedPointLiteral()) {
 | 
						|
    QualType Ty;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (Literal.isAccum) {
 | 
						|
      if (Literal.isHalf) {
 | 
						|
        Ty = Context.ShortAccumTy;
 | 
						|
      } else if (Literal.isLong) {
 | 
						|
        Ty = Context.LongAccumTy;
 | 
						|
      } else {
 | 
						|
        Ty = Context.AccumTy;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    } else if (Literal.isFract) {
 | 
						|
      if (Literal.isHalf) {
 | 
						|
        Ty = Context.ShortFractTy;
 | 
						|
      } else if (Literal.isLong) {
 | 
						|
        Ty = Context.LongFractTy;
 | 
						|
      } else {
 | 
						|
        Ty = Context.FractTy;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (Literal.isUnsigned) Ty = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(Ty);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    bool isSigned = !Literal.isUnsigned;
 | 
						|
    unsigned scale = Context.getFixedPointScale(Ty);
 | 
						|
    unsigned bit_width = Context.getTypeInfo(Ty).Width;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    llvm::APInt Val(bit_width, 0, isSigned);
 | 
						|
    bool Overflowed = Literal.GetFixedPointValue(Val, scale);
 | 
						|
    bool ValIsZero = Val.isNullValue() && !Overflowed;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    auto MaxVal = Context.getFixedPointMax(Ty).getValue();
 | 
						|
    if (Literal.isFract && Val == MaxVal + 1 && !ValIsZero)
 | 
						|
      // Clause 6.4.4 - The value of a constant shall be in the range of
 | 
						|
      // representable values for its type, with exception for constants of a
 | 
						|
      // fract type with a value of exactly 1; such a constant shall denote
 | 
						|
      // the maximal value for the type.
 | 
						|
      --Val;
 | 
						|
    else if (Val.ugt(MaxVal) || Overflowed)
 | 
						|
      Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_too_large_for_fixed_point);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    Res = FixedPointLiteral::CreateFromRawInt(Context, Val, Ty,
 | 
						|
                                              Tok.getLocation(), scale);
 | 
						|
  } else if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
 | 
						|
    QualType Ty;
 | 
						|
    if (Literal.isHalf){
 | 
						|
      if (getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp16"))
 | 
						|
        Ty = Context.HalfTy;
 | 
						|
      else {
 | 
						|
        Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_half_const_requires_fp16);
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    } else if (Literal.isFloat)
 | 
						|
      Ty = Context.FloatTy;
 | 
						|
    else if (Literal.isLong)
 | 
						|
      Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
 | 
						|
    else if (Literal.isFloat16)
 | 
						|
      Ty = Context.Float16Ty;
 | 
						|
    else if (Literal.isFloat128)
 | 
						|
      Ty = Context.Float128Ty;
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    Res = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (Ty == Context.DoubleTy) {
 | 
						|
      if (getLangOpts().SinglePrecisionConstants) {
 | 
						|
        const BuiltinType *BTy = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>();
 | 
						|
        if (BTy->getKind() != BuiltinType::Float) {
 | 
						|
          Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      } else if (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
 | 
						|
                 !getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp64")) {
 | 
						|
        // Impose single-precision float type when cl_khr_fp64 is not enabled.
 | 
						|
        Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_double_const_requires_fp64);
 | 
						|
        Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    QualType Ty;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // 'long long' is a C99 or C++11 feature.
 | 
						|
    if (!getLangOpts().C99 && Literal.isLongLong) {
 | 
						|
      if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
 | 
						|
        Diag(Tok.getLocation(),
 | 
						|
             getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ?
 | 
						|
             diag::warn_cxx98_compat_longlong : diag::ext_cxx11_longlong);
 | 
						|
      else
 | 
						|
        Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_longlong);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
 | 
						|
    unsigned MaxWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntMaxTWidth();
 | 
						|
    llvm::APInt ResultVal(MaxWidth, 0);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
 | 
						|
      // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, error and force to ull.
 | 
						|
      Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large)
 | 
						|
          << /* Unsigned */ 1;
 | 
						|
      Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
 | 
						|
      assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
 | 
						|
             "long long is not intmax_t?");
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
 | 
						|
      // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
 | 
						|
      // be an unsigned int.
 | 
						|
      bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
 | 
						|
      unsigned Width = 0;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Microsoft specific integer suffixes are explicitly sized.
 | 
						|
      if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger) {
 | 
						|
        if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger == 8 && !Literal.isUnsigned) {
 | 
						|
          Width = 8;
 | 
						|
          Ty = Context.CharTy;
 | 
						|
        } else {
 | 
						|
          Width = Literal.MicrosoftInteger;
 | 
						|
          Ty = Context.getIntTypeForBitwidth(Width,
 | 
						|
                                             /*Signed=*/!Literal.isUnsigned);
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
 | 
						|
        // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
 | 
						|
        unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
 | 
						|
        if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
 | 
						|
          // Does it fit in a signed int?
 | 
						|
          if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
 | 
						|
            Ty = Context.IntTy;
 | 
						|
          else if (AllowUnsigned)
 | 
						|
            Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
 | 
						|
          Width = IntSize;
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
 | 
						|
      if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
 | 
						|
        unsigned LongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
 | 
						|
        if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
 | 
						|
          // Does it fit in a signed long?
 | 
						|
          if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
 | 
						|
            Ty = Context.LongTy;
 | 
						|
          else if (AllowUnsigned)
 | 
						|
            Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
 | 
						|
          // Check according to the rules of C90 6.1.3.2p5. C++03 [lex.icon]p2
 | 
						|
          // is compatible.
 | 
						|
          else if (!getLangOpts().C99 && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
 | 
						|
            const unsigned LongLongSize =
 | 
						|
                Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
 | 
						|
            Diag(Tok.getLocation(),
 | 
						|
                 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
 | 
						|
                     ? Literal.isLong
 | 
						|
                           ? diag::warn_old_implicitly_unsigned_long_cxx
 | 
						|
                           : /*C++98 UB*/ diag::
 | 
						|
                                 ext_old_implicitly_unsigned_long_cxx
 | 
						|
                     : diag::warn_old_implicitly_unsigned_long)
 | 
						|
                << (LongLongSize > LongSize ? /*will have type 'long long'*/ 0
 | 
						|
                                            : /*will be ill-formed*/ 1);
 | 
						|
            Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
 | 
						|
          }
 | 
						|
          Width = LongSize;
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Check long long if needed.
 | 
						|
      if (Ty.isNull()) {
 | 
						|
        unsigned LongLongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
 | 
						|
        if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
 | 
						|
          // Does it fit in a signed long long?
 | 
						|
          // To be compatible with MSVC, hex integer literals ending with the
 | 
						|
          // LL or i64 suffix are always signed in Microsoft mode.
 | 
						|
          if (!Literal.isUnsigned && (ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0 ||
 | 
						|
              (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && Literal.isLongLong)))
 | 
						|
            Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
 | 
						|
          else if (AllowUnsigned)
 | 
						|
            Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
 | 
						|
          Width = LongLongSize;
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
 | 
						|
      // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
 | 
						|
      if (Ty.isNull()) {
 | 
						|
        Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_integer_literal_too_large_for_signed);
 | 
						|
        Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
 | 
						|
        Width = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
 | 
						|
        ResultVal = ResultVal.trunc(Width);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
 | 
						|
  if (Literal.isImaginary) {
 | 
						|
    Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
 | 
						|
                                        Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_imaginary_constant);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return Res;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L, SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  assert(E && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
 | 
						|
  return new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static bool CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T,
 | 
						|
                                         SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                         SourceRange ArgRange) {
 | 
						|
  // [OpenCL 1.1 6.11.12] "The vec_step built-in function takes a built-in
 | 
						|
  // scalar or vector data type argument..."
 | 
						|
  // Every built-in scalar type (OpenCL 1.1 6.1.1) is either an arithmetic
 | 
						|
  // type (C99 6.2.5p18) or void.
 | 
						|
  if (!(T->isArithmeticType() || T->isVoidType() || T->isVectorType())) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_vecstep_non_scalar_vector_type)
 | 
						|
      << T << ArgRange;
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  assert((T->isVoidType() || !T->isIncompleteType()) &&
 | 
						|
         "Scalar types should always be complete");
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static bool CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T,
 | 
						|
                                           SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                           SourceRange ArgRange,
 | 
						|
                                           UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) {
 | 
						|
  // Invalid types must be hard errors for SFINAE in C++.
 | 
						|
  if (S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus)
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
 | 
						|
  if (T->isFunctionType() &&
 | 
						|
      (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf || TraitKind == UETT_AlignOf ||
 | 
						|
       TraitKind == UETT_PreferredAlignOf)) {
 | 
						|
    // sizeof(function)/alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_function_type)
 | 
						|
      << TraitKind << ArgRange;
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension, unless in OpenCL where
 | 
						|
  // this is an error (OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.k)
 | 
						|
  if (T->isVoidType()) {
 | 
						|
    unsigned DiagID = S.LangOpts.OpenCL ? diag::err_opencl_sizeof_alignof_type
 | 
						|
                                        : diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_void_type;
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << TraitKind << ArgRange;
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return true;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static bool CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(Sema &S, QualType T,
 | 
						|
                                             SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                             SourceRange ArgRange,
 | 
						|
                                             UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) {
 | 
						|
  // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) if the
 | 
						|
  // runtime doesn't allow it.
 | 
						|
  if (!S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsSizeofAlignof() && T->isObjCObjectType()) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
 | 
						|
      << T << (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf)
 | 
						|
      << ArgRange;
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Check whether E is a pointer from a decayed array type (the decayed
 | 
						|
/// pointer type is equal to T) and emit a warning if it is.
 | 
						|
static void warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T,
 | 
						|
                                     Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  // Don't warn if the operation changed the type.
 | 
						|
  if (T != E->getType())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Now look for array decays.
 | 
						|
  ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E);
 | 
						|
  if (!ICE || ICE->getCastKind() != CK_ArrayToPointerDecay)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_sizeof_array_decay) << ICE->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
                                             << ICE->getType()
 | 
						|
                                             << ICE->getSubExpr()->getType();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Check the constraints on expression operands to unary type expression
 | 
						|
/// and type traits.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// Completes any types necessary and validates the constraints on the operand
 | 
						|
/// expression. The logic mostly mirrors the type-based overload, but may modify
 | 
						|
/// the expression as it completes the type for that expression through template
 | 
						|
/// instantiation, etc.
 | 
						|
bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(Expr *E,
 | 
						|
                                            UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) {
 | 
						|
  QualType ExprTy = E->getType();
 | 
						|
  assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool IsUnevaluatedOperand =
 | 
						|
      (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf || ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf ||
 | 
						|
       ExprKind == UETT_PreferredAlignOf);
 | 
						|
  if (IsUnevaluatedOperand) {
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Result = CheckUnevaluatedOperand(E);
 | 
						|
    if (Result.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    E = Result.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep)
 | 
						|
    return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(),
 | 
						|
                                        E->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Whitelist some types as extensions
 | 
						|
  if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(),
 | 
						|
                                      E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind))
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // 'alignof' applied to an expression only requires the base element type of
 | 
						|
  // the expression to be complete. 'sizeof' requires the expression's type to
 | 
						|
  // be complete (and will attempt to complete it if it's an array of unknown
 | 
						|
  // bound).
 | 
						|
  if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf || ExprKind == UETT_PreferredAlignOf) {
 | 
						|
    if (RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(),
 | 
						|
                            Context.getBaseElementType(E->getType()),
 | 
						|
                            diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, ExprKind,
 | 
						|
                            E->getSourceRange()))
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    if (RequireCompleteExprType(E, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type,
 | 
						|
                                ExprKind, E->getSourceRange()))
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Completing the expression's type may have changed it.
 | 
						|
  ExprTy = E->getType();
 | 
						|
  assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (ExprTy->isFunctionType()) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type)
 | 
						|
      << ExprKind << E->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The operand for sizeof and alignof is in an unevaluated expression context,
 | 
						|
  // so side effects could result in unintended consequences.
 | 
						|
  if (IsUnevaluatedOperand && !inTemplateInstantiation() &&
 | 
						|
      E->HasSideEffects(Context, false))
 | 
						|
    Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(),
 | 
						|
                                       E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind))
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf) {
 | 
						|
    if (DeclRefExpr *DeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens())) {
 | 
						|
      if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(DeclRef->getFoundDecl())) {
 | 
						|
        QualType OType = PVD->getOriginalType();
 | 
						|
        QualType Type = PVD->getType();
 | 
						|
        if (Type->isPointerType() && OType->isArrayType()) {
 | 
						|
          Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_sizeof_array_param)
 | 
						|
            << Type << OType;
 | 
						|
          Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Warn on "sizeof(array op x)" and "sizeof(x op array)", where the array
 | 
						|
    // decays into a pointer and returns an unintended result. This is most
 | 
						|
    // likely a typo for "sizeof(array) op x".
 | 
						|
    if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParens())) {
 | 
						|
      warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(),
 | 
						|
                               BO->getLHS());
 | 
						|
      warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(),
 | 
						|
                               BO->getRHS());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Check the constraints on operands to unary expression and type
 | 
						|
/// traits.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// This will complete any types necessary, and validate the various constraints
 | 
						|
/// on those operands.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
 | 
						|
/// C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] all state:
 | 
						|
///   Except when it is the operand of the sizeof operator ...
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// C++ [expr.sizeof]p4
 | 
						|
///   The lvalue-to-rvalue, array-to-pointer, and function-to-pointer
 | 
						|
///   standard conversions are not applied to the operand of sizeof.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// This policy is followed for all of the unary trait expressions.
 | 
						|
bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(QualType ExprType,
 | 
						|
                                            SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                                            SourceRange ExprRange,
 | 
						|
                                            UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) {
 | 
						|
  if (ExprType->isDependentType())
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2:
 | 
						|
  //     When applied to a reference or a reference type, the result
 | 
						|
  //     is the size of the referenced type.
 | 
						|
  // C++11 [expr.alignof]p3:
 | 
						|
  //     When alignof is applied to a reference type, the result
 | 
						|
  //     shall be the alignment of the referenced type.
 | 
						|
  if (const ReferenceType *Ref = ExprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
 | 
						|
    ExprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C11 6.5.3.4/3, C++11 [expr.alignof]p3:
 | 
						|
  //   When alignof or _Alignof is applied to an array type, the result
 | 
						|
  //   is the alignment of the element type.
 | 
						|
  if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf || ExprKind == UETT_PreferredAlignOf ||
 | 
						|
      ExprKind == UETT_OpenMPRequiredSimdAlign)
 | 
						|
    ExprType = Context.getBaseElementType(ExprType);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep)
 | 
						|
    return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Whitelist some types as extensions
 | 
						|
  if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange,
 | 
						|
                                      ExprKind))
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, ExprType,
 | 
						|
                          diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type,
 | 
						|
                          ExprKind, ExprRange))
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (ExprType->isFunctionType()) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type)
 | 
						|
      << ExprKind << ExprRange;
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange,
 | 
						|
                                       ExprKind))
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E, UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) {
 | 
						|
  // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
 | 
						|
  if (E->isTypeDependent())
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (E->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_typeof_bitfield)
 | 
						|
       << 1 << E->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ValueDecl *D = nullptr;
 | 
						|
  Expr *Inner = E->IgnoreParens();
 | 
						|
  if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Inner)) {
 | 
						|
    D = DRE->getDecl();
 | 
						|
  } else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Inner)) {
 | 
						|
    D = ME->getMemberDecl();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If it's a field, require the containing struct to have a
 | 
						|
  // complete definition so that we can compute the layout.
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // This can happen in C++11 onwards, either by naming the member
 | 
						|
  // in a way that is not transformed into a member access expression
 | 
						|
  // (in an unevaluated operand, for instance), or by naming the member
 | 
						|
  // in a trailing-return-type.
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // For the record, since __alignof__ on expressions is a GCC
 | 
						|
  // extension, GCC seems to permit this but always gives the
 | 
						|
  // nonsensical answer 0.
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // We don't really need the layout here --- we could instead just
 | 
						|
  // directly check for all the appropriate alignment-lowing
 | 
						|
  // attributes --- but that would require duplicating a lot of
 | 
						|
  // logic that just isn't worth duplicating for such a marginal
 | 
						|
  // use-case.
 | 
						|
  if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FieldDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
    // Fast path this check, since we at least know the record has a
 | 
						|
    // definition if we can find a member of it.
 | 
						|
    if (!FD->getParent()->isCompleteDefinition()) {
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_alignof_member_of_incomplete_type)
 | 
						|
        << E->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Otherwise, if it's a field, and the field doesn't have
 | 
						|
    // reference type, then it must have a complete type (or be a
 | 
						|
    // flexible array member, which we explicitly want to
 | 
						|
    // white-list anyway), which makes the following checks trivial.
 | 
						|
    if (!FD->getType()->isReferenceType())
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return S.CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, ExprKind);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
bool Sema::CheckVecStepExpr(Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  E = E->IgnoreParens();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
 | 
						|
  if (E->isTypeDependent())
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_VecStep);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void captureVariablyModifiedType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T,
 | 
						|
                                        CapturingScopeInfo *CSI) {
 | 
						|
  assert(T->isVariablyModifiedType());
 | 
						|
  assert(CSI != nullptr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // We're going to walk down into the type and look for VLA expressions.
 | 
						|
  do {
 | 
						|
    const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
 | 
						|
    switch (Ty->getTypeClass()) {
 | 
						|
#define TYPE(Class, Base)
 | 
						|
#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
 | 
						|
#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
 | 
						|
#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
 | 
						|
#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base)
 | 
						|
#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
 | 
						|
      T = QualType();
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    // These types are never variably-modified.
 | 
						|
    case Type::Builtin:
 | 
						|
    case Type::Complex:
 | 
						|
    case Type::Vector:
 | 
						|
    case Type::ExtVector:
 | 
						|
    case Type::Record:
 | 
						|
    case Type::Enum:
 | 
						|
    case Type::Elaborated:
 | 
						|
    case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
 | 
						|
    case Type::ObjCObject:
 | 
						|
    case Type::ObjCInterface:
 | 
						|
    case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
 | 
						|
    case Type::ObjCTypeParam:
 | 
						|
    case Type::Pipe:
 | 
						|
      llvm_unreachable("type class is never variably-modified!");
 | 
						|
    case Type::Adjusted:
 | 
						|
      T = cast<AdjustedType>(Ty)->getOriginalType();
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    case Type::Decayed:
 | 
						|
      T = cast<DecayedType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    case Type::Pointer:
 | 
						|
      T = cast<PointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    case Type::BlockPointer:
 | 
						|
      T = cast<BlockPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    case Type::LValueReference:
 | 
						|
    case Type::RValueReference:
 | 
						|
      T = cast<ReferenceType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    case Type::MemberPointer:
 | 
						|
      T = cast<MemberPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    case Type::ConstantArray:
 | 
						|
    case Type::IncompleteArray:
 | 
						|
      // Losing element qualification here is fine.
 | 
						|
      T = cast<ArrayType>(Ty)->getElementType();
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    case Type::VariableArray: {
 | 
						|
      // Losing element qualification here is fine.
 | 
						|
      const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(Ty);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Unknown size indication requires no size computation.
 | 
						|
      // Otherwise, evaluate and record it.
 | 
						|
      auto Size = VAT->getSizeExpr();
 | 
						|
      if (Size && !CSI->isVLATypeCaptured(VAT) &&
 | 
						|
          (isa<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI) || isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)))
 | 
						|
        CSI->addVLATypeCapture(Size->getExprLoc(), VAT, Context.getSizeType());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      T = VAT->getElementType();
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    case Type::FunctionProto:
 | 
						|
    case Type::FunctionNoProto:
 | 
						|
      T = cast<FunctionType>(Ty)->getReturnType();
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    case Type::Paren:
 | 
						|
    case Type::TypeOf:
 | 
						|
    case Type::UnaryTransform:
 | 
						|
    case Type::Attributed:
 | 
						|
    case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
 | 
						|
    case Type::PackExpansion:
 | 
						|
    case Type::MacroQualified:
 | 
						|
      // Keep walking after single level desugaring.
 | 
						|
      T = T.getSingleStepDesugaredType(Context);
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    case Type::Typedef:
 | 
						|
      T = cast<TypedefType>(Ty)->desugar();
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    case Type::Decltype:
 | 
						|
      T = cast<DecltypeType>(Ty)->desugar();
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    case Type::Auto:
 | 
						|
    case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
 | 
						|
      T = cast<DeducedType>(Ty)->getDeducedType();
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    case Type::TypeOfExpr:
 | 
						|
      T = cast<TypeOfExprType>(Ty)->getUnderlyingExpr()->getType();
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    case Type::Atomic:
 | 
						|
      T = cast<AtomicType>(Ty)->getValueType();
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } while (!T.isNull() && T->isVariablyModifiedType());
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
 | 
						|
                                     SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                                     UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind,
 | 
						|
                                     SourceRange R) {
 | 
						|
  if (!TInfo)
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType T = TInfo->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!T->isDependentType() &&
 | 
						|
      CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(T, OpLoc, R, ExprKind))
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (T->isVariablyModifiedType() && FunctionScopes.size() > 1) {
 | 
						|
    if (auto *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>()) {
 | 
						|
      for (auto I = FunctionScopes.rbegin(),
 | 
						|
                E = std::prev(FunctionScopes.rend());
 | 
						|
           I != E; ++I) {
 | 
						|
        auto *CSI = dyn_cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(*I);
 | 
						|
        if (CSI == nullptr)
 | 
						|
          break;
 | 
						|
        DeclContext *DC = nullptr;
 | 
						|
        if (auto *LSI = dyn_cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI))
 | 
						|
          DC = LSI->CallOperator;
 | 
						|
        else if (auto *CRSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI))
 | 
						|
          DC = CRSI->TheCapturedDecl;
 | 
						|
        else if (auto *BSI = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI))
 | 
						|
          DC = BSI->TheDecl;
 | 
						|
        if (DC) {
 | 
						|
          if (DC->containsDecl(TT->getDecl()))
 | 
						|
            break;
 | 
						|
          captureVariablyModifiedType(Context, T, CSI);
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
 | 
						|
  return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(
 | 
						|
      ExprKind, TInfo, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, R.getEnd());
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
 | 
						|
/// operand.
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                                     UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) {
 | 
						|
  ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
 | 
						|
  if (PE.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  E = PE.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Verify that the operand is valid.
 | 
						|
  bool isInvalid = false;
 | 
						|
  if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
 | 
						|
    // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
 | 
						|
  } else if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf || ExprKind == UETT_PreferredAlignOf) {
 | 
						|
    isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E, ExprKind);
 | 
						|
  } else if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) {
 | 
						|
    isInvalid = CheckVecStepExpr(E);
 | 
						|
  } else if (ExprKind == UETT_OpenMPRequiredSimdAlign) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_openmp_default_simd_align_expr);
 | 
						|
      isInvalid = true;
 | 
						|
  } else if (E->refersToBitField()) {  // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
 | 
						|
    Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_typeof_bitfield) << 0;
 | 
						|
    isInvalid = true;
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    isInvalid = CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_SizeOf);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (isInvalid)
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf && E->getType()->isVariableArrayType()) {
 | 
						|
    PE = TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E);
 | 
						|
    if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    E = PE.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
 | 
						|
  return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(
 | 
						|
      ExprKind, E, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c
 | 
						|
/// expr and the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
 | 
						|
/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                                    UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind, bool IsType,
 | 
						|
                                    void *TyOrEx, SourceRange ArgRange) {
 | 
						|
  // If error parsing type, ignore.
 | 
						|
  if (!TyOrEx) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (IsType) {
 | 
						|
    TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
 | 
						|
    (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
 | 
						|
    return CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, ExprKind, ArgRange);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
 | 
						|
  ExprResult Result = CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, ExprKind);
 | 
						|
  return Result;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static QualType CheckRealImagOperand(Sema &S, ExprResult &V, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                     bool IsReal) {
 | 
						|
  if (V.get()->isTypeDependent())
 | 
						|
    return S.Context.DependentTy;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // _Real and _Imag are only l-values for normal l-values.
 | 
						|
  if (V.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_Ordinary) {
 | 
						|
    V = S.DefaultLvalueConversion(V.get());
 | 
						|
    if (V.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
 | 
						|
  if (const ComplexType *CT = V.get()->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
 | 
						|
    return CT->getElementType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
 | 
						|
  if (V.get()->getType()->isArithmeticType())
 | 
						|
    return V.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Test for placeholders.
 | 
						|
  ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(V.get());
 | 
						|
  if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
 | 
						|
  if (PR.get() != V.get()) {
 | 
						|
    V = PR;
 | 
						|
    return CheckRealImagOperand(S, V, Loc, IsReal);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Reject anything else.
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V.get()->getType()
 | 
						|
    << (IsReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
 | 
						|
  return QualType();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                          tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
 | 
						|
  UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
 | 
						|
  switch (Kind) {
 | 
						|
  default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!");
 | 
						|
  case tok::plusplus:   Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Since this might is a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
 | 
						|
  ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Input);
 | 
						|
  if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  Input = Result.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Diagnose if arithmetic on the given ObjC pointer is illegal.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// \return true on error
 | 
						|
static bool checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(Sema &S,
 | 
						|
                                         SourceLocation opLoc,
 | 
						|
                                         Expr *op) {
 | 
						|
  assert(op->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType());
 | 
						|
  if (S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsPointerArithmetic() &&
 | 
						|
      !S.LangOpts.ObjCSubscriptingLegacyRuntime)
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(opLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
 | 
						|
    << op->getType()->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType()
 | 
						|
    << op->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
  return true;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static bool isMSPropertySubscriptExpr(Sema &S, Expr *Base) {
 | 
						|
  auto *BaseNoParens = Base->IgnoreParens();
 | 
						|
  if (auto *MSProp = dyn_cast<MSPropertyRefExpr>(BaseNoParens))
 | 
						|
    return MSProp->getPropertyDecl()->getType()->isArrayType();
 | 
						|
  return isa<MSPropertySubscriptExpr>(BaseNoParens);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *base, SourceLocation lbLoc,
 | 
						|
                              Expr *idx, SourceLocation rbLoc) {
 | 
						|
  if (base && !base->getType().isNull() &&
 | 
						|
      base->getType()->isSpecificPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::OMPArraySection))
 | 
						|
    return ActOnOMPArraySectionExpr(base, lbLoc, idx, SourceLocation(),
 | 
						|
                                    /*Length=*/nullptr, rbLoc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
 | 
						|
  if (isa<ParenListExpr>(base)) {
 | 
						|
    ExprResult result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, base);
 | 
						|
    if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    base = result.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // A comma-expression as the index is deprecated in C++2a onwards.
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a &&
 | 
						|
      ((isa<BinaryOperator>(idx) && cast<BinaryOperator>(idx)->isCommaOp()) ||
 | 
						|
       (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(idx) &&
 | 
						|
        cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(idx)->getOperator() == OO_Comma))) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(idx->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_deprecated_comma_subscript)
 | 
						|
      << SourceRange(base->getBeginLoc(), rbLoc);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Handle any non-overload placeholder types in the base and index
 | 
						|
  // expressions.  We can't handle overloads here because the other
 | 
						|
  // operand might be an overloadable type, in which case the overload
 | 
						|
  // resolution for the operator overload should get the first crack
 | 
						|
  // at the overload.
 | 
						|
  bool IsMSPropertySubscript = false;
 | 
						|
  if (base->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) {
 | 
						|
    IsMSPropertySubscript = isMSPropertySubscriptExpr(*this, base);
 | 
						|
    if (!IsMSPropertySubscript) {
 | 
						|
      ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(base);
 | 
						|
      if (result.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      base = result.get();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (idx->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) {
 | 
						|
    ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(idx);
 | 
						|
    if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    idx = result.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Build an unanalyzed expression if either operand is type-dependent.
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
 | 
						|
      (base->isTypeDependent() || idx->isTypeDependent())) {
 | 
						|
    return new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(base, idx, Context.DependentTy,
 | 
						|
                                            VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, rbLoc);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // MSDN, property (C++)
 | 
						|
  // https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/yhfk0thd(v=vs.120).aspx
 | 
						|
  // This attribute can also be used in the declaration of an empty array in a
 | 
						|
  // class or structure definition. For example:
 | 
						|
  // __declspec(property(get=GetX, put=PutX)) int x[];
 | 
						|
  // The above statement indicates that x[] can be used with one or more array
 | 
						|
  // indices. In this case, i=p->x[a][b] will be turned into i=p->GetX(a, b),
 | 
						|
  // and p->x[a][b] = i will be turned into p->PutX(a, b, i);
 | 
						|
  if (IsMSPropertySubscript) {
 | 
						|
    // Build MS property subscript expression if base is MS property reference
 | 
						|
    // or MS property subscript.
 | 
						|
    return new (Context) MSPropertySubscriptExpr(
 | 
						|
        base, idx, Context.PseudoObjectTy, VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, rbLoc);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Use C++ overloaded-operator rules if either operand has record
 | 
						|
  // type.  The spec says to do this if either type is *overloadable*,
 | 
						|
  // but enum types can't declare subscript operators or conversion
 | 
						|
  // operators, so there's nothing interesting for overload resolution
 | 
						|
  // to do if there aren't any record types involved.
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // ObjC pointers have their own subscripting logic that is not tied
 | 
						|
  // to overload resolution and so should not take this path.
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
 | 
						|
      (base->getType()->isRecordType() ||
 | 
						|
       (!base->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
 | 
						|
        idx->getType()->isRecordType()))) {
 | 
						|
    return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(lbLoc, rbLoc, base, idx);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ExprResult Res = CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(base, lbLoc, idx, rbLoc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!Res.isInvalid() && isa<ArraySubscriptExpr>(Res.get()))
 | 
						|
    CheckSubscriptAccessOfNoDeref(cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(Res.get()));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return Res;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
void Sema::CheckAddressOfNoDeref(const Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord &LastRecord = ExprEvalContexts.back();
 | 
						|
  const Expr *StrippedExpr = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // For expressions like `&(*s).b`, the base is recorded and what should be
 | 
						|
  // checked.
 | 
						|
  const MemberExpr *Member = nullptr;
 | 
						|
  while ((Member = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(StrippedExpr)) && !Member->isArrow())
 | 
						|
    StrippedExpr = Member->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  LastRecord.PossibleDerefs.erase(StrippedExpr);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
void Sema::CheckSubscriptAccessOfNoDeref(const ArraySubscriptExpr *E) {
 | 
						|
  QualType ResultTy = E->getType();
 | 
						|
  ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord &LastRecord = ExprEvalContexts.back();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Bail if the element is an array since it is not memory access.
 | 
						|
  if (isa<ArrayType>(ResultTy))
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (ResultTy->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref)) {
 | 
						|
    LastRecord.PossibleDerefs.insert(E);
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check if the base type is a pointer to a member access of a struct
 | 
						|
  // marked with noderef.
 | 
						|
  const Expr *Base = E->getBase();
 | 
						|
  QualType BaseTy = Base->getType();
 | 
						|
  if (!(isa<ArrayType>(BaseTy) || isa<PointerType>(BaseTy)))
 | 
						|
    // Not a pointer access
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  const MemberExpr *Member = nullptr;
 | 
						|
  while ((Member = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base->IgnoreParenCasts())) &&
 | 
						|
         Member->isArrow())
 | 
						|
    Base = Member->getBase();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (const auto *Ptr = dyn_cast<PointerType>(Base->getType())) {
 | 
						|
    if (Ptr->getPointeeType()->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref))
 | 
						|
      LastRecord.PossibleDerefs.insert(E);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnOMPArraySectionExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LBLoc,
 | 
						|
                                          Expr *LowerBound,
 | 
						|
                                          SourceLocation ColonLoc, Expr *Length,
 | 
						|
                                          SourceLocation RBLoc) {
 | 
						|
  if (Base->getType()->isPlaceholderType() &&
 | 
						|
      !Base->getType()->isSpecificPlaceholderType(
 | 
						|
          BuiltinType::OMPArraySection)) {
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Base);
 | 
						|
    if (Result.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    Base = Result.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (LowerBound && LowerBound->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) {
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LowerBound);
 | 
						|
    if (Result.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    Result = DefaultLvalueConversion(Result.get());
 | 
						|
    if (Result.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    LowerBound = Result.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (Length && Length->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) {
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Length);
 | 
						|
    if (Result.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    Result = DefaultLvalueConversion(Result.get());
 | 
						|
    if (Result.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    Length = Result.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Build an unanalyzed expression if either operand is type-dependent.
 | 
						|
  if (Base->isTypeDependent() ||
 | 
						|
      (LowerBound &&
 | 
						|
       (LowerBound->isTypeDependent() || LowerBound->isValueDependent())) ||
 | 
						|
      (Length && (Length->isTypeDependent() || Length->isValueDependent()))) {
 | 
						|
    return new (Context)
 | 
						|
        OMPArraySectionExpr(Base, LowerBound, Length, Context.DependentTy,
 | 
						|
                            VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, ColonLoc, RBLoc);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Perform default conversions.
 | 
						|
  QualType OriginalTy = OMPArraySectionExpr::getBaseOriginalType(Base);
 | 
						|
  QualType ResultTy;
 | 
						|
  if (OriginalTy->isAnyPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
    ResultTy = OriginalTy->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
  } else if (OriginalTy->isArrayType()) {
 | 
						|
    ResultTy = OriginalTy->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe()->getElementType();
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    return ExprError(
 | 
						|
        Diag(Base->getExprLoc(), diag::err_omp_typecheck_section_value)
 | 
						|
        << Base->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.2.1p1
 | 
						|
  if (LowerBound) {
 | 
						|
    auto Res = PerformOpenMPImplicitIntegerConversion(LowerBound->getExprLoc(),
 | 
						|
                                                      LowerBound);
 | 
						|
    if (Res.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError(Diag(LowerBound->getExprLoc(),
 | 
						|
                            diag::err_omp_typecheck_section_not_integer)
 | 
						|
                       << 0 << LowerBound->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
    LowerBound = Res.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (LowerBound->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
 | 
						|
        LowerBound->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
 | 
						|
      Diag(LowerBound->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_omp_section_is_char)
 | 
						|
          << 0 << LowerBound->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (Length) {
 | 
						|
    auto Res =
 | 
						|
        PerformOpenMPImplicitIntegerConversion(Length->getExprLoc(), Length);
 | 
						|
    if (Res.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError(Diag(Length->getExprLoc(),
 | 
						|
                            diag::err_omp_typecheck_section_not_integer)
 | 
						|
                       << 1 << Length->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
    Length = Res.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (Length->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
 | 
						|
        Length->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
 | 
						|
      Diag(Length->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_omp_section_is_char)
 | 
						|
          << 1 << Length->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
 | 
						|
  // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
 | 
						|
  // type. Note that functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
 | 
						|
  // incomplete types are not object types.
 | 
						|
  if (ResultTy->isFunctionType()) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(Base->getExprLoc(), diag::err_omp_section_function_type)
 | 
						|
        << ResultTy << Base->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (RequireCompleteType(Base->getExprLoc(), ResultTy,
 | 
						|
                          diag::err_omp_section_incomplete_type, Base))
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LowerBound && !OriginalTy->isAnyPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
    Expr::EvalResult Result;
 | 
						|
    if (LowerBound->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context)) {
 | 
						|
      // OpenMP 4.5, [2.4 Array Sections]
 | 
						|
      // The array section must be a subset of the original array.
 | 
						|
      llvm::APSInt LowerBoundValue = Result.Val.getInt();
 | 
						|
      if (LowerBoundValue.isNegative()) {
 | 
						|
        Diag(LowerBound->getExprLoc(), diag::err_omp_section_not_subset_of_array)
 | 
						|
            << LowerBound->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Length) {
 | 
						|
    Expr::EvalResult Result;
 | 
						|
    if (Length->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context)) {
 | 
						|
      // OpenMP 4.5, [2.4 Array Sections]
 | 
						|
      // The length must evaluate to non-negative integers.
 | 
						|
      llvm::APSInt LengthValue = Result.Val.getInt();
 | 
						|
      if (LengthValue.isNegative()) {
 | 
						|
        Diag(Length->getExprLoc(), diag::err_omp_section_length_negative)
 | 
						|
            << LengthValue.toString(/*Radix=*/10, /*Signed=*/true)
 | 
						|
            << Length->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } else if (ColonLoc.isValid() &&
 | 
						|
             (OriginalTy.isNull() || (!OriginalTy->isConstantArrayType() &&
 | 
						|
                                      !OriginalTy->isVariableArrayType()))) {
 | 
						|
    // OpenMP 4.5, [2.4 Array Sections]
 | 
						|
    // When the size of the array dimension is not known, the length must be
 | 
						|
    // specified explicitly.
 | 
						|
    Diag(ColonLoc, diag::err_omp_section_length_undefined)
 | 
						|
        << (!OriginalTy.isNull() && OriginalTy->isArrayType());
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!Base->getType()->isSpecificPlaceholderType(
 | 
						|
          BuiltinType::OMPArraySection)) {
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Base);
 | 
						|
    if (Result.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    Base = Result.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return new (Context)
 | 
						|
      OMPArraySectionExpr(Base, LowerBound, Length, Context.OMPArraySectionTy,
 | 
						|
                          VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, ColonLoc, RBLoc);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
 | 
						|
                                      Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
 | 
						|
  Expr *LHSExp = Base;
 | 
						|
  Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ExprValueKind VK = VK_LValue;
 | 
						|
  ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Per C++ core issue 1213, the result is an xvalue if either operand is
 | 
						|
  // a non-lvalue array, and an lvalue otherwise.
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
 | 
						|
    for (auto *Op : {LHSExp, RHSExp}) {
 | 
						|
      Op = Op->IgnoreImplicit();
 | 
						|
      if (Op->getType()->isArrayType() && !Op->isLValue())
 | 
						|
        VK = VK_XValue;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Perform default conversions.
 | 
						|
  if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>()) {
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
 | 
						|
    if (Result.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    LHSExp = Result.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
 | 
						|
  if (Result.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  RHSExp = Result.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
 | 
						|
  // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
 | 
						|
  // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
 | 
						|
  // and index from the expression types.
 | 
						|
  Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
 | 
						|
  QualType ResultType;
 | 
						|
  if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
 | 
						|
    BaseExpr = LHSExp;
 | 
						|
    IndexExpr = RHSExp;
 | 
						|
    ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
 | 
						|
  } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
 | 
						|
    BaseExpr = LHSExp;
 | 
						|
    IndexExpr = RHSExp;
 | 
						|
    ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
  } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
 | 
						|
               LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
 | 
						|
    BaseExpr = LHSExp;
 | 
						|
    IndexExpr = RHSExp;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Use custom logic if this should be the pseudo-object subscript
 | 
						|
    // expression.
 | 
						|
    if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic())
 | 
						|
      return BuildObjCSubscriptExpression(RLoc, BaseExpr, IndexExpr, nullptr,
 | 
						|
                                          nullptr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
  } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
 | 
						|
     // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
 | 
						|
    BaseExpr = RHSExp;
 | 
						|
    IndexExpr = LHSExp;
 | 
						|
    ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
  } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
 | 
						|
               RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
 | 
						|
     // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
 | 
						|
    BaseExpr = RHSExp;
 | 
						|
    IndexExpr = LHSExp;
 | 
						|
    ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
    if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic()) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
 | 
						|
        << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
 | 
						|
    BaseExpr = LHSExp;    // vectors: V[123]
 | 
						|
    IndexExpr = RHSExp;
 | 
						|
    // We apply C++ DR1213 to vector subscripting too.
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && LHSExp->getValueKind() == VK_RValue) {
 | 
						|
      ExprResult Materialized = TemporaryMaterializationConversion(LHSExp);
 | 
						|
      if (Materialized.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      LHSExp = Materialized.get();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    VK = LHSExp->getValueKind();
 | 
						|
    if (VK != VK_RValue)
 | 
						|
      OK = OK_VectorComponent;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
 | 
						|
    QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
 | 
						|
    Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
 | 
						|
    Qualifiers MemberQuals = ResultType.getQualifiers();
 | 
						|
    Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
 | 
						|
    if (Combined != MemberQuals)
 | 
						|
      ResultType = Context.getQualifiedType(ResultType, Combined);
 | 
						|
  } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
 | 
						|
    // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
 | 
						|
    // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
 | 
						|
    // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
 | 
						|
    // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays.  Warn, then
 | 
						|
    // force the promotion here.
 | 
						|
    Diag(LHSExp->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue)
 | 
						|
        << LHSExp->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    LHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
 | 
						|
                               CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get();
 | 
						|
    LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    BaseExpr = LHSExp;
 | 
						|
    IndexExpr = RHSExp;
 | 
						|
    ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
  } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
 | 
						|
    // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
 | 
						|
    Diag(RHSExp->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue)
 | 
						|
        << RHSExp->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    RHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
 | 
						|
                               CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get();
 | 
						|
    RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    BaseExpr = RHSExp;
 | 
						|
    IndexExpr = LHSExp;
 | 
						|
    ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
 | 
						|
       << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.2.1p1
 | 
						|
  if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
 | 
						|
                     << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
 | 
						|
       IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
 | 
						|
         && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
 | 
						|
    Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
 | 
						|
  // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
 | 
						|
  // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
 | 
						|
  // incomplete types are not object types.
 | 
						|
  if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(BaseExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
 | 
						|
        << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
    // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
 | 
						|
    Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_subscript_void_type)
 | 
						|
      << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // C forbids expressions of unqualified void type from being l-values.
 | 
						|
    // See IsCForbiddenLValueType.
 | 
						|
    if (!ResultType.hasQualifiers()) VK = VK_RValue;
 | 
						|
  } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
 | 
						|
      RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
 | 
						|
                          diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type, BaseExpr))
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  assert(VK == VK_RValue || LangOpts.CPlusPlus ||
 | 
						|
         !ResultType.isCForbiddenLValueType());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LHSExp->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType() &&
 | 
						|
      FunctionScopes.size() > 1) {
 | 
						|
    if (auto *TT =
 | 
						|
            LHSExp->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType()->getAs<TypedefType>()) {
 | 
						|
      for (auto I = FunctionScopes.rbegin(),
 | 
						|
                E = std::prev(FunctionScopes.rend());
 | 
						|
           I != E; ++I) {
 | 
						|
        auto *CSI = dyn_cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(*I);
 | 
						|
        if (CSI == nullptr)
 | 
						|
          break;
 | 
						|
        DeclContext *DC = nullptr;
 | 
						|
        if (auto *LSI = dyn_cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI))
 | 
						|
          DC = LSI->CallOperator;
 | 
						|
        else if (auto *CRSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI))
 | 
						|
          DC = CRSI->TheCapturedDecl;
 | 
						|
        else if (auto *BSI = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI))
 | 
						|
          DC = BSI->TheDecl;
 | 
						|
        if (DC) {
 | 
						|
          if (DC->containsDecl(TT->getDecl()))
 | 
						|
            break;
 | 
						|
          captureVariablyModifiedType(
 | 
						|
              Context, LHSExp->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType(), CSI);
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return new (Context)
 | 
						|
      ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp, ResultType, VK, OK, RLoc);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
bool Sema::CheckCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FD,
 | 
						|
                                  ParmVarDecl *Param) {
 | 
						|
  if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(CallLoc,
 | 
						|
         diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
 | 
						|
      FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
    Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
 | 
						|
         diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
 | 
						|
    Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext(
 | 
						|
        *this, ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated, Param);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Instantiate the expression.
 | 
						|
    //
 | 
						|
    // FIXME: Pass in a correct Pattern argument, otherwise
 | 
						|
    // getTemplateInstantiationArgs uses the lexical context of FD, e.g.
 | 
						|
    //
 | 
						|
    // template<typename T>
 | 
						|
    // struct A {
 | 
						|
    //   static int FooImpl();
 | 
						|
    //
 | 
						|
    //   template<typename Tp>
 | 
						|
    //   // bug: default argument A<T>::FooImpl() is evaluated with 2-level
 | 
						|
    //   // template argument list [[T], [Tp]], should be [[Tp]].
 | 
						|
    //   friend A<Tp> Foo(int a);
 | 
						|
    // };
 | 
						|
    //
 | 
						|
    // template<typename T>
 | 
						|
    // A<T> Foo(int a = A<T>::FooImpl());
 | 
						|
    MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList MutiLevelArgList
 | 
						|
      = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, nullptr, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param,
 | 
						|
                               MutiLevelArgList.getInnermost());
 | 
						|
    if (Inst.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    if (Inst.isAlreadyInstantiating()) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(Param->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_recursive_default_argument) << FD;
 | 
						|
      Param->setInvalidDecl();
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Result;
 | 
						|
    {
 | 
						|
      // C++ [dcl.fct.default]p5:
 | 
						|
      //   The names in the [default argument] expression are bound, and
 | 
						|
      //   the semantic constraints are checked, at the point where the
 | 
						|
      //   default argument expression appears.
 | 
						|
      ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, FD);
 | 
						|
      LocalInstantiationScope Local(*this);
 | 
						|
      runWithSufficientStackSpace(CallLoc, [&] {
 | 
						|
        Result = SubstInitializer(UninstExpr, MutiLevelArgList,
 | 
						|
                                  /*DirectInit*/false);
 | 
						|
      });
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    if (Result.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
 | 
						|
    InitializedEntity Entity
 | 
						|
      = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
 | 
						|
    InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(
 | 
						|
        Param->getLocation(),
 | 
						|
        /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/ UninstExpr->getBeginLoc());
 | 
						|
    Expr *ResultE = Result.getAs<Expr>();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, ResultE);
 | 
						|
    Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, ResultE);
 | 
						|
    if (Result.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    Result =
 | 
						|
        ActOnFinishFullExpr(Result.getAs<Expr>(), Param->getOuterLocStart(),
 | 
						|
                            /*DiscardedValue*/ false);
 | 
						|
    if (Result.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Remember the instantiated default argument.
 | 
						|
    Param->setDefaultArg(Result.getAs<Expr>());
 | 
						|
    if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener()) {
 | 
						|
      L->DefaultArgumentInstantiated(Param);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If the default argument expression is not set yet, we are building it now.
 | 
						|
  if (!Param->hasInit()) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(Param->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_recursive_default_argument) << FD;
 | 
						|
    Param->setInvalidDecl();
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
 | 
						|
  // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
 | 
						|
  // be properly destroyed.
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
 | 
						|
  // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
 | 
						|
  // We don't need to do that with block decls, though, because
 | 
						|
  // blocks in default argument expression can never capture anything.
 | 
						|
  if (auto Init = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Param->getInit())) {
 | 
						|
    // Set the "needs cleanups" bit regardless of whether there are
 | 
						|
    // any explicit objects.
 | 
						|
    Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(Init->cleanupsHaveSideEffects());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Append all the objects to the cleanup list.  Right now, this
 | 
						|
    // should always be a no-op, because blocks in default argument
 | 
						|
    // expressions should never be able to capture anything.
 | 
						|
    assert(!Init->getNumObjects() &&
 | 
						|
           "default argument expression has capturing blocks?");
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
 | 
						|
  // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
 | 
						|
  // as being "referenced".
 | 
						|
  EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext(
 | 
						|
      *this, ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated, Param);
 | 
						|
  MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg(),
 | 
						|
                                   /*SkipLocalVariables=*/true);
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
 | 
						|
                                        FunctionDecl *FD, ParmVarDecl *Param) {
 | 
						|
  if (CheckCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FD, Param))
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  return CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param, CurContext);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
Sema::VariadicCallType
 | 
						|
Sema::getVariadicCallType(FunctionDecl *FDecl, const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
 | 
						|
                          Expr *Fn) {
 | 
						|
  if (Proto && Proto->isVariadic()) {
 | 
						|
    if (dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConstructorDecl>(FDecl))
 | 
						|
      return VariadicConstructor;
 | 
						|
    else if (Fn && Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
 | 
						|
      return VariadicBlock;
 | 
						|
    else if (FDecl) {
 | 
						|
      if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
 | 
						|
        if (Method->isInstance())
 | 
						|
          return VariadicMethod;
 | 
						|
    } else if (Fn && Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy)
 | 
						|
      return VariadicMethod;
 | 
						|
    return VariadicFunction;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return VariadicDoesNotApply;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
namespace {
 | 
						|
class FunctionCallCCC final : public FunctionCallFilterCCC {
 | 
						|
public:
 | 
						|
  FunctionCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, const IdentifierInfo *FuncName,
 | 
						|
                  unsigned NumArgs, MemberExpr *ME)
 | 
						|
      : FunctionCallFilterCCC(SemaRef, NumArgs, false, ME),
 | 
						|
        FunctionName(FuncName) {}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override {
 | 
						|
    if (!candidate.getCorrectionSpecifier() ||
 | 
						|
        candidate.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo() != FunctionName) {
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return FunctionCallFilterCCC::ValidateCandidate(candidate);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override {
 | 
						|
    return std::make_unique<FunctionCallCCC>(*this);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
private:
 | 
						|
  const IdentifierInfo *const FunctionName;
 | 
						|
};
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static TypoCorrection TryTypoCorrectionForCall(Sema &S, Expr *Fn,
 | 
						|
                                               FunctionDecl *FDecl,
 | 
						|
                                               ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
 | 
						|
  MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn);
 | 
						|
  DeclarationName FuncName = FDecl->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation NameLoc = ME ? ME->getMemberLoc() : Fn->getBeginLoc();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  FunctionCallCCC CCC(S, FuncName.getAsIdentifierInfo(), Args.size(), ME);
 | 
						|
  if (TypoCorrection Corrected = S.CorrectTypo(
 | 
						|
          DeclarationNameInfo(FuncName, NameLoc), Sema::LookupOrdinaryName,
 | 
						|
          S.getScopeForContext(S.CurContext), nullptr, CCC,
 | 
						|
          Sema::CTK_ErrorRecovery)) {
 | 
						|
    if (NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getFoundDecl()) {
 | 
						|
      if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) {
 | 
						|
        OverloadCandidateSet OCS(NameLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
 | 
						|
        OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
 | 
						|
        for (NamedDecl *CD : Corrected) {
 | 
						|
          if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CD))
 | 
						|
            S.AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none), Args,
 | 
						|
                                   OCS);
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
        switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(S, NameLoc, Best)) {
 | 
						|
        case OR_Success:
 | 
						|
          ND = Best->FoundDecl;
 | 
						|
          Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND);
 | 
						|
          break;
 | 
						|
        default:
 | 
						|
          break;
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      ND = ND->getUnderlyingDecl();
 | 
						|
      if (isa<ValueDecl>(ND) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND))
 | 
						|
        return Corrected;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return TypoCorrection();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
 | 
						|
/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
 | 
						|
/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
 | 
						|
/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
 | 
						|
/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
 | 
						|
/// true if the call is ill-formed.
 | 
						|
bool
 | 
						|
Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
 | 
						|
                              FunctionDecl *FDecl,
 | 
						|
                              const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
 | 
						|
                              ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
 | 
						|
                              SourceLocation RParenLoc,
 | 
						|
                              bool IsExecConfig) {
 | 
						|
  // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom typechecking.
 | 
						|
  if (FDecl)
 | 
						|
    if (unsigned ID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
 | 
						|
      if (Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(ID))
 | 
						|
        return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
 | 
						|
  // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
 | 
						|
  unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
 | 
						|
  bool Invalid = false;
 | 
						|
  unsigned MinArgs = FDecl ? FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments() : NumParams;
 | 
						|
  unsigned FnKind = Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
 | 
						|
                       ? 1 /* block */
 | 
						|
                       : (IsExecConfig ? 3 /* kernel function (exec config) */
 | 
						|
                                       : 0 /* function */);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
 | 
						|
  // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
 | 
						|
  if (Args.size() < NumParams) {
 | 
						|
    if (Args.size() < MinArgs) {
 | 
						|
      TypoCorrection TC;
 | 
						|
      if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) {
 | 
						|
        unsigned diag_id =
 | 
						|
            MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()
 | 
						|
                ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_suggest
 | 
						|
                : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_suggest;
 | 
						|
        diagnoseTypo(TC, PDiag(diag_id) << FnKind << MinArgs
 | 
						|
                                        << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size())
 | 
						|
                                        << TC.getCorrectionRange());
 | 
						|
      } else if (MinArgs == 1 && FDecl && FDecl->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
 | 
						|
        Diag(RParenLoc,
 | 
						|
             MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()
 | 
						|
                 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_one
 | 
						|
                 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_one)
 | 
						|
            << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(0) << Fn->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      else
 | 
						|
        Diag(RParenLoc, MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()
 | 
						|
                            ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args
 | 
						|
                            : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least)
 | 
						|
            << FnKind << MinArgs << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size())
 | 
						|
            << Fn->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Emit the location of the prototype.
 | 
						|
      if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig)
 | 
						|
        Diag(FDecl->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_callee_decl) << FDecl;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    // We reserve space for the default arguments when we create
 | 
						|
    // the call expression, before calling ConvertArgumentsForCall.
 | 
						|
    assert((Call->getNumArgs() == NumParams) &&
 | 
						|
           "We should have reserved space for the default arguments before!");
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
 | 
						|
  // them.
 | 
						|
  if (Args.size() > NumParams) {
 | 
						|
    if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
 | 
						|
      TypoCorrection TC;
 | 
						|
      if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) {
 | 
						|
        unsigned diag_id =
 | 
						|
            MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()
 | 
						|
                ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_suggest
 | 
						|
                : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_suggest;
 | 
						|
        diagnoseTypo(TC, PDiag(diag_id) << FnKind << NumParams
 | 
						|
                                        << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size())
 | 
						|
                                        << TC.getCorrectionRange());
 | 
						|
      } else if (NumParams == 1 && FDecl &&
 | 
						|
                 FDecl->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
 | 
						|
        Diag(Args[NumParams]->getBeginLoc(),
 | 
						|
             MinArgs == NumParams
 | 
						|
                 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_one
 | 
						|
                 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_one)
 | 
						|
            << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(0)
 | 
						|
            << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) << Fn->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
            << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getBeginLoc(),
 | 
						|
                           Args.back()->getEndLoc());
 | 
						|
      else
 | 
						|
        Diag(Args[NumParams]->getBeginLoc(),
 | 
						|
             MinArgs == NumParams
 | 
						|
                 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args
 | 
						|
                 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most)
 | 
						|
            << FnKind << NumParams << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size())
 | 
						|
            << Fn->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
            << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getBeginLoc(),
 | 
						|
                           Args.back()->getEndLoc());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Emit the location of the prototype.
 | 
						|
      if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig)
 | 
						|
        Diag(FDecl->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_callee_decl) << FDecl;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // This deletes the extra arguments.
 | 
						|
      Call->shrinkNumArgs(NumParams);
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
 | 
						|
  VariadicCallType CallType = getVariadicCallType(FDecl, Proto, Fn);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getBeginLoc(), FDecl, Proto, 0, Args,
 | 
						|
                                   AllArgs, CallType);
 | 
						|
  if (Invalid)
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
 | 
						|
  for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
 | 
						|
    Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FDecl,
 | 
						|
                                  const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
 | 
						|
                                  unsigned FirstParam, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
 | 
						|
                                  SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &AllArgs,
 | 
						|
                                  VariadicCallType CallType, bool AllowExplicit,
 | 
						|
                                  bool IsListInitialization) {
 | 
						|
  unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
 | 
						|
  bool Invalid = false;
 | 
						|
  size_t ArgIx = 0;
 | 
						|
  // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
 | 
						|
  for (unsigned i = FirstParam; i < NumParams; i++) {
 | 
						|
    QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getParamType(i);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    Expr *Arg;
 | 
						|
    ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl ? FDecl->getParamDecl(i) : nullptr;
 | 
						|
    if (ArgIx < Args.size()) {
 | 
						|
      Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getBeginLoc(), ProtoArgType,
 | 
						|
                              diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg))
 | 
						|
        return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable.
 | 
						|
      bool CFAudited = false;
 | 
						|
      if (Arg->getType() == Context.ARCUnbridgedCastTy &&
 | 
						|
          FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() &&
 | 
						|
          (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>()))
 | 
						|
        Arg = stripARCUnbridgedCast(Arg);
 | 
						|
      else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
 | 
						|
               FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() &&
 | 
						|
               (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>()))
 | 
						|
        CFAudited = true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (Proto->getExtParameterInfo(i).isNoEscape())
 | 
						|
        if (auto *BE = dyn_cast<BlockExpr>(Arg->IgnoreParenNoopCasts(Context)))
 | 
						|
          BE->getBlockDecl()->setDoesNotEscape();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      InitializedEntity Entity =
 | 
						|
          Param ? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param,
 | 
						|
                                                         ProtoArgType)
 | 
						|
                : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
 | 
						|
                      Context, ProtoArgType, Proto->isParamConsumed(i));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Remember that parameter belongs to a CF audited API.
 | 
						|
      if (CFAudited)
 | 
						|
        Entity.setParameterCFAudited();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(
 | 
						|
          Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg, IsListInitialization, AllowExplicit);
 | 
						|
      if (ArgE.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
        return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>();
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      assert(Param && "can't use default arguments without a known callee");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      ExprResult ArgExpr = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
 | 
						|
      if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
        return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      Arg = ArgExpr.getAs<Expr>();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Check for array bounds violations for each argument to the call. This
 | 
						|
    // check only triggers warnings when the argument isn't a more complex Expr
 | 
						|
    // with its own checking, such as a BinaryOperator.
 | 
						|
    CheckArrayAccess(Arg);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Check for violations of C99 static array rules (C99 6.7.5.3p7).
 | 
						|
    CheckStaticArrayArgument(CallLoc, Param, Arg);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
 | 
						|
  if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
 | 
						|
    // Assume that extern "C" functions with variadic arguments that
 | 
						|
    // return __unknown_anytype aren't *really* variadic.
 | 
						|
    if (Proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy && FDecl &&
 | 
						|
        FDecl->isExternC()) {
 | 
						|
      for (Expr *A : Args.slice(ArgIx)) {
 | 
						|
        QualType paramType; // ignored
 | 
						|
        ExprResult arg = checkUnknownAnyArg(CallLoc, A, paramType);
 | 
						|
        Invalid |= arg.isInvalid();
 | 
						|
        AllArgs.push_back(arg.get());
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Otherwise do argument promotion, (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      for (Expr *A : Args.slice(ArgIx)) {
 | 
						|
        ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(A, CallType, FDecl);
 | 
						|
        Invalid |= Arg.isInvalid();
 | 
						|
        // Copy blocks to the heap.
 | 
						|
        if (A->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
 | 
						|
          maybeExtendBlockObject(Arg);
 | 
						|
        AllArgs.push_back(Arg.get());
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Check for array bounds violations.
 | 
						|
    for (Expr *A : Args.slice(ArgIx))
 | 
						|
      CheckArrayAccess(A);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return Invalid;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(Sema &S, ParmVarDecl *PVD) {
 | 
						|
  TypeLoc TL = PVD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc();
 | 
						|
  if (DecayedTypeLoc DTL = TL.getAs<DecayedTypeLoc>())
 | 
						|
    TL = DTL.getOriginalLoc();
 | 
						|
  if (ArrayTypeLoc ATL = TL.getAs<ArrayTypeLoc>())
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_callee_static_array)
 | 
						|
      << ATL.getLocalSourceRange();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// CheckStaticArrayArgument - If the given argument corresponds to a static
 | 
						|
/// array parameter, check that it is non-null, and that if it is formed by
 | 
						|
/// array-to-pointer decay, the underlying array is sufficiently large.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// C99 6.7.5.3p7: If the keyword static also appears within the [ and ] of the
 | 
						|
/// array type derivation, then for each call to the function, the value of the
 | 
						|
/// corresponding actual argument shall provide access to the first element of
 | 
						|
/// an array with at least as many elements as specified by the size expression.
 | 
						|
void
 | 
						|
Sema::CheckStaticArrayArgument(SourceLocation CallLoc,
 | 
						|
                               ParmVarDecl *Param,
 | 
						|
                               const Expr *ArgExpr) {
 | 
						|
  // Static array parameters are not supported in C++.
 | 
						|
  if (!Param || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType OrigTy = Param->getOriginalType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(OrigTy);
 | 
						|
  if (!AT || AT->getSizeModifier() != ArrayType::Static)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (ArgExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
 | 
						|
                                     Expr::NPC_NeverValueDependent)) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_null_arg) << ArgExpr->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param);
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT);
 | 
						|
  if (!CAT)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  const ConstantArrayType *ArgCAT =
 | 
						|
    Context.getAsConstantArrayType(ArgExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType());
 | 
						|
  if (!ArgCAT)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (getASTContext().hasSameUnqualifiedType(CAT->getElementType(),
 | 
						|
                                             ArgCAT->getElementType())) {
 | 
						|
    if (ArgCAT->getSize().ult(CAT->getSize())) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_static_array_too_small)
 | 
						|
          << ArgExpr->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
          << (unsigned)ArgCAT->getSize().getZExtValue()
 | 
						|
          << (unsigned)CAT->getSize().getZExtValue() << 0;
 | 
						|
      DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Optional<CharUnits> ArgSize =
 | 
						|
      getASTContext().getTypeSizeInCharsIfKnown(ArgCAT);
 | 
						|
  Optional<CharUnits> ParmSize = getASTContext().getTypeSizeInCharsIfKnown(CAT);
 | 
						|
  if (ArgSize && ParmSize && *ArgSize < *ParmSize) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_static_array_too_small)
 | 
						|
        << ArgExpr->getSourceRange() << (unsigned)ArgSize->getQuantity()
 | 
						|
        << (unsigned)ParmSize->getQuantity() << 1;
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it
 | 
						|
/// to have a function type.
 | 
						|
static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *fn);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Is the given type a placeholder that we need to lower out
 | 
						|
/// immediately during argument processing?
 | 
						|
static bool isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(QualType type) {
 | 
						|
  // Placeholders are never sugared.
 | 
						|
  const BuiltinType *placeholder = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(type);
 | 
						|
  if (!placeholder) return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  switch (placeholder->getKind()) {
 | 
						|
  // Ignore all the non-placeholder types.
 | 
						|
#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::Id:
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
 | 
						|
#define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::Id:
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def"
 | 
						|
  // In practice we'll never use this, since all SVE types are sugared
 | 
						|
  // via TypedefTypes rather than exposed directly as BuiltinTypes.
 | 
						|
#define SVE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) \
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::Id:
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Basic/AArch64SVEACLETypes.def"
 | 
						|
#define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID)
 | 
						|
#define BUILTIN_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID) case BuiltinType::ID:
 | 
						|
#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // We cannot lower out overload sets; they might validly be resolved
 | 
						|
  // by the call machinery.
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::Overload:
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Unbridged casts in ARC can be handled in some call positions and
 | 
						|
  // should be left in place.
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast:
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Pseudo-objects should be converted as soon as possible.
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::PseudoObject:
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The debugger mode could theoretically but currently does not try
 | 
						|
  // to resolve unknown-typed arguments based on known parameter types.
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::UnknownAny:
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // These are always invalid as call arguments and should be reported.
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::BoundMember:
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn:
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::OMPArraySection:
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  llvm_unreachable("bad builtin type kind");
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Check an argument list for placeholders that we won't try to
 | 
						|
/// handle later.
 | 
						|
static bool checkArgsForPlaceholders(Sema &S, MultiExprArg args) {
 | 
						|
  // Apply this processing to all the arguments at once instead of
 | 
						|
  // dying at the first failure.
 | 
						|
  bool hasInvalid = false;
 | 
						|
  for (size_t i = 0, e = args.size(); i != e; i++) {
 | 
						|
    if (isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(args[i]->getType())) {
 | 
						|
      ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(args[i]);
 | 
						|
      if (result.isInvalid()) hasInvalid = true;
 | 
						|
      else args[i] = result.get();
 | 
						|
    } else if (hasInvalid) {
 | 
						|
      (void)S.CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(args[i]);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return hasInvalid;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// If a builtin function has a pointer argument with no explicit address
 | 
						|
/// space, then it should be able to accept a pointer to any address
 | 
						|
/// space as input.  In order to do this, we need to replace the
 | 
						|
/// standard builtin declaration with one that uses the same address space
 | 
						|
/// as the call.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// \returns nullptr If this builtin is not a candidate for a rewrite i.e.
 | 
						|
///                  it does not contain any pointer arguments without
 | 
						|
///                  an address space qualifer.  Otherwise the rewritten
 | 
						|
///                  FunctionDecl is returned.
 | 
						|
/// TODO: Handle pointer return types.
 | 
						|
static FunctionDecl *rewriteBuiltinFunctionDecl(Sema *Sema, ASTContext &Context,
 | 
						|
                                                FunctionDecl *FDecl,
 | 
						|
                                                MultiExprArg ArgExprs) {
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType DeclType = FDecl->getType();
 | 
						|
  const FunctionProtoType *FT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(DeclType);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.hasPtrArgsOrResult(FDecl->getBuiltinID()) || !FT ||
 | 
						|
      ArgExprs.size() < FT->getNumParams())
 | 
						|
    return nullptr;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool NeedsNewDecl = false;
 | 
						|
  unsigned i = 0;
 | 
						|
  SmallVector<QualType, 8> OverloadParams;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  for (QualType ParamType : FT->param_types()) {
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Convert array arguments to pointer to simplify type lookup.
 | 
						|
    ExprResult ArgRes =
 | 
						|
        Sema->DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(ArgExprs[i++]);
 | 
						|
    if (ArgRes.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return nullptr;
 | 
						|
    Expr *Arg = ArgRes.get();
 | 
						|
    QualType ArgType = Arg->getType();
 | 
						|
    if (!ParamType->isPointerType() ||
 | 
						|
        ParamType.hasAddressSpace() ||
 | 
						|
        !ArgType->isPointerType() ||
 | 
						|
        !ArgType->getPointeeType().hasAddressSpace()) {
 | 
						|
      OverloadParams.push_back(ParamType);
 | 
						|
      continue;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    QualType PointeeType = ParamType->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
    if (PointeeType.hasAddressSpace())
 | 
						|
      continue;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    NeedsNewDecl = true;
 | 
						|
    LangAS AS = ArgType->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    PointeeType = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(PointeeType, AS);
 | 
						|
    OverloadParams.push_back(Context.getPointerType(PointeeType));
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!NeedsNewDecl)
 | 
						|
    return nullptr;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
 | 
						|
  EPI.Variadic = FT->isVariadic();
 | 
						|
  QualType OverloadTy = Context.getFunctionType(FT->getReturnType(),
 | 
						|
                                                OverloadParams, EPI);
 | 
						|
  DeclContext *Parent = FDecl->getParent();
 | 
						|
  FunctionDecl *OverloadDecl = FunctionDecl::Create(Context, Parent,
 | 
						|
                                                    FDecl->getLocation(),
 | 
						|
                                                    FDecl->getLocation(),
 | 
						|
                                                    FDecl->getIdentifier(),
 | 
						|
                                                    OverloadTy,
 | 
						|
                                                    /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
 | 
						|
                                                    SC_Extern, false,
 | 
						|
                                                    /*hasPrototype=*/true);
 | 
						|
  SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params;
 | 
						|
  FT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OverloadTy);
 | 
						|
  for (unsigned i = 0, e = FT->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) {
 | 
						|
    QualType ParamType = FT->getParamType(i);
 | 
						|
    ParmVarDecl *Parm =
 | 
						|
        ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, OverloadDecl, SourceLocation(),
 | 
						|
                                SourceLocation(), nullptr, ParamType,
 | 
						|
                                /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr);
 | 
						|
    Parm->setScopeInfo(0, i);
 | 
						|
    Params.push_back(Parm);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  OverloadDecl->setParams(Params);
 | 
						|
  return OverloadDecl;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void checkDirectCallValidity(Sema &S, const Expr *Fn,
 | 
						|
                                    FunctionDecl *Callee,
 | 
						|
                                    MultiExprArg ArgExprs) {
 | 
						|
  // `Callee` (when called with ArgExprs) may be ill-formed. enable_if (and
 | 
						|
  // similar attributes) really don't like it when functions are called with an
 | 
						|
  // invalid number of args.
 | 
						|
  if (S.TooManyArguments(Callee->getNumParams(), ArgExprs.size(),
 | 
						|
                         /*PartialOverloading=*/false) &&
 | 
						|
      !Callee->isVariadic())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  if (Callee->getMinRequiredArguments() > ArgExprs.size())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr = S.CheckEnableIf(Callee, ArgExprs, true)) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Fn->getBeginLoc(),
 | 
						|
           isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Callee)
 | 
						|
               ? diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call
 | 
						|
               : diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
 | 
						|
        << Callee << Callee->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(),
 | 
						|
           diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr)
 | 
						|
        << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage();
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static bool enclosingClassIsRelatedToClassInWhichMembersWereFound(
 | 
						|
    const UnresolvedMemberExpr *const UME, Sema &S) {
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  const auto GetFunctionLevelDCIfCXXClass =
 | 
						|
      [](Sema &S) -> const CXXRecordDecl * {
 | 
						|
    const DeclContext *const DC = S.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
 | 
						|
    if (!DC || !DC->getParent())
 | 
						|
      return nullptr;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // If the call to some member function was made from within a member
 | 
						|
    // function body 'M' return return 'M's parent.
 | 
						|
    if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC))
 | 
						|
      return MD->getParent()->getCanonicalDecl();
 | 
						|
    // else the call was made from within a default member initializer of a
 | 
						|
    // class, so return the class.
 | 
						|
    if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
 | 
						|
      return RD->getCanonicalDecl();
 | 
						|
    return nullptr;
 | 
						|
  };
 | 
						|
  // If our DeclContext is neither a member function nor a class (in the
 | 
						|
  // case of a lambda in a default member initializer), we can't have an
 | 
						|
  // enclosing 'this'.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  const CXXRecordDecl *const CurParentClass = GetFunctionLevelDCIfCXXClass(S);
 | 
						|
  if (!CurParentClass)
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The naming class for implicit member functions call is the class in which
 | 
						|
  // name lookup starts.
 | 
						|
  const CXXRecordDecl *const NamingClass =
 | 
						|
      UME->getNamingClass()->getCanonicalDecl();
 | 
						|
  assert(NamingClass && "Must have naming class even for implicit access");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If the unresolved member functions were found in a 'naming class' that is
 | 
						|
  // related (either the same or derived from) to the class that contains the
 | 
						|
  // member function that itself contained the implicit member access.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return CurParentClass == NamingClass ||
 | 
						|
         CurParentClass->isDerivedFrom(NamingClass);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void
 | 
						|
tryImplicitlyCaptureThisIfImplicitMemberFunctionAccessWithDependentArgs(
 | 
						|
    Sema &S, const UnresolvedMemberExpr *const UME, SourceLocation CallLoc) {
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!UME)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  LambdaScopeInfo *const CurLSI = S.getCurLambda();
 | 
						|
  // Only try and implicitly capture 'this' within a C++ Lambda if it hasn't
 | 
						|
  // already been captured, or if this is an implicit member function call (if
 | 
						|
  // it isn't, an attempt to capture 'this' should already have been made).
 | 
						|
  if (!CurLSI || CurLSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CurLSI->ImpCap_None ||
 | 
						|
      !UME->isImplicitAccess() || CurLSI->isCXXThisCaptured())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check if the naming class in which the unresolved members were found is
 | 
						|
  // related (same as or is a base of) to the enclosing class.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!enclosingClassIsRelatedToClassInWhichMembersWereFound(UME, S))
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  DeclContext *EnclosingFunctionCtx = S.CurContext->getParent()->getParent();
 | 
						|
  // If the enclosing function is not dependent, then this lambda is
 | 
						|
  // capture ready, so if we can capture this, do so.
 | 
						|
  if (!EnclosingFunctionCtx->isDependentContext()) {
 | 
						|
    // If the current lambda and all enclosing lambdas can capture 'this' -
 | 
						|
    // then go ahead and capture 'this' (since our unresolved overload set
 | 
						|
    // contains at least one non-static member function).
 | 
						|
    if (!S.CheckCXXThisCapture(CallLoc, /*Explcit*/ false, /*Diagnose*/ false))
 | 
						|
      S.CheckCXXThisCapture(CallLoc);
 | 
						|
  } else if (S.CurContext->isDependentContext()) {
 | 
						|
    // ... since this is an implicit member reference, that might potentially
 | 
						|
    // involve a 'this' capture, mark 'this' for potential capture in
 | 
						|
    // enclosing lambdas.
 | 
						|
    if (CurLSI->ImpCaptureStyle != CurLSI->ImpCap_None)
 | 
						|
      CurLSI->addPotentialThisCapture(CallLoc);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *Scope, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
 | 
						|
                               MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc,
 | 
						|
                               Expr *ExecConfig) {
 | 
						|
  ExprResult Call =
 | 
						|
      BuildCallExpr(Scope, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc, ExecConfig);
 | 
						|
  if (Call.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return Call;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Diagnose uses of the C++20 "ADL-only template-id call" feature in earlier
 | 
						|
  // language modes.
 | 
						|
  if (auto *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(Fn)) {
 | 
						|
    if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
 | 
						|
        ULE->decls_begin() == ULE->decls_end()) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(Fn->getExprLoc(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a
 | 
						|
                                 ? diag::warn_cxx17_compat_adl_only_template_id
 | 
						|
                                 : diag::ext_adl_only_template_id)
 | 
						|
          << ULE->getName();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return Call;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// BuildCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
 | 
						|
/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
 | 
						|
/// locations.
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::BuildCallExpr(Scope *Scope, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
 | 
						|
                               MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc,
 | 
						|
                               Expr *ExecConfig, bool IsExecConfig) {
 | 
						|
  // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
 | 
						|
  ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope, Fn);
 | 
						|
  if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  Fn = Result.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (checkArgsForPlaceholders(*this, ArgExprs))
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
    // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
 | 
						|
    if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
 | 
						|
      if (!ArgExprs.empty()) {
 | 
						|
        // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
 | 
						|
        Diag(Fn->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
 | 
						|
            << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
 | 
						|
                   SourceRange(ArgExprs.front()->getBeginLoc(),
 | 
						|
                               ArgExprs.back()->getEndLoc()));
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      return CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, /*Args=*/{}, Context.VoidTy,
 | 
						|
                              VK_RValue, RParenLoc);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    if (Fn->getType() == Context.PseudoObjectTy) {
 | 
						|
      ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Fn);
 | 
						|
      if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      Fn = result.get();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
 | 
						|
    // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
 | 
						|
    if (Fn->isTypeDependent() || Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(ArgExprs)) {
 | 
						|
      if (ExecConfig) {
 | 
						|
        return CUDAKernelCallExpr::Create(
 | 
						|
            Context, Fn, cast<CallExpr>(ExecConfig), ArgExprs,
 | 
						|
            Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc);
 | 
						|
      } else {
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        tryImplicitlyCaptureThisIfImplicitMemberFunctionAccessWithDependentArgs(
 | 
						|
            *this, dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(Fn->IgnoreParens()),
 | 
						|
            Fn->getBeginLoc());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        return CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, ArgExprs, Context.DependentTy,
 | 
						|
                                VK_RValue, RParenLoc);
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
 | 
						|
    if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
 | 
						|
      return BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs,
 | 
						|
                                          RParenLoc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
 | 
						|
      ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn);
 | 
						|
      if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      Fn = result.get();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy) {
 | 
						|
      return BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs,
 | 
						|
                                       RParenLoc);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check for overloaded calls.  This can happen even in C due to extensions.
 | 
						|
  if (Fn->getType() == Context.OverloadTy) {
 | 
						|
    OverloadExpr::FindResult find = OverloadExpr::find(Fn);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // We aren't supposed to apply this logic if there's an '&' involved.
 | 
						|
    if (!find.HasFormOfMemberPointer) {
 | 
						|
      if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(ArgExprs))
 | 
						|
        return CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, ArgExprs, Context.DependentTy,
 | 
						|
                                VK_RValue, RParenLoc);
 | 
						|
      OverloadExpr *ovl = find.Expression;
 | 
						|
      if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(ovl))
 | 
						|
        return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(
 | 
						|
            Scope, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc, ExecConfig,
 | 
						|
            /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/true, find.IsAddressOfOperand);
 | 
						|
      return BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs,
 | 
						|
                                       RParenLoc);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
 | 
						|
  if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
 | 
						|
    ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn);
 | 
						|
    if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    Fn = result.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool CallingNDeclIndirectly = false;
 | 
						|
  NamedDecl *NDecl = nullptr;
 | 
						|
  if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
 | 
						|
    if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf) {
 | 
						|
      CallingNDeclIndirectly = true;
 | 
						|
      NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)) {
 | 
						|
    NDecl = DRE->getDecl();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
 | 
						|
    if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID()) {
 | 
						|
      // Rewrite the function decl for this builtin by replacing parameters
 | 
						|
      // with no explicit address space with the address space of the arguments
 | 
						|
      // in ArgExprs.
 | 
						|
      if ((FDecl =
 | 
						|
               rewriteBuiltinFunctionDecl(this, Context, FDecl, ArgExprs))) {
 | 
						|
        NDecl = FDecl;
 | 
						|
        Fn = DeclRefExpr::Create(
 | 
						|
            Context, FDecl->getQualifierLoc(), SourceLocation(), FDecl, false,
 | 
						|
            SourceLocation(), FDecl->getType(), Fn->getValueKind(), FDecl,
 | 
						|
            nullptr, DRE->isNonOdrUse());
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } else if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedFn))
 | 
						|
    NDecl = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)->getMemberDecl();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl)) {
 | 
						|
    if (CallingNDeclIndirectly && !checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(
 | 
						|
                                      FD, /*Complain=*/true, Fn->getBeginLoc()))
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && checkOpenCLDisabledDecl(*FD, *Fn))
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    checkDirectCallValidity(*this, Fn, FD, ArgExprs);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc,
 | 
						|
                               ExecConfig, IsExecConfig);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// ActOnAsTypeExpr - create a new asType (bitcast) from the arguments.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// __builtin_astype( value, dst type )
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnAsTypeExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy,
 | 
						|
                                 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
 | 
						|
                                 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
 | 
						|
  ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
 | 
						|
  ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
 | 
						|
  QualType DstTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy);
 | 
						|
  QualType SrcTy = E->getType();
 | 
						|
  if (Context.getTypeSize(DstTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
 | 
						|
    return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc,
 | 
						|
                          diag::err_invalid_astype_of_different_size)
 | 
						|
                     << DstTy
 | 
						|
                     << SrcTy
 | 
						|
                     << E->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
  return new (Context) AsTypeExpr(E, DstTy, VK, OK, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// ActOnConvertVectorExpr - create a new convert-vector expression from the
 | 
						|
/// provided arguments.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// __builtin_convertvector( value, dst type )
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnConvertVectorExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy,
 | 
						|
                                        SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
 | 
						|
                                        SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
 | 
						|
  TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
 | 
						|
  GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy, &TInfo);
 | 
						|
  return SemaConvertVectorExpr(E, TInfo, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
 | 
						|
/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy.  The expression should
 | 
						|
/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
 | 
						|
/// block-pointer type.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
 | 
						|
                                       SourceLocation LParenLoc,
 | 
						|
                                       ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
 | 
						|
                                       SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Config,
 | 
						|
                                       bool IsExecConfig, ADLCallKind UsesADL) {
 | 
						|
  FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
 | 
						|
  unsigned BuiltinID = (FDecl ? FDecl->getBuiltinID() : 0);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Functions with 'interrupt' attribute cannot be called directly.
 | 
						|
  if (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>()) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(Fn->getExprLoc(), diag::err_anyx86_interrupt_called);
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Interrupt handlers don't save off the VFP regs automatically on ARM,
 | 
						|
  // so there's some risk when calling out to non-interrupt handler functions
 | 
						|
  // that the callee might not preserve them. This is easy to diagnose here,
 | 
						|
  // but can be very challenging to debug.
 | 
						|
  if (auto *Caller = getCurFunctionDecl())
 | 
						|
    if (Caller->hasAttr<ARMInterruptAttr>()) {
 | 
						|
      bool VFP = Context.getTargetInfo().hasFeature("vfp");
 | 
						|
      if (VFP && (!FDecl || !FDecl->hasAttr<ARMInterruptAttr>()))
 | 
						|
        Diag(Fn->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_arm_interrupt_calling_convention);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Promote the function operand.
 | 
						|
  // We special-case function promotion here because we only allow promoting
 | 
						|
  // builtin functions to function pointers in the callee of a call.
 | 
						|
  ExprResult Result;
 | 
						|
  QualType ResultTy;
 | 
						|
  if (BuiltinID &&
 | 
						|
      Fn->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::BuiltinFn)) {
 | 
						|
    // Extract the return type from the (builtin) function pointer type.
 | 
						|
    // FIXME Several builtins still have setType in
 | 
						|
    // Sema::CheckBuiltinFunctionCall. One should review their definitions in
 | 
						|
    // Builtins.def to ensure they are correct before removing setType calls.
 | 
						|
    QualType FnPtrTy = Context.getPointerType(FDecl->getType());
 | 
						|
    Result = ImpCastExprToType(Fn, FnPtrTy, CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr).get();
 | 
						|
    ResultTy = FDecl->getCallResultType();
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    Result = CallExprUnaryConversions(Fn);
 | 
						|
    ResultTy = Context.BoolTy;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (Result.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  Fn = Result.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check for a valid function type, but only if it is not a builtin which
 | 
						|
  // requires custom type checking. These will be handled by
 | 
						|
  // CheckBuiltinFunctionCall below just after creation of the call expression.
 | 
						|
  const FunctionType *FuncT = nullptr;
 | 
						|
  if (!BuiltinID || !Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(BuiltinID)) {
 | 
						|
  retry:
 | 
						|
    if (const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
 | 
						|
      // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
 | 
						|
      // have type pointer to function".
 | 
						|
      FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
 | 
						|
      if (!FuncT)
 | 
						|
        return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
 | 
						|
                         << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
    } else if (const BlockPointerType *BPT =
 | 
						|
                   Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
 | 
						|
      FuncT = BPT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      // Handle calls to expressions of unknown-any type.
 | 
						|
      if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
 | 
						|
        ExprResult rewrite = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn);
 | 
						|
        if (rewrite.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
          return ExprError();
 | 
						|
        Fn = rewrite.get();
 | 
						|
        goto retry;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
 | 
						|
                       << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Get the number of parameters in the function prototype, if any.
 | 
						|
  // We will allocate space for max(Args.size(), NumParams) arguments
 | 
						|
  // in the call expression.
 | 
						|
  const auto *Proto = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT);
 | 
						|
  unsigned NumParams = Proto ? Proto->getNumParams() : 0;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  CallExpr *TheCall;
 | 
						|
  if (Config) {
 | 
						|
    assert(UsesADL == ADLCallKind::NotADL &&
 | 
						|
           "CUDAKernelCallExpr should not use ADL");
 | 
						|
    TheCall =
 | 
						|
        CUDAKernelCallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, cast<CallExpr>(Config), Args,
 | 
						|
                                   ResultTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc, NumParams);
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    TheCall = CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, Args, ResultTy, VK_RValue,
 | 
						|
                               RParenLoc, NumParams, UsesADL);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
    // Forget about the nulled arguments since typo correction
 | 
						|
    // do not handle them well.
 | 
						|
    TheCall->shrinkNumArgs(Args.size());
 | 
						|
    // C cannot always handle TypoExpr nodes in builtin calls and direct
 | 
						|
    // function calls as their argument checking don't necessarily handle
 | 
						|
    // dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have been
 | 
						|
    // dealt with.
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Result = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(TheCall);
 | 
						|
    if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    CallExpr *TheOldCall = TheCall;
 | 
						|
    TheCall = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(Result.get());
 | 
						|
    bool CorrectedTypos = TheCall != TheOldCall;
 | 
						|
    if (!TheCall) return Result;
 | 
						|
    Args = llvm::makeArrayRef(TheCall->getArgs(), TheCall->getNumArgs());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // A new call expression node was created if some typos were corrected.
 | 
						|
    // However it may not have been constructed with enough storage. In this
 | 
						|
    // case, rebuild the node with enough storage. The waste of space is
 | 
						|
    // immaterial since this only happens when some typos were corrected.
 | 
						|
    if (CorrectedTypos && Args.size() < NumParams) {
 | 
						|
      if (Config)
 | 
						|
        TheCall = CUDAKernelCallExpr::Create(
 | 
						|
            Context, Fn, cast<CallExpr>(Config), Args, ResultTy, VK_RValue,
 | 
						|
            RParenLoc, NumParams);
 | 
						|
      else
 | 
						|
        TheCall = CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, Args, ResultTy, VK_RValue,
 | 
						|
                                   RParenLoc, NumParams, UsesADL);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    // We can now handle the nulled arguments for the default arguments.
 | 
						|
    TheCall->setNumArgsUnsafe(std::max<unsigned>(Args.size(), NumParams));
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom type checking.
 | 
						|
  if (BuiltinID && Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(BuiltinID))
 | 
						|
    return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FDecl, BuiltinID, TheCall);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CUDA) {
 | 
						|
    if (Config) {
 | 
						|
      // CUDA: Kernel calls must be to global functions
 | 
						|
      if (FDecl && !FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>())
 | 
						|
        return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc,diag::err_kern_call_not_global_function)
 | 
						|
            << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // CUDA: Kernel function must have 'void' return type
 | 
						|
      if (!FuncT->getReturnType()->isVoidType() &&
 | 
						|
          !FuncT->getReturnType()->getAs<AutoType>() &&
 | 
						|
          !FuncT->getReturnType()->isInstantiationDependentType())
 | 
						|
        return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_kern_type_not_void_return)
 | 
						|
            << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      // CUDA: Calls to global functions must be configured
 | 
						|
      if (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>())
 | 
						|
        return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_global_call_not_config)
 | 
						|
            << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check for a valid return type
 | 
						|
  if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getReturnType(), Fn->getBeginLoc(), TheCall,
 | 
						|
                          FDecl))
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // We know the result type of the call, set it.
 | 
						|
  TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
 | 
						|
  TheCall->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(FuncT->getReturnType()));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Proto) {
 | 
						|
    if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, RParenLoc,
 | 
						|
                                IsExecConfig))
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (FDecl) {
 | 
						|
      // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
 | 
						|
      // on our knowledge of the function definition.
 | 
						|
      const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr;
 | 
						|
      if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && Args.size() != Def->param_size()) {
 | 
						|
        Proto = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
 | 
						|
       if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && Args.size() >= Def->param_size()))
 | 
						|
          Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
 | 
						|
          << (Args.size() > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have
 | 
						|
      // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype.
 | 
						|
      if (!FDecl->hasPrototype())
 | 
						|
        Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
 | 
						|
    for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; i++) {
 | 
						|
      Expr *Arg = Args[i];
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumParams()) {
 | 
						|
        InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
 | 
						|
            Context, Proto->getParamType(i), Proto->isParamConsumed(i));
 | 
						|
        ExprResult ArgE =
 | 
						|
            PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg);
 | 
						|
        if (ArgE.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
          return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      } else {
 | 
						|
        ExprResult ArgE = DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        if (ArgE.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
          return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getBeginLoc(), Arg->getType(),
 | 
						|
                              diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg))
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
 | 
						|
    if (!Method->isStatic())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
 | 
						|
        << Fn->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check for sentinels
 | 
						|
  if (NDecl)
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
 | 
						|
  if (FDecl) {
 | 
						|
    if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall, Proto))
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    checkFortifiedBuiltinMemoryFunction(FDecl, TheCall);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (BuiltinID)
 | 
						|
      return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FDecl, BuiltinID, TheCall);
 | 
						|
  } else if (NDecl) {
 | 
						|
    if (CheckPointerCall(NDecl, TheCall, Proto))
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    if (CheckOtherCall(TheCall, Proto))
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
 | 
						|
                           SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
 | 
						|
  assert(Ty && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
 | 
						|
  assert(InitExpr && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
 | 
						|
  QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
 | 
						|
  if (!TInfo)
 | 
						|
    TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
 | 
						|
                               SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *LiteralExpr) {
 | 
						|
  QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Context.getBaseElementType(literalType),
 | 
						|
          diag::err_illegal_decl_array_incomplete_type,
 | 
						|
          SourceRange(LParenLoc,
 | 
						|
                      LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
 | 
						|
        << SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
 | 
						|
  } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
 | 
						|
             RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
 | 
						|
               diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type,
 | 
						|
               SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  InitializedEntity Entity
 | 
						|
    = InitializedEntity::InitializeCompoundLiteralInit(TInfo);
 | 
						|
  InitializationKind Kind
 | 
						|
    = InitializationKind::CreateCStyleCast(LParenLoc,
 | 
						|
                                           SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
 | 
						|
                                           /*InitList=*/true);
 | 
						|
  InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr);
 | 
						|
  ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr,
 | 
						|
                                      &literalType);
 | 
						|
  if (Result.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  LiteralExpr = Result.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool isFileScope = !CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // In C, compound literals are l-values for some reason.
 | 
						|
  // For GCC compatibility, in C++, file-scope array compound literals with
 | 
						|
  // constant initializers are also l-values, and compound literals are
 | 
						|
  // otherwise prvalues.
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // (GCC also treats C++ list-initialized file-scope array prvalues with
 | 
						|
  // constant initializers as l-values, but that's non-conforming, so we don't
 | 
						|
  // follow it there.)
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: It would be better to handle the lvalue cases as materializing and
 | 
						|
  // lifetime-extending a temporary object, but our materialized temporaries
 | 
						|
  // representation only supports lifetime extension from a variable, not "out
 | 
						|
  // of thin air".
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: For C++, we might want to instead lifetime-extend only if a pointer
 | 
						|
  // is bound to the result of applying array-to-pointer decay to the compound
 | 
						|
  // literal.
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: GCC supports compound literals of reference type, which should
 | 
						|
  // obviously have a value kind derived from the kind of reference involved.
 | 
						|
  ExprValueKind VK =
 | 
						|
      (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !(isFileScope && literalType->isArrayType()))
 | 
						|
          ? VK_RValue
 | 
						|
          : VK_LValue;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (isFileScope)
 | 
						|
    if (auto ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(LiteralExpr))
 | 
						|
      for (unsigned i = 0, j = ILE->getNumInits(); i != j; i++) {
 | 
						|
        Expr *Init = ILE->getInit(i);
 | 
						|
        ILE->setInit(i, ConstantExpr::Create(Context, Init));
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  auto *E = new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
 | 
						|
                                              VK, LiteralExpr, isFileScope);
 | 
						|
  if (isFileScope) {
 | 
						|
    if (!LiteralExpr->isTypeDependent() &&
 | 
						|
        !LiteralExpr->isValueDependent() &&
 | 
						|
        !literalType->isDependentType()) // C99 6.5.2.5p3
 | 
						|
      if (CheckForConstantInitializer(LiteralExpr, literalType))
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  } else if (literalType.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private &&
 | 
						|
             literalType.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) {
 | 
						|
    // Embedded-C extensions to C99 6.5.2.5:
 | 
						|
    //   "If the compound literal occurs inside the body of a function, the
 | 
						|
    //   type name shall not be qualified by an address-space qualifier."
 | 
						|
    Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_compound_literal_with_address_space)
 | 
						|
      << SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd());
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Compound literals that have automatic storage duration are destroyed at
 | 
						|
  // the end of the scope. Emit diagnostics if it is or contains a C union type
 | 
						|
  // that is non-trivial to destruct.
 | 
						|
  if (!isFileScope)
 | 
						|
    if (E->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion())
 | 
						|
      checkNonTrivialCUnion(E->getType(), E->getExprLoc(),
 | 
						|
                            NTCUC_CompoundLiteral, NTCUK_Destruct);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (E->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() ||
 | 
						|
      E->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
 | 
						|
    checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(E->getInitializer(),
 | 
						|
                                       E->getInitializer()->getExprLoc());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return MaybeBindToTemporary(E);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg InitArgList,
 | 
						|
                    SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
 | 
						|
  // Only produce each kind of designated initialization diagnostic once.
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation FirstDesignator;
 | 
						|
  bool DiagnosedArrayDesignator = false;
 | 
						|
  bool DiagnosedNestedDesignator = false;
 | 
						|
  bool DiagnosedMixedDesignator = false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check that any designated initializers are syntactically valid in the
 | 
						|
  // current language mode.
 | 
						|
  for (unsigned I = 0, E = InitArgList.size(); I != E; ++I) {
 | 
						|
    if (auto *DIE = dyn_cast<DesignatedInitExpr>(InitArgList[I])) {
 | 
						|
      if (FirstDesignator.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
        FirstDesignator = DIE->getBeginLoc();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (!DiagnosedNestedDesignator && DIE->size() > 1) {
 | 
						|
        DiagnosedNestedDesignator = true;
 | 
						|
        Diag(DIE->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_designated_init_nested)
 | 
						|
          << DIE->getDesignatorsSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      for (auto &Desig : DIE->designators()) {
 | 
						|
        if (!Desig.isFieldDesignator() && !DiagnosedArrayDesignator) {
 | 
						|
          DiagnosedArrayDesignator = true;
 | 
						|
          Diag(Desig.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_designated_init_array)
 | 
						|
            << Desig.getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (!DiagnosedMixedDesignator &&
 | 
						|
          !isa<DesignatedInitExpr>(InitArgList[0])) {
 | 
						|
        DiagnosedMixedDesignator = true;
 | 
						|
        Diag(DIE->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_designated_init_mixed)
 | 
						|
          << DIE->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
        Diag(InitArgList[0]->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_designated_init_mixed)
 | 
						|
          << InitArgList[0]->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !DiagnosedMixedDesignator &&
 | 
						|
               isa<DesignatedInitExpr>(InitArgList[0])) {
 | 
						|
      DiagnosedMixedDesignator = true;
 | 
						|
      auto *DIE = cast<DesignatedInitExpr>(InitArgList[0]);
 | 
						|
      Diag(DIE->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_designated_init_mixed)
 | 
						|
        << DIE->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      Diag(InitArgList[I]->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_designated_init_mixed)
 | 
						|
        << InitArgList[I]->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (FirstDesignator.isValid()) {
 | 
						|
    // Only diagnose designated initiaization as a C++20 extension if we didn't
 | 
						|
    // already diagnose use of (non-C++20) C99 designator syntax.
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !DiagnosedArrayDesignator &&
 | 
						|
        !DiagnosedNestedDesignator && !DiagnosedMixedDesignator) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(FirstDesignator, getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a
 | 
						|
                                ? diag::warn_cxx17_compat_designated_init
 | 
						|
                                : diag::ext_cxx_designated_init);
 | 
						|
    } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !getLangOpts().C99) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(FirstDesignator, diag::ext_designated_init);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return BuildInitList(LBraceLoc, InitArgList, RBraceLoc);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::BuildInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg InitArgList,
 | 
						|
                    SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
 | 
						|
  // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
 | 
						|
  // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being initialized.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Immediately handle non-overload placeholders.  Overloads can be
 | 
						|
  // resolved contextually, but everything else here can't.
 | 
						|
  for (unsigned I = 0, E = InitArgList.size(); I != E; ++I) {
 | 
						|
    if (InitArgList[I]->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) {
 | 
						|
      ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(InitArgList[I]);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Ignore failures; dropping the entire initializer list because
 | 
						|
      // of one failure would be terrible for indexing/etc.
 | 
						|
      if (result.isInvalid()) continue;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      InitArgList[I] = result.get();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitArgList,
 | 
						|
                                               RBraceLoc);
 | 
						|
  E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
 | 
						|
  return E;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Do an explicit extend of the given block pointer if we're in ARC.
 | 
						|
void Sema::maybeExtendBlockObject(ExprResult &E) {
 | 
						|
  assert(E.get()->getType()->isBlockPointerType());
 | 
						|
  assert(E.get()->isRValue());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Only do this in an r-value context.
 | 
						|
  if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  E = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, E.get()->getType(),
 | 
						|
                               CK_ARCExtendBlockObject, E.get(),
 | 
						|
                               /*base path*/ nullptr, VK_RValue);
 | 
						|
  Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(true);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Prepare a conversion of the given expression to an ObjC object
 | 
						|
/// pointer type.
 | 
						|
CastKind Sema::PrepareCastToObjCObjectPointer(ExprResult &E) {
 | 
						|
  QualType type = E.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
  if (type->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
    return CK_BitCast;
 | 
						|
  } else if (type->isBlockPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
    maybeExtendBlockObject(E);
 | 
						|
    return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    assert(type->isPointerType());
 | 
						|
    return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Prepares for a scalar cast, performing all the necessary stages
 | 
						|
/// except the final cast and returning the kind required.
 | 
						|
CastKind Sema::PrepareScalarCast(ExprResult &Src, QualType DestTy) {
 | 
						|
  // Both Src and Dest are scalar types, i.e. arithmetic or pointer.
 | 
						|
  // Also, callers should have filtered out the invalid cases with
 | 
						|
  // pointers.  Everything else should be possible.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType SrcTy = Src.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
  if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
 | 
						|
    return CK_NoOp;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  switch (Type::ScalarTypeKind SrcKind = SrcTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
 | 
						|
  case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
 | 
						|
    llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case Type::STK_CPointer:
 | 
						|
  case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
 | 
						|
  case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
 | 
						|
    switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_CPointer: {
 | 
						|
      LangAS SrcAS = SrcTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
 | 
						|
      LangAS DestAS = DestTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
 | 
						|
      if (SrcAS != DestAS)
 | 
						|
        return CK_AddressSpaceConversion;
 | 
						|
      if (Context.hasCvrSimilarType(SrcTy, DestTy))
 | 
						|
        return CK_NoOp;
 | 
						|
      return CK_BitCast;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
 | 
						|
      return (SrcKind == Type::STK_BlockPointer
 | 
						|
                ? CK_BitCast : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast);
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
 | 
						|
      if (SrcKind == Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer)
 | 
						|
        return CK_BitCast;
 | 
						|
      if (SrcKind == Type::STK_CPointer)
 | 
						|
        return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
 | 
						|
      maybeExtendBlockObject(Src);
 | 
						|
      return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_Bool:
 | 
						|
      return CK_PointerToBoolean;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_Integral:
 | 
						|
      return CK_PointerToIntegral;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_Floating:
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_FixedPoint:
 | 
						|
      llvm_unreachable("illegal cast from pointer");
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case Type::STK_FixedPoint:
 | 
						|
    switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_FixedPoint:
 | 
						|
      return CK_FixedPointCast;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_Bool:
 | 
						|
      return CK_FixedPointToBoolean;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_Integral:
 | 
						|
      return CK_FixedPointToIntegral;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_Floating:
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
 | 
						|
      Diag(Src.get()->getExprLoc(),
 | 
						|
           diag::err_unimplemented_conversion_with_fixed_point_type)
 | 
						|
          << DestTy;
 | 
						|
      return CK_IntegralCast;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_CPointer:
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
 | 
						|
      llvm_unreachable("illegal cast to pointer type");
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case Type::STK_Bool: // casting from bool is like casting from an integer
 | 
						|
  case Type::STK_Integral:
 | 
						|
    switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_CPointer:
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
 | 
						|
      if (Src.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
 | 
						|
                                           Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
 | 
						|
        return CK_NullToPointer;
 | 
						|
      return CK_IntegralToPointer;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_Bool:
 | 
						|
      return CK_IntegralToBoolean;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_Integral:
 | 
						|
      return CK_IntegralCast;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_Floating:
 | 
						|
      return CK_IntegralToFloating;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
 | 
						|
      Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
 | 
						|
                      DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
 | 
						|
                      CK_IntegralCast);
 | 
						|
      return CK_IntegralRealToComplex;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
 | 
						|
      Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
 | 
						|
                      DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
 | 
						|
                      CK_IntegralToFloating);
 | 
						|
      return CK_FloatingRealToComplex;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
 | 
						|
      llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_FixedPoint:
 | 
						|
      return CK_IntegralToFixedPoint;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case Type::STK_Floating:
 | 
						|
    switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_Floating:
 | 
						|
      return CK_FloatingCast;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_Bool:
 | 
						|
      return CK_FloatingToBoolean;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_Integral:
 | 
						|
      return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
 | 
						|
      Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
 | 
						|
                              DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
 | 
						|
                              CK_FloatingCast);
 | 
						|
      return CK_FloatingRealToComplex;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
 | 
						|
      Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
 | 
						|
                              DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
 | 
						|
                              CK_FloatingToIntegral);
 | 
						|
      return CK_IntegralRealToComplex;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_CPointer:
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
 | 
						|
      llvm_unreachable("valid float->pointer cast?");
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
 | 
						|
      llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_FixedPoint:
 | 
						|
      Diag(Src.get()->getExprLoc(),
 | 
						|
           diag::err_unimplemented_conversion_with_fixed_point_type)
 | 
						|
          << SrcTy;
 | 
						|
      return CK_IntegralCast;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
 | 
						|
    switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
 | 
						|
      return CK_FloatingComplexCast;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
 | 
						|
      return CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_Floating: {
 | 
						|
      QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType();
 | 
						|
      if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy))
 | 
						|
        return CK_FloatingComplexToReal;
 | 
						|
      Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_FloatingComplexToReal);
 | 
						|
      return CK_FloatingCast;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_Bool:
 | 
						|
      return CK_FloatingComplexToBoolean;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_Integral:
 | 
						|
      Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
 | 
						|
                              SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
 | 
						|
                              CK_FloatingComplexToReal);
 | 
						|
      return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_CPointer:
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
 | 
						|
      llvm_unreachable("valid complex float->pointer cast?");
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
 | 
						|
      llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_FixedPoint:
 | 
						|
      Diag(Src.get()->getExprLoc(),
 | 
						|
           diag::err_unimplemented_conversion_with_fixed_point_type)
 | 
						|
          << SrcTy;
 | 
						|
      return CK_IntegralCast;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
 | 
						|
    switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
 | 
						|
      return CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
 | 
						|
      return CK_IntegralComplexCast;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_Integral: {
 | 
						|
      QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType();
 | 
						|
      if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy))
 | 
						|
        return CK_IntegralComplexToReal;
 | 
						|
      Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_IntegralComplexToReal);
 | 
						|
      return CK_IntegralCast;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_Bool:
 | 
						|
      return CK_IntegralComplexToBoolean;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_Floating:
 | 
						|
      Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
 | 
						|
                              SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
 | 
						|
                              CK_IntegralComplexToReal);
 | 
						|
      return CK_IntegralToFloating;
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_CPointer:
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
 | 
						|
      llvm_unreachable("valid complex int->pointer cast?");
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
 | 
						|
      llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
 | 
						|
    case Type::STK_FixedPoint:
 | 
						|
      Diag(Src.get()->getExprLoc(),
 | 
						|
           diag::err_unimplemented_conversion_with_fixed_point_type)
 | 
						|
          << SrcTy;
 | 
						|
      return CK_IntegralCast;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  llvm_unreachable("Unhandled scalar cast");
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static bool breakDownVectorType(QualType type, uint64_t &len,
 | 
						|
                                QualType &eltType) {
 | 
						|
  // Vectors are simple.
 | 
						|
  if (const VectorType *vecType = type->getAs<VectorType>()) {
 | 
						|
    len = vecType->getNumElements();
 | 
						|
    eltType = vecType->getElementType();
 | 
						|
    assert(eltType->isScalarType());
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // We allow lax conversion to and from non-vector types, but only if
 | 
						|
  // they're real types (i.e. non-complex, non-pointer scalar types).
 | 
						|
  if (!type->isRealType()) return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  len = 1;
 | 
						|
  eltType = type;
 | 
						|
  return true;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Are the two types lax-compatible vector types?  That is, given
 | 
						|
/// that one of them is a vector, do they have equal storage sizes,
 | 
						|
/// where the storage size is the number of elements times the element
 | 
						|
/// size?
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// This will also return false if either of the types is neither a
 | 
						|
/// vector nor a real type.
 | 
						|
bool Sema::areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) {
 | 
						|
  assert(destTy->isVectorType() || srcTy->isVectorType());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Disallow lax conversions between scalars and ExtVectors (these
 | 
						|
  // conversions are allowed for other vector types because common headers
 | 
						|
  // depend on them).  Most scalar OP ExtVector cases are handled by the
 | 
						|
  // splat path anyway, which does what we want (convert, not bitcast).
 | 
						|
  // What this rules out for ExtVectors is crazy things like char4*float.
 | 
						|
  if (srcTy->isScalarType() && destTy->isExtVectorType()) return false;
 | 
						|
  if (destTy->isScalarType() && srcTy->isExtVectorType()) return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  uint64_t srcLen, destLen;
 | 
						|
  QualType srcEltTy, destEltTy;
 | 
						|
  if (!breakDownVectorType(srcTy, srcLen, srcEltTy)) return false;
 | 
						|
  if (!breakDownVectorType(destTy, destLen, destEltTy)) return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // ASTContext::getTypeSize will return the size rounded up to a
 | 
						|
  // power of 2, so instead of using that, we need to use the raw
 | 
						|
  // element size multiplied by the element count.
 | 
						|
  uint64_t srcEltSize = Context.getTypeSize(srcEltTy);
 | 
						|
  uint64_t destEltSize = Context.getTypeSize(destEltTy);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return (srcLen * srcEltSize == destLen * destEltSize);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Is this a legal conversion between two types, one of which is
 | 
						|
/// known to be a vector type?
 | 
						|
bool Sema::isLaxVectorConversion(QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) {
 | 
						|
  assert(destTy->isVectorType() || srcTy->isVectorType());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  switch (Context.getLangOpts().getLaxVectorConversions()) {
 | 
						|
  case LangOptions::LaxVectorConversionKind::None:
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case LangOptions::LaxVectorConversionKind::Integer:
 | 
						|
    if (!srcTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
 | 
						|
      auto *Vec = srcTy->getAs<VectorType>();
 | 
						|
      if (!Vec || !Vec->getElementType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
 | 
						|
        return false;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    if (!destTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
 | 
						|
      auto *Vec = destTy->getAs<VectorType>();
 | 
						|
      if (!Vec || !Vec->getElementType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
 | 
						|
        return false;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    // OK, integer (vector) -> integer (vector) bitcast.
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    case LangOptions::LaxVectorConversionKind::All:
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(srcTy, destTy);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
 | 
						|
                           CastKind &Kind) {
 | 
						|
  assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegralType(Context)) {
 | 
						|
    if (!areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(Ty, VectorTy))
 | 
						|
      return Diag(R.getBegin(),
 | 
						|
                  Ty->isVectorType() ?
 | 
						|
                  diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
 | 
						|
                  diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
 | 
						|
        << VectorTy << Ty << R;
 | 
						|
  } else
 | 
						|
    return Diag(R.getBegin(),
 | 
						|
                diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
 | 
						|
      << VectorTy << Ty << R;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Kind = CK_BitCast;
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::prepareVectorSplat(QualType VectorTy, Expr *SplattedExpr) {
 | 
						|
  QualType DestElemTy = VectorTy->castAs<VectorType>()->getElementType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (DestElemTy == SplattedExpr->getType())
 | 
						|
    return SplattedExpr;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  assert(DestElemTy->isFloatingType() ||
 | 
						|
         DestElemTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  CastKind CK;
 | 
						|
  if (VectorTy->isExtVectorType() && SplattedExpr->getType()->isBooleanType()) {
 | 
						|
    // OpenCL requires that we convert `true` boolean expressions to -1, but
 | 
						|
    // only when splatting vectors.
 | 
						|
    if (DestElemTy->isFloatingType()) {
 | 
						|
      // To avoid having to have a CK_BooleanToSignedFloating cast kind, we cast
 | 
						|
      // in two steps: boolean to signed integral, then to floating.
 | 
						|
      ExprResult CastExprRes = ImpCastExprToType(SplattedExpr, Context.IntTy,
 | 
						|
                                                 CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral);
 | 
						|
      SplattedExpr = CastExprRes.get();
 | 
						|
      CK = CK_IntegralToFloating;
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      CK = CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    ExprResult CastExprRes = SplattedExpr;
 | 
						|
    CK = PrepareScalarCast(CastExprRes, DestElemTy);
 | 
						|
    if (CastExprRes.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    SplattedExpr = CastExprRes.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return ImpCastExprToType(SplattedExpr, DestElemTy, CK);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy,
 | 
						|
                                    Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &Kind) {
 | 
						|
  assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
 | 
						|
  // an ExtVectorType.
 | 
						|
  // In OpenCL, casts between vectors of different types are not allowed.
 | 
						|
  // (See OpenCL 6.2).
 | 
						|
  if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (!areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(SrcTy, DestTy) ||
 | 
						|
        (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
 | 
						|
         !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DestTy, SrcTy))) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
 | 
						|
        << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    Kind = CK_BitCast;
 | 
						|
    return CastExpr;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type.  The appropriate
 | 
						|
  // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
 | 
						|
  // splat from elt type to vector.
 | 
						|
  if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
 | 
						|
    return Diag(R.getBegin(),
 | 
						|
                diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
 | 
						|
      << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
 | 
						|
  return prepareVectorSplat(DestTy, CastExpr);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
 | 
						|
                    Declarator &D, ParsedType &Ty,
 | 
						|
                    SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *CastExpr) {
 | 
						|
  assert(!D.isInvalidType() && (CastExpr != nullptr) &&
 | 
						|
         "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo = GetTypeForDeclaratorCast(D, CastExpr->getType());
 | 
						|
  if (D.isInvalidType())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
    // Check that there are no default arguments (C++ only).
 | 
						|
    CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D);
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    // Make sure any TypoExprs have been dealt with.
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(CastExpr);
 | 
						|
    if (!Res.isUsable())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    CastExpr = Res.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  checkUnusedDeclAttributes(D);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType castType = castTInfo->getType();
 | 
						|
  Ty = CreateParsedType(castType, castTInfo);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool isVectorLiteral = false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check for an altivec or OpenCL literal,
 | 
						|
  // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
 | 
						|
  ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(CastExpr);
 | 
						|
  ParenListExpr *PLE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr);
 | 
						|
  if ((getLangOpts().AltiVec || getLangOpts().ZVector || getLangOpts().OpenCL)
 | 
						|
       && castType->isVectorType() && (PE || PLE)) {
 | 
						|
    if (PLE && PLE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(PLE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    if (PE || PLE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
 | 
						|
      Expr *E = (PE ? PE->getSubExpr() : PLE->getExpr(0));
 | 
						|
      if (!E->getType()->isVectorType())
 | 
						|
        isVectorLiteral = true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      isVectorLiteral = true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If this is a vector initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
 | 
						|
  // then handle it as such.
 | 
						|
  if (isVectorLiteral)
 | 
						|
    return BuildVectorLiteral(LParenLoc, RParenLoc, CastExpr, castTInfo);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
 | 
						|
  // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
 | 
						|
  // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
 | 
						|
  if (isa<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr)) {
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, CastExpr);
 | 
						|
    if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    CastExpr = Result.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !castType->isVoidType() &&
 | 
						|
      !getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro(LParenLoc))
 | 
						|
    Diag(LParenLoc, diag::warn_old_style_cast) << CastExpr->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  CheckTollFreeBridgeCast(castType, CastExpr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  CheckObjCBridgeRelatedCast(castType, CastExpr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  DiscardMisalignedMemberAddress(castType.getTypePtr(), CastExpr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, CastExpr);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::BuildVectorLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc,
 | 
						|
                                    SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *E,
 | 
						|
                                    TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
 | 
						|
  assert((isa<ParenListExpr>(E) || isa<ParenExpr>(E)) &&
 | 
						|
         "Expected paren or paren list expression");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Expr **exprs;
 | 
						|
  unsigned numExprs;
 | 
						|
  Expr *subExpr;
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation LiteralLParenLoc, LiteralRParenLoc;
 | 
						|
  if (ParenListExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
    LiteralLParenLoc = PE->getLParenLoc();
 | 
						|
    LiteralRParenLoc = PE->getRParenLoc();
 | 
						|
    exprs = PE->getExprs();
 | 
						|
    numExprs = PE->getNumExprs();
 | 
						|
  } else { // isa<ParenExpr> by assertion at function entrance
 | 
						|
    LiteralLParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getLParen();
 | 
						|
    LiteralRParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getRParen();
 | 
						|
    subExpr = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr();
 | 
						|
    exprs = &subExpr;
 | 
						|
    numExprs = 1;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
 | 
						|
  assert(Ty->isVectorType() && "Expected vector type");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
 | 
						|
  const VectorType *VTy = Ty->castAs<VectorType>();
 | 
						|
  unsigned numElems = VTy->getNumElements();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // '(...)' form of vector initialization in AltiVec: the number of
 | 
						|
  // initializers must be one or must match the size of the vector.
 | 
						|
  // If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will be
 | 
						|
  // replicated to all the components of the vector
 | 
						|
  if (VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector) {
 | 
						|
    // The number of initializers must be one or must match the size of the
 | 
						|
    // vector. If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will
 | 
						|
    // be replicated to all the components of the vector
 | 
						|
    if (numExprs == 1) {
 | 
						|
      QualType ElemTy = VTy->getElementType();
 | 
						|
      ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]);
 | 
						|
      if (Literal.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy,
 | 
						|
                                  PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy));
 | 
						|
      return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    else if (numExprs < numElems) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(E->getExprLoc(),
 | 
						|
           diag::err_incorrect_number_of_vector_initializers);
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  else {
 | 
						|
    // For OpenCL, when the number of initializers is a single value,
 | 
						|
    // it will be replicated to all components of the vector.
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
 | 
						|
        VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::GenericVector &&
 | 
						|
        numExprs == 1) {
 | 
						|
        QualType ElemTy = VTy->getElementType();
 | 
						|
        ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]);
 | 
						|
        if (Literal.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
          return ExprError();
 | 
						|
        Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy,
 | 
						|
                                    PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy));
 | 
						|
        return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
 | 
						|
  // braces instead of the original commas.
 | 
						|
  InitListExpr *initE = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LiteralLParenLoc,
 | 
						|
                                                   initExprs, LiteralRParenLoc);
 | 
						|
  initE->setType(Ty);
 | 
						|
  return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, initE);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast or or C++ direct-initialization, so turn
 | 
						|
/// the ParenListExpr into a sequence of comma binary operators.
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *OrigExpr) {
 | 
						|
  ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(OrigExpr);
 | 
						|
  if (!E)
 | 
						|
    return OrigExpr;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
 | 
						|
    Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
 | 
						|
                        E->getExpr(i));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
 | 
						|
                                    SourceLocation R,
 | 
						|
                                    MultiExprArg Val) {
 | 
						|
  return ParenListExpr::Create(Context, L, Val, R);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Emit a specialized diagnostic when one expression is a null pointer
 | 
						|
/// constant and the other is not a pointer.  Returns true if a diagnostic is
 | 
						|
/// emitted.
 | 
						|
bool Sema::DiagnoseConditionalForNull(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
 | 
						|
                                      SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
 | 
						|
  Expr *NullExpr = LHSExpr;
 | 
						|
  Expr *NonPointerExpr = RHSExpr;
 | 
						|
  Expr::NullPointerConstantKind NullKind =
 | 
						|
      NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
 | 
						|
                                      Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull) {
 | 
						|
    NullExpr = RHSExpr;
 | 
						|
    NonPointerExpr = LHSExpr;
 | 
						|
    NullKind =
 | 
						|
        NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
 | 
						|
                                        Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull)
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression)
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroLiteral) {
 | 
						|
    // In this case, check to make sure that we got here from a "NULL"
 | 
						|
    // string in the source code.
 | 
						|
    NullExpr = NullExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
 | 
						|
    SourceLocation loc = NullExpr->getExprLoc();
 | 
						|
    if (!findMacroSpelling(loc, "NULL"))
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  int DiagType = (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_CXX11_nullptr);
 | 
						|
  Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands_null)
 | 
						|
      << NonPointerExpr->getType() << DiagType
 | 
						|
      << NonPointerExpr->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
  return true;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Return false if the condition expression is valid, true otherwise.
 | 
						|
static bool checkCondition(Sema &S, Expr *Cond, SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
 | 
						|
  QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i says the condition cannot be a floating point type.
 | 
						|
  if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && CondTy->isFloatingType()) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_nonfloat)
 | 
						|
      << CondTy << Cond->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.15p2
 | 
						|
  if (CondTy->isScalarType()) return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
 | 
						|
    << CondTy << Cond->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
  return true;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Handle when one or both operands are void type.
 | 
						|
static QualType checkConditionalVoidType(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
 | 
						|
                                         ExprResult &RHS) {
 | 
						|
    Expr *LHSExpr = LHS.get();
 | 
						|
    Expr *RHSExpr = RHS.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (!LHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType())
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(RHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
 | 
						|
          << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    if (!RHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType())
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
 | 
						|
          << LHSExpr->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
 | 
						|
    RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
 | 
						|
    return S.Context.VoidTy;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Return false if the NullExpr can be promoted to PointerTy,
 | 
						|
/// true otherwise.
 | 
						|
static bool checkConditionalNullPointer(Sema &S, ExprResult &NullExpr,
 | 
						|
                                        QualType PointerTy) {
 | 
						|
  if ((!PointerTy->isAnyPointerType() && !PointerTy->isBlockPointerType()) ||
 | 
						|
      !NullExpr.get()->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context,
 | 
						|
                                            Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  NullExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(NullExpr.get(), PointerTy, CK_NullToPointer);
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Checks compatibility between two pointers and return the resulting
 | 
						|
/// type.
 | 
						|
static QualType checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
 | 
						|
                                                     ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                                     SourceLocation Loc) {
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (S.Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, RHSTy)) {
 | 
						|
    // Two identical pointers types are always compatible.
 | 
						|
    return LHSTy;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType lhptee, rhptee;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Get the pointee types.
 | 
						|
  bool IsBlockPointer = false;
 | 
						|
  if (const BlockPointerType *LHSBTy = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
 | 
						|
    lhptee = LHSBTy->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
    rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
    IsBlockPointer = true;
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    lhptee = LHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
    rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types or to
 | 
						|
  // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
 | 
						|
  // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the composite
 | 
						|
  // type.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Only CVR-qualifiers exist in the standard, and the differently-qualified
 | 
						|
  // clause doesn't make sense for our extensions. E.g. address space 2 should
 | 
						|
  // be incompatible with address space 3: they may live on different devices or
 | 
						|
  // anything.
 | 
						|
  Qualifiers lhQual = lhptee.getQualifiers();
 | 
						|
  Qualifiers rhQual = rhptee.getQualifiers();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  LangAS ResultAddrSpace = LangAS::Default;
 | 
						|
  LangAS LAddrSpace = lhQual.getAddressSpace();
 | 
						|
  LangAS RAddrSpace = rhQual.getAddressSpace();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5 - Conversion between pointers to distinct address
 | 
						|
  // spaces is disallowed.
 | 
						|
  if (lhQual.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(rhQual))
 | 
						|
    ResultAddrSpace = LAddrSpace;
 | 
						|
  else if (rhQual.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(lhQual))
 | 
						|
    ResultAddrSpace = RAddrSpace;
 | 
						|
  else {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers)
 | 
						|
        << LHSTy << RHSTy << 2 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
        << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  unsigned MergedCVRQual = lhQual.getCVRQualifiers() | rhQual.getCVRQualifiers();
 | 
						|
  auto LHSCastKind = CK_BitCast, RHSCastKind = CK_BitCast;
 | 
						|
  lhQual.removeCVRQualifiers();
 | 
						|
  rhQual.removeCVRQualifiers();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // OpenCL v2.0 specification doesn't extend compatibility of type qualifiers
 | 
						|
  // (C99 6.7.3) for address spaces. We assume that the check should behave in
 | 
						|
  // the same manner as it's defined for CVR qualifiers, so for OpenCL two
 | 
						|
  // qual types are compatible iff
 | 
						|
  //  * corresponded types are compatible
 | 
						|
  //  * CVR qualifiers are equal
 | 
						|
  //  * address spaces are equal
 | 
						|
  // Thus for conditional operator we merge CVR and address space unqualified
 | 
						|
  // pointees and if there is a composite type we return a pointer to it with
 | 
						|
  // merged qualifiers.
 | 
						|
  LHSCastKind =
 | 
						|
      LAddrSpace == ResultAddrSpace ? CK_BitCast : CK_AddressSpaceConversion;
 | 
						|
  RHSCastKind =
 | 
						|
      RAddrSpace == ResultAddrSpace ? CK_BitCast : CK_AddressSpaceConversion;
 | 
						|
  lhQual.removeAddressSpace();
 | 
						|
  rhQual.removeAddressSpace();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  lhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), lhQual);
 | 
						|
  rhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), rhQual);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType CompositeTy = S.Context.mergeTypes(lhptee, rhptee);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (CompositeTy.isNull()) {
 | 
						|
    // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
 | 
						|
    // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
 | 
						|
    // to get a consistent AST.
 | 
						|
    QualType incompatTy;
 | 
						|
    incompatTy = S.Context.getPointerType(
 | 
						|
        S.Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(S.Context.VoidTy, ResultAddrSpace));
 | 
						|
    LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, LHSCastKind);
 | 
						|
    RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, RHSCastKind);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // FIXME: For OpenCL the warning emission and cast to void* leaves a room
 | 
						|
    // for casts between types with incompatible address space qualifiers.
 | 
						|
    // For the following code the compiler produces casts between global and
 | 
						|
    // local address spaces of the corresponded innermost pointees:
 | 
						|
    // local int *global *a;
 | 
						|
    // global int *global *b;
 | 
						|
    // a = (0 ? a : b); // see C99 6.5.16.1.p1.
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
 | 
						|
        << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
        << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return incompatTy;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The pointer types are compatible.
 | 
						|
  // In case of OpenCL ResultTy should have the address space qualifier
 | 
						|
  // which is a superset of address spaces of both the 2nd and the 3rd
 | 
						|
  // operands of the conditional operator.
 | 
						|
  QualType ResultTy = [&, ResultAddrSpace]() {
 | 
						|
    if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
 | 
						|
      Qualifiers CompositeQuals = CompositeTy.getQualifiers();
 | 
						|
      CompositeQuals.setAddressSpace(ResultAddrSpace);
 | 
						|
      return S.Context
 | 
						|
          .getQualifiedType(CompositeTy.getUnqualifiedType(), CompositeQuals)
 | 
						|
          .withCVRQualifiers(MergedCVRQual);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    return CompositeTy.withCVRQualifiers(MergedCVRQual);
 | 
						|
  }();
 | 
						|
  if (IsBlockPointer)
 | 
						|
    ResultTy = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(ResultTy);
 | 
						|
  else
 | 
						|
    ResultTy = S.Context.getPointerType(ResultTy);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResultTy, LHSCastKind);
 | 
						|
  RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResultTy, RHSCastKind);
 | 
						|
  return ResultTy;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Return the resulting type when the operands are both block pointers.
 | 
						|
static QualType checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(Sema &S,
 | 
						|
                                                          ExprResult &LHS,
 | 
						|
                                                          ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                                          SourceLocation Loc) {
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
      QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.VoidTy);
 | 
						|
      LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
      RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
      return destType;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
 | 
						|
      << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
      << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // We have 2 block pointer types.
 | 
						|
  return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Return the resulting type when the operands are both pointers.
 | 
						|
static QualType
 | 
						|
checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
 | 
						|
                                            ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                            SourceLocation Loc) {
 | 
						|
  // get the pointer types
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // get the "pointed to" types
 | 
						|
  QualType lhptee = LHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
  QualType rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
 | 
						|
  if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
 | 
						|
    // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
 | 
						|
    QualType destPointee
 | 
						|
      = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
 | 
						|
    QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
 | 
						|
    // Add qualifiers if necessary.
 | 
						|
    LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp);
 | 
						|
    // Promote to void*.
 | 
						|
    RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
    return destType;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
 | 
						|
    QualType destPointee
 | 
						|
      = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
 | 
						|
    QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
 | 
						|
    // Add qualifiers if necessary.
 | 
						|
    RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp);
 | 
						|
    // Promote to void*.
 | 
						|
    LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
    return destType;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Return false if the first expression is not an integer and the second
 | 
						|
/// expression is not a pointer, true otherwise.
 | 
						|
static bool checkPointerIntegerMismatch(Sema &S, ExprResult &Int,
 | 
						|
                                        Expr* PointerExpr, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                        bool IsIntFirstExpr) {
 | 
						|
  if (!PointerExpr->getType()->isPointerType() ||
 | 
						|
      !Int.get()->getType()->isIntegerType())
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Expr *Expr1 = IsIntFirstExpr ? Int.get() : PointerExpr;
 | 
						|
  Expr *Expr2 = IsIntFirstExpr ? PointerExpr : Int.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
 | 
						|
    << Expr1->getType() << Expr2->getType()
 | 
						|
    << Expr1->getSourceRange() << Expr2->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
  Int = S.ImpCastExprToType(Int.get(), PointerExpr->getType(),
 | 
						|
                            CK_IntegralToPointer);
 | 
						|
  return true;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Simple conversion between integer and floating point types.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// Used when handling the OpenCL conditional operator where the
 | 
						|
/// condition is a vector while the other operands are scalar.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i and s6.11.6 together require that the scalar
 | 
						|
/// types are either integer or floating type. Between the two
 | 
						|
/// operands, the type with the higher rank is defined as the "result
 | 
						|
/// type". The other operand needs to be promoted to the same type. No
 | 
						|
/// other type promotion is allowed. We cannot use
 | 
						|
/// UsualArithmeticConversions() for this purpose, since it always
 | 
						|
/// promotes promotable types.
 | 
						|
static QualType OpenCLArithmeticConversions(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
 | 
						|
                                            ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                            SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
 | 
						|
  LHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get());
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
 | 
						|
  if (RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
 | 
						|
  // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSType =
 | 
						|
    S.Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSType =
 | 
						|
    S.Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!LHSType->isIntegerType() && !LHSType->isRealFloatingType()) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_int_float)
 | 
						|
      << LHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!RHSType->isIntegerType() && !RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_int_float)
 | 
						|
      << RHSType << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
 | 
						|
  if (LHSType == RHSType)
 | 
						|
    return LHSType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double).
 | 
						|
  if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType())
 | 
						|
    return handleFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
 | 
						|
                                 /*IsCompAssign = */ false);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Finally, we have two differing integer types.
 | 
						|
  return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast>
 | 
						|
  (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, /*IsCompAssign = */ false);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Convert scalar operands to a vector that matches the
 | 
						|
///        condition in length.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// Used when handling the OpenCL conditional operator where the
 | 
						|
/// condition is a vector while the other operands are scalar.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// We first compute the "result type" for the scalar operands
 | 
						|
/// according to OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i. Both operands are then converted
 | 
						|
/// into a vector of that type where the length matches the condition
 | 
						|
/// vector type. s6.11.6 requires that the element types of the result
 | 
						|
/// and the condition must have the same number of bits.
 | 
						|
static QualType
 | 
						|
OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                              QualType CondTy, SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
 | 
						|
  QualType ResTy = OpenCLArithmeticConversions(S, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
 | 
						|
  if (ResTy.isNull()) return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  const VectorType *CV = CondTy->getAs<VectorType>();
 | 
						|
  assert(CV);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Determine the vector result type
 | 
						|
  unsigned NumElements = CV->getNumElements();
 | 
						|
  QualType VectorTy = S.Context.getExtVectorType(ResTy, NumElements);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Ensure that all types have the same number of bits
 | 
						|
  if (S.Context.getTypeSize(CV->getElementType())
 | 
						|
      != S.Context.getTypeSize(ResTy)) {
 | 
						|
    // Since VectorTy is created internally, it does not pretty print
 | 
						|
    // with an OpenCL name. Instead, we just print a description.
 | 
						|
    std::string EleTyName = ResTy.getUnqualifiedType().getAsString();
 | 
						|
    SmallString<64> Str;
 | 
						|
    llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str);
 | 
						|
    OS << "(vector of " << NumElements << " '" << EleTyName << "' values)";
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_element_size)
 | 
						|
      << CondTy << OS.str();
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Convert operands to the vector result type
 | 
						|
  LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat);
 | 
						|
  RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return VectorTy;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Return false if this is a valid OpenCL condition vector
 | 
						|
static bool checkOpenCLConditionVector(Sema &S, Expr *Cond,
 | 
						|
                                       SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
 | 
						|
  // OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6 says the elements of the vector must be of
 | 
						|
  // integral type.
 | 
						|
  const VectorType *CondTy = Cond->getType()->getAs<VectorType>();
 | 
						|
  assert(CondTy);
 | 
						|
  QualType EleTy = CondTy->getElementType();
 | 
						|
  if (EleTy->isIntegerType()) return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_nonfloat)
 | 
						|
    << Cond->getType() << Cond->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
  return true;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Return false if the vector condition type and the vector
 | 
						|
///        result type are compatible.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6 requires that both vector types have the same
 | 
						|
/// number of elements, and their element types have the same number
 | 
						|
/// of bits.
 | 
						|
static bool checkVectorResult(Sema &S, QualType CondTy, QualType VecResTy,
 | 
						|
                              SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
 | 
						|
  const VectorType *CV = CondTy->getAs<VectorType>();
 | 
						|
  const VectorType *RV = VecResTy->getAs<VectorType>();
 | 
						|
  assert(CV && RV);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (CV->getNumElements() != RV->getNumElements()) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_size)
 | 
						|
      << CondTy << VecResTy;
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType CVE = CV->getElementType();
 | 
						|
  QualType RVE = RV->getElementType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (S.Context.getTypeSize(CVE) != S.Context.getTypeSize(RVE)) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_element_size)
 | 
						|
      << CondTy << VecResTy;
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Return the resulting type for the conditional operator in
 | 
						|
///        OpenCL (aka "ternary selection operator", OpenCL v1.1
 | 
						|
///        s6.3.i) when the condition is a vector type.
 | 
						|
static QualType
 | 
						|
OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(Sema &S, ExprResult &Cond,
 | 
						|
                             ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                             SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
 | 
						|
  Cond = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Cond.get());
 | 
						|
  if (Cond.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  QualType CondTy = Cond.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (checkOpenCLConditionVector(S, Cond.get(), QuestionLoc))
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If either operand is a vector then find the vector type of the
 | 
						|
  // result as specified in OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i.
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
 | 
						|
      RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
 | 
						|
    QualType VecResTy = S.CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc,
 | 
						|
                                              /*isCompAssign*/false,
 | 
						|
                                              /*AllowBothBool*/true,
 | 
						|
                                              /*AllowBoolConversions*/false);
 | 
						|
    if (VecResTy.isNull()) return QualType();
 | 
						|
    // The result type must match the condition type as specified in
 | 
						|
    // OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6.
 | 
						|
    if (checkVectorResult(S, CondTy, VecResTy, QuestionLoc))
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
    return VecResTy;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Both operands are scalar.
 | 
						|
  return OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(S, LHS, RHS, CondTy, QuestionLoc);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Return true if the Expr is block type
 | 
						|
static bool checkBlockType(Sema &S, const Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  if (const CallExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
    QualType Ty = CE->getCallee()->getType();
 | 
						|
    if (Ty->isBlockPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_ternary_with_block);
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Note that LHS is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
 | 
						|
/// In that case, LHS = cond.
 | 
						|
/// C99 6.5.15
 | 
						|
QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(ExprResult &Cond, ExprResult &LHS,
 | 
						|
                                        ExprResult &RHS, ExprValueKind &VK,
 | 
						|
                                        ExprObjectKind &OK,
 | 
						|
                                        SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get());
 | 
						|
  if (!LHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType();
 | 
						|
  LHS = LHSResult;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get());
 | 
						|
  if (!RHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType();
 | 
						|
  RHS = RHSResult;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
 | 
						|
    return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, VK, OK, QuestionLoc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  VK = VK_RValue;
 | 
						|
  OK = OK_Ordinary;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The OpenCL operator with a vector condition is sufficiently
 | 
						|
  // different to merit its own checker.
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && Cond.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
 | 
						|
    return OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(*this, Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // First, check the condition.
 | 
						|
  Cond = UsualUnaryConversions(Cond.get());
 | 
						|
  if (Cond.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  if (checkCondition(*this, Cond.get(), QuestionLoc))
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Now check the two expressions.
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
 | 
						|
      RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
 | 
						|
    return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc, /*isCompAssign*/false,
 | 
						|
                               /*AllowBothBool*/true,
 | 
						|
                               /*AllowBoolConversions*/false);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType ResTy =
 | 
						|
      UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc, ACK_Conditional);
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Diagnose attempts to convert between __float128 and long double where
 | 
						|
  // such conversions currently can't be handled.
 | 
						|
  if (unsupportedTypeConversion(*this, LHSTy, RHSTy)) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(QuestionLoc,
 | 
						|
         diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) << LHSTy << RHSTy
 | 
						|
      << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Blocks cannot be used as expressions of the ternary
 | 
						|
  // selection operator (?:).
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
 | 
						|
      (checkBlockType(*this, LHS.get()) | checkBlockType(*this, RHS.get()))) {
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
 | 
						|
  // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
 | 
						|
  if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
 | 
						|
    LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResTy, PrepareScalarCast(LHS, ResTy));
 | 
						|
    RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResTy, PrepareScalarCast(RHS, ResTy));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return ResTy;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
 | 
						|
  // type.
 | 
						|
  if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {    // C99 6.5.15p3
 | 
						|
    if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
 | 
						|
      if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
 | 
						|
        // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
 | 
						|
        // that type."  This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
 | 
						|
        return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
    // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
 | 
						|
  // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
 | 
						|
  if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
 | 
						|
    return checkConditionalVoidType(*this, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
 | 
						|
  // the type of the other operand."
 | 
						|
  if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, RHS, LHSTy)) return LHSTy;
 | 
						|
  if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, LHS, RHSTy)) return RHSTy;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
 | 
						|
  QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
 | 
						|
                                                        QuestionLoc);
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  if (!compositeType.isNull())
 | 
						|
    return compositeType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Handle block pointer types.
 | 
						|
  if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType())
 | 
						|
    return checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS,
 | 
						|
                                                     QuestionLoc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
 | 
						|
  if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType())
 | 
						|
    return checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS,
 | 
						|
                                                       QuestionLoc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.  Note that
 | 
						|
  // null pointers have been filtered out by this point.
 | 
						|
  if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, LHS, RHS.get(), QuestionLoc,
 | 
						|
      /*IsIntFirstExpr=*/true))
 | 
						|
    return RHSTy;
 | 
						|
  if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, RHS, LHS.get(), QuestionLoc,
 | 
						|
      /*IsIntFirstExpr=*/false))
 | 
						|
    return LHSTy;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Emit a better diagnostic if one of the expressions is a null pointer
 | 
						|
  // constant and the other is not a pointer type. In this case, the user most
 | 
						|
  // likely forgot to take the address of the other expression.
 | 
						|
  if (DiagnoseConditionalForNull(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc))
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
 | 
						|
  Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
 | 
						|
    << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
    << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
  return QualType();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
 | 
						|
/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
 | 
						|
QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                            SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*.  Here we case the result
 | 
						|
  // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
 | 
						|
  // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
 | 
						|
  if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
 | 
						|
      (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) {
 | 
						|
    RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
 | 
						|
    return LHSTy;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
 | 
						|
      (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) {
 | 
						|
    LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
 | 
						|
    return RHSTy;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
 | 
						|
  if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
 | 
						|
      (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) {
 | 
						|
    RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
 | 
						|
    return LHSTy;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
 | 
						|
      (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) {
 | 
						|
    LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
 | 
						|
    return RHSTy;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
 | 
						|
  if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
 | 
						|
      (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) {
 | 
						|
    RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
    return LHSTy;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
 | 
						|
      (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) {
 | 
						|
    LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
    return RHSTy;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
 | 
						|
  if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
 | 
						|
      // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
 | 
						|
      return LHSTy;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
 | 
						|
    const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
 | 
						|
    QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
 | 
						|
    // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
 | 
						|
    // type. This allows
 | 
						|
    //   xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
 | 
						|
    // where B is a subclass of A.
 | 
						|
    //
 | 
						|
    // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
 | 
						|
    // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
 | 
						|
    // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
 | 
						|
    // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
 | 
						|
    // It could return the composite type.
 | 
						|
    if (!(compositeType =
 | 
						|
          Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull()) {
 | 
						|
      // Nothing more to do.
 | 
						|
    } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
 | 
						|
      compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
 | 
						|
    } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
 | 
						|
      compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
 | 
						|
    } else if ((LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
 | 
						|
                RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
 | 
						|
               Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT,
 | 
						|
                                                         true)) {
 | 
						|
      // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
 | 
						|
      // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
 | 
						|
      // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
 | 
						|
      // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
 | 
						|
      compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
 | 
						|
    } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
 | 
						|
      compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
 | 
						|
      << LHSTy << RHSTy
 | 
						|
      << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
 | 
						|
      LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
      RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
      return incompatTy;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    // The object pointer types are compatible.
 | 
						|
    LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), compositeType, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
    RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), compositeType, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
    return compositeType;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
 | 
						|
  if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
 | 
						|
      // ARC forbids the implicit conversion of object pointers to 'void *',
 | 
						|
      // so these types are not compatible.
 | 
						|
      Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_cond_voidptr_arc) << LHSTy << RHSTy
 | 
						|
          << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      LHS = RHS = true;
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    QualType lhptee = LHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
    QualType rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
    QualType destPointee
 | 
						|
    = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
 | 
						|
    QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
 | 
						|
    // Add qualifiers if necessary.
 | 
						|
    LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp);
 | 
						|
    // Promote to void*.
 | 
						|
    RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
    return destType;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
 | 
						|
      // ARC forbids the implicit conversion of object pointers to 'void *',
 | 
						|
      // so these types are not compatible.
 | 
						|
      Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_cond_voidptr_arc) << LHSTy << RHSTy
 | 
						|
          << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      LHS = RHS = true;
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    QualType lhptee = LHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
    QualType rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
    QualType destPointee
 | 
						|
    = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
 | 
						|
    QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
 | 
						|
    // Add qualifiers if necessary.
 | 
						|
    RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp);
 | 
						|
    // Promote to void*.
 | 
						|
    LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
    return destType;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return QualType();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a note with a fixit hint that wraps
 | 
						|
/// ParenRange in parentheses.
 | 
						|
static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                               const PartialDiagnostic &Note,
 | 
						|
                               SourceRange ParenRange) {
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.getLocForEndOfToken(ParenRange.getEnd());
 | 
						|
  if (ParenRange.getBegin().isFileID() && ParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() &&
 | 
						|
      EndLoc.isValid()) {
 | 
						|
    Self.Diag(Loc, Note)
 | 
						|
      << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(ParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
 | 
						|
      << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    // We can't display the parentheses, so just show the bare note.
 | 
						|
    Self.Diag(Loc, Note) << ParenRange;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static bool IsArithmeticOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
 | 
						|
  return BinaryOperator::isAdditiveOp(Opc) ||
 | 
						|
         BinaryOperator::isMultiplicativeOp(Opc) ||
 | 
						|
         BinaryOperator::isShiftOp(Opc) || Opc == BO_And || Opc == BO_Or;
 | 
						|
  // This only checks for bitwise-or and bitwise-and, but not bitwise-xor and
 | 
						|
  // not any of the logical operators.  Bitwise-xor is commonly used as a
 | 
						|
  // logical-xor because there is no logical-xor operator.  The logical
 | 
						|
  // operators, including uses of xor, have a high false positive rate for
 | 
						|
  // precedence warnings.
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// IsArithmeticBinaryExpr - Returns true if E is an arithmetic binary
 | 
						|
/// expression, either using a built-in or overloaded operator,
 | 
						|
/// and sets *OpCode to the opcode and *RHSExprs to the right-hand side
 | 
						|
/// expression.
 | 
						|
static bool IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Expr *E, BinaryOperatorKind *Opcode,
 | 
						|
                                   Expr **RHSExprs) {
 | 
						|
  // Don't strip parenthesis: we should not warn if E is in parenthesis.
 | 
						|
  E = E->IgnoreImpCasts();
 | 
						|
  E = E->IgnoreConversionOperator();
 | 
						|
  E = E->IgnoreImpCasts();
 | 
						|
  if (auto *MTE = dyn_cast<MaterializeTemporaryExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
    E = MTE->getSubExpr();
 | 
						|
    E = E->IgnoreImpCasts();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Built-in binary operator.
 | 
						|
  if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
 | 
						|
    if (IsArithmeticOp(OP->getOpcode())) {
 | 
						|
      *Opcode = OP->getOpcode();
 | 
						|
      *RHSExprs = OP->getRHS();
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Overloaded operator.
 | 
						|
  if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Call = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
    if (Call->getNumArgs() != 2)
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Make sure this is really a binary operator that is safe to pass into
 | 
						|
    // BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(), e.g. it's not a subscript op.
 | 
						|
    OverloadedOperatorKind OO = Call->getOperator();
 | 
						|
    if (OO < OO_Plus || OO > OO_Arrow ||
 | 
						|
        OO == OO_PlusPlus || OO == OO_MinusMinus)
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    BinaryOperatorKind OpKind = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(OO);
 | 
						|
    if (IsArithmeticOp(OpKind)) {
 | 
						|
      *Opcode = OpKind;
 | 
						|
      *RHSExprs = Call->getArg(1);
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// ExprLooksBoolean - Returns true if E looks boolean, i.e. it has boolean type
 | 
						|
/// or is a logical expression such as (x==y) which has int type, but is
 | 
						|
/// commonly interpreted as boolean.
 | 
						|
static bool ExprLooksBoolean(Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (E->getType()->isBooleanType())
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E))
 | 
						|
    return OP->isComparisonOp() || OP->isLogicalOp();
 | 
						|
  if (UnaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E))
 | 
						|
    return OP->getOpcode() == UO_LNot;
 | 
						|
  if (E->getType()->isPointerType())
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: What about overloaded operator calls returning "unspecified boolean
 | 
						|
  // type"s (commonly pointer-to-members)?
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence - Emit a warning when a conditional operator
 | 
						|
/// and binary operator are mixed in a way that suggests the programmer assumed
 | 
						|
/// the conditional operator has higher precedence, for example:
 | 
						|
/// "int x = a + someBinaryCondition ? 1 : 2".
 | 
						|
static void DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(Sema &Self,
 | 
						|
                                          SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                                          Expr *Condition,
 | 
						|
                                          Expr *LHSExpr,
 | 
						|
                                          Expr *RHSExpr) {
 | 
						|
  BinaryOperatorKind CondOpcode;
 | 
						|
  Expr *CondRHS;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Condition, &CondOpcode, &CondRHS))
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  if (!ExprLooksBoolean(CondRHS))
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The condition is an arithmetic binary expression, with a right-
 | 
						|
  // hand side that looks boolean, so warn.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  unsigned DiagID = BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(CondOpcode)
 | 
						|
                        ? diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_conditional
 | 
						|
                        : diag::warn_precedence_conditional;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Self.Diag(OpLoc, DiagID)
 | 
						|
      << Condition->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
      << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  SuggestParentheses(
 | 
						|
      Self, OpLoc,
 | 
						|
      Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence)
 | 
						|
          << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode),
 | 
						|
      SourceRange(Condition->getBeginLoc(), Condition->getEndLoc()));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                     Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_conditional_first),
 | 
						|
                     SourceRange(CondRHS->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc()));
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Compute the nullability of a conditional expression.
 | 
						|
static QualType computeConditionalNullability(QualType ResTy, bool IsBin,
 | 
						|
                                              QualType LHSTy, QualType RHSTy,
 | 
						|
                                              ASTContext &Ctx) {
 | 
						|
  if (!ResTy->isAnyPointerType())
 | 
						|
    return ResTy;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  auto GetNullability = [&Ctx](QualType Ty) {
 | 
						|
    Optional<NullabilityKind> Kind = Ty->getNullability(Ctx);
 | 
						|
    if (Kind)
 | 
						|
      return *Kind;
 | 
						|
    return NullabilityKind::Unspecified;
 | 
						|
  };
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  auto LHSKind = GetNullability(LHSTy), RHSKind = GetNullability(RHSTy);
 | 
						|
  NullabilityKind MergedKind;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Compute nullability of a binary conditional expression.
 | 
						|
  if (IsBin) {
 | 
						|
    if (LHSKind == NullabilityKind::NonNull)
 | 
						|
      MergedKind = NullabilityKind::NonNull;
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      MergedKind = RHSKind;
 | 
						|
  // Compute nullability of a normal conditional expression.
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    if (LHSKind == NullabilityKind::Nullable ||
 | 
						|
        RHSKind == NullabilityKind::Nullable)
 | 
						|
      MergedKind = NullabilityKind::Nullable;
 | 
						|
    else if (LHSKind == NullabilityKind::NonNull)
 | 
						|
      MergedKind = RHSKind;
 | 
						|
    else if (RHSKind == NullabilityKind::NonNull)
 | 
						|
      MergedKind = LHSKind;
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      MergedKind = NullabilityKind::Unspecified;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Return if ResTy already has the correct nullability.
 | 
						|
  if (GetNullability(ResTy) == MergedKind)
 | 
						|
    return ResTy;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Strip all nullability from ResTy.
 | 
						|
  while (ResTy->getNullability(Ctx))
 | 
						|
    ResTy = ResTy.getSingleStepDesugaredType(Ctx);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Create a new AttributedType with the new nullability kind.
 | 
						|
  auto NewAttr = AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(MergedKind);
 | 
						|
  return Ctx.getAttributedType(NewAttr, ResTy, ResTy);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation.  Note that 'LHS' may be null
 | 
						|
/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
 | 
						|
                                    SourceLocation ColonLoc,
 | 
						|
                                    Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
 | 
						|
                                    Expr *RHSExpr) {
 | 
						|
  if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
    // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes in the condition because it
 | 
						|
    // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have
 | 
						|
    // been dealt with before checking the operands.
 | 
						|
    ExprResult CondResult = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(CondExpr);
 | 
						|
    ExprResult LHSResult = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(LHSExpr);
 | 
						|
    ExprResult RHSResult = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (!CondResult.isUsable())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (LHSExpr) {
 | 
						|
      if (!LHSResult.isUsable())
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (!RHSResult.isUsable())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    CondExpr = CondResult.get();
 | 
						|
    LHSExpr = LHSResult.get();
 | 
						|
    RHSExpr = RHSResult.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
 | 
						|
  // was the condition.
 | 
						|
  OpaqueValueExpr *opaqueValue = nullptr;
 | 
						|
  Expr *commonExpr = nullptr;
 | 
						|
  if (!LHSExpr) {
 | 
						|
    commonExpr = CondExpr;
 | 
						|
    // Lower out placeholder types first.  This is important so that we don't
 | 
						|
    // try to capture a placeholder. This happens in few cases in C++; such
 | 
						|
    // as Objective-C++'s dictionary subscripting syntax.
 | 
						|
    if (commonExpr->hasPlaceholderType()) {
 | 
						|
      ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(commonExpr);
 | 
						|
      if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      commonExpr = result.get();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    // We usually want to apply unary conversions *before* saving, except
 | 
						|
    // in the special case of a C++ l-value conditional.
 | 
						|
    if (!(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
 | 
						|
          && !commonExpr->isTypeDependent()
 | 
						|
          && commonExpr->getValueKind() == RHSExpr->getValueKind()
 | 
						|
          && commonExpr->isGLValue()
 | 
						|
          && commonExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject()
 | 
						|
          && RHSExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject()
 | 
						|
          && Context.hasSameType(commonExpr->getType(), RHSExpr->getType()))) {
 | 
						|
      ExprResult commonRes = UsualUnaryConversions(commonExpr);
 | 
						|
      if (commonRes.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      commonExpr = commonRes.get();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // If the common expression is a class or array prvalue, materialize it
 | 
						|
    // so that we can safely refer to it multiple times.
 | 
						|
    if (commonExpr->isRValue() && (commonExpr->getType()->isRecordType() ||
 | 
						|
                                   commonExpr->getType()->isArrayType())) {
 | 
						|
      ExprResult MatExpr = TemporaryMaterializationConversion(commonExpr);
 | 
						|
      if (MatExpr.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      commonExpr = MatExpr.get();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    opaqueValue = new (Context) OpaqueValueExpr(commonExpr->getExprLoc(),
 | 
						|
                                                commonExpr->getType(),
 | 
						|
                                                commonExpr->getValueKind(),
 | 
						|
                                                commonExpr->getObjectKind(),
 | 
						|
                                                commonExpr);
 | 
						|
    LHSExpr = CondExpr = opaqueValue;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSTy = LHSExpr->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExpr->getType();
 | 
						|
  ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
 | 
						|
  ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
 | 
						|
  ExprResult Cond = CondExpr, LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr;
 | 
						|
  QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS,
 | 
						|
                                             VK, OK, QuestionLoc);
 | 
						|
  if (result.isNull() || Cond.isInvalid() || LHS.isInvalid() ||
 | 
						|
      RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(*this, QuestionLoc, Cond.get(), LHS.get(),
 | 
						|
                                RHS.get());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  CheckBoolLikeConversion(Cond.get(), QuestionLoc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  result = computeConditionalNullability(result, commonExpr, LHSTy, RHSTy,
 | 
						|
                                         Context);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!commonExpr)
 | 
						|
    return new (Context)
 | 
						|
        ConditionalOperator(Cond.get(), QuestionLoc, LHS.get(), ColonLoc,
 | 
						|
                            RHS.get(), result, VK, OK);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return new (Context) BinaryConditionalOperator(
 | 
						|
      commonExpr, opaqueValue, Cond.get(), LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc,
 | 
						|
      ColonLoc, result, VK, OK);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// checkPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
 | 
						|
// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
 | 
						|
// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
 | 
						|
// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
 | 
						|
// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
 | 
						|
static Sema::AssignConvertType
 | 
						|
checkPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) {
 | 
						|
  assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!");
 | 
						|
  assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
 | 
						|
  const Type *lhptee, *rhptee;
 | 
						|
  Qualifiers lhq, rhq;
 | 
						|
  std::tie(lhptee, lhq) =
 | 
						|
      cast<PointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair();
 | 
						|
  std::tie(rhptee, rhq) =
 | 
						|
      cast<PointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
 | 
						|
  // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
 | 
						|
  // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // As a special case, 'non-__weak A *' -> 'non-__weak const *' is okay.
 | 
						|
  if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime() &&
 | 
						|
      lhq.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(rhq)) {
 | 
						|
    // Ignore lifetime for further calculation.
 | 
						|
    lhq.removeObjCLifetime();
 | 
						|
    rhq.removeObjCLifetime();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!lhq.compatiblyIncludes(rhq)) {
 | 
						|
    // Treat address-space mismatches as fatal.
 | 
						|
    if (!lhq.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(rhq))
 | 
						|
      return Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // It's okay to add or remove GC or lifetime qualifiers when converting to
 | 
						|
    // and from void*.
 | 
						|
    else if (lhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime()
 | 
						|
                        .compatiblyIncludes(
 | 
						|
                                rhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime())
 | 
						|
             && (lhptee->isVoidType() || rhptee->isVoidType()))
 | 
						|
      ; // keep old
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Treat lifetime mismatches as fatal.
 | 
						|
    else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime())
 | 
						|
      ConvTy = Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // For GCC/MS compatibility, other qualifier mismatches are treated
 | 
						|
    // as still compatible in C.
 | 
						|
    else ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
 | 
						|
  // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
 | 
						|
  // version of void...
 | 
						|
  if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
 | 
						|
      return ConvTy;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
 | 
						|
    assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
 | 
						|
    return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
 | 
						|
      return ConvTy;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
 | 
						|
    assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
 | 
						|
    return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
 | 
						|
  // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
 | 
						|
  QualType ltrans = QualType(lhptee, 0), rtrans = QualType(rhptee, 0);
 | 
						|
  if (!S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ltrans, rtrans)) {
 | 
						|
    // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
 | 
						|
    // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
 | 
						|
    // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
 | 
						|
    if (lhptee->isCharType())
 | 
						|
      ltrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy;
 | 
						|
    else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
 | 
						|
      ltrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(ltrans);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (rhptee->isCharType())
 | 
						|
      rtrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy;
 | 
						|
    else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
 | 
						|
      rtrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rtrans);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (ltrans == rtrans) {
 | 
						|
      // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
 | 
						|
      // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
 | 
						|
      // warning can be disabled.
 | 
						|
      if (ConvTy != Sema::Compatible)
 | 
						|
        return ConvTy;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      return Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
 | 
						|
    // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
 | 
						|
    // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
 | 
						|
    // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
 | 
						|
    if (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee)) {
 | 
						|
      do {
 | 
						|
        std::tie(lhptee, lhq) =
 | 
						|
          cast<PointerType>(lhptee)->getPointeeType().split().asPair();
 | 
						|
        std::tie(rhptee, rhq) =
 | 
						|
          cast<PointerType>(rhptee)->getPointeeType().split().asPair();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        // Inconsistent address spaces at this point is invalid, even if the
 | 
						|
        // address spaces would be compatible.
 | 
						|
        // FIXME: This doesn't catch address space mismatches for pointers of
 | 
						|
        // different nesting levels, like:
 | 
						|
        //   __local int *** a;
 | 
						|
        //   int ** b = a;
 | 
						|
        // It's not clear how to actually determine when such pointers are
 | 
						|
        // invalidly incompatible.
 | 
						|
        if (lhq.getAddressSpace() != rhq.getAddressSpace())
 | 
						|
          return Sema::IncompatibleNestedPointerAddressSpaceMismatch;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      } while (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (lhptee == rhptee)
 | 
						|
        return Sema::IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
 | 
						|
    return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
 | 
						|
      S.IsFunctionConversion(ltrans, rtrans, ltrans))
 | 
						|
    return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
 | 
						|
  return ConvTy;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
 | 
						|
/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
 | 
						|
/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
 | 
						|
// types.
 | 
						|
static Sema::AssignConvertType
 | 
						|
checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType,
 | 
						|
                                    QualType RHSType) {
 | 
						|
  assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!");
 | 
						|
  assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType lhptee, rhptee;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
 | 
						|
  lhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
  rhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // In C++, the types have to match exactly.
 | 
						|
  if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
 | 
						|
    return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
 | 
						|
  Qualifiers LQuals = lhptee.getLocalQualifiers();
 | 
						|
  Qualifiers RQuals = rhptee.getLocalQualifiers();
 | 
						|
  if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
 | 
						|
    LQuals.removeAddressSpace();
 | 
						|
    RQuals.removeAddressSpace();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (LQuals != RQuals)
 | 
						|
    ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: OpenCL doesn't define the exact compile time semantics for a block
 | 
						|
  // assignment.
 | 
						|
  // The current behavior is similar to C++ lambdas. A block might be
 | 
						|
  // assigned to a variable iff its return type and parameters are compatible
 | 
						|
  // (C99 6.2.7) with the corresponding return type and parameters of the LHS of
 | 
						|
  // an assignment. Presumably it should behave in way that a function pointer
 | 
						|
  // assignment does in C, so for each parameter and return type:
 | 
						|
  //  * CVR and address space of LHS should be a superset of CVR and address
 | 
						|
  //  space of RHS.
 | 
						|
  //  * unqualified types should be compatible.
 | 
						|
  if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
 | 
						|
    if (!S.Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(
 | 
						|
            S.Context.getQualifiedType(LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), LQuals),
 | 
						|
            S.Context.getQualifiedType(RHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), RQuals)))
 | 
						|
      return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer;
 | 
						|
  } else if (!S.Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(LHSType, RHSType))
 | 
						|
    return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return ConvTy;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
 | 
						|
/// for assignment compatibility.
 | 
						|
static Sema::AssignConvertType
 | 
						|
checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType,
 | 
						|
                                   QualType RHSType) {
 | 
						|
  assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS was not canonicalized!");
 | 
						|
  assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS was not canonicalized!");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
 | 
						|
    // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
 | 
						|
    if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() && !RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
 | 
						|
        !RHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
 | 
						|
      return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
 | 
						|
    return Sema::Compatible;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() && !LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
 | 
						|
        !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
 | 
						|
      return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
 | 
						|
    return Sema::Compatible;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  QualType lhptee = LHSType->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
  QualType rhptee = RHSType->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee) &&
 | 
						|
      // make an exception for id<P>
 | 
						|
      !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
 | 
						|
    return Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (S.Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType))
 | 
						|
    return Sema::Compatible;
 | 
						|
  if (LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
 | 
						|
    return Sema::IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
 | 
						|
  return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
Sema::AssignConvertType
 | 
						|
Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                 QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) {
 | 
						|
  // Fake up an opaque expression.  We don't actually care about what
 | 
						|
  // cast operations are required, so if CheckAssignmentConstraints
 | 
						|
  // adds casts to this they'll be wasted, but fortunately that doesn't
 | 
						|
  // usually happen on valid code.
 | 
						|
  OpaqueValueExpr RHSExpr(Loc, RHSType, VK_RValue);
 | 
						|
  ExprResult RHSPtr = &RHSExpr;
 | 
						|
  CastKind K;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSPtr, K, /*ConvertRHS=*/false);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// This helper function returns true if QT is a vector type that has element
 | 
						|
/// type ElementType.
 | 
						|
static bool isVector(QualType QT, QualType ElementType) {
 | 
						|
  if (const VectorType *VT = QT->getAs<VectorType>())
 | 
						|
    return VT->getElementType() == ElementType;
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
 | 
						|
/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
 | 
						|
/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
///  int a, *pint;
 | 
						|
///  short *pshort;
 | 
						|
///  struct foo *pfoo;
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
///  pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
 | 
						|
///  a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
 | 
						|
///  pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
 | 
						|
///  pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
 | 
						|
/// C99 spec dictates.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// Sets 'Kind' for any result kind except Incompatible.
 | 
						|
Sema::AssignConvertType
 | 
						|
Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                 CastKind &Kind, bool ConvertRHS) {
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
  QualType OrigLHSType = LHSType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Get canonical types.  We're not formatting these types, just comparing
 | 
						|
  // them.
 | 
						|
  LHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(LHSType).getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
  RHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(RHSType).getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Common case: no conversion required.
 | 
						|
  if (LHSType == RHSType) {
 | 
						|
    Kind = CK_NoOp;
 | 
						|
    return Compatible;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If we have an atomic type, try a non-atomic assignment, then just add an
 | 
						|
  // atomic qualification step.
 | 
						|
  if (const AtomicType *AtomicTy = dyn_cast<AtomicType>(LHSType)) {
 | 
						|
    Sema::AssignConvertType result =
 | 
						|
      CheckAssignmentConstraints(AtomicTy->getValueType(), RHS, Kind);
 | 
						|
    if (result != Compatible)
 | 
						|
      return result;
 | 
						|
    if (Kind != CK_NoOp && ConvertRHS)
 | 
						|
      RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), AtomicTy->getValueType(), Kind);
 | 
						|
    Kind = CK_NonAtomicToAtomic;
 | 
						|
    return Compatible;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
 | 
						|
  // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
 | 
						|
  // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
 | 
						|
  // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
 | 
						|
  // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
 | 
						|
  // LHSType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
 | 
						|
  // type.
 | 
						|
  if (const ReferenceType *LHSTypeRef = LHSType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
 | 
						|
    if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSTypeRef->getPointeeType(), RHSType)) {
 | 
						|
      Kind = CK_LValueBitCast;
 | 
						|
      return Compatible;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    return Incompatible;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
 | 
						|
  // to the same ExtVector type.
 | 
						|
  if (LHSType->isExtVectorType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (RHSType->isExtVectorType())
 | 
						|
      return Incompatible;
 | 
						|
    if (RHSType->isArithmeticType()) {
 | 
						|
      // CK_VectorSplat does T -> vector T, so first cast to the element type.
 | 
						|
      if (ConvertRHS)
 | 
						|
        RHS = prepareVectorSplat(LHSType, RHS.get());
 | 
						|
      Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
 | 
						|
      return Compatible;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Conversions to or from vector type.
 | 
						|
  if (LHSType->isVectorType() || RHSType->isVectorType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (LHSType->isVectorType() && RHSType->isVectorType()) {
 | 
						|
      // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
 | 
						|
      // vector type and vice versa
 | 
						|
      if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) {
 | 
						|
        Kind = CK_BitCast;
 | 
						|
        return Compatible;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
 | 
						|
      // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
 | 
						|
      // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
 | 
						|
      if (isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) {
 | 
						|
        Kind = CK_BitCast;
 | 
						|
        return IncompatibleVectors;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // When the RHS comes from another lax conversion (e.g. binops between
 | 
						|
    // scalars and vectors) the result is canonicalized as a vector. When the
 | 
						|
    // LHS is also a vector, the lax is allowed by the condition above. Handle
 | 
						|
    // the case where LHS is a scalar.
 | 
						|
    if (LHSType->isScalarType()) {
 | 
						|
      const VectorType *VecType = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
 | 
						|
      if (VecType && VecType->getNumElements() == 1 &&
 | 
						|
          isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) {
 | 
						|
        ExprResult *VecExpr = &RHS;
 | 
						|
        *VecExpr = ImpCastExprToType(VecExpr->get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
        Kind = CK_BitCast;
 | 
						|
        return Compatible;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return Incompatible;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Diagnose attempts to convert between __float128 and long double where
 | 
						|
  // such conversions currently can't be handled.
 | 
						|
  if (unsupportedTypeConversion(*this, LHSType, RHSType))
 | 
						|
    return Incompatible;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Disallow assigning a _Complex to a real type in C++ mode since it simply
 | 
						|
  // discards the imaginary part.
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && RHSType->getAs<ComplexType>() &&
 | 
						|
      !LHSType->getAs<ComplexType>())
 | 
						|
    return Incompatible;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Arithmetic conversions.
 | 
						|
  if (LHSType->isArithmeticType() && RHSType->isArithmeticType() &&
 | 
						|
      !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHSType->isEnumeralType())) {
 | 
						|
    if (ConvertRHS)
 | 
						|
      Kind = PrepareScalarCast(RHS, LHSType);
 | 
						|
    return Compatible;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Conversions to normal pointers.
 | 
						|
  if (const PointerType *LHSPointer = dyn_cast<PointerType>(LHSType)) {
 | 
						|
    // U* -> T*
 | 
						|
    if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) {
 | 
						|
      LangAS AddrSpaceL = LHSPointer->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
 | 
						|
      LangAS AddrSpaceR = RHSType->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
 | 
						|
      if (AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR)
 | 
						|
        Kind = CK_AddressSpaceConversion;
 | 
						|
      else if (Context.hasCvrSimilarType(RHSType, LHSType))
 | 
						|
        Kind = CK_NoOp;
 | 
						|
      else
 | 
						|
        Kind = CK_BitCast;
 | 
						|
      return checkPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // int -> T*
 | 
						|
    if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
 | 
						|
      Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null?
 | 
						|
      return IntToPointer;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers,
 | 
						|
    // with two exceptions:
 | 
						|
    if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) {
 | 
						|
      //  - conversions to void*
 | 
						|
      if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
 | 
						|
        Kind = CK_BitCast;
 | 
						|
        return Compatible;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      //  - conversions from 'Class' to the redefinition type
 | 
						|
      if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() &&
 | 
						|
          Context.hasSameType(LHSType,
 | 
						|
                              Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) {
 | 
						|
        Kind = CK_BitCast;
 | 
						|
        return Compatible;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      Kind = CK_BitCast;
 | 
						|
      return IncompatiblePointer;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // U^ -> void*
 | 
						|
    if (RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
 | 
						|
      if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
 | 
						|
        LangAS AddrSpaceL = LHSPointer->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
 | 
						|
        LangAS AddrSpaceR = RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()
 | 
						|
                                ->getPointeeType()
 | 
						|
                                .getAddressSpace();
 | 
						|
        Kind =
 | 
						|
            AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion : CK_BitCast;
 | 
						|
        return Compatible;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return Incompatible;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Conversions to block pointers.
 | 
						|
  if (isa<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)) {
 | 
						|
    // U^ -> T^
 | 
						|
    if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
      LangAS AddrSpaceL = LHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()
 | 
						|
                              ->getPointeeType()
 | 
						|
                              .getAddressSpace();
 | 
						|
      LangAS AddrSpaceR = RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()
 | 
						|
                              ->getPointeeType()
 | 
						|
                              .getAddressSpace();
 | 
						|
      Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion : CK_BitCast;
 | 
						|
      return checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // int or null -> T^
 | 
						|
    if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
 | 
						|
      Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null
 | 
						|
      return IntToBlockPointer;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // id -> T^
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().ObjC && RHSType->isObjCIdType()) {
 | 
						|
      Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
 | 
						|
      return Compatible;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // void* -> T^
 | 
						|
    if (const PointerType *RHSPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>())
 | 
						|
      if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
 | 
						|
        Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
 | 
						|
        return Compatible;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return Incompatible;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Conversions to Objective-C pointers.
 | 
						|
  if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(LHSType)) {
 | 
						|
    // A* -> B*
 | 
						|
    if (RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
      Kind = CK_BitCast;
 | 
						|
      Sema::AssignConvertType result =
 | 
						|
        checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType);
 | 
						|
      if (getLangOpts().allowsNonTrivialObjCLifetimeQualifiers() &&
 | 
						|
          result == Compatible &&
 | 
						|
          !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(OrigLHSType, RHSType))
 | 
						|
        result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef;
 | 
						|
      return result;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // int or null -> A*
 | 
						|
    if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
 | 
						|
      Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null
 | 
						|
      return IntToPointer;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers,
 | 
						|
    // with two exceptions:
 | 
						|
    if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) {
 | 
						|
      Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      //  - conversions from 'void*'
 | 
						|
      if (RHSType->isVoidPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
        return Compatible;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      //  - conversions to 'Class' from its redefinition type
 | 
						|
      if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() &&
 | 
						|
          Context.hasSameType(RHSType,
 | 
						|
                              Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) {
 | 
						|
        return Compatible;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      return IncompatiblePointer;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Only under strict condition T^ is compatible with an Objective-C pointer.
 | 
						|
    if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType() &&
 | 
						|
        LHSType->isBlockCompatibleObjCPointerType(Context)) {
 | 
						|
      if (ConvertRHS)
 | 
						|
        maybeExtendBlockObject(RHS);
 | 
						|
      Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
 | 
						|
      return Compatible;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return Incompatible;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Conversions from pointers that are not covered by the above.
 | 
						|
  if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) {
 | 
						|
    // T* -> _Bool
 | 
						|
    if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) {
 | 
						|
      Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean;
 | 
						|
      return Compatible;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // T* -> int
 | 
						|
    if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) {
 | 
						|
      Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral;
 | 
						|
      return PointerToInt;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return Incompatible;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Conversions from Objective-C pointers that are not covered by the above.
 | 
						|
  if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) {
 | 
						|
    // T* -> _Bool
 | 
						|
    if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) {
 | 
						|
      Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean;
 | 
						|
      return Compatible;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // T* -> int
 | 
						|
    if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) {
 | 
						|
      Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral;
 | 
						|
      return PointerToInt;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return Incompatible;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // struct A -> struct B
 | 
						|
  if (isa<TagType>(LHSType) && isa<TagType>(RHSType)) {
 | 
						|
    if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) {
 | 
						|
      Kind = CK_NoOp;
 | 
						|
      return Compatible;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LHSType->isSamplerT() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
 | 
						|
    Kind = CK_IntToOCLSampler;
 | 
						|
    return Compatible;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return Incompatible;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
 | 
						|
/// used to initialize the transparent union.
 | 
						|
static void ConstructTransparentUnion(Sema &S, ASTContext &C,
 | 
						|
                                      ExprResult &EResult, QualType UnionType,
 | 
						|
                                      FieldDecl *Field) {
 | 
						|
  // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
 | 
						|
  // of the transparent union.
 | 
						|
  Expr *E = EResult.get();
 | 
						|
  InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
 | 
						|
                                                   E, SourceLocation());
 | 
						|
  Initializer->setType(UnionType);
 | 
						|
  Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
 | 
						|
  // union type from this initializer list.
 | 
						|
  TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
 | 
						|
  EResult = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
 | 
						|
                                        VK_RValue, Initializer, false);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
Sema::AssignConvertType
 | 
						|
Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType,
 | 
						|
                                               ExprResult &RHS) {
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
 | 
						|
  // transparent_union GCC extension.
 | 
						|
  const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
 | 
						|
  if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
 | 
						|
    return Incompatible;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
 | 
						|
  RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
 | 
						|
  FieldDecl *InitField = nullptr;
 | 
						|
  // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
 | 
						|
  for (auto *it : UD->fields()) {
 | 
						|
    if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
      // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
 | 
						|
      // 1) void pointer
 | 
						|
      // 2) null pointer constant
 | 
						|
      if (RHSType->isPointerType())
 | 
						|
        if (RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
 | 
						|
          RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
          InitField = it;
 | 
						|
          break;
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
 | 
						|
                                           Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
 | 
						|
        RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(),
 | 
						|
                                CK_NullToPointer);
 | 
						|
        InitField = it;
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    CastKind Kind;
 | 
						|
    if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), RHS, Kind)
 | 
						|
          == Compatible) {
 | 
						|
      RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), Kind);
 | 
						|
      InitField = it;
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!InitField)
 | 
						|
    return Incompatible;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ConstructTransparentUnion(*this, Context, RHS, ArgType, InitField);
 | 
						|
  return Compatible;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
Sema::AssignConvertType
 | 
						|
Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &CallerRHS,
 | 
						|
                                       bool Diagnose,
 | 
						|
                                       bool DiagnoseCFAudited,
 | 
						|
                                       bool ConvertRHS) {
 | 
						|
  // We need to be able to tell the caller whether we diagnosed a problem, if
 | 
						|
  // they ask us to issue diagnostics.
 | 
						|
  assert((ConvertRHS || !Diagnose) && "can't indicate whether we diagnosed");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If ConvertRHS is false, we want to leave the caller's RHS untouched. Sadly,
 | 
						|
  // we can't avoid *all* modifications at the moment, so we need some somewhere
 | 
						|
  // to put the updated value.
 | 
						|
  ExprResult LocalRHS = CallerRHS;
 | 
						|
  ExprResult &RHS = ConvertRHS ? CallerRHS : LocalRHS;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (const auto *LHSPtrType = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
 | 
						|
    if (const auto *RHSPtrType = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
 | 
						|
      if (RHSPtrType->getPointeeType()->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref) &&
 | 
						|
          !LHSPtrType->getPointeeType()->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref)) {
 | 
						|
        Diag(RHS.get()->getExprLoc(),
 | 
						|
             diag::warn_noderef_to_dereferenceable_pointer)
 | 
						|
            << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
    if (!LHSType->isRecordType() && !LHSType->isAtomicType()) {
 | 
						|
      // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
 | 
						|
      // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
 | 
						|
      // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
 | 
						|
      QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
      if (Diagnose) {
 | 
						|
        RHS = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(),
 | 
						|
                                        AA_Assigning);
 | 
						|
      } else {
 | 
						|
        ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
 | 
						|
            TryImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(),
 | 
						|
                                  /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
 | 
						|
                                  /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
 | 
						|
                                  /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
 | 
						|
                                  /*CStyle=*/false,
 | 
						|
                                  /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
 | 
						|
        if (ICS.isFailure())
 | 
						|
          return Incompatible;
 | 
						|
        RHS = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(),
 | 
						|
                                        ICS, AA_Assigning);
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      if (RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
        return Incompatible;
 | 
						|
      Sema::AssignConvertType result = Compatible;
 | 
						|
      if (getLangOpts().allowsNonTrivialObjCLifetimeQualifiers() &&
 | 
						|
          !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(LHSType, RHSType))
 | 
						|
        result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef;
 | 
						|
      return result;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
 | 
						|
    // structures.
 | 
						|
    // FIXME: We also fall through for atomics; not sure what should
 | 
						|
    // happen there, though.
 | 
						|
  } else if (RHS.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy) {
 | 
						|
    // As a set of extensions to C, we support overloading on functions. These
 | 
						|
    // functions need to be resolved here.
 | 
						|
    DeclAccessPair DAP;
 | 
						|
    if (FunctionDecl *FD = ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
 | 
						|
            RHS.get(), LHSType, /*Complain=*/false, DAP))
 | 
						|
      RHS = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(RHS.get(), DAP, FD);
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      return Incompatible;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
 | 
						|
  // a null pointer constant.
 | 
						|
  if ((LHSType->isPointerType() || LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
 | 
						|
       LHSType->isBlockPointerType()) &&
 | 
						|
      RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
 | 
						|
                                       Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
 | 
						|
    if (Diagnose || ConvertRHS) {
 | 
						|
      CastKind Kind;
 | 
						|
      CXXCastPath Path;
 | 
						|
      CheckPointerConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, Path,
 | 
						|
                             /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false, Diagnose);
 | 
						|
      if (ConvertRHS)
 | 
						|
        RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, VK_RValue, &Path);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    return Compatible;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // OpenCL queue_t type assignment.
 | 
						|
  if (LHSType->isQueueT() && RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(
 | 
						|
                                 Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
 | 
						|
    RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
 | 
						|
    return Compatible;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
 | 
						|
  // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
 | 
						|
  // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
 | 
						|
  // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
 | 
						|
  if (!LHSType->isReferenceType()) {
 | 
						|
    // FIXME: We potentially allocate here even if ConvertRHS is false.
 | 
						|
    RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get(), Diagnose);
 | 
						|
    if (RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return Incompatible;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  CastKind Kind;
 | 
						|
  Sema::AssignConvertType result =
 | 
						|
    CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS, Kind, ConvertRHS);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
 | 
						|
  // type of the assignment expression.
 | 
						|
  // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
 | 
						|
  // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
 | 
						|
  // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
 | 
						|
  // does not have reference type.
 | 
						|
  if (result != Incompatible && RHS.get()->getType() != LHSType) {
 | 
						|
    QualType Ty = LHSType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
 | 
						|
    Expr *E = RHS.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Check for various Objective-C errors. If we are not reporting
 | 
						|
    // diagnostics and just checking for errors, e.g., during overload
 | 
						|
    // resolution, return Incompatible to indicate the failure.
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().allowsNonTrivialObjCLifetimeQualifiers() &&
 | 
						|
        CheckObjCConversion(SourceRange(), Ty, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion,
 | 
						|
                            Diagnose, DiagnoseCFAudited) != ACR_okay) {
 | 
						|
      if (!Diagnose)
 | 
						|
        return Incompatible;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().ObjC &&
 | 
						|
        (CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(E->getBeginLoc(), LHSType,
 | 
						|
                                           E->getType(), E, Diagnose) ||
 | 
						|
         ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(LHSType, E, Diagnose))) {
 | 
						|
      if (!Diagnose)
 | 
						|
        return Incompatible;
 | 
						|
      // Replace the expression with a corrected version and continue so we
 | 
						|
      // can find further errors.
 | 
						|
      RHS = E;
 | 
						|
      return Compatible;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (ConvertRHS)
 | 
						|
      RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty, Kind);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return result;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
namespace {
 | 
						|
/// The original operand to an operator, prior to the application of the usual
 | 
						|
/// arithmetic conversions and converting the arguments of a builtin operator
 | 
						|
/// candidate.
 | 
						|
struct OriginalOperand {
 | 
						|
  explicit OriginalOperand(Expr *Op) : Orig(Op), Conversion(nullptr) {
 | 
						|
    if (auto *MTE = dyn_cast<MaterializeTemporaryExpr>(Op))
 | 
						|
      Op = MTE->getSubExpr();
 | 
						|
    if (auto *BTE = dyn_cast<CXXBindTemporaryExpr>(Op))
 | 
						|
      Op = BTE->getSubExpr();
 | 
						|
    if (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Op)) {
 | 
						|
      Orig = ICE->getSubExprAsWritten();
 | 
						|
      Conversion = ICE->getConversionFunction();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType getType() const { return Orig->getType(); }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Expr *Orig;
 | 
						|
  NamedDecl *Conversion;
 | 
						|
};
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &LHS,
 | 
						|
                               ExprResult &RHS) {
 | 
						|
  OriginalOperand OrigLHS(LHS.get()), OrigRHS(RHS.get());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
 | 
						|
    << OrigLHS.getType() << OrigRHS.getType()
 | 
						|
    << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If a user-defined conversion was applied to either of the operands prior
 | 
						|
  // to applying the built-in operator rules, tell the user about it.
 | 
						|
  if (OrigLHS.Conversion) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(OrigLHS.Conversion->getLocation(),
 | 
						|
         diag::note_typecheck_invalid_operands_converted)
 | 
						|
      << 0 << LHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (OrigRHS.Conversion) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(OrigRHS.Conversion->getLocation(),
 | 
						|
         diag::note_typecheck_invalid_operands_converted)
 | 
						|
      << 1 << RHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return QualType();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// Diagnose cases where a scalar was implicitly converted to a vector and
 | 
						|
// diagnose the underlying types. Otherwise, diagnose the error
 | 
						|
// as invalid vector logical operands for non-C++ cases.
 | 
						|
QualType Sema::InvalidLogicalVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &LHS,
 | 
						|
                                            ExprResult &RHS) {
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType();
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool LHSNatVec = LHSType->isVectorType();
 | 
						|
  bool RHSNatVec = RHSType->isVectorType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!(LHSNatVec && RHSNatVec)) {
 | 
						|
    Expr *Vector = LHSNatVec ? LHS.get() : RHS.get();
 | 
						|
    Expr *NonVector = !LHSNatVec ? LHS.get() : RHS.get();
 | 
						|
    Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_logical_vector_expr_gnu_cpp_restrict)
 | 
						|
        << 0 << Vector->getType() << NonVector->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType()
 | 
						|
        << Vector->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_logical_vector_expr_gnu_cpp_restrict)
 | 
						|
      << 1 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
      << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return QualType();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Try to convert a value of non-vector type to a vector type by converting
 | 
						|
/// the type to the element type of the vector and then performing a splat.
 | 
						|
/// If the language is OpenCL, we only use conversions that promote scalar
 | 
						|
/// rank; for C, Obj-C, and C++ we allow any real scalar conversion except
 | 
						|
/// for float->int.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// OpenCL V2.0 6.2.6.p2:
 | 
						|
/// An error shall occur if any scalar operand type has greater rank
 | 
						|
/// than the type of the vector element.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// \param scalar - if non-null, actually perform the conversions
 | 
						|
/// \return true if the operation fails (but without diagnosing the failure)
 | 
						|
static bool tryVectorConvertAndSplat(Sema &S, ExprResult *scalar,
 | 
						|
                                     QualType scalarTy,
 | 
						|
                                     QualType vectorEltTy,
 | 
						|
                                     QualType vectorTy,
 | 
						|
                                     unsigned &DiagID) {
 | 
						|
  // The conversion to apply to the scalar before splatting it,
 | 
						|
  // if necessary.
 | 
						|
  CastKind scalarCast = CK_NoOp;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (vectorEltTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
 | 
						|
    if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && (scalarTy->isRealFloatingType() ||
 | 
						|
        (scalarTy->isIntegerType() &&
 | 
						|
         S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0))) {
 | 
						|
      DiagID = diag::err_opencl_scalar_type_rank_greater_than_vector_type;
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    if (!scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context))
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    scalarCast = CK_IntegralCast;
 | 
						|
  } else if (vectorEltTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (scalarTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
 | 
						|
      if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
 | 
						|
          S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0) {
 | 
						|
        DiagID = diag::err_opencl_scalar_type_rank_greater_than_vector_type;
 | 
						|
        return true;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      scalarCast = CK_FloatingCast;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    else if (scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context))
 | 
						|
      scalarCast = CK_IntegralToFloating;
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Adjust scalar if desired.
 | 
						|
  if (scalar) {
 | 
						|
    if (scalarCast != CK_NoOp)
 | 
						|
      *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorEltTy, scalarCast);
 | 
						|
    *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorTy, CK_VectorSplat);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Convert vector E to a vector with the same number of elements but different
 | 
						|
/// element type.
 | 
						|
static ExprResult convertVector(Expr *E, QualType ElementType, Sema &S) {
 | 
						|
  const auto *VecTy = E->getType()->getAs<VectorType>();
 | 
						|
  assert(VecTy && "Expression E must be a vector");
 | 
						|
  QualType NewVecTy = S.Context.getVectorType(ElementType,
 | 
						|
                                              VecTy->getNumElements(),
 | 
						|
                                              VecTy->getVectorKind());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Look through the implicit cast. Return the subexpression if its type is
 | 
						|
  // NewVecTy.
 | 
						|
  if (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E))
 | 
						|
    if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType() == NewVecTy)
 | 
						|
      return ICE->getSubExpr();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  auto Cast = ElementType->isIntegerType() ? CK_IntegralCast : CK_FloatingCast;
 | 
						|
  return S.ImpCastExprToType(E, NewVecTy, Cast);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Test if a (constant) integer Int can be casted to another integer type
 | 
						|
/// IntTy without losing precision.
 | 
						|
static bool canConvertIntToOtherIntTy(Sema &S, ExprResult *Int,
 | 
						|
                                      QualType OtherIntTy) {
 | 
						|
  QualType IntTy = Int->get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Reject cases where the value of the Int is unknown as that would
 | 
						|
  // possibly cause truncation, but accept cases where the scalar can be
 | 
						|
  // demoted without loss of precision.
 | 
						|
  Expr::EvalResult EVResult;
 | 
						|
  bool CstInt = Int->get()->EvaluateAsInt(EVResult, S.Context);
 | 
						|
  int Order = S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(OtherIntTy, IntTy);
 | 
						|
  bool IntSigned = IntTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation();
 | 
						|
  bool OtherIntSigned = OtherIntTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (CstInt) {
 | 
						|
    // If the scalar is constant and is of a higher order and has more active
 | 
						|
    // bits that the vector element type, reject it.
 | 
						|
    llvm::APSInt Result = EVResult.Val.getInt();
 | 
						|
    unsigned NumBits = IntSigned
 | 
						|
                           ? (Result.isNegative() ? Result.getMinSignedBits()
 | 
						|
                                                  : Result.getActiveBits())
 | 
						|
                           : Result.getActiveBits();
 | 
						|
    if (Order < 0 && S.Context.getIntWidth(OtherIntTy) < NumBits)
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // If the signedness of the scalar type and the vector element type
 | 
						|
    // differs and the number of bits is greater than that of the vector
 | 
						|
    // element reject it.
 | 
						|
    return (IntSigned != OtherIntSigned &&
 | 
						|
            NumBits > S.Context.getIntWidth(OtherIntTy));
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Reject cases where the value of the scalar is not constant and it's
 | 
						|
  // order is greater than that of the vector element type.
 | 
						|
  return (Order < 0);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Test if a (constant) integer Int can be casted to floating point type
 | 
						|
/// FloatTy without losing precision.
 | 
						|
static bool canConvertIntTyToFloatTy(Sema &S, ExprResult *Int,
 | 
						|
                                     QualType FloatTy) {
 | 
						|
  QualType IntTy = Int->get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Determine if the integer constant can be expressed as a floating point
 | 
						|
  // number of the appropriate type.
 | 
						|
  Expr::EvalResult EVResult;
 | 
						|
  bool CstInt = Int->get()->EvaluateAsInt(EVResult, S.Context);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  uint64_t Bits = 0;
 | 
						|
  if (CstInt) {
 | 
						|
    // Reject constants that would be truncated if they were converted to
 | 
						|
    // the floating point type. Test by simple to/from conversion.
 | 
						|
    // FIXME: Ideally the conversion to an APFloat and from an APFloat
 | 
						|
    //        could be avoided if there was a convertFromAPInt method
 | 
						|
    //        which could signal back if implicit truncation occurred.
 | 
						|
    llvm::APSInt Result = EVResult.Val.getInt();
 | 
						|
    llvm::APFloat Float(S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FloatTy));
 | 
						|
    Float.convertFromAPInt(Result, IntTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(),
 | 
						|
                           llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero);
 | 
						|
    llvm::APSInt ConvertBack(S.Context.getIntWidth(IntTy),
 | 
						|
                             !IntTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation());
 | 
						|
    bool Ignored = false;
 | 
						|
    Float.convertToInteger(ConvertBack, llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven,
 | 
						|
                           &Ignored);
 | 
						|
    if (Result != ConvertBack)
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    // Reject types that cannot be fully encoded into the mantissa of
 | 
						|
    // the float.
 | 
						|
    Bits = S.Context.getTypeSize(IntTy);
 | 
						|
    unsigned FloatPrec = llvm::APFloat::semanticsPrecision(
 | 
						|
        S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FloatTy));
 | 
						|
    if (Bits > FloatPrec)
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Attempt to convert and splat Scalar into a vector whose types matches
 | 
						|
/// Vector following GCC conversion rules. The rule is that implicit
 | 
						|
/// conversion can occur when Scalar can be casted to match Vector's element
 | 
						|
/// type without causing truncation of Scalar.
 | 
						|
static bool tryGCCVectorConvertAndSplat(Sema &S, ExprResult *Scalar,
 | 
						|
                                        ExprResult *Vector) {
 | 
						|
  QualType ScalarTy = Scalar->get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
  QualType VectorTy = Vector->get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
  const VectorType *VT = VectorTy->getAs<VectorType>();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  assert(!isa<ExtVectorType>(VT) &&
 | 
						|
         "ExtVectorTypes should not be handled here!");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType VectorEltTy = VT->getElementType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Reject cases where the vector element type or the scalar element type are
 | 
						|
  // not integral or floating point types.
 | 
						|
  if (!VectorEltTy->isArithmeticType() || !ScalarTy->isArithmeticType())
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The conversion to apply to the scalar before splatting it,
 | 
						|
  // if necessary.
 | 
						|
  CastKind ScalarCast = CK_NoOp;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Accept cases where the vector elements are integers and the scalar is
 | 
						|
  // an integer.
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: Notionally if the scalar was a floating point value with a precise
 | 
						|
  //        integral representation, we could cast it to an appropriate integer
 | 
						|
  //        type and then perform the rest of the checks here. GCC will perform
 | 
						|
  //        this conversion in some cases as determined by the input language.
 | 
						|
  //        We should accept it on a language independent basis.
 | 
						|
  if (VectorEltTy->isIntegralType(S.Context) &&
 | 
						|
      ScalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context) &&
 | 
						|
      S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(VectorEltTy, ScalarTy)) {
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (canConvertIntToOtherIntTy(S, Scalar, VectorEltTy))
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ScalarCast = CK_IntegralCast;
 | 
						|
  } else if (VectorEltTy->isIntegralType(S.Context) &&
 | 
						|
             ScalarTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (S.Context.getTypeSize(VectorEltTy) == S.Context.getTypeSize(ScalarTy))
 | 
						|
      ScalarCast = CK_FloatingToIntegral;
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
  } else if (VectorEltTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (ScalarTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Reject cases where the scalar type is not a constant and has a higher
 | 
						|
      // Order than the vector element type.
 | 
						|
      llvm::APFloat Result(0.0);
 | 
						|
      bool CstScalar = Scalar->get()->EvaluateAsFloat(Result, S.Context);
 | 
						|
      int Order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(VectorEltTy, ScalarTy);
 | 
						|
      if (!CstScalar && Order < 0)
 | 
						|
        return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // If the scalar cannot be safely casted to the vector element type,
 | 
						|
      // reject it.
 | 
						|
      if (CstScalar) {
 | 
						|
        bool Truncated = false;
 | 
						|
        Result.convert(S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(VectorEltTy),
 | 
						|
                       llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &Truncated);
 | 
						|
        if (Truncated)
 | 
						|
          return true;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      ScalarCast = CK_FloatingCast;
 | 
						|
    } else if (ScalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
 | 
						|
      if (canConvertIntTyToFloatTy(S, Scalar, VectorEltTy))
 | 
						|
        return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      ScalarCast = CK_IntegralToFloating;
 | 
						|
    } else
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Adjust scalar if desired.
 | 
						|
  if (Scalar) {
 | 
						|
    if (ScalarCast != CK_NoOp)
 | 
						|
      *Scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(Scalar->get(), VectorEltTy, ScalarCast);
 | 
						|
    *Scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(Scalar->get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                   SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign,
 | 
						|
                                   bool AllowBothBool,
 | 
						|
                                   bool AllowBoolConversions) {
 | 
						|
  if (!IsCompAssign) {
 | 
						|
    LHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get());
 | 
						|
    if (LHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
 | 
						|
  if (RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
 | 
						|
  // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  const VectorType *LHSVecType = LHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
 | 
						|
  const VectorType *RHSVecType = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
 | 
						|
  assert(LHSVecType || RHSVecType);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // AltiVec-style "vector bool op vector bool" combinations are allowed
 | 
						|
  // for some operators but not others.
 | 
						|
  if (!AllowBothBool &&
 | 
						|
      LHSVecType && LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
 | 
						|
      RHSVecType && RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool)
 | 
						|
    return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If the vector types are identical, return.
 | 
						|
  if (Context.hasSameType(LHSType, RHSType))
 | 
						|
    return LHSType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If we have compatible AltiVec and GCC vector types, use the AltiVec type.
 | 
						|
  if (LHSVecType && RHSVecType &&
 | 
						|
      Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) {
 | 
						|
    if (isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) {
 | 
						|
      RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
      return LHSType;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (!IsCompAssign)
 | 
						|
      LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
    return RHSType;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // AllowBoolConversions says that bool and non-bool AltiVec vectors
 | 
						|
  // can be mixed, with the result being the non-bool type.  The non-bool
 | 
						|
  // operand must have integer element type.
 | 
						|
  if (AllowBoolConversions && LHSVecType && RHSVecType &&
 | 
						|
      LHSVecType->getNumElements() == RHSVecType->getNumElements() &&
 | 
						|
      (Context.getTypeSize(LHSVecType->getElementType()) ==
 | 
						|
       Context.getTypeSize(RHSVecType->getElementType()))) {
 | 
						|
    if (LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector &&
 | 
						|
        LHSVecType->getElementType()->isIntegerType() &&
 | 
						|
        RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool) {
 | 
						|
      RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
      return LHSType;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    if (!IsCompAssign &&
 | 
						|
        LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
 | 
						|
        RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector &&
 | 
						|
        RHSVecType->getElementType()->isIntegerType()) {
 | 
						|
      LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
      return RHSType;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If there's a vector type and a scalar, try to convert the scalar to
 | 
						|
  // the vector element type and splat.
 | 
						|
  unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable;
 | 
						|
  if (!RHSVecType) {
 | 
						|
    if (isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) {
 | 
						|
      if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &RHS, RHSType,
 | 
						|
                                    LHSVecType->getElementType(), LHSType,
 | 
						|
                                    DiagID))
 | 
						|
        return LHSType;
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      if (!tryGCCVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &RHS, &LHS))
 | 
						|
        return LHSType;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (!LHSVecType) {
 | 
						|
    if (isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType)) {
 | 
						|
      if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, (IsCompAssign ? nullptr : &LHS),
 | 
						|
                                    LHSType, RHSVecType->getElementType(),
 | 
						|
                                    RHSType, DiagID))
 | 
						|
        return RHSType;
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      if (LHS.get()->getValueKind() == VK_LValue ||
 | 
						|
          !tryGCCVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &LHS, &RHS))
 | 
						|
        return RHSType;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: The code below also handles conversion between vectors and
 | 
						|
  // non-scalars, we should break this down into fine grained specific checks
 | 
						|
  // and emit proper diagnostics.
 | 
						|
  QualType VecType = LHSVecType ? LHSType : RHSType;
 | 
						|
  const VectorType *VT = LHSVecType ? LHSVecType : RHSVecType;
 | 
						|
  QualType OtherType = LHSVecType ? RHSType : LHSType;
 | 
						|
  ExprResult *OtherExpr = LHSVecType ? &RHS : &LHS;
 | 
						|
  if (isLaxVectorConversion(OtherType, VecType)) {
 | 
						|
    // If we're allowing lax vector conversions, only the total (data) size
 | 
						|
    // needs to be the same. For non compound assignment, if one of the types is
 | 
						|
    // scalar, the result is always the vector type.
 | 
						|
    if (!IsCompAssign) {
 | 
						|
      *OtherExpr = ImpCastExprToType(OtherExpr->get(), VecType, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
      return VecType;
 | 
						|
    // In a compound assignment, lhs += rhs, 'lhs' is a lvalue src, forbidding
 | 
						|
    // any implicit cast. Here, the 'rhs' should be implicit casted to 'lhs'
 | 
						|
    // type. Note that this is already done by non-compound assignments in
 | 
						|
    // CheckAssignmentConstraints. If it's a scalar type, only bitcast for
 | 
						|
    // <1 x T> -> T. The result is also a vector type.
 | 
						|
    } else if (OtherType->isExtVectorType() || OtherType->isVectorType() ||
 | 
						|
               (OtherType->isScalarType() && VT->getNumElements() == 1)) {
 | 
						|
      ExprResult *RHSExpr = &RHS;
 | 
						|
      *RHSExpr = ImpCastExprToType(RHSExpr->get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
      return VecType;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Okay, the expression is invalid.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If there's a non-vector, non-real operand, diagnose that.
 | 
						|
  if ((!RHSVecType && !RHSType->isRealType()) ||
 | 
						|
      (!LHSVecType && !LHSType->isRealType())) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable_non_scalar)
 | 
						|
      << LHSType << RHSType
 | 
						|
      << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // OpenCL V1.1 6.2.6.p1:
 | 
						|
  // If the operands are of more than one vector type, then an error shall
 | 
						|
  // occur. Implicit conversions between vector types are not permitted, per
 | 
						|
  // section 6.2.1.
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
 | 
						|
      RHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType) &&
 | 
						|
      LHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_implicit_vector_conversion) << LHSType
 | 
						|
                                                           << RHSType;
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If there is a vector type that is not a ExtVector and a scalar, we reach
 | 
						|
  // this point if scalar could not be converted to the vector's element type
 | 
						|
  // without truncation.
 | 
						|
  if ((RHSVecType && !isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType)) ||
 | 
						|
      (LHSVecType && !isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType))) {
 | 
						|
    QualType Scalar = LHSVecType ? RHSType : LHSType;
 | 
						|
    QualType Vector = LHSVecType ? LHSType : RHSType;
 | 
						|
    unsigned ScalarOrVector = LHSVecType && RHSVecType ? 1 : 0;
 | 
						|
    Diag(Loc,
 | 
						|
         diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable_implict_truncation)
 | 
						|
        << ScalarOrVector << Scalar << Vector;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Otherwise, use the generic diagnostic.
 | 
						|
  Diag(Loc, DiagID)
 | 
						|
    << LHSType << RHSType
 | 
						|
    << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
  return QualType();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// checkArithmeticNull - Detect when a NULL constant is used improperly in an
 | 
						|
// expression.  These are mainly cases where the null pointer is used as an
 | 
						|
// integer instead of a pointer.
 | 
						|
static void checkArithmeticNull(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompare) {
 | 
						|
  // The canonical way to check for a GNU null is with isNullPointerConstant,
 | 
						|
  // but we use a bit of a hack here for speed; this is a relatively
 | 
						|
  // hot path, and isNullPointerConstant is slow.
 | 
						|
  bool LHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
 | 
						|
  bool RHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType NonNullType = LHSNull ? RHS.get()->getType() : LHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Avoid analyzing cases where the result will either be invalid (and
 | 
						|
  // diagnosed as such) or entirely valid and not something to warn about.
 | 
						|
  if ((!LHSNull && !RHSNull) || NonNullType->isBlockPointerType() ||
 | 
						|
      NonNullType->isMemberPointerType() || NonNullType->isFunctionType())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Comparison operations would not make sense with a null pointer no matter
 | 
						|
  // what the other expression is.
 | 
						|
  if (!IsCompare) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_arithmetic_operation)
 | 
						|
        << (LHSNull ? LHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
 | 
						|
        << (RHSNull ? RHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The rest of the operations only make sense with a null pointer
 | 
						|
  // if the other expression is a pointer.
 | 
						|
  if (LHSNull == RHSNull || NonNullType->isAnyPointerType() ||
 | 
						|
      NonNullType->canDecayToPointerType())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_comparison_operation)
 | 
						|
      << LHSNull /* LHS is NULL */ << NonNullType
 | 
						|
      << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void DiagnoseDivisionSizeofPointerOrArray(Sema &S, Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS,
 | 
						|
                                          SourceLocation Loc) {
 | 
						|
  const auto *LUE = dyn_cast<UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr>(LHS);
 | 
						|
  const auto *RUE = dyn_cast<UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr>(RHS);
 | 
						|
  if (!LUE || !RUE)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  if (LUE->getKind() != UETT_SizeOf || LUE->isArgumentType() ||
 | 
						|
      RUE->getKind() != UETT_SizeOf)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  const Expr *LHSArg = LUE->getArgumentExpr()->IgnoreParens();
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSTy = LHSArg->getType();
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSTy;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (RUE->isArgumentType())
 | 
						|
    RHSTy = RUE->getArgumentType();
 | 
						|
  else
 | 
						|
    RHSTy = RUE->getArgumentExpr()->IgnoreParens()->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && !RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHSTy->getPointeeType(), RHSTy))
 | 
						|
      return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_division_sizeof_ptr) << LHS << LHS->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    if (const auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSArg)) {
 | 
						|
      if (const ValueDecl *LHSArgDecl = DRE->getDecl())
 | 
						|
        S.Diag(LHSArgDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_pointer_declared_here)
 | 
						|
            << LHSArgDecl;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } else if (const auto *ArrayTy = S.Context.getAsArrayType(LHSTy)) {
 | 
						|
    QualType ArrayElemTy = ArrayTy->getElementType();
 | 
						|
    if (ArrayElemTy != S.Context.getBaseElementType(ArrayTy) ||
 | 
						|
        ArrayElemTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType() ||
 | 
						|
        ArrayElemTy->isCharType() ||
 | 
						|
        S.Context.getTypeSize(ArrayElemTy) == S.Context.getTypeSize(RHSTy))
 | 
						|
      return;
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_division_sizeof_array)
 | 
						|
        << LHSArg->getSourceRange() << ArrayElemTy << RHSTy;
 | 
						|
    if (const auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSArg)) {
 | 
						|
      if (const ValueDecl *LHSArgDecl = DRE->getDecl())
 | 
						|
        S.Diag(LHSArgDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_array_declared_here)
 | 
						|
            << LHSArgDecl;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_precedence_silence) << RHS;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void DiagnoseBadDivideOrRemainderValues(Sema& S, ExprResult &LHS,
 | 
						|
                                               ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                               SourceLocation Loc, bool IsDiv) {
 | 
						|
  // Check for division/remainder by zero.
 | 
						|
  Expr::EvalResult RHSValue;
 | 
						|
  if (!RHS.get()->isValueDependent() &&
 | 
						|
      RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSValue, S.Context) &&
 | 
						|
      RHSValue.Val.getInt() == 0)
 | 
						|
    S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(),
 | 
						|
                          S.PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_division_by_zero)
 | 
						|
                            << IsDiv << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                           SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                           bool IsCompAssign, bool IsDiv) {
 | 
						|
  checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
 | 
						|
      RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
 | 
						|
    return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign,
 | 
						|
                               /*AllowBothBool*/getLangOpts().AltiVec,
 | 
						|
                               /*AllowBoolConversions*/false);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(
 | 
						|
      LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign ? ACK_CompAssign : ACK_Arithmetic);
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isArithmeticType())
 | 
						|
    return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
  if (IsDiv) {
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseBadDivideOrRemainderValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, IsDiv);
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseDivisionSizeofPointerOrArray(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Loc);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return compType;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
 | 
						|
  ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) {
 | 
						|
  checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
 | 
						|
      RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
 | 
						|
        RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
 | 
						|
      return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign,
 | 
						|
                                 /*AllowBothBool*/getLangOpts().AltiVec,
 | 
						|
                                 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false);
 | 
						|
    return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(
 | 
						|
      LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign ? ACK_CompAssign : ACK_Arithmetic);
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isIntegerType())
 | 
						|
    return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
  DiagnoseBadDivideOrRemainderValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, false /* IsDiv */);
 | 
						|
  return compType;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two void pointers.
 | 
						|
static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                                Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
 | 
						|
                ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type
 | 
						|
                : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
 | 
						|
    << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHSExpr->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
                            << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a void pointer.
 | 
						|
static void diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                            Expr *Pointer) {
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
 | 
						|
                ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type
 | 
						|
                : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
 | 
						|
    << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a null pointer.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// If \p IsGNUIdiom is true, the operation is using the 'p = (i8*)nullptr + n'
 | 
						|
/// idiom, which we recognize as a GNU extension.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
static void diagnoseArithmeticOnNullPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                            Expr *Pointer, bool IsGNUIdiom) {
 | 
						|
  if (IsGNUIdiom)
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_gnu_null_ptr_arith)
 | 
						|
      << Pointer->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
  else
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_pointer_arith_null_ptr)
 | 
						|
      << S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus << Pointer->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two function pointers.
 | 
						|
static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                                    Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
 | 
						|
  assert(LHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
 | 
						|
  assert(RHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
 | 
						|
                ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type
 | 
						|
                : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
 | 
						|
    << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHS->getType()->getPointeeType()
 | 
						|
    // We only show the second type if it differs from the first.
 | 
						|
    << (unsigned)!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHS->getType(),
 | 
						|
                                                   RHS->getType())
 | 
						|
    << RHS->getType()->getPointeeType()
 | 
						|
    << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a function pointer.
 | 
						|
static void diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                                Expr *Pointer) {
 | 
						|
  assert(Pointer->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
 | 
						|
                ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type
 | 
						|
                : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
 | 
						|
    << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getType()->getPointeeType()
 | 
						|
    << 0 /* one pointer, so only one type */
 | 
						|
    << Pointer->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Emit error if Operand is incomplete pointer type
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// \returns True if pointer has incomplete type
 | 
						|
static bool checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                                 Expr *Operand) {
 | 
						|
  QualType ResType = Operand->getType();
 | 
						|
  if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>())
 | 
						|
    ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  assert(ResType->isAnyPointerType() && !ResType->isDependentType());
 | 
						|
  QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
  return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
 | 
						|
                               diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type,
 | 
						|
                               PointeeTy, Operand->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Check the validity of an arithmetic pointer operand.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// If the operand has pointer type, this code will check for pointer types
 | 
						|
/// which are invalid in arithmetic operations. These will be diagnosed
 | 
						|
/// appropriately, including whether or not the use is supported as an
 | 
						|
/// extension.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension).
 | 
						|
static bool checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                            Expr *Operand) {
 | 
						|
  QualType ResType = Operand->getType();
 | 
						|
  if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>())
 | 
						|
    ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!ResType->isAnyPointerType()) return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
  if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
 | 
						|
    diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, Operand);
 | 
						|
    return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
 | 
						|
    diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, Operand);
 | 
						|
    return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, Operand)) return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return true;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Check the validity of a binary arithmetic operation w.r.t. pointer
 | 
						|
/// operands.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// This routine will diagnose any invalid arithmetic on pointer operands much
 | 
						|
/// like \see checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand. However, it has special logic
 | 
						|
/// for emitting a single diagnostic even for operations where both LHS and RHS
 | 
						|
/// are (potentially problematic) pointers.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension).
 | 
						|
static bool checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                                Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
 | 
						|
  bool isLHSPointer = LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType();
 | 
						|
  bool isRHSPointer = RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType();
 | 
						|
  if (!isLHSPointer && !isRHSPointer) return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSPointeeTy, RHSPointeeTy;
 | 
						|
  if (isLHSPointer) LHSPointeeTy = LHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
  if (isRHSPointer) RHSPointeeTy = RHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // if both are pointers check if operation is valid wrt address spaces
 | 
						|
  if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && isLHSPointer && isRHSPointer) {
 | 
						|
    const PointerType *lhsPtr = LHSExpr->getType()->castAs<PointerType>();
 | 
						|
    const PointerType *rhsPtr = RHSExpr->getType()->castAs<PointerType>();
 | 
						|
    if (!lhsPtr->isAddressSpaceOverlapping(*rhsPtr)) {
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(Loc,
 | 
						|
             diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers)
 | 
						|
          << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << 1 /*arithmetic op*/
 | 
						|
          << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
 | 
						|
  bool isLHSVoidPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isVoidType();
 | 
						|
  bool isRHSVoidPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isVoidType();
 | 
						|
  if (isLHSVoidPtr || isRHSVoidPtr) {
 | 
						|
    if (!isRHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr);
 | 
						|
    else if (!isLHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
    else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool isLHSFuncPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType();
 | 
						|
  bool isRHSFuncPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType();
 | 
						|
  if (isLHSFuncPtr || isRHSFuncPtr) {
 | 
						|
    if (!isRHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr);
 | 
						|
    else if (!isLHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc,
 | 
						|
                                                                RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
    else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (isLHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, LHSExpr))
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
  if (isRHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, RHSExpr))
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return true;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// diagnoseStringPlusInt - Emit a warning when adding an integer to a string
 | 
						|
/// literal.
 | 
						|
static void diagnoseStringPlusInt(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                                  Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
 | 
						|
  StringLiteral* StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts());
 | 
						|
  Expr* IndexExpr = RHSExpr;
 | 
						|
  if (!StrExpr) {
 | 
						|
    StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts());
 | 
						|
    IndexExpr = LHSExpr;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool IsStringPlusInt = StrExpr &&
 | 
						|
      IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
 | 
						|
  if (!IsStringPlusInt || IndexExpr->isValueDependent())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc());
 | 
						|
  Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_int)
 | 
						|
      << DiagRange << IndexExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Only print a fixit for "str" + int, not for int + "str".
 | 
						|
  if (IndexExpr == RHSExpr) {
 | 
						|
    SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getEndLoc());
 | 
						|
    Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence)
 | 
						|
        << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), "&")
 | 
						|
        << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[")
 | 
						|
        << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]");
 | 
						|
  } else
 | 
						|
    Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Emit a warning when adding a char literal to a string.
 | 
						|
static void diagnoseStringPlusChar(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                                   Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
 | 
						|
  const Expr *StringRefExpr = LHSExpr;
 | 
						|
  const CharacterLiteral *CharExpr =
 | 
						|
      dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!CharExpr) {
 | 
						|
    CharExpr = dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts());
 | 
						|
    StringRefExpr = RHSExpr;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!CharExpr || !StringRefExpr)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  const QualType StringType = StringRefExpr->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Return if not a PointerType.
 | 
						|
  if (!StringType->isAnyPointerType())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Return if not a CharacterType.
 | 
						|
  if (!StringType->getPointeeType()->isAnyCharacterType())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ASTContext &Ctx = Self.getASTContext();
 | 
						|
  SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  const QualType CharType = CharExpr->getType();
 | 
						|
  if (!CharType->isAnyCharacterType() &&
 | 
						|
      CharType->isIntegerType() &&
 | 
						|
      llvm::isUIntN(Ctx.getCharWidth(), CharExpr->getValue())) {
 | 
						|
    Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char)
 | 
						|
        << DiagRange << Ctx.CharTy;
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char)
 | 
						|
        << DiagRange << CharExpr->getType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Only print a fixit for str + char, not for char + str.
 | 
						|
  if (isa<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts())) {
 | 
						|
    SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getEndLoc());
 | 
						|
    Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence)
 | 
						|
        << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), "&")
 | 
						|
        << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[")
 | 
						|
        << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]");
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Emit error when two pointers are incompatible.
 | 
						|
static void diagnosePointerIncompatibility(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                           Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
 | 
						|
  assert(LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
 | 
						|
  assert(RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
 | 
						|
    << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << LHSExpr->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
    << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// C99 6.5.6
 | 
						|
QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                     SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
 | 
						|
                                     QualType* CompLHSTy) {
 | 
						|
  checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
 | 
						|
      RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
 | 
						|
    QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(
 | 
						|
        LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy,
 | 
						|
        /*AllowBothBool*/getLangOpts().AltiVec,
 | 
						|
        /*AllowBoolConversions*/getLangOpts().ZVector);
 | 
						|
    if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
 | 
						|
    return compType;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(
 | 
						|
      LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy ? ACK_CompAssign : ACK_Arithmetic);
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Diagnose "string literal" '+' int and string '+' "char literal".
 | 
						|
  if (Opc == BO_Add) {
 | 
						|
    diagnoseStringPlusInt(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
 | 
						|
    diagnoseStringPlusChar(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
 | 
						|
  if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
 | 
						|
    return compType;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Type-checking.  Ultimately the pointer's going to be in PExp;
 | 
						|
  // note that we bias towards the LHS being the pointer.
 | 
						|
  Expr *PExp = LHS.get(), *IExp = RHS.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool isObjCPointer;
 | 
						|
  if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
    isObjCPointer = false;
 | 
						|
  } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
    isObjCPointer = true;
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    std::swap(PExp, IExp);
 | 
						|
    if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
      isObjCPointer = false;
 | 
						|
    } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
      isObjCPointer = true;
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  assert(PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!IExp->getType()->isIntegerType())
 | 
						|
    return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Adding to a null pointer results in undefined behavior.
 | 
						|
  if (PExp->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(
 | 
						|
          Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull)) {
 | 
						|
    // In C++ adding zero to a null pointer is defined.
 | 
						|
    Expr::EvalResult KnownVal;
 | 
						|
    if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ||
 | 
						|
        (!IExp->isValueDependent() &&
 | 
						|
         (!IExp->EvaluateAsInt(KnownVal, Context) ||
 | 
						|
          KnownVal.Val.getInt() != 0))) {
 | 
						|
      // Check the conditions to see if this is the 'p = nullptr + n' idiom.
 | 
						|
      bool IsGNUIdiom = BinaryOperator::isNullPointerArithmeticExtension(
 | 
						|
          Context, BO_Add, PExp, IExp);
 | 
						|
      diagnoseArithmeticOnNullPointer(*this, Loc, PExp, IsGNUIdiom);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, PExp))
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (isObjCPointer && checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, PExp))
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic
 | 
						|
  CheckArrayAccess(PExp, IExp);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (CompLHSTy) {
 | 
						|
    QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get());
 | 
						|
    if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
 | 
						|
      LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
      if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
 | 
						|
        LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return PExp->getType();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// C99 6.5.6
 | 
						|
QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                        SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                        QualType* CompLHSTy) {
 | 
						|
  checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
 | 
						|
      RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
 | 
						|
    QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(
 | 
						|
        LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy,
 | 
						|
        /*AllowBothBool*/getLangOpts().AltiVec,
 | 
						|
        /*AllowBoolConversions*/getLangOpts().ZVector);
 | 
						|
    if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
 | 
						|
    return compType;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(
 | 
						|
      LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy ? ACK_CompAssign : ACK_Arithmetic);
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
 | 
						|
  if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
 | 
						|
    return compType;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Either ptr - int   or   ptr - ptr.
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.get()->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
    QualType lpointee = LHS.get()->getType()->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
 | 
						|
    if (LHS.get()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
 | 
						|
        checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, LHS.get()))
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
 | 
						|
    if (RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
 | 
						|
      // Subtracting from a null pointer should produce a warning.
 | 
						|
      // The last argument to the diagnose call says this doesn't match the
 | 
						|
      // GNU int-to-pointer idiom.
 | 
						|
      if (LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
 | 
						|
                                           Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull)) {
 | 
						|
        // In C++ adding zero to a null pointer is defined.
 | 
						|
        Expr::EvalResult KnownVal;
 | 
						|
        if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ||
 | 
						|
            (!RHS.get()->isValueDependent() &&
 | 
						|
             (!RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(KnownVal, Context) ||
 | 
						|
              KnownVal.Val.getInt() != 0))) {
 | 
						|
          diagnoseArithmeticOnNullPointer(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), false);
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, LHS.get()))
 | 
						|
        return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic
 | 
						|
      CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), /*ArraySubscriptExpr*/nullptr,
 | 
						|
                       /*AllowOnePastEnd*/true, /*IndexNegated*/true);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
      return LHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
 | 
						|
    if (const PointerType *RHSPTy
 | 
						|
          = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
 | 
						|
      QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
        // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
 | 
						|
        if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
 | 
						|
          diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      } else {
 | 
						|
        // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
 | 
						|
        if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
 | 
						|
                Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
 | 
						|
                Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
 | 
						|
          diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
 | 
						|
          return QualType();
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (!checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(*this, Loc,
 | 
						|
                                               LHS.get(), RHS.get()))
 | 
						|
        return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // FIXME: Add warnings for nullptr - ptr.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // The pointee type may have zero size.  As an extension, a structure or
 | 
						|
      // union may have zero size or an array may have zero length.  In this
 | 
						|
      // case subtraction does not make sense.
 | 
						|
      if (!rpointee->isVoidType() && !rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
 | 
						|
        CharUnits ElementSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(rpointee);
 | 
						|
        if (ElementSize.isZero()) {
 | 
						|
          Diag(Loc,diag::warn_sub_ptr_zero_size_types)
 | 
						|
            << rpointee.getUnqualifiedType()
 | 
						|
            << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
      return Context.getPointerDiffType();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
 | 
						|
  if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
 | 
						|
    return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void DiagnoseBadShiftValues(Sema& S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                   SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
 | 
						|
                                   QualType LHSType) {
 | 
						|
  // OpenCL 6.3j: shift values are effectively % word size of LHS (more defined),
 | 
						|
  // so skip remaining warnings as we don't want to modify values within Sema.
 | 
						|
  if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check right/shifter operand
 | 
						|
  Expr::EvalResult RHSResult;
 | 
						|
  if (RHS.get()->isValueDependent() ||
 | 
						|
      !RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSResult, S.Context))
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  llvm::APSInt Right = RHSResult.Val.getInt();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Right.isNegative()) {
 | 
						|
    S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(),
 | 
						|
                          S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_negative)
 | 
						|
                            << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
 | 
						|
                       S.Context.getTypeSize(LHS.get()->getType()));
 | 
						|
  if (Right.uge(LeftBits)) {
 | 
						|
    S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(),
 | 
						|
                          S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth)
 | 
						|
                            << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (Opc != BO_Shl)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // When left shifting an ICE which is signed, we can check for overflow which
 | 
						|
  // according to C++ standards prior to C++2a has undefined behavior
 | 
						|
  // ([expr.shift] 5.8/2). Unsigned integers have defined behavior modulo one
 | 
						|
  // more than the maximum value representable in the result type, so never
 | 
						|
  // warn for those. (FIXME: Unsigned left-shift overflow in a constant
 | 
						|
  // expression is still probably a bug.)
 | 
						|
  Expr::EvalResult LHSResult;
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.get()->isValueDependent() ||
 | 
						|
      LHSType->hasUnsignedIntegerRepresentation() ||
 | 
						|
      !LHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(LHSResult, S.Context))
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  llvm::APSInt Left = LHSResult.Val.getInt();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If LHS does not have a signed type and non-negative value
 | 
						|
  // then, the behavior is undefined before C++2a. Warn about it.
 | 
						|
  if (Left.isNegative() && !S.getLangOpts().isSignedOverflowDefined() &&
 | 
						|
      !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a) {
 | 
						|
    S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, LHS.get(),
 | 
						|
                          S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_lhs_negative)
 | 
						|
                            << LHS.get()->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  llvm::APInt ResultBits =
 | 
						|
      static_cast<llvm::APInt&>(Right) + Left.getMinSignedBits();
 | 
						|
  if (LeftBits.uge(ResultBits))
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  llvm::APSInt Result = Left.extend(ResultBits.getLimitedValue());
 | 
						|
  Result = Result.shl(Right);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Print the bit representation of the signed integer as an unsigned
 | 
						|
  // hexadecimal number.
 | 
						|
  SmallString<40> HexResult;
 | 
						|
  Result.toString(HexResult, 16, /*Signed =*/false, /*Literal =*/true);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If we are only missing a sign bit, this is less likely to result in actual
 | 
						|
  // bugs -- if the result is cast back to an unsigned type, it will have the
 | 
						|
  // expected value. Thus we place this behind a different warning that can be
 | 
						|
  // turned off separately if needed.
 | 
						|
  if (LeftBits == ResultBits - 1) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_sets_sign_bit)
 | 
						|
        << HexResult << LHSType
 | 
						|
        << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_gt_typewidth)
 | 
						|
    << HexResult.str() << Result.getMinSignedBits() << LHSType
 | 
						|
    << Left.getBitWidth() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
    << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Return the resulting type when a vector is shifted
 | 
						|
///        by a scalar or vector shift amount.
 | 
						|
static QualType checkVectorShift(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) {
 | 
						|
  // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.j says RHS can be a vector only if LHS is a vector.
 | 
						|
  if ((S.LangOpts.OpenCL || S.LangOpts.ZVector) &&
 | 
						|
      !LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_shift_rhs_only_vector)
 | 
						|
      << RHS.get()->getType() << LHS.get()->getType()
 | 
						|
      << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!IsCompAssign) {
 | 
						|
    LHS = S.UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get());
 | 
						|
    if (LHS.isInvalid()) return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  RHS = S.UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get());
 | 
						|
  if (RHS.isInvalid()) return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
  // Note that LHS might be a scalar because the routine calls not only in
 | 
						|
  // OpenCL case.
 | 
						|
  const VectorType *LHSVecTy = LHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSEleType = LHSVecTy ? LHSVecTy->getElementType() : LHSType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Note that RHS might not be a vector.
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
  const VectorType *RHSVecTy = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSEleType = RHSVecTy ? RHSVecTy->getElementType() : RHSType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The operands need to be integers.
 | 
						|
  if (!LHSEleType->isIntegerType()) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_expect_int)
 | 
						|
      << LHS.get()->getType() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!RHSEleType->isIntegerType()) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_expect_int)
 | 
						|
      << RHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!LHSVecTy) {
 | 
						|
    assert(RHSVecTy);
 | 
						|
    if (IsCompAssign)
 | 
						|
      return RHSType;
 | 
						|
    if (LHSEleType != RHSEleType) {
 | 
						|
      LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(),RHSEleType, CK_IntegralCast);
 | 
						|
      LHSEleType = RHSEleType;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    QualType VecTy =
 | 
						|
        S.Context.getExtVectorType(LHSEleType, RHSVecTy->getNumElements());
 | 
						|
    LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), VecTy, CK_VectorSplat);
 | 
						|
    LHSType = VecTy;
 | 
						|
  } else if (RHSVecTy) {
 | 
						|
    // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.j says that for vector types, the operators
 | 
						|
    // are applied component-wise. So if RHS is a vector, then ensure
 | 
						|
    // that the number of elements is the same as LHS...
 | 
						|
    if (RHSVecTy->getNumElements() != LHSVecTy->getNumElements()) {
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_lengths_not_equal)
 | 
						|
        << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
 | 
						|
        << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    if (!S.LangOpts.OpenCL && !S.LangOpts.ZVector) {
 | 
						|
      const BuiltinType *LHSBT = LHSEleType->getAs<clang::BuiltinType>();
 | 
						|
      const BuiltinType *RHSBT = RHSEleType->getAs<clang::BuiltinType>();
 | 
						|
      if (LHSBT != RHSBT &&
 | 
						|
          S.Context.getTypeSize(LHSBT) != S.Context.getTypeSize(RHSBT)) {
 | 
						|
        S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_typecheck_vector_element_sizes_not_equal)
 | 
						|
            << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
 | 
						|
            << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    // ...else expand RHS to match the number of elements in LHS.
 | 
						|
    QualType VecTy =
 | 
						|
      S.Context.getExtVectorType(RHSEleType, LHSVecTy->getNumElements());
 | 
						|
    RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), VecTy, CK_VectorSplat);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return LHSType;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// C99 6.5.7
 | 
						|
QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                  SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
 | 
						|
                                  bool IsCompAssign) {
 | 
						|
  checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
 | 
						|
      RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (LangOpts.ZVector) {
 | 
						|
      // The shift operators for the z vector extensions work basically
 | 
						|
      // like general shifts, except that neither the LHS nor the RHS is
 | 
						|
      // allowed to be a "vector bool".
 | 
						|
      if (auto LHSVecType = LHS.get()->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
 | 
						|
        if (LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool)
 | 
						|
          return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
      if (auto RHSVecType = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
 | 
						|
        if (RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool)
 | 
						|
          return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    return checkVectorShift(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
 | 
						|
  // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // For the LHS, do usual unary conversions, but then reset them away
 | 
						|
  // if this is a compound assignment.
 | 
						|
  ExprResult OldLHS = LHS;
 | 
						|
  LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get());
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
  if (IsCompAssign) LHS = OldLHS;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The RHS is simpler.
 | 
						|
  RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get());
 | 
						|
  if (RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
 | 
						|
  if (!LHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
 | 
						|
      !RHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
 | 
						|
    return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
 | 
						|
  // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
 | 
						|
  if (isScopedEnumerationType(LHSType) ||
 | 
						|
      isScopedEnumerationType(RHSType)) {
 | 
						|
    return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  // Sanity-check shift operands
 | 
						|
  DiagnoseBadShiftValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc, LHSType);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
 | 
						|
  return LHSType;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Diagnose bad pointer comparisons.
 | 
						|
static void diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                              ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                              bool IsError) {
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers
 | 
						|
                      : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
 | 
						|
    << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
 | 
						|
    << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Returns false if the pointers are converted to a composite type,
 | 
						|
/// true otherwise.
 | 
						|
static bool convertPointersToCompositeType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                           ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS) {
 | 
						|
  // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
 | 
						|
  //   [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
 | 
						|
  //   conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
 | 
						|
  //   a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
 | 
						|
  //   them to their composite pointer type. [...]
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
 | 
						|
  // comparisons of pointers.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
  assert(LHSType->isPointerType() || RHSType->isPointerType() ||
 | 
						|
         LHSType->isMemberPointerType() || RHSType->isMemberPointerType());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType T = S.FindCompositePointerType(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
  if (T.isNull()) {
 | 
						|
    if ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() || LHSType->isMemberPointerType()) &&
 | 
						|
        (RHSType->isAnyPointerType() || RHSType->isMemberPointerType()))
 | 
						|
      diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(S, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/true);
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                                    ExprResult &LHS,
 | 
						|
                                                    ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                                    bool IsError) {
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
 | 
						|
                      : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
 | 
						|
    << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
 | 
						|
    << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static bool isObjCObjectLiteral(ExprResult &E) {
 | 
						|
  switch (E.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getStmtClass()) {
 | 
						|
  case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass:
 | 
						|
  case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass:
 | 
						|
  case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass:
 | 
						|
  case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass:
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  default:
 | 
						|
    // Note that ObjCBoolLiteral is NOT an object literal!
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static bool hasIsEqualMethod(Sema &S, const Expr *LHS, const Expr *RHS) {
 | 
						|
  const ObjCObjectPointerType *Type =
 | 
						|
    LHS->getType()->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If this is not actually an Objective-C object, bail out.
 | 
						|
  if (!Type)
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Get the LHS object's interface type.
 | 
						|
  QualType InterfaceType = Type->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If the RHS isn't an Objective-C object, bail out.
 | 
						|
  if (!RHS->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType())
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Try to find the -isEqual: method.
 | 
						|
  Selector IsEqualSel = S.NSAPIObj->getIsEqualSelector();
 | 
						|
  ObjCMethodDecl *Method = S.LookupMethodInObjectType(IsEqualSel,
 | 
						|
                                                      InterfaceType,
 | 
						|
                                                      /*IsInstance=*/true);
 | 
						|
  if (!Method) {
 | 
						|
    if (Type->isObjCIdType()) {
 | 
						|
      // For 'id', just check the global pool.
 | 
						|
      Method = S.LookupInstanceMethodInGlobalPool(IsEqualSel, SourceRange(),
 | 
						|
                                                  /*receiverId=*/true);
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      // Check protocols.
 | 
						|
      Method = S.LookupMethodInQualifiedType(IsEqualSel, Type,
 | 
						|
                                             /*IsInstance=*/true);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!Method)
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType T = Method->parameters()[0]->getType();
 | 
						|
  if (!T->isObjCObjectPointerType())
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType R = Method->getReturnType();
 | 
						|
  if (!R->isScalarType())
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return true;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
Sema::ObjCLiteralKind Sema::CheckLiteralKind(Expr *FromE) {
 | 
						|
  FromE = FromE->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
 | 
						|
  switch (FromE->getStmtClass()) {
 | 
						|
    default:
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass:
 | 
						|
      // "string literal"
 | 
						|
      return LK_String;
 | 
						|
    case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass:
 | 
						|
      // "array literal"
 | 
						|
      return LK_Array;
 | 
						|
    case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass:
 | 
						|
      // "dictionary literal"
 | 
						|
      return LK_Dictionary;
 | 
						|
    case Stmt::BlockExprClass:
 | 
						|
      return LK_Block;
 | 
						|
    case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass: {
 | 
						|
      Expr *Inner = cast<ObjCBoxedExpr>(FromE)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
 | 
						|
      switch (Inner->getStmtClass()) {
 | 
						|
        case Stmt::IntegerLiteralClass:
 | 
						|
        case Stmt::FloatingLiteralClass:
 | 
						|
        case Stmt::CharacterLiteralClass:
 | 
						|
        case Stmt::ObjCBoolLiteralExprClass:
 | 
						|
        case Stmt::CXXBoolLiteralExprClass:
 | 
						|
          // "numeric literal"
 | 
						|
          return LK_Numeric;
 | 
						|
        case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass: {
 | 
						|
          CastKind CK = cast<CastExpr>(Inner)->getCastKind();
 | 
						|
          // Boolean literals can be represented by implicit casts.
 | 
						|
          if (CK == CK_IntegralToBoolean || CK == CK_IntegralCast)
 | 
						|
            return LK_Numeric;
 | 
						|
          break;
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
        default:
 | 
						|
          break;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      return LK_Boxed;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return LK_None;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                          ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                          BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc){
 | 
						|
  Expr *Literal;
 | 
						|
  Expr *Other;
 | 
						|
  if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS)) {
 | 
						|
    Literal = LHS.get();
 | 
						|
    Other = RHS.get();
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    Literal = RHS.get();
 | 
						|
    Other = LHS.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Don't warn on comparisons against nil.
 | 
						|
  Other = Other->IgnoreParenCasts();
 | 
						|
  if (Other->isNullPointerConstant(S.getASTContext(),
 | 
						|
                                   Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // This should be kept in sync with warn_objc_literal_comparison.
 | 
						|
  // LK_String should always be after the other literals, since it has its own
 | 
						|
  // warning flag.
 | 
						|
  Sema::ObjCLiteralKind LiteralKind = S.CheckLiteralKind(Literal);
 | 
						|
  assert(LiteralKind != Sema::LK_Block);
 | 
						|
  if (LiteralKind == Sema::LK_None) {
 | 
						|
    llvm_unreachable("Unknown Objective-C object literal kind");
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LiteralKind == Sema::LK_String)
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_string_literal_comparison)
 | 
						|
      << Literal->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
  else
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_literal_comparison)
 | 
						|
      << LiteralKind << Literal->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc) &&
 | 
						|
      hasIsEqualMethod(S, LHS.get(), RHS.get())) {
 | 
						|
    SourceLocation Start = LHS.get()->getBeginLoc();
 | 
						|
    SourceLocation End = S.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getEndLoc());
 | 
						|
    CharSourceRange OpRange =
 | 
						|
      CharSourceRange::getCharRange(Loc, S.getLocForEndOfToken(Loc));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_objc_literal_comparison_isequal)
 | 
						|
      << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Start, Opc == BO_EQ ? "[" : "![")
 | 
						|
      << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpRange, " isEqual:")
 | 
						|
      << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(End, "]");
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Warns on !x < y, !x & y where !(x < y), !(x & y) was probably intended.
 | 
						|
static void diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofCheck(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
 | 
						|
                                           ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                           BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
 | 
						|
  // Check that left hand side is !something.
 | 
						|
  UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts());
 | 
						|
  if (!UO || UO->getOpcode() != UO_LNot) return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Only check if the right hand side is non-bool arithmetic type.
 | 
						|
  if (RHS.get()->isKnownToHaveBooleanValue()) return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Make sure that the something in !something is not bool.
 | 
						|
  Expr *SubExpr = UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreImpCasts();
 | 
						|
  if (SubExpr->isKnownToHaveBooleanValue()) return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Emit warning.
 | 
						|
  bool IsBitwiseOp = Opc == BO_And || Opc == BO_Or || Opc == BO_Xor;
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_not_on_lhs_of_check)
 | 
						|
      << Loc << IsBitwiseOp;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // First note suggest !(x < y)
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation FirstOpen = SubExpr->getBeginLoc();
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation FirstClose = RHS.get()->getEndLoc();
 | 
						|
  FirstClose = S.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstClose);
 | 
						|
  if (FirstClose.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    FirstOpen = SourceLocation();
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_fix)
 | 
						|
      << IsBitwiseOp
 | 
						|
      << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstOpen, "(")
 | 
						|
      << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstClose, ")");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Second note suggests (!x) < y
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation SecondOpen = LHS.get()->getBeginLoc();
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation SecondClose = LHS.get()->getEndLoc();
 | 
						|
  SecondClose = S.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondClose);
 | 
						|
  if (SecondClose.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    SecondOpen = SourceLocation();
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_silence_with_parens)
 | 
						|
      << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondOpen, "(")
 | 
						|
      << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondClose, ")");
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// Returns true if E refers to a non-weak array.
 | 
						|
static bool checkForArray(const Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  const ValueDecl *D = nullptr;
 | 
						|
  if (const DeclRefExpr *DR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
    D = DR->getDecl();
 | 
						|
  } else if (const MemberExpr *Mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
    if (Mem->isImplicitAccess())
 | 
						|
      D = Mem->getMemberDecl();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (!D)
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
  return D->getType()->isArrayType() && !D->isWeak();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Diagnose some forms of syntactically-obvious tautological comparison.
 | 
						|
static void diagnoseTautologicalComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                           Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS,
 | 
						|
                                           BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
 | 
						|
  Expr *LHSStripped = LHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
 | 
						|
  Expr *RHSStripped = RHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSType = RHS->getType();
 | 
						|
  if (LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation() ||
 | 
						|
      (LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && !BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc)) ||
 | 
						|
      S.inTemplateInstantiation())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Comparisons between two array types are ill-formed for operator<=>, so
 | 
						|
  // we shouldn't emit any additional warnings about it.
 | 
						|
  if (Opc == BO_Cmp && LHSType->isArrayType() && RHSType->isArrayType())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
 | 
						|
  // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc.  These always evaluate to a constant, and
 | 
						|
  // often indicate logic errors in the program.
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
 | 
						|
  // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
 | 
						|
  // comparisons within a template instantiation. The warnings should catch
 | 
						|
  // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
 | 
						|
  // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
 | 
						|
  // result.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Used for indexing into %select in warn_comparison_always
 | 
						|
  enum {
 | 
						|
    AlwaysConstant,
 | 
						|
    AlwaysTrue,
 | 
						|
    AlwaysFalse,
 | 
						|
    AlwaysEqual, // std::strong_ordering::equal from operator<=>
 | 
						|
  };
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++2a [depr.array.comp]:
 | 
						|
  //   Equality and relational comparisons ([expr.eq], [expr.rel]) between two
 | 
						|
  //   operands of array type are deprecated.
 | 
						|
  if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a && LHSStripped->getType()->isArrayType() &&
 | 
						|
      RHSStripped->getType()->isArrayType()) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_depr_array_comparison)
 | 
						|
        << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
        << LHSStripped->getType() << RHSStripped->getType();
 | 
						|
    // Carry on to produce the tautological comparison warning, if this
 | 
						|
    // expression is potentially-evaluated, we can resolve the array to a
 | 
						|
    // non-weak declaration, and so on.
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!LHS->getBeginLoc().isMacroID() && !RHS->getBeginLoc().isMacroID()) {
 | 
						|
    if (Expr::isSameComparisonOperand(LHS, RHS)) {
 | 
						|
      unsigned Result;
 | 
						|
      switch (Opc) {
 | 
						|
      case BO_EQ:
 | 
						|
      case BO_LE:
 | 
						|
      case BO_GE:
 | 
						|
        Result = AlwaysTrue;
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      case BO_NE:
 | 
						|
      case BO_LT:
 | 
						|
      case BO_GT:
 | 
						|
        Result = AlwaysFalse;
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      case BO_Cmp:
 | 
						|
        Result = AlwaysEqual;
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      default:
 | 
						|
        Result = AlwaysConstant;
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr,
 | 
						|
                            S.PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
 | 
						|
                                << 0 /*self-comparison*/
 | 
						|
                                << Result);
 | 
						|
    } else if (checkForArray(LHSStripped) && checkForArray(RHSStripped)) {
 | 
						|
      // What is it always going to evaluate to?
 | 
						|
      unsigned Result;
 | 
						|
      switch (Opc) {
 | 
						|
      case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
 | 
						|
        Result = AlwaysFalse;
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
 | 
						|
        Result = AlwaysTrue;
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      default: // e.g. array1 <= array2
 | 
						|
        // The best we can say is 'a constant'
 | 
						|
        Result = AlwaysConstant;
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr,
 | 
						|
                            S.PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
 | 
						|
                                << 1 /*array comparison*/
 | 
						|
                                << Result);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
 | 
						|
    LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
 | 
						|
  if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
 | 
						|
    RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
 | 
						|
  // operand is null); the user probably wants string comparison function.
 | 
						|
  Expr *LiteralString = nullptr;
 | 
						|
  Expr *LiteralStringStripped = nullptr;
 | 
						|
  if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
 | 
						|
      !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context,
 | 
						|
                                          Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
 | 
						|
    LiteralString = LHS;
 | 
						|
    LiteralStringStripped = LHSStripped;
 | 
						|
  } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
 | 
						|
              isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
 | 
						|
             !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context,
 | 
						|
                                          Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
 | 
						|
    LiteralString = RHS;
 | 
						|
    LiteralStringStripped = RHSStripped;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LiteralString) {
 | 
						|
    S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr,
 | 
						|
                          S.PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
 | 
						|
                              << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LiteralStringStripped)
 | 
						|
                              << LiteralString->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static ImplicitConversionKind castKindToImplicitConversionKind(CastKind CK) {
 | 
						|
  switch (CK) {
 | 
						|
  default: {
 | 
						|
#ifndef NDEBUG
 | 
						|
    llvm::errs() << "unhandled cast kind: " << CastExpr::getCastKindName(CK)
 | 
						|
                 << "\n";
 | 
						|
#endif
 | 
						|
    llvm_unreachable("unhandled cast kind");
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  case CK_UserDefinedConversion:
 | 
						|
    return ICK_Identity;
 | 
						|
  case CK_LValueToRValue:
 | 
						|
    return ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
 | 
						|
  case CK_ArrayToPointerDecay:
 | 
						|
    return ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
 | 
						|
  case CK_FunctionToPointerDecay:
 | 
						|
    return ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
 | 
						|
  case CK_IntegralCast:
 | 
						|
    return ICK_Integral_Conversion;
 | 
						|
  case CK_FloatingCast:
 | 
						|
    return ICK_Floating_Conversion;
 | 
						|
  case CK_IntegralToFloating:
 | 
						|
  case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
 | 
						|
    return ICK_Floating_Integral;
 | 
						|
  case CK_IntegralComplexCast:
 | 
						|
  case CK_FloatingComplexCast:
 | 
						|
  case CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex:
 | 
						|
  case CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex:
 | 
						|
    return ICK_Complex_Conversion;
 | 
						|
  case CK_FloatingComplexToReal:
 | 
						|
  case CK_FloatingRealToComplex:
 | 
						|
  case CK_IntegralComplexToReal:
 | 
						|
  case CK_IntegralRealToComplex:
 | 
						|
    return ICK_Complex_Real;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static bool checkThreeWayNarrowingConversion(Sema &S, QualType ToType, Expr *E,
 | 
						|
                                             QualType FromType,
 | 
						|
                                             SourceLocation Loc) {
 | 
						|
  // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
 | 
						|
  StandardConversionSequence SCS;
 | 
						|
  SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
 | 
						|
  SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
 | 
						|
  SCS.setToType(1, ToType);
 | 
						|
  if (const auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E))
 | 
						|
    SCS.Second = castKindToImplicitConversionKind(ICE->getCastKind());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  APValue PreNarrowingValue;
 | 
						|
  QualType PreNarrowingType;
 | 
						|
  switch (SCS.getNarrowingKind(S.Context, E, PreNarrowingValue,
 | 
						|
                               PreNarrowingType,
 | 
						|
                               /*IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion*/ true)) {
 | 
						|
  case NK_Dependent_Narrowing:
 | 
						|
    // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, but the expression is
 | 
						|
    // value-dependent so we can't tell whether it's actually narrowing.
 | 
						|
  case NK_Not_Narrowing:
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
 | 
						|
    // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
 | 
						|
    // expression.
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_spaceship_argument_narrowing)
 | 
						|
        << /*Constant*/ 1
 | 
						|
        << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(S.Context, PreNarrowingType) << ToType;
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
 | 
						|
    // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
 | 
						|
    // expression.
 | 
						|
  case NK_Type_Narrowing:
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_spaceship_argument_narrowing)
 | 
						|
        << /*Constant*/ 0 << FromType << ToType;
 | 
						|
    // TODO: It's not a constant expression, but what if the user intended it
 | 
						|
    // to be? Can we produce notes to help them figure out why it isn't?
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  llvm_unreachable("unhandled case in switch");
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static QualType checkArithmeticOrEnumeralThreeWayCompare(Sema &S,
 | 
						|
                                                         ExprResult &LHS,
 | 
						|
                                                         ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                                         SourceLocation Loc) {
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
  // Dig out the original argument type and expression before implicit casts
 | 
						|
  // were applied. These are the types/expressions we need to check the
 | 
						|
  // [expr.spaceship] requirements against.
 | 
						|
  ExprResult LHSStripped = LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
 | 
						|
  ExprResult RHSStripped = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSStrippedType = LHSStripped.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSStrippedType = RHSStripped.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p3: If one of the operands is of type bool and the
 | 
						|
  // other is not, the program is ill-formed.
 | 
						|
  if (LHSStrippedType->isBooleanType() != RHSStrippedType->isBooleanType()) {
 | 
						|
    S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHSStripped, RHSStripped);
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: Consider combining this with checkEnumArithmeticConversions.
 | 
						|
  int NumEnumArgs = (int)LHSStrippedType->isEnumeralType() +
 | 
						|
                    RHSStrippedType->isEnumeralType();
 | 
						|
  if (NumEnumArgs == 1) {
 | 
						|
    bool LHSIsEnum = LHSStrippedType->isEnumeralType();
 | 
						|
    QualType OtherTy = LHSIsEnum ? RHSStrippedType : LHSStrippedType;
 | 
						|
    if (OtherTy->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
 | 
						|
      S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHSStripped, RHSStripped);
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (NumEnumArgs == 2) {
 | 
						|
    // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p5: If both operands have the same enumeration
 | 
						|
    // type E, the operator yields the result of converting the operands
 | 
						|
    // to the underlying type of E and applying <=> to the converted operands.
 | 
						|
    if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHSStrippedType, RHSStrippedType)) {
 | 
						|
      S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    QualType IntType =
 | 
						|
        LHSStrippedType->castAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
 | 
						|
    assert(IntType->isArithmeticType());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // We can't use `CK_IntegralCast` when the underlying type is 'bool', so we
 | 
						|
    // promote the boolean type, and all other promotable integer types, to
 | 
						|
    // avoid this.
 | 
						|
    if (IntType->isPromotableIntegerType())
 | 
						|
      IntType = S.Context.getPromotedIntegerType(IntType);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), IntType, CK_IntegralCast);
 | 
						|
    RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), IntType, CK_IntegralCast);
 | 
						|
    LHSType = RHSType = IntType;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p4: If both operands have arithmetic types, the
 | 
						|
  // usual arithmetic conversions are applied to the operands.
 | 
						|
  QualType Type =
 | 
						|
      S.UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, Loc, Sema::ACK_Comparison);
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  if (Type.isNull())
 | 
						|
    return S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Optional<ComparisonCategoryType> CCT =
 | 
						|
      getComparisonCategoryForBuiltinCmp(Type);
 | 
						|
  if (!CCT)
 | 
						|
    return S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool HasNarrowing = checkThreeWayNarrowingConversion(
 | 
						|
      S, Type, LHS.get(), LHSType, LHS.get()->getBeginLoc());
 | 
						|
  HasNarrowing |= checkThreeWayNarrowingConversion(S, Type, RHS.get(), RHSType,
 | 
						|
                                                   RHS.get()->getBeginLoc());
 | 
						|
  if (HasNarrowing)
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  assert(!Type.isNull() && "composite type for <=> has not been set");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return S.CheckComparisonCategoryType(
 | 
						|
      *CCT, Loc, Sema::ComparisonCategoryUsage::OperatorInExpression);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static QualType checkArithmeticOrEnumeralCompare(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
 | 
						|
                                                 ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                                 SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                                 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
 | 
						|
  if (Opc == BO_Cmp)
 | 
						|
    return checkArithmeticOrEnumeralThreeWayCompare(S, LHS, RHS, Loc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
 | 
						|
  QualType Type =
 | 
						|
      S.UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, Loc, Sema::ACK_Comparison);
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  if (Type.isNull())
 | 
						|
    return S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
  assert(Type->isArithmeticType() || Type->isEnumeralType());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Type->isAnyComplexType() && BinaryOperator::isRelationalOp(Opc))
 | 
						|
    return S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
 | 
						|
  if (Type->hasFloatingRepresentation() && BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc))
 | 
						|
    S.CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
 | 
						|
  return S.Context.getLogicalOperationType();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
void Sema::CheckPtrComparisonWithNullChar(ExprResult &E, ExprResult &NullE) {
 | 
						|
  if (!NullE.get()->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  int NullValue = PP.isMacroDefined("NULL") ? 0 : 1;
 | 
						|
  if (!E.get()->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
 | 
						|
      E.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
 | 
						|
                                     Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) ==
 | 
						|
        Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) {
 | 
						|
    if (const auto *CL = dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(E.get())) {
 | 
						|
      if (CL->getValue() == 0)
 | 
						|
        Diag(E.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_pointer_compare)
 | 
						|
            << NullValue
 | 
						|
            << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(E.get()->getExprLoc(),
 | 
						|
                                            NullValue ? "NULL" : "(void *)0");
 | 
						|
    } else if (const auto *CE = dyn_cast<CStyleCastExpr>(E.get())) {
 | 
						|
        TypeSourceInfo *TI = CE->getTypeInfoAsWritten();
 | 
						|
        QualType T = Context.getCanonicalType(TI->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
        if (T == Context.CharTy)
 | 
						|
          Diag(E.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_pointer_compare)
 | 
						|
              << NullValue
 | 
						|
              << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(E.get()->getExprLoc(),
 | 
						|
                                              NullValue ? "NULL" : "(void *)0");
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
 | 
						|
QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                    SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                    BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
 | 
						|
  bool IsRelational = BinaryOperator::isRelationalOp(Opc);
 | 
						|
  bool IsThreeWay = Opc == BO_Cmp;
 | 
						|
  bool IsOrdered = IsRelational || IsThreeWay;
 | 
						|
  auto IsAnyPointerType = [](ExprResult E) {
 | 
						|
    QualType Ty = E.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
    return Ty->isPointerType() || Ty->isMemberPointerType();
 | 
						|
  };
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p6: If at least one of the operands is of pointer
 | 
						|
  // type, array-to-pointer, ..., conversions are performed on both operands to
 | 
						|
  // bring them to their composite type.
 | 
						|
  // Otherwise, all comparisons expect an rvalue, so convert to rvalue before
 | 
						|
  // any type-related checks.
 | 
						|
  if (!IsThreeWay || IsAnyPointerType(LHS) || IsAnyPointerType(RHS)) {
 | 
						|
    LHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get());
 | 
						|
    if (LHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
    RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
 | 
						|
    if (RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    LHS = DefaultLvalueConversion(LHS.get());
 | 
						|
    if (LHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
    RHS = DefaultLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
 | 
						|
    if (RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/true);
 | 
						|
  if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc)) {
 | 
						|
    CheckPtrComparisonWithNullChar(LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
    CheckPtrComparisonWithNullChar(RHS, LHS);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Handle vector comparisons separately.
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
 | 
						|
      RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
 | 
						|
    return CheckVectorCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofCheck(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc);
 | 
						|
  diagnoseTautologicalComparison(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
  if ((LHSType->isArithmeticType() || LHSType->isEnumeralType()) &&
 | 
						|
      (RHSType->isArithmeticType() || RHSType->isEnumeralType()))
 | 
						|
    return checkArithmeticOrEnumeralCompare(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind LHSNullKind =
 | 
						|
      LHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
 | 
						|
  const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind RHSNullKind =
 | 
						|
      RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
 | 
						|
  bool LHSIsNull = LHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull;
 | 
						|
  bool RHSIsNull = RHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  auto computeResultTy = [&]() {
 | 
						|
    if (Opc != BO_Cmp)
 | 
						|
      return Context.getLogicalOperationType();
 | 
						|
    assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus);
 | 
						|
    assert(Context.hasSameType(LHS.get()->getType(), RHS.get()->getType()));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    QualType CompositeTy = LHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
    assert(!CompositeTy->isReferenceType());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    Optional<ComparisonCategoryType> CCT =
 | 
						|
        getComparisonCategoryForBuiltinCmp(CompositeTy);
 | 
						|
    if (!CCT)
 | 
						|
      return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (CompositeTy->isPointerType() && LHSIsNull != RHSIsNull) {
 | 
						|
      // P0946R0: Comparisons between a null pointer constant and an object
 | 
						|
      // pointer result in std::strong_equality, which is ill-formed under
 | 
						|
      // P1959R0.
 | 
						|
      Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_three_way_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero)
 | 
						|
          << (LHSIsNull ? LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
                        : RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return CheckComparisonCategoryType(
 | 
						|
        *CCT, Loc, ComparisonCategoryUsage::OperatorInExpression);
 | 
						|
  };
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!IsOrdered && LHSIsNull != RHSIsNull) {
 | 
						|
    bool IsEquality = Opc == BO_EQ;
 | 
						|
    if (RHSIsNull)
 | 
						|
      DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(LHS.get(), RHSNullKind, IsEquality,
 | 
						|
                                   RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(RHS.get(), LHSNullKind, IsEquality,
 | 
						|
                                   LHS.get()->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if ((LHSType->isIntegerType() && !LHSIsNull) ||
 | 
						|
      (RHSType->isIntegerType() && !RHSIsNull)) {
 | 
						|
    // Skip normal pointer conversion checks in this case; we have better
 | 
						|
    // diagnostics for this below.
 | 
						|
  } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
    // Equality comparison of a function pointer to a void pointer is invalid,
 | 
						|
    // but we allow it as an extension.
 | 
						|
    // FIXME: If we really want to allow this, should it be part of composite
 | 
						|
    // pointer type computation so it works in conditionals too?
 | 
						|
    if (!IsOrdered &&
 | 
						|
        ((LHSType->isFunctionPointerType() && RHSType->isVoidPointerType()) ||
 | 
						|
         (RHSType->isFunctionPointerType() && LHSType->isVoidPointerType()))) {
 | 
						|
      // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
 | 
						|
      // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
 | 
						|
      // conformance with the C++ standard.
 | 
						|
      diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(
 | 
						|
          *this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/ (bool)isSFINAEContext());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (isSFINAEContext())
 | 
						|
        return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
      return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
 | 
						|
    //   If at least one operand is a pointer [...] bring them to their
 | 
						|
    //   composite pointer type.
 | 
						|
    // C++ [expr.spaceship]p6
 | 
						|
    //  If at least one of the operands is of pointer type, [...] bring them
 | 
						|
    //  to their composite pointer type.
 | 
						|
    // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
 | 
						|
    //   If both operands are pointers, [...] bring them to their composite
 | 
						|
    //   pointer type.
 | 
						|
    // For <=>, the only valid non-pointer types are arrays and functions, and
 | 
						|
    // we already decayed those, so this is really the same as the relational
 | 
						|
    // comparison rule.
 | 
						|
    if ((int)LHSType->isPointerType() + (int)RHSType->isPointerType() >=
 | 
						|
            (IsOrdered ? 2 : 1) &&
 | 
						|
        (!LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount || !(LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
 | 
						|
                                         RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()))) {
 | 
						|
      if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS))
 | 
						|
        return QualType();
 | 
						|
      return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } else if (LHSType->isPointerType() &&
 | 
						|
             RHSType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
 | 
						|
    // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
 | 
						|
    // when handling null pointer constants.
 | 
						|
    QualType LCanPointeeTy =
 | 
						|
      LHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType();
 | 
						|
    QualType RCanPointeeTy =
 | 
						|
      RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
 | 
						|
    if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
 | 
						|
                                   RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
 | 
						|
      // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
 | 
						|
      if (IsRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
 | 
						|
        Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
 | 
						|
          << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
          << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    } else if (!IsRelational &&
 | 
						|
               (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
 | 
						|
      // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
 | 
						|
      if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
 | 
						|
          && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
 | 
						|
        diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS,
 | 
						|
                                                /*isError*/false);
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      // Invalid
 | 
						|
      diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/false);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy) {
 | 
						|
      // Treat NULL constant as a special case in OpenCL.
 | 
						|
      if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
 | 
						|
        const PointerType *LHSPtr = LHSType->castAs<PointerType>();
 | 
						|
        if (!LHSPtr->isAddressSpaceOverlapping(*RHSType->castAs<PointerType>())) {
 | 
						|
          Diag(Loc,
 | 
						|
               diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers)
 | 
						|
              << LHSType << RHSType << 0 /* comparison */
 | 
						|
              << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      LangAS AddrSpaceL = LCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace();
 | 
						|
      LangAS AddrSpaceR = RCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace();
 | 
						|
      CastKind Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion
 | 
						|
                                               : CK_BitCast;
 | 
						|
      if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
 | 
						|
        LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, Kind);
 | 
						|
      else
 | 
						|
        RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
    // C++ [expr.eq]p4:
 | 
						|
    //   Two operands of type std::nullptr_t or one operand of type
 | 
						|
    //   std::nullptr_t and the other a null pointer constant compare equal.
 | 
						|
    if (!IsOrdered && LHSIsNull && RHSIsNull) {
 | 
						|
      if (LHSType->isNullPtrType()) {
 | 
						|
        RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
 | 
						|
        return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      if (RHSType->isNullPtrType()) {
 | 
						|
        LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
 | 
						|
        return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Comparison of Objective-C pointers and block pointers against nullptr_t.
 | 
						|
    // These aren't covered by the composite pointer type rules.
 | 
						|
    if (!IsOrdered && RHSType->isNullPtrType() &&
 | 
						|
        (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || LHSType->isBlockPointerType())) {
 | 
						|
      RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
 | 
						|
      return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    if (!IsOrdered && LHSType->isNullPtrType() &&
 | 
						|
        (RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || RHSType->isBlockPointerType())) {
 | 
						|
      LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
 | 
						|
      return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (IsRelational &&
 | 
						|
        ((LHSType->isNullPtrType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) ||
 | 
						|
         (RHSType->isNullPtrType() && LHSType->isPointerType()))) {
 | 
						|
      // HACK: Relational comparison of nullptr_t against a pointer type is
 | 
						|
      // invalid per DR583, but we allow it within std::less<> and friends,
 | 
						|
      // since otherwise common uses of it break.
 | 
						|
      // FIXME: Consider removing this hack once LWG fixes std::less<> and
 | 
						|
      // friends to have std::nullptr_t overload candidates.
 | 
						|
      DeclContext *DC = CurContext;
 | 
						|
      if (isa<FunctionDecl>(DC))
 | 
						|
        DC = DC->getParent();
 | 
						|
      if (auto *CTSD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC)) {
 | 
						|
        if (CTSD->isInStdNamespace() &&
 | 
						|
            llvm::StringSwitch<bool>(CTSD->getName())
 | 
						|
                .Cases("less", "less_equal", "greater", "greater_equal", true)
 | 
						|
                .Default(false)) {
 | 
						|
          if (RHSType->isNullPtrType())
 | 
						|
            RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
 | 
						|
          else
 | 
						|
            LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
 | 
						|
          return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
 | 
						|
    //   If at least one operand is a pointer to member, [...] bring them to
 | 
						|
    //   their composite pointer type.
 | 
						|
    if (!IsOrdered &&
 | 
						|
        (LHSType->isMemberPointerType() || RHSType->isMemberPointerType())) {
 | 
						|
      if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS))
 | 
						|
        return QualType();
 | 
						|
      else
 | 
						|
        return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Handle block pointer types.
 | 
						|
  if (!IsOrdered && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() &&
 | 
						|
      RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
    QualType lpointee = LHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
    QualType rpointee = RHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
 | 
						|
        !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
 | 
						|
        << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
        << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
    return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
 | 
						|
  if (!IsOrdered
 | 
						|
      && ((LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType())
 | 
						|
          || (LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
 | 
						|
    if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
 | 
						|
      if (!((RHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()
 | 
						|
             ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
 | 
						|
            || (LHSType->isPointerType() && LHSType->castAs<PointerType>()
 | 
						|
                ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
 | 
						|
        Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
 | 
						|
          << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
          << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
 | 
						|
      LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType,
 | 
						|
                              RHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast
 | 
						|
                                : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast);
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType,
 | 
						|
                              LHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast
 | 
						|
                                : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast);
 | 
						|
    return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
 | 
						|
      RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
    const PointerType *LPT = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>();
 | 
						|
    const PointerType *RPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>();
 | 
						|
    if (LPT || RPT) {
 | 
						|
      bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ? LPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false;
 | 
						|
      bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ? RPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
 | 
						|
          !Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) {
 | 
						|
        diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS,
 | 
						|
                                          /*isError*/false);
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      // FIXME: If LPtrToVoid, we should presumably convert the LHS rather than
 | 
						|
      // the RHS, but we have test coverage for this behavior.
 | 
						|
      // FIXME: Consider using convertPointersToCompositeType in C++.
 | 
						|
      if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
 | 
						|
        Expr *E = LHS.get();
 | 
						|
        if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
 | 
						|
          CheckObjCConversion(SourceRange(), RHSType, E,
 | 
						|
                              CCK_ImplicitConversion);
 | 
						|
        LHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, RHSType,
 | 
						|
                                RPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      else {
 | 
						|
        Expr *E = RHS.get();
 | 
						|
        if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
 | 
						|
          CheckObjCConversion(SourceRange(), LHSType, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion,
 | 
						|
                              /*Diagnose=*/true,
 | 
						|
                              /*DiagnoseCFAudited=*/false, Opc);
 | 
						|
        RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, LHSType,
 | 
						|
                                LPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
 | 
						|
        RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
      if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(LHSType, RHSType))
 | 
						|
        diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS,
 | 
						|
                                          /*isError*/false);
 | 
						|
      if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS) || isObjCObjectLiteral(RHS))
 | 
						|
        diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, Opc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
 | 
						|
        LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
      else
 | 
						|
        RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
 | 
						|
      return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (!IsOrdered && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() &&
 | 
						|
        RHSType->isBlockCompatibleObjCPointerType(Context)) {
 | 
						|
      LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType,
 | 
						|
                              CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast);
 | 
						|
      return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
    } else if (!IsOrdered &&
 | 
						|
               LHSType->isBlockCompatibleObjCPointerType(Context) &&
 | 
						|
               RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
      RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType,
 | 
						|
                              CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast);
 | 
						|
      return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) ||
 | 
						|
      (LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isAnyPointerType())) {
 | 
						|
    unsigned DiagID = 0;
 | 
						|
    bool isError = false;
 | 
						|
    if (LangOpts.DebuggerSupport) {
 | 
						|
      // Under a debugger, allow the comparison of pointers to integers,
 | 
						|
      // since users tend to want to compare addresses.
 | 
						|
    } else if ((LHSIsNull && LHSType->isIntegerType()) ||
 | 
						|
               (RHSIsNull && RHSType->isIntegerType())) {
 | 
						|
      if (IsOrdered) {
 | 
						|
        isError = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
 | 
						|
        DiagID =
 | 
						|
          isError ? diag::err_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero
 | 
						|
                  : diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
      DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
 | 
						|
      isError = true;
 | 
						|
    } else if (IsOrdered)
 | 
						|
      DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (DiagID) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(Loc, DiagID)
 | 
						|
        << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
        << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      if (isError)
 | 
						|
        return QualType();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (LHSType->isIntegerType())
 | 
						|
      LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType,
 | 
						|
                        LHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType,
 | 
						|
                        RHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
 | 
						|
    return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Handle block pointers.
 | 
						|
  if (!IsOrdered && RHSIsNull
 | 
						|
      && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
 | 
						|
    RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
 | 
						|
    return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (!IsOrdered && LHSIsNull
 | 
						|
      && LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
    LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
 | 
						|
    return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion >= 200 || getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
    if (LHSType->isClkEventT() && RHSType->isClkEventT()) {
 | 
						|
      return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (LHSType->isQueueT() && RHSType->isQueueT()) {
 | 
						|
      return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (LHSIsNull && RHSType->isQueueT()) {
 | 
						|
      LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
 | 
						|
      return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (LHSType->isQueueT() && RHSIsNull) {
 | 
						|
      RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
 | 
						|
      return computeResultTy();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// Return a signed ext_vector_type that is of identical size and number of
 | 
						|
// elements. For floating point vectors, return an integer type of identical
 | 
						|
// size and number of elements. In the non ext_vector_type case, search from
 | 
						|
// the largest type to the smallest type to avoid cases where long long == long,
 | 
						|
// where long gets picked over long long.
 | 
						|
QualType Sema::GetSignedVectorType(QualType V) {
 | 
						|
  const VectorType *VTy = V->castAs<VectorType>();
 | 
						|
  unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (isa<ExtVectorType>(VTy)) {
 | 
						|
    if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.CharTy))
 | 
						|
      return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.CharTy, VTy->getNumElements());
 | 
						|
    else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.ShortTy))
 | 
						|
      return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.ShortTy, VTy->getNumElements());
 | 
						|
    else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
 | 
						|
      return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
 | 
						|
    else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
 | 
						|
      return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
 | 
						|
    assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
 | 
						|
           "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
 | 
						|
    return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy))
 | 
						|
    return Context.getVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements(),
 | 
						|
                                 VectorType::GenericVector);
 | 
						|
  else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
 | 
						|
    return Context.getVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements(),
 | 
						|
                                 VectorType::GenericVector);
 | 
						|
  else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
 | 
						|
    return Context.getVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements(),
 | 
						|
                                 VectorType::GenericVector);
 | 
						|
  else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.ShortTy))
 | 
						|
    return Context.getVectorType(Context.ShortTy, VTy->getNumElements(),
 | 
						|
                                 VectorType::GenericVector);
 | 
						|
  assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.CharTy) &&
 | 
						|
         "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
 | 
						|
  return Context.getVectorType(Context.CharTy, VTy->getNumElements(),
 | 
						|
                               VectorType::GenericVector);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
 | 
						|
/// operates on extended vector types.  Instead of producing an IntTy result,
 | 
						|
/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
 | 
						|
/// types.
 | 
						|
QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                          SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                          BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
 | 
						|
  if (Opc == BO_Cmp) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(Loc, diag::err_three_way_vector_comparison);
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
 | 
						|
  // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
 | 
						|
  QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompAssign*/false,
 | 
						|
                              /*AllowBothBool*/true,
 | 
						|
                              /*AllowBoolConversions*/getLangOpts().ZVector);
 | 
						|
  if (vType.isNull())
 | 
						|
    return vType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If AltiVec, the comparison results in a numeric type, i.e.
 | 
						|
  // bool for C++, int for C
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().AltiVec &&
 | 
						|
      vType->castAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector)
 | 
						|
    return Context.getLogicalOperationType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
 | 
						|
  // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc.  These always evaluate to a constant, and
 | 
						|
  // often indicate logic errors in the program.
 | 
						|
  diagnoseTautologicalComparison(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
 | 
						|
  if (BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc) &&
 | 
						|
      LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
 | 
						|
    assert(RHS.get()->getType()->hasFloatingRepresentation());
 | 
						|
    CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Return a signed type for the vector.
 | 
						|
  return GetSignedVectorType(vType);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void diagnoseXorMisusedAsPow(Sema &S, const ExprResult &XorLHS,
 | 
						|
                                    const ExprResult &XorRHS,
 | 
						|
                                    const SourceLocation Loc) {
 | 
						|
  // Do not diagnose macros.
 | 
						|
  if (Loc.isMacroID())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool Negative = false;
 | 
						|
  bool ExplicitPlus = false;
 | 
						|
  const auto *LHSInt = dyn_cast<IntegerLiteral>(XorLHS.get());
 | 
						|
  const auto *RHSInt = dyn_cast<IntegerLiteral>(XorRHS.get());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!LHSInt)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  if (!RHSInt) {
 | 
						|
    // Check negative literals.
 | 
						|
    if (const auto *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(XorRHS.get())) {
 | 
						|
      UnaryOperatorKind Opc = UO->getOpcode();
 | 
						|
      if (Opc != UO_Minus && Opc != UO_Plus)
 | 
						|
        return;
 | 
						|
      RHSInt = dyn_cast<IntegerLiteral>(UO->getSubExpr());
 | 
						|
      if (!RHSInt)
 | 
						|
        return;
 | 
						|
      Negative = (Opc == UO_Minus);
 | 
						|
      ExplicitPlus = !Negative;
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      return;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  const llvm::APInt &LeftSideValue = LHSInt->getValue();
 | 
						|
  llvm::APInt RightSideValue = RHSInt->getValue();
 | 
						|
  if (LeftSideValue != 2 && LeftSideValue != 10)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LeftSideValue.getBitWidth() != RightSideValue.getBitWidth())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  CharSourceRange ExprRange = CharSourceRange::getCharRange(
 | 
						|
      LHSInt->getBeginLoc(), S.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSInt->getLocation()));
 | 
						|
  llvm::StringRef ExprStr =
 | 
						|
      Lexer::getSourceText(ExprRange, S.getSourceManager(), S.getLangOpts());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  CharSourceRange XorRange =
 | 
						|
      CharSourceRange::getCharRange(Loc, S.getLocForEndOfToken(Loc));
 | 
						|
  llvm::StringRef XorStr =
 | 
						|
      Lexer::getSourceText(XorRange, S.getSourceManager(), S.getLangOpts());
 | 
						|
  // Do not diagnose if xor keyword/macro is used.
 | 
						|
  if (XorStr == "xor")
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  std::string LHSStr = std::string(Lexer::getSourceText(
 | 
						|
      CharSourceRange::getTokenRange(LHSInt->getSourceRange()),
 | 
						|
      S.getSourceManager(), S.getLangOpts()));
 | 
						|
  std::string RHSStr = std::string(Lexer::getSourceText(
 | 
						|
      CharSourceRange::getTokenRange(RHSInt->getSourceRange()),
 | 
						|
      S.getSourceManager(), S.getLangOpts()));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Negative) {
 | 
						|
    RightSideValue = -RightSideValue;
 | 
						|
    RHSStr = "-" + RHSStr;
 | 
						|
  } else if (ExplicitPlus) {
 | 
						|
    RHSStr = "+" + RHSStr;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  StringRef LHSStrRef = LHSStr;
 | 
						|
  StringRef RHSStrRef = RHSStr;
 | 
						|
  // Do not diagnose literals with digit separators, binary, hexadecimal, octal
 | 
						|
  // literals.
 | 
						|
  if (LHSStrRef.startswith("0b") || LHSStrRef.startswith("0B") ||
 | 
						|
      RHSStrRef.startswith("0b") || RHSStrRef.startswith("0B") ||
 | 
						|
      LHSStrRef.startswith("0x") || LHSStrRef.startswith("0X") ||
 | 
						|
      RHSStrRef.startswith("0x") || RHSStrRef.startswith("0X") ||
 | 
						|
      (LHSStrRef.size() > 1 && LHSStrRef.startswith("0")) ||
 | 
						|
      (RHSStrRef.size() > 1 && RHSStrRef.startswith("0")) ||
 | 
						|
      LHSStrRef.find('\'') != StringRef::npos ||
 | 
						|
      RHSStrRef.find('\'') != StringRef::npos)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool SuggestXor = S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || S.getPreprocessor().isMacroDefined("xor");
 | 
						|
  const llvm::APInt XorValue = LeftSideValue ^ RightSideValue;
 | 
						|
  int64_t RightSideIntValue = RightSideValue.getSExtValue();
 | 
						|
  if (LeftSideValue == 2 && RightSideIntValue >= 0) {
 | 
						|
    std::string SuggestedExpr = "1 << " + RHSStr;
 | 
						|
    bool Overflow = false;
 | 
						|
    llvm::APInt One = (LeftSideValue - 1);
 | 
						|
    llvm::APInt PowValue = One.sshl_ov(RightSideValue, Overflow);
 | 
						|
    if (Overflow) {
 | 
						|
      if (RightSideIntValue < 64)
 | 
						|
        S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_xor_used_as_pow_base)
 | 
						|
            << ExprStr << XorValue.toString(10, true) << ("1LL << " + RHSStr)
 | 
						|
            << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(ExprRange, "1LL << " + RHSStr);
 | 
						|
      else if (RightSideIntValue == 64)
 | 
						|
        S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_xor_used_as_pow) << ExprStr << XorValue.toString(10, true);
 | 
						|
      else
 | 
						|
        return;
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_xor_used_as_pow_base_extra)
 | 
						|
          << ExprStr << XorValue.toString(10, true) << SuggestedExpr
 | 
						|
          << PowValue.toString(10, true)
 | 
						|
          << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(
 | 
						|
                 ExprRange, (RightSideIntValue == 0) ? "1" : SuggestedExpr);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_xor_used_as_pow_silence) << ("0x2 ^ " + RHSStr) << SuggestXor;
 | 
						|
  } else if (LeftSideValue == 10) {
 | 
						|
    std::string SuggestedValue = "1e" + std::to_string(RightSideIntValue);
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_xor_used_as_pow_base)
 | 
						|
        << ExprStr << XorValue.toString(10, true) << SuggestedValue
 | 
						|
        << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(ExprRange, SuggestedValue);
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_xor_used_as_pow_silence) << ("0xA ^ " + RHSStr) << SuggestXor;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
QualType Sema::CheckVectorLogicalOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                          SourceLocation Loc) {
 | 
						|
  // Ensure that either both operands are of the same vector type, or
 | 
						|
  // one operand is of a vector type and the other is of its element type.
 | 
						|
  QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, false,
 | 
						|
                                       /*AllowBothBool*/true,
 | 
						|
                                       /*AllowBoolConversions*/false);
 | 
						|
  if (vType.isNull())
 | 
						|
    return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120 &&
 | 
						|
      !getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus && vType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
 | 
						|
    return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: The check for C++ here is for GCC compatibility. GCC rejects the
 | 
						|
  //        usage of the logical operators && and || with vectors in C. This
 | 
						|
  //        check could be notionally dropped.
 | 
						|
  if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
 | 
						|
      !(isa<ExtVectorType>(vType->getAs<VectorType>())))
 | 
						|
    return InvalidLogicalVectorOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return GetSignedVectorType(LHS.get()->getType());
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                           SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                           BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
 | 
						|
  checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool IsCompAssign =
 | 
						|
      Opc == BO_AndAssign || Opc == BO_OrAssign || Opc == BO_XorAssign;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
 | 
						|
      RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
 | 
						|
        RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
 | 
						|
      return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign,
 | 
						|
                        /*AllowBothBool*/true,
 | 
						|
                        /*AllowBoolConversions*/getLangOpts().ZVector);
 | 
						|
    return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Opc == BO_And)
 | 
						|
    diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofCheck(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasFloatingRepresentation() ||
 | 
						|
      RHS.get()->getType()->hasFloatingRepresentation())
 | 
						|
    return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ExprResult LHSResult = LHS, RHSResult = RHS;
 | 
						|
  QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(
 | 
						|
      LHSResult, RHSResult, Loc, IsCompAssign ? ACK_CompAssign : ACK_BitwiseOp);
 | 
						|
  if (LHSResult.isInvalid() || RHSResult.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  LHS = LHSResult.get();
 | 
						|
  RHS = RHSResult.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Opc == BO_Xor)
 | 
						|
    diagnoseXorMisusedAsPow(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
 | 
						|
    return compType;
 | 
						|
  return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// C99 6.5.[13,14]
 | 
						|
inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                           SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                           BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
 | 
						|
  // Check vector operands differently.
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
 | 
						|
    return CheckVectorLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool EnumConstantInBoolContext = false;
 | 
						|
  for (const ExprResult &HS : {LHS, RHS}) {
 | 
						|
    if (const auto *DREHS = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(HS.get())) {
 | 
						|
      const auto *ECDHS = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(DREHS->getDecl());
 | 
						|
      if (ECDHS && ECDHS->getInitVal() != 0 && ECDHS->getInitVal() != 1)
 | 
						|
        EnumConstantInBoolContext = true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (EnumConstantInBoolContext)
 | 
						|
    Diag(Loc, diag::warn_enum_constant_in_bool_context);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
 | 
						|
  // bitwise one.  We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
 | 
						|
  // is a constant.
 | 
						|
  if (!EnumConstantInBoolContext && LHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
 | 
						|
      !LHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
 | 
						|
      RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() && !RHS.get()->isValueDependent() &&
 | 
						|
      // Don't warn in macros or template instantiations.
 | 
						|
      !Loc.isMacroID() && !inTemplateInstantiation()) {
 | 
						|
    // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
 | 
						|
    // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
 | 
						|
    // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
 | 
						|
    // Parens on the RHS are ignored.
 | 
						|
    Expr::EvalResult EVResult;
 | 
						|
    if (RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(EVResult, Context)) {
 | 
						|
      llvm::APSInt Result = EVResult.Val.getInt();
 | 
						|
      if ((getLangOpts().Bool && !RHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
 | 
						|
           !RHS.get()->getExprLoc().isMacroID()) ||
 | 
						|
          (Result != 0 && Result != 1)) {
 | 
						|
        Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
 | 
						|
          << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
          << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||");
 | 
						|
        // Suggest replacing the logical operator with the bitwise version
 | 
						|
        Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_change_operator)
 | 
						|
            << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|")
 | 
						|
            << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(
 | 
						|
                                                 Loc, getLocForEndOfToken(Loc)),
 | 
						|
                                            Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
 | 
						|
        if (Opc == BO_LAnd)
 | 
						|
          // Suggest replacing "Foo() && kNonZero" with "Foo()"
 | 
						|
          Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_remove_constant)
 | 
						|
              << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
 | 
						|
                     SourceRange(getLocForEndOfToken(LHS.get()->getEndLoc()),
 | 
						|
                                 RHS.get()->getEndLoc()));
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
    // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.g: The logical operators and (&&), or (||) do
 | 
						|
    // not operate on the built-in scalar and vector float types.
 | 
						|
    if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
 | 
						|
        Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) {
 | 
						|
      if (LHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType() ||
 | 
						|
          RHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType())
 | 
						|
        return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get());
 | 
						|
    if (LHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get());
 | 
						|
    if (RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (!LHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType() ||
 | 
						|
        !RHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType())
 | 
						|
      return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return Context.IntTy;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The following is safe because we only use this method for
 | 
						|
  // non-overloadable operands.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
 | 
						|
  // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
 | 
						|
  // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
 | 
						|
  ExprResult LHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(LHS.get());
 | 
						|
  if (LHSRes.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
  LHS = LHSRes;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ExprResult RHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(RHS.get());
 | 
						|
  if (RHSRes.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
  RHS = RHSRes;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
 | 
						|
  // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
 | 
						|
  // The result is a bool.
 | 
						|
  return Context.BoolTy;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static bool IsReadonlyMessage(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
 | 
						|
  const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E);
 | 
						|
  if (!ME) return false;
 | 
						|
  if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) return false;
 | 
						|
  ObjCMessageExpr *Base = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(
 | 
						|
      ME->getBase()->IgnoreImplicit()->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
 | 
						|
  if (!Base) return false;
 | 
						|
  return Base->getMethodDecl() != nullptr;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Is the given expression (which must be 'const') a reference to a
 | 
						|
/// variable which was originally non-const, but which has become
 | 
						|
/// 'const' due to being captured within a block?
 | 
						|
enum NonConstCaptureKind { NCCK_None, NCCK_Block, NCCK_Lambda };
 | 
						|
static NonConstCaptureKind isReferenceToNonConstCapture(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  assert(E->isLValue() && E->getType().isConstQualified());
 | 
						|
  E = E->IgnoreParens();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Must be a reference to a declaration from an enclosing scope.
 | 
						|
  DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E);
 | 
						|
  if (!DRE) return NCCK_None;
 | 
						|
  if (!DRE->refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture()) return NCCK_None;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The declaration must be a variable which is not declared 'const'.
 | 
						|
  VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
 | 
						|
  if (!var) return NCCK_None;
 | 
						|
  if (var->getType().isConstQualified()) return NCCK_None;
 | 
						|
  assert(var->hasLocalStorage() && "capture added 'const' to non-local?");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Decide whether the first capture was for a block or a lambda.
 | 
						|
  DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext, *Prev = nullptr;
 | 
						|
  // Decide whether the first capture was for a block or a lambda.
 | 
						|
  while (DC) {
 | 
						|
    // For init-capture, it is possible that the variable belongs to the
 | 
						|
    // template pattern of the current context.
 | 
						|
    if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
 | 
						|
      if (var->isInitCapture() &&
 | 
						|
          FD->getTemplateInstantiationPattern() == var->getDeclContext())
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
    if (DC == var->getDeclContext())
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    Prev = DC;
 | 
						|
    DC = DC->getParent();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  // Unless we have an init-capture, we've gone one step too far.
 | 
						|
  if (!var->isInitCapture())
 | 
						|
    DC = Prev;
 | 
						|
  return (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) ? NCCK_Block : NCCK_Lambda);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static bool IsTypeModifiable(QualType Ty, bool IsDereference) {
 | 
						|
  Ty = Ty.getNonReferenceType();
 | 
						|
  if (IsDereference && Ty->isPointerType())
 | 
						|
    Ty = Ty->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
  return !Ty.isConstQualified();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// Update err_typecheck_assign_const and note_typecheck_assign_const
 | 
						|
// when this enum is changed.
 | 
						|
enum {
 | 
						|
  ConstFunction,
 | 
						|
  ConstVariable,
 | 
						|
  ConstMember,
 | 
						|
  ConstMethod,
 | 
						|
  NestedConstMember,
 | 
						|
  ConstUnknown,  // Keep as last element
 | 
						|
};
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Emit the "read-only variable not assignable" error and print notes to give
 | 
						|
/// more information about why the variable is not assignable, such as pointing
 | 
						|
/// to the declaration of a const variable, showing that a method is const, or
 | 
						|
/// that the function is returning a const reference.
 | 
						|
static void DiagnoseConstAssignment(Sema &S, const Expr *E,
 | 
						|
                                    SourceLocation Loc) {
 | 
						|
  SourceRange ExprRange = E->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Only emit one error on the first const found.  All other consts will emit
 | 
						|
  // a note to the error.
 | 
						|
  bool DiagnosticEmitted = false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Track if the current expression is the result of a dereference, and if the
 | 
						|
  // next checked expression is the result of a dereference.
 | 
						|
  bool IsDereference = false;
 | 
						|
  bool NextIsDereference = false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Loop to process MemberExpr chains.
 | 
						|
  while (true) {
 | 
						|
    IsDereference = NextIsDereference;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    E = E->IgnoreImplicit()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
 | 
						|
    if (const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
      NextIsDereference = ME->isArrow();
 | 
						|
      const ValueDecl *VD = ME->getMemberDecl();
 | 
						|
      if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
 | 
						|
        // Mutable fields can be modified even if the class is const.
 | 
						|
        if (Field->isMutable()) {
 | 
						|
          assert(DiagnosticEmitted && "Expected diagnostic not emitted.");
 | 
						|
          break;
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        if (!IsTypeModifiable(Field->getType(), IsDereference)) {
 | 
						|
          if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
 | 
						|
            S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const)
 | 
						|
                << ExprRange << ConstMember << false /*static*/ << Field
 | 
						|
                << Field->getType();
 | 
						|
            DiagnosticEmitted = true;
 | 
						|
          }
 | 
						|
          S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
 | 
						|
              << ConstMember << false /*static*/ << Field << Field->getType()
 | 
						|
              << Field->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
        E = ME->getBase();
 | 
						|
        continue;
 | 
						|
      } else if (const VarDecl *VDecl = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD)) {
 | 
						|
        if (VDecl->getType().isConstQualified()) {
 | 
						|
          if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
 | 
						|
            S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const)
 | 
						|
                << ExprRange << ConstMember << true /*static*/ << VDecl
 | 
						|
                << VDecl->getType();
 | 
						|
            DiagnosticEmitted = true;
 | 
						|
          }
 | 
						|
          S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
 | 
						|
              << ConstMember << true /*static*/ << VDecl << VDecl->getType()
 | 
						|
              << VDecl->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
        // Static fields do not inherit constness from parents.
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      break; // End MemberExpr
 | 
						|
    } else if (const ArraySubscriptExpr *ASE =
 | 
						|
                   dyn_cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
      E = ASE->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
 | 
						|
      continue;
 | 
						|
    } else if (const ExtVectorElementExpr *EVE =
 | 
						|
                   dyn_cast<ExtVectorElementExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
      E = EVE->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
 | 
						|
      continue;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (const CallExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
    // Function calls
 | 
						|
    const FunctionDecl *FD = CE->getDirectCallee();
 | 
						|
    if (FD && !IsTypeModifiable(FD->getReturnType(), IsDereference)) {
 | 
						|
      if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
 | 
						|
        S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange
 | 
						|
                                                      << ConstFunction << FD;
 | 
						|
        DiagnosticEmitted = true;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange().getBegin(),
 | 
						|
             diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
 | 
						|
          << ConstFunction << FD << FD->getReturnType()
 | 
						|
          << FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } else if (const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
    // Point to variable declaration.
 | 
						|
    if (const ValueDecl *VD = DRE->getDecl()) {
 | 
						|
      if (!IsTypeModifiable(VD->getType(), IsDereference)) {
 | 
						|
        if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
 | 
						|
          S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const)
 | 
						|
              << ExprRange << ConstVariable << VD << VD->getType();
 | 
						|
          DiagnosticEmitted = true;
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
        S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
 | 
						|
            << ConstVariable << VD << VD->getType() << VD->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } else if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
    if (const DeclContext *DC = S.getFunctionLevelDeclContext()) {
 | 
						|
      if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
 | 
						|
        if (MD->isConst()) {
 | 
						|
          if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
 | 
						|
            S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange
 | 
						|
                                                          << ConstMethod << MD;
 | 
						|
            DiagnosticEmitted = true;
 | 
						|
          }
 | 
						|
          S.Diag(MD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
 | 
						|
              << ConstMethod << MD << MD->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (DiagnosticEmitted)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Can't determine a more specific message, so display the generic error.
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange << ConstUnknown;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
enum OriginalExprKind {
 | 
						|
  OEK_Variable,
 | 
						|
  OEK_Member,
 | 
						|
  OEK_LValue
 | 
						|
};
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(Sema &S, const ValueDecl *VD,
 | 
						|
                                         const RecordType *Ty,
 | 
						|
                                         SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange Range,
 | 
						|
                                         OriginalExprKind OEK,
 | 
						|
                                         bool &DiagnosticEmitted) {
 | 
						|
  std::vector<const RecordType *> RecordTypeList;
 | 
						|
  RecordTypeList.push_back(Ty);
 | 
						|
  unsigned NextToCheckIndex = 0;
 | 
						|
  // We walk the record hierarchy breadth-first to ensure that we print
 | 
						|
  // diagnostics in field nesting order.
 | 
						|
  while (RecordTypeList.size() > NextToCheckIndex) {
 | 
						|
    bool IsNested = NextToCheckIndex > 0;
 | 
						|
    for (const FieldDecl *Field :
 | 
						|
         RecordTypeList[NextToCheckIndex]->getDecl()->fields()) {
 | 
						|
      // First, check every field for constness.
 | 
						|
      QualType FieldTy = Field->getType();
 | 
						|
      if (FieldTy.isConstQualified()) {
 | 
						|
        if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
 | 
						|
          S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const)
 | 
						|
              << Range << NestedConstMember << OEK << VD
 | 
						|
              << IsNested << Field;
 | 
						|
          DiagnosticEmitted = true;
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
        S.Diag(Field->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
 | 
						|
            << NestedConstMember << IsNested << Field
 | 
						|
            << FieldTy << Field->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Then we append it to the list to check next in order.
 | 
						|
      FieldTy = FieldTy.getCanonicalType();
 | 
						|
      if (const auto *FieldRecTy = FieldTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
 | 
						|
        if (llvm::find(RecordTypeList, FieldRecTy) == RecordTypeList.end())
 | 
						|
          RecordTypeList.push_back(FieldRecTy);
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    ++NextToCheckIndex;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Emit an error for the case where a record we are trying to assign to has a
 | 
						|
/// const-qualified field somewhere in its hierarchy.
 | 
						|
static void DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(Sema &S, const Expr *E,
 | 
						|
                                         SourceLocation Loc) {
 | 
						|
  QualType Ty = E->getType();
 | 
						|
  assert(Ty->isRecordType() && "lvalue was not record?");
 | 
						|
  SourceRange Range = E->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
  const RecordType *RTy = Ty.getCanonicalType()->getAs<RecordType>();
 | 
						|
  bool DiagEmitted = false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, ME->getMemberDecl(), RTy, Loc,
 | 
						|
            Range, OEK_Member, DiagEmitted);
 | 
						|
  else if (const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E))
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, DRE->getDecl(), RTy, Loc,
 | 
						|
            Range, OEK_Variable, DiagEmitted);
 | 
						|
  else
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, nullptr, RTy, Loc,
 | 
						|
            Range, OEK_LValue, DiagEmitted);
 | 
						|
  if (!DiagEmitted)
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseConstAssignment(S, E, Loc);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue.  If not,
 | 
						|
/// emit an error and return true.  If so, return false.
 | 
						|
static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
 | 
						|
  assert(!E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  S.CheckShadowingDeclModification(E, Loc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
 | 
						|
  Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
 | 
						|
                                                              &Loc);
 | 
						|
  if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary && IsReadonlyMessage(E, S))
 | 
						|
    IsLV = Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression;
 | 
						|
  if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  unsigned DiagID = 0;
 | 
						|
  bool NeedType = false;
 | 
						|
  switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
 | 
						|
  case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified:
 | 
						|
    // Use a specialized diagnostic when we're assigning to an object
 | 
						|
    // from an enclosing function or block.
 | 
						|
    if (NonConstCaptureKind NCCK = isReferenceToNonConstCapture(S, E)) {
 | 
						|
      if (NCCK == NCCK_Block)
 | 
						|
        DiagID = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
 | 
						|
      else
 | 
						|
        DiagID = diag::err_lambda_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // In ARC, use some specialized diagnostics for occasions where we
 | 
						|
    // infer 'const'.  These are always pseudo-strong variables.
 | 
						|
    if (S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
 | 
						|
      DeclRefExpr *declRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts());
 | 
						|
      if (declRef && isa<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl())) {
 | 
						|
        VarDecl *var = cast<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        // Use the normal diagnostic if it's pseudo-__strong but the
 | 
						|
        // user actually wrote 'const'.
 | 
						|
        if (var->isARCPseudoStrong() &&
 | 
						|
            (!var->getTypeSourceInfo() ||
 | 
						|
             !var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType().isConstQualified())) {
 | 
						|
          // There are three pseudo-strong cases:
 | 
						|
          //  - self
 | 
						|
          ObjCMethodDecl *method = S.getCurMethodDecl();
 | 
						|
          if (method && var == method->getSelfDecl()) {
 | 
						|
            DiagID = method->isClassMethod()
 | 
						|
              ? diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self_class_method
 | 
						|
              : diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
          //  - Objective-C externally_retained attribute.
 | 
						|
          } else if (var->hasAttr<ObjCExternallyRetainedAttr>() ||
 | 
						|
                     isa<ParmVarDecl>(var)) {
 | 
						|
            DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_externally_retained;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
          //  - fast enumeration variables
 | 
						|
          } else {
 | 
						|
            DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_arr_assign_enumeration;
 | 
						|
          }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
          SourceRange Assign;
 | 
						|
          if (Loc != OrigLoc)
 | 
						|
            Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
 | 
						|
          S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
 | 
						|
          // We need to preserve the AST regardless, so migration tool
 | 
						|
          // can do its job.
 | 
						|
          return false;
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // If none of the special cases above are triggered, then this is a
 | 
						|
    // simple const assignment.
 | 
						|
    if (DiagID == 0) {
 | 
						|
      DiagnoseConstAssignment(S, E, Loc);
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case Expr::MLV_ConstAddrSpace:
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseConstAssignment(S, E, Loc);
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  case Expr::MLV_ConstQualifiedField:
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, E, Loc);
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
 | 
						|
  case Expr::MLV_ArrayTemporary:
 | 
						|
    DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
 | 
						|
    NeedType = true;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
 | 
						|
    DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
 | 
						|
    NeedType = true;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
 | 
						|
    DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case Expr::MLV_Valid:
 | 
						|
    llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
 | 
						|
  case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
 | 
						|
  case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
 | 
						|
  case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
 | 
						|
    DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
 | 
						|
  case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
 | 
						|
    return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
 | 
						|
             diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue, E);
 | 
						|
  case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
 | 
						|
    DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
 | 
						|
    llvm_unreachable("readonly properties should be processed differently");
 | 
						|
  case Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression:
 | 
						|
    DiagID = diag::err_readonly_message_assignment;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
 | 
						|
    DiagID = diag::err_no_subobject_property_setting;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  SourceRange Assign;
 | 
						|
  if (Loc != OrigLoc)
 | 
						|
    Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
 | 
						|
  if (NeedType)
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
 | 
						|
  else
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
 | 
						|
  return true;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
 | 
						|
                                         SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                         Sema &Sema) {
 | 
						|
  if (Sema.inTemplateInstantiation())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  if (Sema.isUnevaluatedContext())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  if (Loc.isInvalid() || Loc.isMacroID())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  if (LHSExpr->getExprLoc().isMacroID() || RHSExpr->getExprLoc().isMacroID())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C / C++ fields
 | 
						|
  MemberExpr *ML = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(LHSExpr);
 | 
						|
  MemberExpr *MR = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
  if (ML && MR) {
 | 
						|
    if (!(isa<CXXThisExpr>(ML->getBase()) && isa<CXXThisExpr>(MR->getBase())))
 | 
						|
      return;
 | 
						|
    const ValueDecl *LHSDecl =
 | 
						|
        cast<ValueDecl>(ML->getMemberDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
 | 
						|
    const ValueDecl *RHSDecl =
 | 
						|
        cast<ValueDecl>(MR->getMemberDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
 | 
						|
    if (LHSDecl != RHSDecl)
 | 
						|
      return;
 | 
						|
    if (LHSDecl->getType().isVolatileQualified())
 | 
						|
      return;
 | 
						|
    if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = LHSDecl->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>())
 | 
						|
      if (RefTy->getPointeeType().isVolatileQualified())
 | 
						|
        return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 0;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Objective-C instance variables
 | 
						|
  ObjCIvarRefExpr *OL = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHSExpr);
 | 
						|
  ObjCIvarRefExpr *OR = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
  if (OL && OR && OL->getDecl() == OR->getDecl()) {
 | 
						|
    DeclRefExpr *RL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OL->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts());
 | 
						|
    DeclRefExpr *RR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OR->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts());
 | 
						|
    if (RL && RR && RL->getDecl() == RR->getDecl())
 | 
						|
      Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 1;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// C99 6.5.16.1
 | 
						|
QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHSExpr, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                       SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                       QualType CompoundType) {
 | 
						|
  assert(!LHSExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
 | 
						|
  if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHSExpr, Loc, *this))
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType LHSType = LHSExpr->getType();
 | 
						|
  QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS.get()->getType() :
 | 
						|
                                             CompoundType;
 | 
						|
  // OpenCL v1.2 s6.1.1.1 p2:
 | 
						|
  // The half data type can only be used to declare a pointer to a buffer that
 | 
						|
  // contains half values
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp16") &&
 | 
						|
    LHSType->isHalfType()) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_half_load_store) << 1
 | 
						|
        << LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  AssignConvertType ConvTy;
 | 
						|
  if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
 | 
						|
    Expr *RHSCheck = RHS.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(LHSExpr, RHSCheck, Loc, *this);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
 | 
						|
    ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
 | 
						|
    if (RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
    // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
 | 
						|
    if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
 | 
						|
        ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
 | 
						|
          RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
 | 
						|
         (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
 | 
						|
          LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
 | 
						|
      ConvTy = Compatible;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (ConvTy == Compatible &&
 | 
						|
        LHSType->isObjCObjectType())
 | 
						|
        Diag(Loc, diag::err_objc_object_assignment)
 | 
						|
          << LHSType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
 | 
						|
    // right next to each other.  If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
 | 
						|
    // instead of "x += 4".
 | 
						|
    if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
 | 
						|
      RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
 | 
						|
    if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
 | 
						|
      if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus || UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
 | 
						|
          Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
 | 
						|
          // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
 | 
						|
          Loc.getLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
 | 
						|
          // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
 | 
						|
          // unary +/-.  We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
 | 
						|
          Loc.getLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getBeginLoc() &&
 | 
						|
          UO->getSubExpr()->getBeginLoc().isFileID()) {
 | 
						|
        Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
 | 
						|
          << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
 | 
						|
          << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (ConvTy == Compatible) {
 | 
						|
      if (LHSType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong) {
 | 
						|
        // Warn about retain cycles where a block captures the LHS, but
 | 
						|
        // not if the LHS is a simple variable into which the block is
 | 
						|
        // being stored...unless that variable can be captured by reference!
 | 
						|
        const Expr *InnerLHS = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenCasts();
 | 
						|
        const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InnerLHS);
 | 
						|
        if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl()->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>())
 | 
						|
          checkRetainCycles(LHSExpr, RHS.get());
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (LHSType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong ||
 | 
						|
          LHSType.isNonWeakInMRRWithObjCWeak(Context)) {
 | 
						|
        // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable.
 | 
						|
        // Although this code can still have problems:
 | 
						|
        //   id x = self.weakProp;
 | 
						|
        //   id y = self.weakProp;
 | 
						|
        // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate
 | 
						|
        // paths through the function. This should be revisited if
 | 
						|
        // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive.
 | 
						|
        // For ObjCWeak only, we do not warn if the assign is to a non-weak
 | 
						|
        // variable, which will be valid for the current autorelease scope.
 | 
						|
        if (!Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak,
 | 
						|
                             RHS.get()->getBeginLoc()))
 | 
						|
          getCurFunction()->markSafeWeakUse(RHS.get());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      } else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount || getLangOpts().ObjCWeak) {
 | 
						|
        checkUnsafeExprAssigns(Loc, LHSExpr, RHS.get());
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    // Compound assignment "x += y"
 | 
						|
    ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(Loc, LHSType, RHSType);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
 | 
						|
                               RHS.get(), AA_Assigning))
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, LHSExpr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a && LHSType.isVolatileQualified()) {
 | 
						|
    if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
 | 
						|
      // C++2a [expr.ass]p5:
 | 
						|
      //   A simple-assignment whose left operand is of a volatile-qualified
 | 
						|
      //   type is deprecated unless the assignment is either a discarded-value
 | 
						|
      //   expression or an unevaluated operand
 | 
						|
      ExprEvalContexts.back().VolatileAssignmentLHSs.push_back(LHSExpr);
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      // C++2a [expr.ass]p6:
 | 
						|
      //   [Compound-assignment] expressions are deprecated if E1 has
 | 
						|
      //   volatile-qualified type
 | 
						|
      Diag(Loc, diag::warn_deprecated_compound_assign_volatile) << LHSType;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
 | 
						|
  // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
 | 
						|
  // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
 | 
						|
  // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
 | 
						|
  // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
 | 
						|
  // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
 | 
						|
  // operand.
 | 
						|
  return (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
 | 
						|
          ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType());
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// Only ignore explicit casts to void.
 | 
						|
static bool IgnoreCommaOperand(const Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  E = E->IgnoreParens();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (const CastExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CastExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
    if (CE->getCastKind() == CK_ToVoid) {
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // static_cast<void> on a dependent type will not show up as CK_ToVoid.
 | 
						|
    if (CE->getCastKind() == CK_Dependent && E->getType()->isVoidType() &&
 | 
						|
        CE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isDependentType()) {
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// Look for instances where it is likely the comma operator is confused with
 | 
						|
// another operator.  There is a whitelist of acceptable expressions for the
 | 
						|
// left hand side of the comma operator, otherwise emit a warning.
 | 
						|
void Sema::DiagnoseCommaOperator(const Expr *LHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
 | 
						|
  // No warnings in macros
 | 
						|
  if (Loc.isMacroID())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Don't warn in template instantiations.
 | 
						|
  if (inTemplateInstantiation())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Scope isn't fine-grained enough to whitelist the specific cases, so
 | 
						|
  // instead, skip more than needed, then call back into here with the
 | 
						|
  // CommaVisitor in SemaStmt.cpp.
 | 
						|
  // The whitelisted locations are the initialization and increment portions
 | 
						|
  // of a for loop.  The additional checks are on the condition of
 | 
						|
  // if statements, do/while loops, and for loops.
 | 
						|
  // Differences in scope flags for C89 mode requires the extra logic.
 | 
						|
  const unsigned ForIncrementFlags =
 | 
						|
      getLangOpts().C99 || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
 | 
						|
          ? Scope::ControlScope | Scope::ContinueScope | Scope::BreakScope
 | 
						|
          : Scope::ContinueScope | Scope::BreakScope;
 | 
						|
  const unsigned ForInitFlags = Scope::ControlScope | Scope::DeclScope;
 | 
						|
  const unsigned ScopeFlags = getCurScope()->getFlags();
 | 
						|
  if ((ScopeFlags & ForIncrementFlags) == ForIncrementFlags ||
 | 
						|
      (ScopeFlags & ForInitFlags) == ForInitFlags)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If there are multiple comma operators used together, get the RHS of the
 | 
						|
  // of the comma operator as the LHS.
 | 
						|
  while (const BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHS)) {
 | 
						|
    if (BO->getOpcode() != BO_Comma)
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    LHS = BO->getRHS();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Only allow some expressions on LHS to not warn.
 | 
						|
  if (IgnoreCommaOperand(LHS))
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Diag(Loc, diag::warn_comma_operator);
 | 
						|
  Diag(LHS->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_cast_to_void)
 | 
						|
      << LHS->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
      << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHS->getBeginLoc(),
 | 
						|
                                    LangOpts.CPlusPlus ? "static_cast<void>("
 | 
						|
                                                       : "(void)(")
 | 
						|
      << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(LHS->getEndLoc()),
 | 
						|
                                    ")");
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// C99 6.5.17
 | 
						|
static QualType CheckCommaOperands(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
 | 
						|
                                   SourceLocation Loc) {
 | 
						|
  LHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get());
 | 
						|
  RHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get());
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its
 | 
						|
  // operands, but not unary promotions.
 | 
						|
  // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // So we treat the LHS as a ignored value, and in C++ we allow the
 | 
						|
  // containing site to determine what should be done with the RHS.
 | 
						|
  LHS = S.IgnoredValueConversions(LHS.get());
 | 
						|
  if (LHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  S.DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS.get());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
    RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
 | 
						|
    if (RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
    if (!RHS.get()->getType()->isVoidType())
 | 
						|
      S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS.get()->getType(),
 | 
						|
                            diag::err_incomplete_type);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!S.getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_comma_operator, Loc))
 | 
						|
    S.DiagnoseCommaOperator(LHS.get(), Loc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return RHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
 | 
						|
/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
 | 
						|
static QualType CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op,
 | 
						|
                                               ExprValueKind &VK,
 | 
						|
                                               ExprObjectKind &OK,
 | 
						|
                                               SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                                               bool IsInc, bool IsPrefix) {
 | 
						|
  if (Op->isTypeDependent())
 | 
						|
    return S.Context.DependentTy;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType ResType = Op->getType();
 | 
						|
  // Atomic types can be used for increment / decrement where the non-atomic
 | 
						|
  // versions can, so ignore the _Atomic() specifier for the purpose of
 | 
						|
  // checking.
 | 
						|
  if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>())
 | 
						|
    ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
 | 
						|
    // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
 | 
						|
    if (!IsInc) {
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(OpLoc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_increment_bool
 | 
						|
                                              : diag::warn_increment_bool)
 | 
						|
      << Op->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
  } else if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isEnumeralType()) {
 | 
						|
    // Error on enum increments and decrements in C++ mode
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_increment_decrement_enum) << IsInc << ResType;
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
 | 
						|
    // OK!
 | 
						|
  } else if (ResType->isPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
    // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
 | 
						|
    if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(S, OpLoc, Op))
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
  } else if (ResType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
    // On modern runtimes, ObjC pointer arithmetic is forbidden.
 | 
						|
    // Otherwise, we just need a complete type.
 | 
						|
    if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, OpLoc, Op) ||
 | 
						|
        checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(S, OpLoc, Op))
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
  } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
 | 
						|
    // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
 | 
						|
      << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
  } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) {
 | 
						|
    ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op);
 | 
						|
    if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
 | 
						|
    return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OK, OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                                          IsInc, IsPrefix);
 | 
						|
  } else if (S.getLangOpts().AltiVec && ResType->isVectorType()) {
 | 
						|
    // OK! ( C/C++ Language Extensions for CBEA(Version 2.6) 10.3 )
 | 
						|
  } else if (S.getLangOpts().ZVector && ResType->isVectorType() &&
 | 
						|
             (ResType->castAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() !=
 | 
						|
              VectorType::AltiVecBool)) {
 | 
						|
    // The z vector extensions allow ++ and -- for non-bool vectors.
 | 
						|
  } else if(S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && ResType->isVectorType() &&
 | 
						|
            ResType->castAs<VectorType>()->getElementType()->isIntegerType()) {
 | 
						|
    // OpenCL V1.2 6.3 says dec/inc ops operate on integer vector types.
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
 | 
						|
      << ResType << int(IsInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
 | 
						|
  // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
 | 
						|
  if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, S))
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a && ResType.isVolatileQualified()) {
 | 
						|
    // C++2a [expr.pre.inc]p1, [expr.post.inc]p1:
 | 
						|
    //   An operand with volatile-qualified type is deprecated
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_deprecated_increment_decrement_volatile)
 | 
						|
        << IsInc << ResType;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
 | 
						|
  // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
 | 
						|
  // operand.
 | 
						|
  if (IsPrefix && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
    VK = VK_LValue;
 | 
						|
    OK = Op->getObjectKind();
 | 
						|
    return ResType;
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    VK = VK_RValue;
 | 
						|
    return ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
 | 
						|
/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
 | 
						|
/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
 | 
						|
/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
 | 
						|
/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
 | 
						|
///  - &(x) => x
 | 
						|
///  - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
 | 
						|
///  - &s.xx => s
 | 
						|
///  - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
 | 
						|
///  - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
 | 
						|
///  - &"123"[2] -> 0
 | 
						|
///  - & __real__ x -> x
 | 
						|
static ValueDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
 | 
						|
  case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
 | 
						|
    return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
 | 
						|
  case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
 | 
						|
    // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
 | 
						|
    // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
 | 
						|
    // irrelevant.
 | 
						|
    if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
 | 
						|
      return nullptr;
 | 
						|
    // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
 | 
						|
    return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
 | 
						|
  case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
 | 
						|
    // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary!  We should catch the implicit
 | 
						|
    // promotion of register arrays earlier.
 | 
						|
    Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
 | 
						|
    if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
 | 
						|
      if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
 | 
						|
        return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    return nullptr;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
 | 
						|
    UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
 | 
						|
    case UO_Real:
 | 
						|
    case UO_Imag:
 | 
						|
    case UO_Extension:
 | 
						|
      return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
 | 
						|
    default:
 | 
						|
      return nullptr;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
 | 
						|
    return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
 | 
						|
  case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
 | 
						|
    // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
 | 
						|
    // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
 | 
						|
    return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
 | 
						|
  default:
 | 
						|
    return nullptr;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
namespace {
 | 
						|
  enum {
 | 
						|
    AO_Bit_Field = 0,
 | 
						|
    AO_Vector_Element = 1,
 | 
						|
    AO_Property_Expansion = 2,
 | 
						|
    AO_Register_Variable = 3,
 | 
						|
    AO_No_Error = 4
 | 
						|
  };
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
/// Diagnose invalid operand for address of operations.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// \param Type The type of operand which cannot have its address taken.
 | 
						|
static void diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                         Expr *E, unsigned Type) {
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of) << Type << E->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
 | 
						|
/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
 | 
						|
/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
 | 
						|
/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
 | 
						|
/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
 | 
						|
/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
 | 
						|
/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
 | 
						|
QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(ExprResult &OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
 | 
						|
  if (const BuiltinType *PTy = OrigOp.get()->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()){
 | 
						|
    if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
 | 
						|
      Expr *E = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens();
 | 
						|
      if (!isa<OverloadExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
        assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf);
 | 
						|
        Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof_addrof_function)
 | 
						|
          << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
        return QualType();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      OverloadExpr *Ovl = cast<OverloadExpr>(E);
 | 
						|
      if (isa<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(Ovl))
 | 
						|
        if (!ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Ovl)) {
 | 
						|
          Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
 | 
						|
            << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
          return QualType();
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      return Context.OverloadTy;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny)
 | 
						|
      return Context.UnknownAnyTy;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
 | 
						|
        << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    OrigOp = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp.get());
 | 
						|
    if (OrigOp.isInvalid()) return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (OrigOp.get()->isTypeDependent())
 | 
						|
    return Context.DependentTy;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  assert(!OrigOp.get()->getType()->isPlaceholderType());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
 | 
						|
  Expr *op = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // In OpenCL captures for blocks called as lambda functions
 | 
						|
  // are located in the private address space. Blocks used in
 | 
						|
  // enqueue_kernel can be located in a different address space
 | 
						|
  // depending on a vendor implementation. Thus preventing
 | 
						|
  // taking an address of the capture to avoid invalid AS casts.
 | 
						|
  if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
 | 
						|
    auto* VarRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
 | 
						|
    if (VarRef && VarRef->refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture()) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(op->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_taking_address_capture);
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().C99) {
 | 
						|
    // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
 | 
						|
    if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
 | 
						|
      if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
 | 
						|
        // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
 | 
						|
        // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
 | 
						|
        return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
 | 
						|
    // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  ValueDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
 | 
						|
    if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, /*Complain=*/true,
 | 
						|
                                           op->getBeginLoc()))
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Expr::LValueClassification lval = op->ClassifyLValue(Context);
 | 
						|
  unsigned AddressOfError = AO_No_Error;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary || lval == Expr::LV_ArrayTemporary) {
 | 
						|
    bool sfinae = (bool)isSFINAEContext();
 | 
						|
    Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_temporary
 | 
						|
                                  : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_temporary)
 | 
						|
      << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    if (sfinae)
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
    // Materialize the temporary as an lvalue so that we can take its address.
 | 
						|
    OrigOp = op =
 | 
						|
        CreateMaterializeTemporaryExpr(op->getType(), OrigOp.get(), true);
 | 
						|
  } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
 | 
						|
    return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
 | 
						|
  } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
 | 
						|
    // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
 | 
						|
    // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
 | 
						|
    if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
 | 
						|
        << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      return QualType();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
 | 
						|
    CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // The id-expression was parenthesized.
 | 
						|
    if (OrigOp.get() != DRE) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
 | 
						|
        << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // The method was named without a qualifier.
 | 
						|
    } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
 | 
						|
      if (MD->getParent()->getName().empty())
 | 
						|
        Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
 | 
						|
          << op->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      else {
 | 
						|
        SmallString<32> Str;
 | 
						|
        StringRef Qual = (MD->getParent()->getName() + "::").toStringRef(Str);
 | 
						|
        Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
 | 
						|
          << op->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
          << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(op->getSourceRange().getBegin(), Qual);
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Taking the address of a dtor is illegal per C++ [class.dtor]p2.
 | 
						|
    if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD))
 | 
						|
      Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_addrof_dtor) << op->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType(
 | 
						|
        op->getType(), Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
 | 
						|
    // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now.
 | 
						|
    if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
 | 
						|
      (void)isCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy);
 | 
						|
    return MPTy;
 | 
						|
  } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
 | 
						|
    // C99 6.5.3.2p1
 | 
						|
    // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
 | 
						|
    if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
 | 
						|
      // Use a special diagnostic for loads from property references.
 | 
						|
      if (isa<PseudoObjectExpr>(op)) {
 | 
						|
        AddressOfError = AO_Property_Expansion;
 | 
						|
      } else {
 | 
						|
        Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
 | 
						|
          << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
        return QualType();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
 | 
						|
    // The operand cannot be a bit-field
 | 
						|
    AddressOfError = AO_Bit_Field;
 | 
						|
  } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_VectorComponent) {
 | 
						|
    // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
 | 
						|
    AddressOfError = AO_Vector_Element;
 | 
						|
  } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
 | 
						|
    // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
 | 
						|
    // with the register storage-class specifier.
 | 
						|
    if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
 | 
						|
      // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
 | 
						|
      // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
 | 
						|
      if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
 | 
						|
          !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
        AddressOfError = AO_Register_Variable;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    } else if (isa<MSPropertyDecl>(dcl)) {
 | 
						|
      AddressOfError = AO_Property_Expansion;
 | 
						|
    } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
 | 
						|
      return Context.OverloadTy;
 | 
						|
    } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(dcl) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(dcl)) {
 | 
						|
      // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
 | 
						|
      // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
 | 
						|
      // scope qualifier for the class.
 | 
						|
      if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
 | 
						|
        DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
 | 
						|
        if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
 | 
						|
          if (dcl->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
 | 
						|
            Diag(OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
 | 
						|
              << dcl->getDeclName() << dcl->getType();
 | 
						|
            return QualType();
 | 
						|
          }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
          while (cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
 | 
						|
            Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
          QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType(
 | 
						|
              op->getType(),
 | 
						|
              Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
 | 
						|
          // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now.
 | 
						|
          if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
 | 
						|
            (void)isCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy);
 | 
						|
          return MPTy;
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl) && !isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(dcl) &&
 | 
						|
               !isa<BindingDecl>(dcl))
 | 
						|
      llvm_unreachable("Unknown/unexpected decl type");
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (AddressOfError != AO_No_Error) {
 | 
						|
    diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(*this, OpLoc, op, AddressOfError);
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
 | 
						|
    // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
 | 
						|
    // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
 | 
						|
    // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
 | 
						|
    Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
 | 
						|
  if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
 | 
						|
    return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  CheckAddressOfPackedMember(op);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void RecordModifiableNonNullParam(Sema &S, const Expr *Exp) {
 | 
						|
  const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Exp);
 | 
						|
  if (!DRE)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  const Decl *D = DRE->getDecl();
 | 
						|
  if (!D)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  const ParmVarDecl *Param = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D);
 | 
						|
  if (!Param)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  if (const FunctionDecl* FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Param->getDeclContext()))
 | 
						|
    if (!FD->hasAttr<NonNullAttr>() && !Param->hasAttr<NonNullAttr>())
 | 
						|
      return;
 | 
						|
  if (FunctionScopeInfo *FD = S.getCurFunction())
 | 
						|
    if (!FD->ModifiedNonNullParams.count(Param))
 | 
						|
      FD->ModifiedNonNullParams.insert(Param);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
 | 
						|
static QualType CheckIndirectionOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op, ExprValueKind &VK,
 | 
						|
                                        SourceLocation OpLoc) {
 | 
						|
  if (Op->isTypeDependent())
 | 
						|
    return S.Context.DependentTy;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ExprResult ConvResult = S.UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
 | 
						|
  if (ConvResult.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  Op = ConvResult.get();
 | 
						|
  QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
 | 
						|
  QualType Result;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (isa<CXXReinterpretCastExpr>(Op)) {
 | 
						|
    QualType OpOrigType = Op->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType();
 | 
						|
    S.CheckCompatibleReinterpretCast(OpOrigType, OpTy, /*IsDereference*/true,
 | 
						|
                                     Op->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
 | 
						|
  {
 | 
						|
    Result = PT->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
 | 
						|
             OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
 | 
						|
    Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
  else {
 | 
						|
    ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op);
 | 
						|
    if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
 | 
						|
    if (PR.get() != Op)
 | 
						|
      return CheckIndirectionOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OpLoc);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Result.isNull()) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
 | 
						|
      << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if Result
 | 
						|
  // is an incomplete type or void.  It would be possible to warn about
 | 
						|
  // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
 | 
						|
  // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes. In C++, indirection is not valid
 | 
						|
  // for pointers to 'void' but is fine for any other pointer type:
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // C++ [expr.unary.op]p1:
 | 
						|
  //   [...] the expression to which [the unary * operator] is applied shall
 | 
						|
  //   be a pointer to an object type, or a pointer to a function type
 | 
						|
  if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result->isVoidType())
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_indirection_through_void_pointer)
 | 
						|
      << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Dereferences are usually l-values...
 | 
						|
  VK = VK_LValue;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // ...except that certain expressions are never l-values in C.
 | 
						|
  if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result.isCForbiddenLValueType())
 | 
						|
    VK = VK_RValue;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return Result;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
BinaryOperatorKind Sema::ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(tok::TokenKind Kind) {
 | 
						|
  BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
 | 
						|
  switch (Kind) {
 | 
						|
  default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown binop!");
 | 
						|
  case tok::periodstar:           Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::arrowstar:            Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::star:                 Opc = BO_Mul; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::slash:                Opc = BO_Div; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::percent:              Opc = BO_Rem; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::plus:                 Opc = BO_Add; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::minus:                Opc = BO_Sub; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::lessless:             Opc = BO_Shl; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::greatergreater:       Opc = BO_Shr; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::lessequal:            Opc = BO_LE; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::less:                 Opc = BO_LT; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::greaterequal:         Opc = BO_GE; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::greater:              Opc = BO_GT; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::exclaimequal:         Opc = BO_NE; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::equalequal:           Opc = BO_EQ; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::spaceship:            Opc = BO_Cmp; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::amp:                  Opc = BO_And; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::caret:                Opc = BO_Xor; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::pipe:                 Opc = BO_Or; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::ampamp:               Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::pipepipe:             Opc = BO_LOr; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::equal:                Opc = BO_Assign; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::starequal:            Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::slashequal:           Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::percentequal:         Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::plusequal:            Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::minusequal:           Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::lesslessequal:        Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::greatergreaterequal:  Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::ampequal:             Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::caretequal:           Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::pipeequal:            Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::comma:                Opc = BO_Comma; break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return Opc;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
 | 
						|
  tok::TokenKind Kind) {
 | 
						|
  UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
 | 
						|
  switch (Kind) {
 | 
						|
  default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!");
 | 
						|
  case tok::plusplus:     Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::minusminus:   Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::amp:          Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::star:         Opc = UO_Deref; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::plus:         Opc = UO_Plus; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::minus:        Opc = UO_Minus; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::tilde:        Opc = UO_Not; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::exclaim:      Opc = UO_LNot; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::kw___real:    Opc = UO_Real; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::kw___imag:    Opc = UO_Imag; break;
 | 
						|
  case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return Opc;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// DiagnoseSelfAssignment - Emits a warning if a value is assigned to itself.
 | 
						|
/// This warning suppressed in the event of macro expansions.
 | 
						|
static void DiagnoseSelfAssignment(Sema &S, Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
 | 
						|
                                   SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsBuiltin) {
 | 
						|
  if (S.inTemplateInstantiation())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  if (S.isUnevaluatedContext())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  if (OpLoc.isInvalid() || OpLoc.isMacroID())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  LHSExpr = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
 | 
						|
  RHSExpr = RHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
 | 
						|
  const DeclRefExpr *LHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSExpr);
 | 
						|
  const DeclRefExpr *RHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
  if (!LHSDeclRef || !RHSDeclRef ||
 | 
						|
      LHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID() ||
 | 
						|
      RHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  const ValueDecl *LHSDecl =
 | 
						|
    cast<ValueDecl>(LHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
 | 
						|
  const ValueDecl *RHSDecl =
 | 
						|
    cast<ValueDecl>(RHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
 | 
						|
  if (LHSDecl != RHSDecl)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  if (LHSDecl->getType().isVolatileQualified())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = LHSDecl->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>())
 | 
						|
    if (RefTy->getPointeeType().isVolatileQualified())
 | 
						|
      return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(OpLoc, IsBuiltin ? diag::warn_self_assignment_builtin
 | 
						|
                          : diag::warn_self_assignment_overloaded)
 | 
						|
      << LHSDeclRef->getType() << LHSExpr->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
      << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Check if a bitwise-& is performed on an Objective-C pointer.  This
 | 
						|
/// is usually indicative of introspection within the Objective-C pointer.
 | 
						|
static void checkObjCPointerIntrospection(Sema &S, ExprResult &L, ExprResult &R,
 | 
						|
                                          SourceLocation OpLoc) {
 | 
						|
  if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  const Expr *ObjCPointerExpr = nullptr, *OtherExpr = nullptr;
 | 
						|
  const Expr *LHS = L.get();
 | 
						|
  const Expr *RHS = R.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
    ObjCPointerExpr = LHS;
 | 
						|
    OtherExpr = RHS;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  else if (RHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
    ObjCPointerExpr = RHS;
 | 
						|
    OtherExpr = LHS;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // This warning is deliberately made very specific to reduce false
 | 
						|
  // positives with logic that uses '&' for hashing.  This logic mainly
 | 
						|
  // looks for code trying to introspect into tagged pointers, which
 | 
						|
  // code should generally never do.
 | 
						|
  if (ObjCPointerExpr && isa<IntegerLiteral>(OtherExpr->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
 | 
						|
    unsigned Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking;
 | 
						|
    // Determine if we are introspecting the result of performSelectorXXX.
 | 
						|
    const Expr *Ex = ObjCPointerExpr->IgnoreParenCasts();
 | 
						|
    // Special case messages to -performSelector and friends, which
 | 
						|
    // can return non-pointer values boxed in a pointer value.
 | 
						|
    // Some clients may wish to silence warnings in this subcase.
 | 
						|
    if (const ObjCMessageExpr *ME = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Ex)) {
 | 
						|
      Selector S = ME->getSelector();
 | 
						|
      StringRef SelArg0 = S.getNameForSlot(0);
 | 
						|
      if (SelArg0.startswith("performSelector"))
 | 
						|
        Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking_performSelector;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(OpLoc, Diag)
 | 
						|
      << ObjCPointerExpr->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static NamedDecl *getDeclFromExpr(Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  if (!E)
 | 
						|
    return nullptr;
 | 
						|
  if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E))
 | 
						|
    return DRE->getDecl();
 | 
						|
  if (auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
 | 
						|
    return ME->getMemberDecl();
 | 
						|
  if (auto *IRE = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E))
 | 
						|
    return IRE->getDecl();
 | 
						|
  return nullptr;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// This helper function promotes a binary operator's operands (which are of a
 | 
						|
// half vector type) to a vector of floats and then truncates the result to
 | 
						|
// a vector of either half or short.
 | 
						|
static ExprResult convertHalfVecBinOp(Sema &S, ExprResult LHS, ExprResult RHS,
 | 
						|
                                      BinaryOperatorKind Opc, QualType ResultTy,
 | 
						|
                                      ExprValueKind VK, ExprObjectKind OK,
 | 
						|
                                      bool IsCompAssign, SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                                      FPOptions FPFeatures) {
 | 
						|
  auto &Context = S.getASTContext();
 | 
						|
  assert((isVector(ResultTy, Context.HalfTy) ||
 | 
						|
          isVector(ResultTy, Context.ShortTy)) &&
 | 
						|
         "Result must be a vector of half or short");
 | 
						|
  assert(isVector(LHS.get()->getType(), Context.HalfTy) &&
 | 
						|
         isVector(RHS.get()->getType(), Context.HalfTy) &&
 | 
						|
         "both operands expected to be a half vector");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  RHS = convertVector(RHS.get(), Context.FloatTy, S);
 | 
						|
  QualType BinOpResTy = RHS.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If Opc is a comparison, ResultType is a vector of shorts. In that case,
 | 
						|
  // change BinOpResTy to a vector of ints.
 | 
						|
  if (isVector(ResultTy, Context.ShortTy))
 | 
						|
    BinOpResTy = S.GetSignedVectorType(BinOpResTy);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (IsCompAssign)
 | 
						|
    return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(
 | 
						|
        LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, BinOpResTy, BinOpResTy,
 | 
						|
        OpLoc, FPFeatures);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  LHS = convertVector(LHS.get(), Context.FloatTy, S);
 | 
						|
  auto *BO = new (Context) BinaryOperator(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, BinOpResTy,
 | 
						|
                                          VK, OK, OpLoc, FPFeatures);
 | 
						|
  return convertVector(BO, ResultTy->castAs<VectorType>()->getElementType(), S);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static std::pair<ExprResult, ExprResult>
 | 
						|
CorrectDelayedTyposInBinOp(Sema &S, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *LHSExpr,
 | 
						|
                           Expr *RHSExpr) {
 | 
						|
  ExprResult LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr;
 | 
						|
  if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
    // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes on either side of a binop because it
 | 
						|
    // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have
 | 
						|
    // been dealt with before checking the operands.
 | 
						|
    LHS = S.CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(LHS);
 | 
						|
    RHS = S.CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(RHS, [Opc, LHS](Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
      if (Opc != BO_Assign)
 | 
						|
        return ExprResult(E);
 | 
						|
      // Avoid correcting the RHS to the same Expr as the LHS.
 | 
						|
      Decl *D = getDeclFromExpr(E);
 | 
						|
      return (D && D == getDeclFromExpr(LHS.get())) ? ExprError() : E;
 | 
						|
    });
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return std::make_pair(LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Returns true if conversion between vectors of halfs and vectors of floats
 | 
						|
/// is needed.
 | 
						|
static bool needsConversionOfHalfVec(bool OpRequiresConversion, ASTContext &Ctx,
 | 
						|
                                     QualType SrcType) {
 | 
						|
  return OpRequiresConversion && !Ctx.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType &&
 | 
						|
         !Ctx.getTargetInfo().useFP16ConversionIntrinsics() &&
 | 
						|
         isVector(SrcType, Ctx.HalfTy);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
 | 
						|
/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
 | 
						|
/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                                    BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
 | 
						|
                                    Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isa<InitListExpr>(RHSExpr)) {
 | 
						|
    // The syntax only allows initializer lists on the RHS of assignment,
 | 
						|
    // so we don't need to worry about accepting invalid code for
 | 
						|
    // non-assignment operators.
 | 
						|
    // C++11 5.17p9:
 | 
						|
    //   The meaning of x = {v} [...] is that of x = T(v) [...]. The meaning
 | 
						|
    //   of x = {} is x = T().
 | 
						|
    InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateDirectList(
 | 
						|
        RHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc());
 | 
						|
    InitializedEntity Entity =
 | 
						|
        InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(LHSExpr->getType());
 | 
						|
    InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
    if (Init.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return Init;
 | 
						|
    RHSExpr = Init.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ExprResult LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr;
 | 
						|
  QualType ResultTy;     // Result type of the binary operator.
 | 
						|
  // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
 | 
						|
  QualType CompLHSTy;    // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
 | 
						|
  QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
 | 
						|
  ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
 | 
						|
  ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
 | 
						|
  bool ConvertHalfVec = false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  std::tie(LHS, RHS) = CorrectDelayedTyposInBinOp(*this, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
  if (!LHS.isUsable() || !RHS.isUsable())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
 | 
						|
    QualType LHSTy = LHSExpr->getType();
 | 
						|
    QualType RHSTy = RHSExpr->getType();
 | 
						|
    // OpenCLC v2.0 s6.13.11.1 allows atomic variables to be initialized by
 | 
						|
    // the ATOMIC_VAR_INIT macro.
 | 
						|
    if (LHSTy->isAtomicType() || RHSTy->isAtomicType()) {
 | 
						|
      SourceRange SR(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc());
 | 
						|
      if (BO_Assign == Opc)
 | 
						|
        Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_opencl_atomic_init) << 0 << SR;
 | 
						|
      else
 | 
						|
        ResultTy = InvalidOperands(OpLoc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // OpenCL special types - image, sampler, pipe, and blocks are to be used
 | 
						|
    // only with a builtin functions and therefore should be disallowed here.
 | 
						|
    if (LHSTy->isImageType() || RHSTy->isImageType() ||
 | 
						|
        LHSTy->isSamplerT() || RHSTy->isSamplerT() ||
 | 
						|
        LHSTy->isPipeType() || RHSTy->isPipeType() ||
 | 
						|
        LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
      ResultTy = InvalidOperands(OpLoc, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Diagnose operations on the unsupported types for OpenMP device compilation.
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().OpenMP && getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice) {
 | 
						|
    if (Opc != BO_Assign && Opc != BO_Comma) {
 | 
						|
      checkOpenMPDeviceExpr(LHSExpr);
 | 
						|
      checkOpenMPDeviceExpr(RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  switch (Opc) {
 | 
						|
  case BO_Assign:
 | 
						|
    ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, QualType());
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
 | 
						|
        LHS.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty) {
 | 
						|
      VK = LHS.get()->getValueKind();
 | 
						|
      OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    if (!ResultTy.isNull()) {
 | 
						|
      DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc, true);
 | 
						|
      DiagnoseSelfMove(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Avoid copying a block to the heap if the block is assigned to a local
 | 
						|
      // auto variable that is declared in the same scope as the block. This
 | 
						|
      // optimization is unsafe if the local variable is declared in an outer
 | 
						|
      // scope. For example:
 | 
						|
      //
 | 
						|
      // BlockTy b;
 | 
						|
      // {
 | 
						|
      //   b = ^{...};
 | 
						|
      // }
 | 
						|
      // // It is unsafe to invoke the block here if it wasn't copied to the
 | 
						|
      // // heap.
 | 
						|
      // b();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (auto *BE = dyn_cast<BlockExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParens()))
 | 
						|
        if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParens()))
 | 
						|
          if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl()))
 | 
						|
            if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && getCurScope()->isDeclScope(VD))
 | 
						|
              BE->getBlockDecl()->setCanAvoidCopyToHeap();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (LHS.get()->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
 | 
						|
        checkNonTrivialCUnion(LHS.get()->getType(), LHS.get()->getExprLoc(),
 | 
						|
                              NTCUC_Assignment, NTCUK_Copy);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    RecordModifiableNonNullParam(*this, LHS.get());
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case BO_PtrMemD:
 | 
						|
  case BO_PtrMemI:
 | 
						|
    ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(LHS, RHS, VK, OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                                            Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case BO_Mul:
 | 
						|
  case BO_Div:
 | 
						|
    ConvertHalfVec = true;
 | 
						|
    ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, false,
 | 
						|
                                           Opc == BO_Div);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case BO_Rem:
 | 
						|
    ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case BO_Add:
 | 
						|
    ConvertHalfVec = true;
 | 
						|
    ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case BO_Sub:
 | 
						|
    ConvertHalfVec = true;
 | 
						|
    ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case BO_Shl:
 | 
						|
  case BO_Shr:
 | 
						|
    ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case BO_LE:
 | 
						|
  case BO_LT:
 | 
						|
  case BO_GE:
 | 
						|
  case BO_GT:
 | 
						|
    ConvertHalfVec = true;
 | 
						|
    ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case BO_EQ:
 | 
						|
  case BO_NE:
 | 
						|
    ConvertHalfVec = true;
 | 
						|
    ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case BO_Cmp:
 | 
						|
    ConvertHalfVec = true;
 | 
						|
    ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
 | 
						|
    assert(ResultTy.isNull() || ResultTy->getAsCXXRecordDecl());
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case BO_And:
 | 
						|
    checkObjCPointerIntrospection(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
 | 
						|
    LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
 | 
						|
  case BO_Xor:
 | 
						|
  case BO_Or:
 | 
						|
    ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case BO_LAnd:
 | 
						|
  case BO_LOr:
 | 
						|
    ConvertHalfVec = true;
 | 
						|
    ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case BO_MulAssign:
 | 
						|
  case BO_DivAssign:
 | 
						|
    ConvertHalfVec = true;
 | 
						|
    CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true,
 | 
						|
                                               Opc == BO_DivAssign);
 | 
						|
    CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
 | 
						|
    if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case BO_RemAssign:
 | 
						|
    CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true);
 | 
						|
    CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
 | 
						|
    if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case BO_AddAssign:
 | 
						|
    ConvertHalfVec = true;
 | 
						|
    CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, &CompLHSTy);
 | 
						|
    if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case BO_SubAssign:
 | 
						|
    ConvertHalfVec = true;
 | 
						|
    CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
 | 
						|
    if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case BO_ShlAssign:
 | 
						|
  case BO_ShrAssign:
 | 
						|
    CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, true);
 | 
						|
    CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
 | 
						|
    if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case BO_AndAssign:
 | 
						|
  case BO_OrAssign: // fallthrough
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc, true);
 | 
						|
    LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
 | 
						|
  case BO_XorAssign:
 | 
						|
    CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
 | 
						|
    CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
 | 
						|
    if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case BO_Comma:
 | 
						|
    ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !RHS.isInvalid()) {
 | 
						|
      VK = RHS.get()->getValueKind();
 | 
						|
      OK = RHS.get()->getObjectKind();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (ResultTy.isNull() || LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (ResultTy->isRealFloatingType() &&
 | 
						|
      (getLangOpts().getFPRoundingMode() != LangOptions::FPR_ToNearest ||
 | 
						|
       getLangOpts().getFPExceptionMode() != LangOptions::FPE_Ignore))
 | 
						|
    // Mark the current function as usng floating point constrained intrinsics
 | 
						|
    if (FunctionDecl *F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) {
 | 
						|
      F->setUsesFPIntrin(true);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Some of the binary operations require promoting operands of half vector to
 | 
						|
  // float vectors and truncating the result back to half vector. For now, we do
 | 
						|
  // this only when HalfArgsAndReturn is set (that is, when the target is arm or
 | 
						|
  // arm64).
 | 
						|
  assert(isVector(RHS.get()->getType(), Context.HalfTy) ==
 | 
						|
         isVector(LHS.get()->getType(), Context.HalfTy) &&
 | 
						|
         "both sides are half vectors or neither sides are");
 | 
						|
  ConvertHalfVec = needsConversionOfHalfVec(ConvertHalfVec, Context,
 | 
						|
                                            LHS.get()->getType());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check for array bounds violations for both sides of the BinaryOperator
 | 
						|
  CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get());
 | 
						|
  CheckArrayAccess(RHS.get());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
 | 
						|
    NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope,
 | 
						|
                                                 &Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"),
 | 
						|
                                                 SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName);
 | 
						|
    if (ObjectSetClass && isa<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get())) {
 | 
						|
      SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getEndLoc());
 | 
						|
      Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign)
 | 
						|
          << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHS.get()->getBeginLoc(),
 | 
						|
                                        "object_setClass(")
 | 
						|
          << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OpLoc),
 | 
						|
                                          ",")
 | 
						|
          << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")");
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE =
 | 
						|
           dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts()))
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, OpLoc, RHS.get());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Opc is not a compound assignment if CompResultTy is null.
 | 
						|
  if (CompResultTy.isNull()) {
 | 
						|
    if (ConvertHalfVec)
 | 
						|
      return convertHalfVecBinOp(*this, LHS, RHS, Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, false,
 | 
						|
                                 OpLoc, FPFeatures);
 | 
						|
    return new (Context) BinaryOperator(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK,
 | 
						|
                                        OK, OpLoc, FPFeatures);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Handle compound assignments.
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS.get()->getObjectKind() !=
 | 
						|
      OK_ObjCProperty) {
 | 
						|
    VK = VK_LValue;
 | 
						|
    OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (ConvertHalfVec)
 | 
						|
    return convertHalfVecBinOp(*this, LHS, RHS, Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, true,
 | 
						|
                               OpLoc, FPFeatures);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(
 | 
						|
      LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
 | 
						|
      OpLoc, FPFeatures);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
 | 
						|
/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
 | 
						|
/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
 | 
						|
/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
 | 
						|
static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
 | 
						|
                                      SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr,
 | 
						|
                                      Expr *RHSExpr) {
 | 
						|
  BinaryOperator *LHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr);
 | 
						|
  BinaryOperator *RHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check that one of the sides is a comparison operator and the other isn't.
 | 
						|
  bool isLeftComp = LHSBO && LHSBO->isComparisonOp();
 | 
						|
  bool isRightComp = RHSBO && RHSBO->isComparisonOp();
 | 
						|
  if (isLeftComp == isRightComp)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
 | 
						|
  // Don't diagnose this.
 | 
						|
  bool isLeftBitwise = LHSBO && LHSBO->isBitwiseOp();
 | 
						|
  bool isRightBitwise = RHSBO && RHSBO->isBitwiseOp();
 | 
						|
  if (isLeftBitwise || isRightBitwise)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  SourceRange DiagRange = isLeftComp
 | 
						|
                              ? SourceRange(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), OpLoc)
 | 
						|
                              : SourceRange(OpLoc, RHSExpr->getEndLoc());
 | 
						|
  StringRef OpStr = isLeftComp ? LHSBO->getOpcodeStr() : RHSBO->getOpcodeStr();
 | 
						|
  SourceRange ParensRange =
 | 
						|
      isLeftComp
 | 
						|
          ? SourceRange(LHSBO->getRHS()->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc())
 | 
						|
          : SourceRange(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSBO->getLHS()->getEndLoc());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
 | 
						|
    << DiagRange << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << OpStr;
 | 
						|
  SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
 | 
						|
    Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << OpStr,
 | 
						|
    (isLeftComp ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr)->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
  SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
 | 
						|
    Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
 | 
						|
      << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
 | 
						|
    ParensRange);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// It accepts a '&&' expr that is inside a '||' one.
 | 
						|
/// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&&' expression
 | 
						|
/// in parentheses.
 | 
						|
static void
 | 
						|
EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                                       BinaryOperator *Bop) {
 | 
						|
  assert(Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd);
 | 
						|
  Self.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_and_in_logical_or)
 | 
						|
      << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc;
 | 
						|
  SuggestParentheses(Self, Bop->getOperatorLoc(),
 | 
						|
    Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence)
 | 
						|
      << Bop->getOpcodeStr(),
 | 
						|
    Bop->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant
 | 
						|
/// 'true'.
 | 
						|
static bool EvaluatesAsTrue(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  bool Res;
 | 
						|
  return !E->isValueDependent() &&
 | 
						|
         E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && Res;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant
 | 
						|
/// 'false'.
 | 
						|
static bool EvaluatesAsFalse(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  bool Res;
 | 
						|
  return !E->isValueDependent() &&
 | 
						|
         E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && !Res;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Look for '&&' in the left hand of a '||' expr.
 | 
						|
static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                                             Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
 | 
						|
  if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr)) {
 | 
						|
    if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) {
 | 
						|
      // If it's "a && b || 0" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
 | 
						|
      if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, RHSExpr))
 | 
						|
        return;
 | 
						|
      // If it's "1 && a || b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
 | 
						|
      if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getLHS()))
 | 
						|
        return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop);
 | 
						|
    } else if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LOr) {
 | 
						|
      if (BinaryOperator *RBop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Bop->getRHS())) {
 | 
						|
        // If it's "a || b && 1 || c" we didn't warn earlier for
 | 
						|
        // "a || b && 1", but warn now.
 | 
						|
        if (RBop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd && EvaluatesAsTrue(S, RBop->getRHS()))
 | 
						|
          return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, RBop);
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Look for '&&' in the right hand of a '||' expr.
 | 
						|
static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                                             Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
 | 
						|
  if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr)) {
 | 
						|
    if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) {
 | 
						|
      // If it's "0 || a && b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
 | 
						|
      if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, LHSExpr))
 | 
						|
        return;
 | 
						|
      // If it's "a || b && 1" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
 | 
						|
      if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getRHS()))
 | 
						|
        return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Look for bitwise op in the left or right hand of a bitwise op with
 | 
						|
/// lower precedence and emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
 | 
						|
/// the '&' expression in parentheses.
 | 
						|
static void DiagnoseBitwiseOpInBitwiseOp(Sema &S, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
 | 
						|
                                         SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *SubExpr) {
 | 
						|
  if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SubExpr)) {
 | 
						|
    if (Bop->isBitwiseOp() && Bop->getOpcode() < Opc) {
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_bitwise_op_in_bitwise_op)
 | 
						|
        << Bop->getOpcodeStr() << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
 | 
						|
        << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc;
 | 
						|
      SuggestParentheses(S, Bop->getOperatorLoc(),
 | 
						|
        S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence)
 | 
						|
          << Bop->getOpcodeStr(),
 | 
						|
        Bop->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                                    Expr *SubExpr, StringRef Shift) {
 | 
						|
  if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SubExpr)) {
 | 
						|
    if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Add || Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Sub) {
 | 
						|
      StringRef Op = Bop->getOpcodeStr();
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_addition_in_bitshift)
 | 
						|
          << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc << Shift << Op;
 | 
						|
      SuggestParentheses(S, Bop->getOperatorLoc(),
 | 
						|
          S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << Op,
 | 
						|
          Bop->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void DiagnoseShiftCompare(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                                 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
 | 
						|
  CXXOperatorCallExpr *OCE = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(LHSExpr);
 | 
						|
  if (!OCE)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  FunctionDecl *FD = OCE->getDirectCallee();
 | 
						|
  if (!FD || !FD->isOverloadedOperator())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  OverloadedOperatorKind Kind = FD->getOverloadedOperator();
 | 
						|
  if (Kind != OO_LessLess && Kind != OO_GreaterGreater)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_overloaded_shift_in_comparison)
 | 
						|
      << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange()
 | 
						|
      << (Kind == OO_LessLess);
 | 
						|
  SuggestParentheses(S, OCE->getOperatorLoc(),
 | 
						|
                     S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence)
 | 
						|
                         << (Kind == OO_LessLess ? "<<" : ">>"),
 | 
						|
                     OCE->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
  SuggestParentheses(
 | 
						|
      S, OpLoc, S.PDiag(diag::note_evaluate_comparison_first),
 | 
						|
      SourceRange(OCE->getArg(1)->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc()));
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
 | 
						|
/// precedence.
 | 
						|
static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
 | 
						|
                                    SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr,
 | 
						|
                                    Expr *RHSExpr){
 | 
						|
  // Diagnose "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
 | 
						|
  if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Diagnose "arg1 & arg2 | arg3"
 | 
						|
  if ((Opc == BO_Or || Opc == BO_Xor) &&
 | 
						|
      !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) {
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseBitwiseOpInBitwiseOp(Self, Opc, OpLoc, LHSExpr);
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseBitwiseOpInBitwiseOp(Self, Opc, OpLoc, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Warn about arg1 || arg2 && arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
 | 
						|
  // We don't warn for 'assert(a || b && "bad")' since this is safe.
 | 
						|
  if (Opc == BO_LOr && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) {
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if ((Opc == BO_Shl && LHSExpr->getType()->isIntegralType(Self.getASTContext()))
 | 
						|
      || Opc == BO_Shr) {
 | 
						|
    StringRef Shift = BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc);
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, Shift);
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, RHSExpr, Shift);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Warn on overloaded shift operators and comparisons, such as:
 | 
						|
  // cout << 5 == 4;
 | 
						|
  if (BinaryOperator::isComparisonOp(Opc))
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseShiftCompare(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// Binary Operators.  'Tok' is the token for the operator.
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
 | 
						|
                            tok::TokenKind Kind,
 | 
						|
                            Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
 | 
						|
  BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
 | 
						|
  assert(LHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
 | 
						|
  assert(RHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
 | 
						|
  DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Build an overloaded binary operator expression in the given scope.
 | 
						|
static ExprResult BuildOverloadedBinOp(Sema &S, Scope *Sc, SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                                       BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
 | 
						|
                                       Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
 | 
						|
  switch (Opc) {
 | 
						|
  case BO_Assign:
 | 
						|
  case BO_DivAssign:
 | 
						|
  case BO_RemAssign:
 | 
						|
  case BO_SubAssign:
 | 
						|
  case BO_AndAssign:
 | 
						|
  case BO_OrAssign:
 | 
						|
  case BO_XorAssign:
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseSelfAssignment(S, LHS, RHS, OpLoc, false);
 | 
						|
    CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, S);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  default:
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
 | 
						|
  // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
 | 
						|
  // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
 | 
						|
  // the arguments.
 | 
						|
  UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
 | 
						|
  OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp
 | 
						|
    = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
 | 
						|
  if (Sc && OverOp != OO_None && OverOp != OO_Equal)
 | 
						|
    S.LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, Sc, LHS->getType(),
 | 
						|
                                   RHS->getType(), Functions);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // In C++20 onwards, we may have a second operator to look up.
 | 
						|
  if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a) {
 | 
						|
    if (OverloadedOperatorKind ExtraOp = getRewrittenOverloadedOperator(OverOp))
 | 
						|
      S.LookupOverloadedOperatorName(ExtraOp, Sc, LHS->getType(),
 | 
						|
                                     RHS->getType(), Functions);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
 | 
						|
  // binary operation.
 | 
						|
  return S.CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                            BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
 | 
						|
                            Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
 | 
						|
  ExprResult LHS, RHS;
 | 
						|
  std::tie(LHS, RHS) = CorrectDelayedTyposInBinOp(*this, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
  if (!LHS.isUsable() || !RHS.isUsable())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  LHSExpr = LHS.get();
 | 
						|
  RHSExpr = RHS.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // We want to end up calling one of checkPseudoObjectAssignment
 | 
						|
  // (if the LHS is a pseudo-object), BuildOverloadedBinOp (if
 | 
						|
  // both expressions are overloadable or either is type-dependent),
 | 
						|
  // or CreateBuiltinBinOp (in any other case).  We also want to get
 | 
						|
  // any placeholder types out of the way.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Handle pseudo-objects in the LHS.
 | 
						|
  if (const BuiltinType *pty = LHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
 | 
						|
    // Assignments with a pseudo-object l-value need special analysis.
 | 
						|
    if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject &&
 | 
						|
        BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc))
 | 
						|
      return checkPseudoObjectAssignment(S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable.
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
 | 
						|
      // We can't actually test that if we still have a placeholder,
 | 
						|
      // though.  Fortunately, none of the exceptions we see in that
 | 
						|
      // code below are valid when the LHS is an overload set.  Note
 | 
						|
      // that an overload set can be dependently-typed, but it never
 | 
						|
      // instantiates to having an overloadable type.
 | 
						|
      ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
      if (resolvedRHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (RHSExpr->isTypeDependent() ||
 | 
						|
          RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())
 | 
						|
        return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // If we're instantiating "a.x < b" or "A::x < b" and 'x' names a function
 | 
						|
    // template, diagnose the missing 'template' keyword instead of diagnosing
 | 
						|
    // an invalid use of a bound member function.
 | 
						|
    //
 | 
						|
    // Note that "A::x < b" might be valid if 'b' has an overloadable type due
 | 
						|
    // to C++1z [over.over]/1.4, but we already checked for that case above.
 | 
						|
    if (Opc == BO_LT && inTemplateInstantiation() &&
 | 
						|
        (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember ||
 | 
						|
         pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload)) {
 | 
						|
      auto *OE = dyn_cast<OverloadExpr>(LHSExpr);
 | 
						|
      if (OE && !OE->hasTemplateKeyword() && !OE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
 | 
						|
          std::any_of(OE->decls_begin(), OE->decls_end(), [](NamedDecl *ND) {
 | 
						|
            return isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND);
 | 
						|
          })) {
 | 
						|
        Diag(OE->getQualifier() ? OE->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc()
 | 
						|
                                : OE->getNameLoc(),
 | 
						|
             diag::err_template_kw_missing)
 | 
						|
          << OE->getName().getAsString() << "";
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult LHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHSExpr);
 | 
						|
    if (LHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    LHSExpr = LHS.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Handle pseudo-objects in the RHS.
 | 
						|
  if (const BuiltinType *pty = RHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
 | 
						|
    // An overload in the RHS can potentially be resolved by the type
 | 
						|
    // being assigned to.
 | 
						|
    if (Opc == BO_Assign && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
 | 
						|
      if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
 | 
						|
          (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent() ||
 | 
						|
           LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()))
 | 
						|
        return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable.
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload &&
 | 
						|
        LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())
 | 
						|
      return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
    if (!resolvedRHS.isUsable()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
    // If either expression is type-dependent, always build an
 | 
						|
    // overloaded op.
 | 
						|
    if (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent())
 | 
						|
      return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Otherwise, build an overloaded op if either expression has an
 | 
						|
    // overloadable type.
 | 
						|
    if (LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
 | 
						|
        RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())
 | 
						|
      return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Build a built-in binary operation.
 | 
						|
  return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static bool isOverflowingIntegerType(ASTContext &Ctx, QualType T) {
 | 
						|
  if (T.isNull() || T->isDependentType())
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!T->isPromotableIntegerType())
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return Ctx.getIntWidth(T) >= Ctx.getIntWidth(Ctx.IntTy);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                                      UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
 | 
						|
                                      Expr *InputExpr) {
 | 
						|
  ExprResult Input = InputExpr;
 | 
						|
  ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
 | 
						|
  ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
 | 
						|
  QualType resultType;
 | 
						|
  bool CanOverflow = false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool ConvertHalfVec = false;
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
 | 
						|
    QualType Ty = InputExpr->getType();
 | 
						|
    // The only legal unary operation for atomics is '&'.
 | 
						|
    if ((Opc != UO_AddrOf && Ty->isAtomicType()) ||
 | 
						|
    // OpenCL special types - image, sampler, pipe, and blocks are to be used
 | 
						|
    // only with a builtin functions and therefore should be disallowed here.
 | 
						|
        (Ty->isImageType() || Ty->isSamplerT() || Ty->isPipeType()
 | 
						|
        || Ty->isBlockPointerType())) {
 | 
						|
      return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
 | 
						|
                       << InputExpr->getType()
 | 
						|
                       << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  // Diagnose operations on the unsupported types for OpenMP device compilation.
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().OpenMP && getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice) {
 | 
						|
    if (UnaryOperator::isIncrementDecrementOp(Opc) ||
 | 
						|
        UnaryOperator::isArithmeticOp(Opc))
 | 
						|
      checkOpenMPDeviceExpr(InputExpr);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  switch (Opc) {
 | 
						|
  case UO_PreInc:
 | 
						|
  case UO_PreDec:
 | 
						|
  case UO_PostInc:
 | 
						|
  case UO_PostDec:
 | 
						|
    resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OK,
 | 
						|
                                                OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                                                Opc == UO_PreInc ||
 | 
						|
                                                Opc == UO_PostInc,
 | 
						|
                                                Opc == UO_PreInc ||
 | 
						|
                                                Opc == UO_PreDec);
 | 
						|
    CanOverflow = isOverflowingIntegerType(Context, resultType);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case UO_AddrOf:
 | 
						|
    resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
 | 
						|
    CheckAddressOfNoDeref(InputExpr);
 | 
						|
    RecordModifiableNonNullParam(*this, InputExpr);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case UO_Deref: {
 | 
						|
    Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get());
 | 
						|
    if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OpLoc);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  case UO_Plus:
 | 
						|
  case UO_Minus:
 | 
						|
    CanOverflow = Opc == UO_Minus &&
 | 
						|
                  isOverflowingIntegerType(Context, Input.get()->getType());
 | 
						|
    Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get());
 | 
						|
    if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    // Unary plus and minus require promoting an operand of half vector to a
 | 
						|
    // float vector and truncating the result back to a half vector. For now, we
 | 
						|
    // do this only when HalfArgsAndReturns is set (that is, when the target is
 | 
						|
    // arm or arm64).
 | 
						|
    ConvertHalfVec =
 | 
						|
        needsConversionOfHalfVec(true, Context, Input.get()->getType());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // If the operand is a half vector, promote it to a float vector.
 | 
						|
    if (ConvertHalfVec)
 | 
						|
      Input = convertVector(Input.get(), Context.FloatTy, *this);
 | 
						|
    resultType = Input.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
    if (resultType->isDependentType())
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    if (resultType->isArithmeticType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    else if (resultType->isVectorType() &&
 | 
						|
             // The z vector extensions don't allow + or - with bool vectors.
 | 
						|
             (!Context.getLangOpts().ZVector ||
 | 
						|
              resultType->castAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() !=
 | 
						|
              VectorType::AltiVecBool))
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
 | 
						|
             Opc == UO_Plus &&
 | 
						|
             resultType->isPointerType())
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
 | 
						|
      << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
 | 
						|
    Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get());
 | 
						|
    if (Input.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    resultType = Input.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
    if (resultType->isDependentType())
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
 | 
						|
    if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
 | 
						|
      // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
 | 
						|
      Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
 | 
						|
          << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    else if (resultType->isExtVectorType() && Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
 | 
						|
      // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.f: The bitwise operator not (~) does not operate
 | 
						|
      // on vector float types.
 | 
						|
      QualType T = resultType->castAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
 | 
						|
      if (!T->isIntegerType())
 | 
						|
        return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
 | 
						|
                          << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
 | 
						|
                       << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case UO_LNot: // logical negation
 | 
						|
    // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
 | 
						|
    Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get());
 | 
						|
    if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    resultType = Input.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Though we still have to promote half FP to float...
 | 
						|
    if (resultType->isHalfType() && !Context.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType) {
 | 
						|
      Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
 | 
						|
      resultType = Context.FloatTy;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (resultType->isDependentType())
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    if (resultType->isScalarType() && !isScopedEnumerationType(resultType)) {
 | 
						|
      // C99 6.5.3.3p1: ok, fallthrough;
 | 
						|
      if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
        // C++03 [expr.unary.op]p8, C++0x [expr.unary.op]p9:
 | 
						|
        // operand contextually converted to bool.
 | 
						|
        Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.BoolTy,
 | 
						|
                                  ScalarTypeToBooleanCastKind(resultType));
 | 
						|
      } else if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
 | 
						|
                 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) {
 | 
						|
        // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not
 | 
						|
        // operate on scalar float types.
 | 
						|
        if (!resultType->isIntegerType() && !resultType->isPointerType())
 | 
						|
          return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
 | 
						|
                           << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    } else if (resultType->isExtVectorType()) {
 | 
						|
      if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
 | 
						|
          Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120 &&
 | 
						|
          !Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
        // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not
 | 
						|
        // operate on vector float types.
 | 
						|
        QualType T = resultType->castAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
 | 
						|
        if (!T->isIntegerType())
 | 
						|
          return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
 | 
						|
                           << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      // Vector logical not returns the signed variant of the operand type.
 | 
						|
      resultType = GetSignedVectorType(resultType);
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      // FIXME: GCC's vector extension permits the usage of '!' with a vector
 | 
						|
      //        type in C++. We should allow that here too.
 | 
						|
      return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
 | 
						|
        << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
 | 
						|
    // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
 | 
						|
    resultType = Context.getLogicalOperationType();
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case UO_Real:
 | 
						|
  case UO_Imag:
 | 
						|
    resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(*this, Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
 | 
						|
    // _Real maps ordinary l-values into ordinary l-values. _Imag maps ordinary
 | 
						|
    // complex l-values to ordinary l-values and all other values to r-values.
 | 
						|
    if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    if (Opc == UO_Real || Input.get()->getType()->isAnyComplexType()) {
 | 
						|
      if (Input.get()->getValueKind() != VK_RValue &&
 | 
						|
          Input.get()->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary)
 | 
						|
        VK = Input.get()->getValueKind();
 | 
						|
    } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
      // In C, a volatile scalar is read by __imag. In C++, it is not.
 | 
						|
      Input = DefaultLvalueConversion(Input.get());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case UO_Extension:
 | 
						|
    resultType = Input.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
    VK = Input.get()->getValueKind();
 | 
						|
    OK = Input.get()->getObjectKind();
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case UO_Coawait:
 | 
						|
    // It's unnecessary to represent the pass-through operator co_await in the
 | 
						|
    // AST; just return the input expression instead.
 | 
						|
    assert(!Input.get()->getType()->isDependentType() &&
 | 
						|
                   "the co_await expression must be non-dependant before "
 | 
						|
                   "building operator co_await");
 | 
						|
    return Input;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (resultType.isNull() || Input.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check for array bounds violations in the operand of the UnaryOperator,
 | 
						|
  // except for the '*' and '&' operators that have to be handled specially
 | 
						|
  // by CheckArrayAccess (as there are special cases like &array[arraysize]
 | 
						|
  // that are explicitly defined as valid by the standard).
 | 
						|
  if (Opc != UO_AddrOf && Opc != UO_Deref)
 | 
						|
    CheckArrayAccess(Input.get());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  auto *UO = new (Context)
 | 
						|
      UnaryOperator(Input.get(), Opc, resultType, VK, OK, OpLoc, CanOverflow);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Opc == UO_Deref && UO->getType()->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref) &&
 | 
						|
      !isa<ArrayType>(UO->getType().getDesugaredType(Context)))
 | 
						|
    ExprEvalContexts.back().PossibleDerefs.insert(UO);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Convert the result back to a half vector.
 | 
						|
  if (ConvertHalfVec)
 | 
						|
    return convertVector(UO, Context.HalfTy, *this);
 | 
						|
  return UO;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Determine whether the given expression is a qualified member
 | 
						|
/// access expression, of a form that could be turned into a pointer to member
 | 
						|
/// with the address-of operator.
 | 
						|
bool Sema::isQualifiedMemberAccess(Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
    if (!DRE->getQualifier())
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ValueDecl *VD = DRE->getDecl();
 | 
						|
    if (!VD->isCXXClassMember())
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (isa<FieldDecl>(VD) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD))
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD))
 | 
						|
      return Method->isInstance();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
    if (!ULE->getQualifier())
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    for (NamedDecl *D : ULE->decls()) {
 | 
						|
      if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
        if (Method->isInstance())
 | 
						|
          return true;
 | 
						|
      } else {
 | 
						|
        // Overload set does not contain methods.
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                              UnaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *Input) {
 | 
						|
  // First things first: handle placeholders so that the
 | 
						|
  // overloaded-operator check considers the right type.
 | 
						|
  if (const BuiltinType *pty = Input->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
 | 
						|
    // Increment and decrement of pseudo-object references.
 | 
						|
    if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject &&
 | 
						|
        UnaryOperator::isIncrementDecrementOp(Opc))
 | 
						|
      return checkPseudoObjectIncDec(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // extension is always a builtin operator.
 | 
						|
    if (Opc == UO_Extension)
 | 
						|
      return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // & gets special logic for several kinds of placeholder.
 | 
						|
    // The builtin code knows what to do.
 | 
						|
    if (Opc == UO_AddrOf &&
 | 
						|
        (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload ||
 | 
						|
         pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny ||
 | 
						|
         pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember))
 | 
						|
      return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Anything else needs to be handled now.
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input);
 | 
						|
    if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    Input = Result.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
 | 
						|
      UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None &&
 | 
						|
      !(Opc == UO_AddrOf && isQualifiedMemberAccess(Input))) {
 | 
						|
    // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
 | 
						|
    // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
 | 
						|
    // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
 | 
						|
    // the arguments.
 | 
						|
    UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
 | 
						|
    OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
 | 
						|
    if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
 | 
						|
      LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
 | 
						|
                                   Functions);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// Unary Operators.  'Tok' is the token for the operator.
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                              tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
 | 
						|
  return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceLocation LabLoc,
 | 
						|
                                LabelDecl *TheDecl) {
 | 
						|
  TheDecl->markUsed(Context);
 | 
						|
  // Create the AST node.  The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
 | 
						|
  return new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, TheDecl,
 | 
						|
                                     Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy));
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
void Sema::ActOnStartStmtExpr() {
 | 
						|
  PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExprEvalContexts.back().Context);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
void Sema::ActOnStmtExprError() {
 | 
						|
  // Note that function is also called by TreeTransform when leaving a
 | 
						|
  // StmtExpr scope without rebuilding anything.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
 | 
						|
  PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
 | 
						|
                    SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
 | 
						|
  assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
 | 
						|
  CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction())
 | 
						|
    DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
 | 
						|
  assert(!Cleanup.exprNeedsCleanups() &&
 | 
						|
         "cleanups within StmtExpr not correctly bound!");
 | 
						|
  PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
 | 
						|
  // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
 | 
						|
  // More semantic analysis is needed.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If there are sub-stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
 | 
						|
  // as the type of the stmtexpr.
 | 
						|
  QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
 | 
						|
  bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false;
 | 
						|
  if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
 | 
						|
    // For GCC compatibility we get the last Stmt excluding trailing NullStmts.
 | 
						|
    if (const auto *LastStmt =
 | 
						|
            dyn_cast<ValueStmt>(Compound->getStmtExprResult())) {
 | 
						|
      if (const Expr *Value = LastStmt->getExprStmt()) {
 | 
						|
        StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true;
 | 
						|
        Ty = Value->getType();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
 | 
						|
  // expressions are not lvalues.
 | 
						|
  Expr *ResStmtExpr = new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc);
 | 
						|
  if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp)
 | 
						|
    return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr);
 | 
						|
  return ResStmtExpr;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnStmtExprResult(ExprResult ER) {
 | 
						|
  if (ER.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Do function/array conversion on the last expression, but not
 | 
						|
  // lvalue-to-rvalue.  However, initialize an unqualified type.
 | 
						|
  ER = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(ER.get());
 | 
						|
  if (ER.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  Expr *E = ER.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (E->isTypeDependent())
 | 
						|
    return E;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // In ARC, if the final expression ends in a consume, splice
 | 
						|
  // the consume out and bind it later.  In the alternate case
 | 
						|
  // (when dealing with a retainable type), the result
 | 
						|
  // initialization will create a produce.  In both cases the
 | 
						|
  // result will be +1, and we'll need to balance that out with
 | 
						|
  // a bind.
 | 
						|
  auto *Cast = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E);
 | 
						|
  if (Cast && Cast->getCastKind() == CK_ARCConsumeObject)
 | 
						|
    return Cast->getSubExpr();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: Provide a better location for the initialization.
 | 
						|
  return PerformCopyInitialization(
 | 
						|
      InitializedEntity::InitializeStmtExprResult(
 | 
						|
          E->getBeginLoc(), E->getType().getUnqualifiedType()),
 | 
						|
      SourceLocation(), E);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
 | 
						|
                                      TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
 | 
						|
                                      ArrayRef<OffsetOfComponent> Components,
 | 
						|
                                      SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
 | 
						|
  QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
 | 
						|
  bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
 | 
						|
  SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
 | 
						|
  // one is known to be a field designator.  Verify that the ArgTy represents
 | 
						|
  // a struct/union/class.
 | 
						|
  if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
 | 
						|
                       << ArgTy << TypeRange);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
 | 
						|
  // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
 | 
						|
  if (!Dependent
 | 
						|
      && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
 | 
						|
                             diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type, TypeRange))
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
 | 
						|
  QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
 | 
						|
  SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
 | 
						|
  SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
 | 
						|
  for (const OffsetOfComponent &OC : Components) {
 | 
						|
    if (OC.isBrackets) {
 | 
						|
      // Offset of an array sub-field.  TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
 | 
						|
      if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
 | 
						|
        const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
 | 
						|
        if(!AT)
 | 
						|
          return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
 | 
						|
                           << CurrentType);
 | 
						|
        CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
 | 
						|
      } else
 | 
						|
        CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      ExprResult IdxRval = DefaultLvalueConversion(static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E));
 | 
						|
      if (IdxRval.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      Expr *Idx = IdxRval.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // The expression must be an integral expression.
 | 
						|
      // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
 | 
						|
      if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
 | 
						|
          !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
 | 
						|
        return ExprError(
 | 
						|
            Diag(Idx->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
 | 
						|
            << Idx->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Record this array index.
 | 
						|
      Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
 | 
						|
      Exprs.push_back(Idx);
 | 
						|
      continue;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Offset of a field.
 | 
						|
    if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
 | 
						|
      // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
 | 
						|
      // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
 | 
						|
      Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
 | 
						|
      CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
 | 
						|
      continue;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // We need to have a complete type to look into.
 | 
						|
    if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
 | 
						|
                            diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Look for the designated field.
 | 
						|
    const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
 | 
						|
    if (!RC)
 | 
						|
      return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
 | 
						|
                       << CurrentType);
 | 
						|
    RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
 | 
						|
    //   The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
 | 
						|
    //   International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
 | 
						|
    //   (clause 9).
 | 
						|
    // C++11 [support.types]p4:
 | 
						|
    //   If type is not a standard-layout class (Clause 9), the results are
 | 
						|
    //   undefined.
 | 
						|
    if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
 | 
						|
      bool IsSafe = LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? CRD->isStandardLayout() : CRD->isPOD();
 | 
						|
      unsigned DiagID =
 | 
						|
        LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? diag::ext_offsetof_non_standardlayout_type
 | 
						|
                            : diag::ext_offsetof_non_pod_type;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (!IsSafe && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
 | 
						|
          DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc, nullptr,
 | 
						|
                              PDiag(DiagID)
 | 
						|
                              << SourceRange(Components[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
 | 
						|
                              << CurrentType))
 | 
						|
        DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Look for the field.
 | 
						|
    LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
 | 
						|
    LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
 | 
						|
    FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
 | 
						|
    IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectMemberDecl = nullptr;
 | 
						|
    if (!MemberDecl) {
 | 
						|
      if ((IndirectMemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<IndirectFieldDecl>()))
 | 
						|
        MemberDecl = IndirectMemberDecl->getAnonField();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (!MemberDecl)
 | 
						|
      return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
 | 
						|
                       << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
 | 
						|
                                                              OC.LocEnd));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // C99 7.17p3:
 | 
						|
    //   (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
 | 
						|
    //
 | 
						|
    // We diagnose this as an error.
 | 
						|
    if (MemberDecl->isBitField()) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
 | 
						|
        << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
 | 
						|
        << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
 | 
						|
      Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
 | 
						|
    if (IndirectMemberDecl)
 | 
						|
      Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(IndirectMemberDecl->getDeclContext());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
 | 
						|
    // the base class indirections.
 | 
						|
    CXXBasePaths Paths;
 | 
						|
    if (IsDerivedFrom(OC.LocStart, CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent),
 | 
						|
                      Paths)) {
 | 
						|
      if (Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
 | 
						|
        Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_field_of_virtual_base)
 | 
						|
          << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
 | 
						|
          << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
 | 
						|
      for (const CXXBasePathElement &B : Path)
 | 
						|
        Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B.Base));
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (IndirectMemberDecl) {
 | 
						|
      for (auto *FI : IndirectMemberDecl->chain()) {
 | 
						|
        assert(isa<FieldDecl>(FI));
 | 
						|
        Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart,
 | 
						|
                                     cast<FieldDecl>(FI), OC.LocEnd));
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    } else
 | 
						|
      Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc, TInfo,
 | 
						|
                              Comps, Exprs, RParenLoc);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
 | 
						|
                                      SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
 | 
						|
                                      SourceLocation TypeLoc,
 | 
						|
                                      ParsedType ParsedArgTy,
 | 
						|
                                      ArrayRef<OffsetOfComponent> Components,
 | 
						|
                                      SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
 | 
						|
  QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedArgTy, &ArgTInfo);
 | 
						|
  if (ArgTy.isNull())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!ArgTInfo)
 | 
						|
    ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, Components, RParenLoc);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
 | 
						|
                                 Expr *CondExpr,
 | 
						|
                                 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
 | 
						|
                                 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
 | 
						|
  assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
 | 
						|
  ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
 | 
						|
  QualType resType;
 | 
						|
  bool ValueDependent = false;
 | 
						|
  bool CondIsTrue = false;
 | 
						|
  if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
 | 
						|
    resType = Context.DependentTy;
 | 
						|
    ValueDependent = true;
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
 | 
						|
    llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
 | 
						|
    ExprResult CondICE
 | 
						|
      = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(CondExpr, &condEval,
 | 
						|
          diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant, false);
 | 
						|
    if (CondICE.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    CondExpr = CondICE.get();
 | 
						|
    CondIsTrue = condEval.getZExtValue();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LHSExpr.
 | 
						|
    Expr *ActiveExpr = CondIsTrue ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    resType = ActiveExpr->getType();
 | 
						|
    ValueDependent = ActiveExpr->isValueDependent();
 | 
						|
    VK = ActiveExpr->getValueKind();
 | 
						|
    OK = ActiveExpr->getObjectKind();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return new (Context)
 | 
						|
      ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr, resType, VK, OK, RPLoc,
 | 
						|
                 CondIsTrue, resType->isDependentType(), ValueDependent);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | 
						|
// Clang Extensions.
 | 
						|
//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
 | 
						|
void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
 | 
						|
  BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
    MangleNumberingContext *MCtx;
 | 
						|
    Decl *ManglingContextDecl;
 | 
						|
    std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) =
 | 
						|
        getCurrentMangleNumberContext(Block->getDeclContext());
 | 
						|
    if (MCtx) {
 | 
						|
      unsigned ManglingNumber = MCtx->getManglingNumber(Block);
 | 
						|
      Block->setBlockMangling(ManglingNumber, ManglingContextDecl);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  PushBlockScope(CurScope, Block);
 | 
						|
  CurContext->addDecl(Block);
 | 
						|
  if (CurScope)
 | 
						|
    PushDeclContext(CurScope, Block);
 | 
						|
  else
 | 
						|
    CurContext = Block;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  getCurBlock()->HasImplicitReturnType = true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Enter a new evaluation context to insulate the block from any
 | 
						|
  // cleanups from the enclosing full-expression.
 | 
						|
  PushExpressionEvaluationContext(
 | 
						|
      ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Declarator &ParamInfo,
 | 
						|
                               Scope *CurScope) {
 | 
						|
  assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier() == nullptr &&
 | 
						|
         "block-id should have no identifier!");
 | 
						|
  assert(ParamInfo.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::BlockLiteralContext);
 | 
						|
  BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
 | 
						|
  QualType T = Sig->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: We should allow unexpanded parameter packs here, but that would,
 | 
						|
  // in turn, make the block expression contain unexpanded parameter packs.
 | 
						|
  if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(CaretLoc, Sig, UPPC_Block)) {
 | 
						|
    // Drop the parameters.
 | 
						|
    FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
 | 
						|
    EPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
 | 
						|
    EPI.TypeQuals.addConst();
 | 
						|
    T = Context.getFunctionType(Context.DependentTy, None, EPI);
 | 
						|
    Sig = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // GetTypeForDeclarator always produces a function type for a block
 | 
						|
  // literal signature.  Furthermore, it is always a FunctionProtoType
 | 
						|
  // unless the function was written with a typedef.
 | 
						|
  assert(T->isFunctionType() &&
 | 
						|
         "GetTypeForDeclarator made a non-function block signature");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Look for an explicit signature in that function type.
 | 
						|
  FunctionProtoTypeLoc ExplicitSignature;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if ((ExplicitSignature = Sig->getTypeLoc()
 | 
						|
                               .getAsAdjusted<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>())) {
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Check whether that explicit signature was synthesized by
 | 
						|
    // GetTypeForDeclarator.  If so, don't save that as part of the
 | 
						|
    // written signature.
 | 
						|
    if (ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeBegin() ==
 | 
						|
        ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeEnd()) {
 | 
						|
      // This would be much cheaper if we stored TypeLocs instead of
 | 
						|
      // TypeSourceInfos.
 | 
						|
      TypeLoc Result = ExplicitSignature.getReturnLoc();
 | 
						|
      unsigned Size = Result.getFullDataSize();
 | 
						|
      Sig = Context.CreateTypeSourceInfo(Result.getType(), Size);
 | 
						|
      Sig->getTypeLoc().initializeFullCopy(Result, Size);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      ExplicitSignature = FunctionProtoTypeLoc();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
 | 
						|
  CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>();
 | 
						|
  QualType RetTy = Fn->getReturnType();
 | 
						|
  bool isVariadic =
 | 
						|
    (isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) && cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
 | 
						|
  // return type.  TODO:  what should we do with declarators like:
 | 
						|
  //   ^ * { ... }
 | 
						|
  // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
 | 
						|
  if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy) {
 | 
						|
    CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
 | 
						|
    CurBlock->TheDecl->setBlockMissingReturnType(false);
 | 
						|
    CurBlock->HasImplicitReturnType = false;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
 | 
						|
  SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
 | 
						|
  if (ExplicitSignature) {
 | 
						|
    for (unsigned I = 0, E = ExplicitSignature.getNumParams(); I != E; ++I) {
 | 
						|
      ParmVarDecl *Param = ExplicitSignature.getParam(I);
 | 
						|
      if (Param->getIdentifier() == nullptr &&
 | 
						|
          !Param->isImplicit() &&
 | 
						|
          !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
 | 
						|
          !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
 | 
						|
        Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
 | 
						|
      Params.push_back(Param);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
 | 
						|
  //   ^ fntype { ... }
 | 
						|
  } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
 | 
						|
    for (const auto &I : Fn->param_types()) {
 | 
						|
      ParmVarDecl *Param = BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(
 | 
						|
          CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo.getBeginLoc(), I);
 | 
						|
      Params.push_back(Param);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Set the parameters on the block decl.
 | 
						|
  if (!Params.empty()) {
 | 
						|
    CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params);
 | 
						|
    CheckParmsForFunctionDef(CurBlock->TheDecl->parameters(),
 | 
						|
                             /*CheckParameterNames=*/false);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Finally we can process decl attributes.
 | 
						|
  ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Put the parameter variables in scope.
 | 
						|
  for (auto AI : CurBlock->TheDecl->parameters()) {
 | 
						|
    AI->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
 | 
						|
    if (AI->getIdentifier()) {
 | 
						|
      CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, AI);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      PushOnScopeChains(AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
 | 
						|
/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
 | 
						|
void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
 | 
						|
  // Leave the expression-evaluation context.
 | 
						|
  DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
 | 
						|
  PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
 | 
						|
  PopDeclContext();
 | 
						|
  PopFunctionScopeInfo();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
 | 
						|
/// literal was successfully completed.  ^(int x){...}
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
 | 
						|
                                    Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
 | 
						|
  // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
 | 
						|
  if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
 | 
						|
    Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable) << LangOpts.OpenCL;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Leave the expression-evaluation context.
 | 
						|
  if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction())
 | 
						|
    DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
 | 
						|
  assert(!Cleanup.exprNeedsCleanups() &&
 | 
						|
         "cleanups within block not correctly bound!");
 | 
						|
  PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
 | 
						|
  BlockDecl *BD = BSI->TheDecl;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (BSI->HasImplicitReturnType)
 | 
						|
    deduceClosureReturnType(*BSI);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
 | 
						|
  if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
 | 
						|
    RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool NoReturn = BD->hasAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
 | 
						|
  QualType BlockTy;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
 | 
						|
  if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
 | 
						|
    const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->castAs<FunctionType>();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
 | 
						|
    if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
 | 
						|
    if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
 | 
						|
      FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
 | 
						|
      EPI.ExtInfo = Ext;
 | 
						|
      BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, None, EPI);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
 | 
						|
    // preserve its sugar structure.
 | 
						|
    } else if (FTy->getReturnType() == RetTy &&
 | 
						|
               (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
 | 
						|
      BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
 | 
						|
      FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
 | 
						|
      EPI.TypeQuals = Qualifiers();
 | 
						|
      EPI.ExtInfo = Ext;
 | 
						|
      BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
 | 
						|
    EPI.ExtInfo = FunctionType::ExtInfo().withNoReturn(NoReturn);
 | 
						|
    BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, None, EPI);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BD->parameters());
 | 
						|
  BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
 | 
						|
  if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() &&
 | 
						|
      !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled())
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  BD->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Body && getCurFunction()->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations)
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseUnguardedAvailabilityViolations(BD);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check again
 | 
						|
  // if we can do this, though, because blocks keep return statements around
 | 
						|
  // to deduce an implicit return type.
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && RetTy->isRecordType() &&
 | 
						|
      !BD->isDependentContext())
 | 
						|
    computeNRVO(Body, BSI);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (RetTy.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() ||
 | 
						|
      RetTy.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
 | 
						|
    checkNonTrivialCUnion(RetTy, BD->getCaretLocation(), NTCUC_FunctionReturn,
 | 
						|
                          NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  PopDeclContext();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Pop the block scope now but keep it alive to the end of this function.
 | 
						|
  AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
 | 
						|
  PoppedFunctionScopePtr ScopeRAII = PopFunctionScopeInfo(&WP, BD, BlockTy);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Set the captured variables on the block.
 | 
						|
  SmallVector<BlockDecl::Capture, 4> Captures;
 | 
						|
  for (Capture &Cap : BSI->Captures) {
 | 
						|
    if (Cap.isInvalid() || Cap.isThisCapture())
 | 
						|
      continue;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    VarDecl *Var = Cap.getVariable();
 | 
						|
    Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr;
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Cap.isCopyCapture()) {
 | 
						|
      if (const RecordType *Record =
 | 
						|
              Cap.getCaptureType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
 | 
						|
        // The capture logic needs the destructor, so make sure we mark it.
 | 
						|
        // Usually this is unnecessary because most local variables have
 | 
						|
        // their destructors marked at declaration time, but parameters are
 | 
						|
        // an exception because it's technically only the call site that
 | 
						|
        // actually requires the destructor.
 | 
						|
        if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(Var))
 | 
						|
          FinalizeVarWithDestructor(Var, Record);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        // Enter a separate potentially-evaluated context while building block
 | 
						|
        // initializers to isolate their cleanups from those of the block
 | 
						|
        // itself.
 | 
						|
        // FIXME: Is this appropriate even when the block itself occurs in an
 | 
						|
        // unevaluated operand?
 | 
						|
        EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext(
 | 
						|
            *this, ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        SourceLocation Loc = Cap.getLocation();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        ExprResult Result = BuildDeclarationNameExpr(
 | 
						|
            CXXScopeSpec(), DeclarationNameInfo(Var->getDeclName(), Loc), Var);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        // According to the blocks spec, the capture of a variable from
 | 
						|
        // the stack requires a const copy constructor.  This is not true
 | 
						|
        // of the copy/move done to move a __block variable to the heap.
 | 
						|
        if (!Result.isInvalid() &&
 | 
						|
            !Result.get()->getType().isConstQualified()) {
 | 
						|
          Result = ImpCastExprToType(Result.get(),
 | 
						|
                                     Result.get()->getType().withConst(),
 | 
						|
                                     CK_NoOp, VK_LValue);
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        if (!Result.isInvalid()) {
 | 
						|
          Result = PerformCopyInitialization(
 | 
						|
              InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(Var->getLocation(),
 | 
						|
                                                 Cap.getCaptureType(), false),
 | 
						|
              Loc, Result.get());
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        // Build a full-expression copy expression if initialization
 | 
						|
        // succeeded and used a non-trivial constructor.  Recover from
 | 
						|
        // errors by pretending that the copy isn't necessary.
 | 
						|
        if (!Result.isInvalid() &&
 | 
						|
            !cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Result.get())->getConstructor()
 | 
						|
                ->isTrivial()) {
 | 
						|
          Result = MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Result);
 | 
						|
          CopyExpr = Result.get();
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    BlockDecl::Capture NewCap(Var, Cap.isBlockCapture(), Cap.isNested(),
 | 
						|
                              CopyExpr);
 | 
						|
    Captures.push_back(NewCap);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  BD->setCaptures(Context, Captures, BSI->CXXThisCaptureIndex != 0);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BD, BlockTy);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If the block isn't obviously global, i.e. it captures anything at
 | 
						|
  // all, then we need to do a few things in the surrounding context:
 | 
						|
  if (Result->getBlockDecl()->hasCaptures()) {
 | 
						|
    // First, this expression has a new cleanup object.
 | 
						|
    ExprCleanupObjects.push_back(Result->getBlockDecl());
 | 
						|
    Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(true);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // It also gets a branch-protected scope if any of the captured
 | 
						|
    // variables needs destruction.
 | 
						|
    for (const auto &CI : Result->getBlockDecl()->captures()) {
 | 
						|
      const VarDecl *var = CI.getVariable();
 | 
						|
      if (var->getType().isDestructedType() != QualType::DK_none) {
 | 
						|
        setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (getCurFunction())
 | 
						|
    getCurFunction()->addBlock(BD);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return Result;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, Expr *E, ParsedType Ty,
 | 
						|
                            SourceLocation RPLoc) {
 | 
						|
  TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
 | 
						|
  GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
 | 
						|
  return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
 | 
						|
                                Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
 | 
						|
                                SourceLocation RPLoc) {
 | 
						|
  Expr *OrigExpr = E;
 | 
						|
  bool IsMS = false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // CUDA device code does not support varargs.
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CUDA && getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice) {
 | 
						|
    if (const FunctionDecl *F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) {
 | 
						|
      CUDAFunctionTarget T = IdentifyCUDATarget(F);
 | 
						|
      if (T == CFT_Global || T == CFT_Device || T == CFT_HostDevice)
 | 
						|
        return ExprError(Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_va_arg_in_device));
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // NVPTX does not support va_arg expression.
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().OpenMP && getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice &&
 | 
						|
      Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isNVPTX())
 | 
						|
    targetDiag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_va_arg_in_device);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // It might be a __builtin_ms_va_list. (But don't ever mark a va_arg()
 | 
						|
  // as Microsoft ABI on an actual Microsoft platform, where
 | 
						|
  // __builtin_ms_va_list and __builtin_va_list are the same.)
 | 
						|
  if (!E->isTypeDependent() && Context.getTargetInfo().hasBuiltinMSVaList() &&
 | 
						|
      Context.getTargetInfo().getBuiltinVaListKind() != TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList) {
 | 
						|
    QualType MSVaListType = Context.getBuiltinMSVaListType();
 | 
						|
    if (Context.hasSameType(MSVaListType, E->getType())) {
 | 
						|
      if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      IsMS = true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Get the va_list type
 | 
						|
  QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
 | 
						|
  if (!IsMS) {
 | 
						|
    if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
 | 
						|
      // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
 | 
						|
      // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
 | 
						|
      // a pointer for va_arg.
 | 
						|
      VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
 | 
						|
      // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
 | 
						|
      ExprResult Result = UsualUnaryConversions(E);
 | 
						|
      if (Result.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      E = Result.get();
 | 
						|
    } else if (VaListType->isRecordType() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
      // If va_list is a record type and we are compiling in C++ mode,
 | 
						|
      // check the argument using reference binding.
 | 
						|
      InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
 | 
						|
          Context, Context.getLValueReferenceType(VaListType), false);
 | 
						|
      ExprResult Init = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), E);
 | 
						|
      if (Init.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      E = Init.getAs<Expr>();
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
 | 
						|
      // it is modified by va_arg.
 | 
						|
      if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
 | 
						|
          CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!IsMS && !E->isTypeDependent() &&
 | 
						|
      !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType()))
 | 
						|
    return ExprError(
 | 
						|
        Diag(E->getBeginLoc(),
 | 
						|
             diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
 | 
						|
        << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!TInfo->getType()->isDependentType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (RequireCompleteType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TInfo->getType(),
 | 
						|
                            diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_incomplete,
 | 
						|
                            TInfo->getTypeLoc()))
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (RequireNonAbstractType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
 | 
						|
                               TInfo->getType(),
 | 
						|
                               diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_abstract,
 | 
						|
                               TInfo->getTypeLoc()))
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (!TInfo->getType().isPODType(Context)) {
 | 
						|
      Diag(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
 | 
						|
           TInfo->getType()->isObjCLifetimeType()
 | 
						|
             ? diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_ownership_qualified
 | 
						|
             : diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_not_pod)
 | 
						|
        << TInfo->getType()
 | 
						|
        << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Check for va_arg where arguments of the given type will be promoted
 | 
						|
    // (i.e. this va_arg is guaranteed to have undefined behavior).
 | 
						|
    QualType PromoteType;
 | 
						|
    if (TInfo->getType()->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
 | 
						|
      PromoteType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(TInfo->getType());
 | 
						|
      if (Context.typesAreCompatible(PromoteType, TInfo->getType()))
 | 
						|
        PromoteType = QualType();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    if (TInfo->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
 | 
						|
      PromoteType = Context.DoubleTy;
 | 
						|
    if (!PromoteType.isNull())
 | 
						|
      DiagRuntimeBehavior(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), E,
 | 
						|
                  PDiag(diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_never_compatible)
 | 
						|
                          << TInfo->getType()
 | 
						|
                          << PromoteType
 | 
						|
                          << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
 | 
						|
  return new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T, IsMS);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
 | 
						|
  // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
 | 
						|
  // pointers on the target.
 | 
						|
  QualType Ty;
 | 
						|
  unsigned pw = Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0);
 | 
						|
  if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth())
 | 
						|
    Ty = Context.IntTy;
 | 
						|
  else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth())
 | 
						|
    Ty = Context.LongTy;
 | 
						|
  else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth())
 | 
						|
    Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
 | 
						|
  else {
 | 
						|
    llvm_unreachable("I don't know size of pointer!");
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnSourceLocExpr(SourceLocExpr::IdentKind Kind,
 | 
						|
                                    SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
 | 
						|
                                    SourceLocation RPLoc) {
 | 
						|
  return BuildSourceLocExpr(Kind, BuiltinLoc, RPLoc, CurContext);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::BuildSourceLocExpr(SourceLocExpr::IdentKind Kind,
 | 
						|
                                    SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
 | 
						|
                                    SourceLocation RPLoc,
 | 
						|
                                    DeclContext *ParentContext) {
 | 
						|
  return new (Context)
 | 
						|
      SourceLocExpr(Context, Kind, BuiltinLoc, RPLoc, ParentContext);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
bool Sema::ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(QualType DstType, Expr *&Exp,
 | 
						|
                                              bool Diagnose) {
 | 
						|
  if (!getLangOpts().ObjC)
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
 | 
						|
  if (!PT)
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
 | 
						|
    // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
 | 
						|
    const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
 | 
						|
    if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Ignore any parens, implicit casts (should only be
 | 
						|
  // array-to-pointer decays), and not-so-opaque values.  The last is
 | 
						|
  // important for making this trigger for property assignments.
 | 
						|
  Expr *SrcExpr = Exp->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
 | 
						|
  if (OpaqueValueExpr *OV = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(SrcExpr))
 | 
						|
    if (OV->getSourceExpr())
 | 
						|
      SrcExpr = OV->getSourceExpr()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr);
 | 
						|
  if (!SL || !SL->isAscii())
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
  if (Diagnose) {
 | 
						|
    Diag(SL->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_missing_atsign_prefix)
 | 
						|
        << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getBeginLoc(), "@");
 | 
						|
    Exp = BuildObjCStringLiteral(SL->getBeginLoc(), SL).get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return true;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static bool maybeDiagnoseAssignmentToFunction(Sema &S, QualType DstType,
 | 
						|
                                              const Expr *SrcExpr) {
 | 
						|
  if (!DstType->isFunctionPointerType() ||
 | 
						|
      !SrcExpr->getType()->isFunctionType())
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
 | 
						|
  if (!DRE)
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
 | 
						|
  if (!FD)
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return !S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD,
 | 
						|
                                              /*Complain=*/true,
 | 
						|
                                              SrcExpr->getBeginLoc());
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
 | 
						|
                                    SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                    QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
 | 
						|
                                    Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
 | 
						|
                                    bool *Complained) {
 | 
						|
  if (Complained)
 | 
						|
    *Complained = false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
 | 
						|
  bool CheckInferredResultType = false;
 | 
						|
  bool isInvalid = false;
 | 
						|
  unsigned DiagKind = 0;
 | 
						|
  FixItHint Hint;
 | 
						|
  ConversionFixItGenerator ConvHints;
 | 
						|
  bool MayHaveConvFixit = false;
 | 
						|
  bool MayHaveFunctionDiff = false;
 | 
						|
  const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr;
 | 
						|
  const ObjCProtocolDecl *PDecl = nullptr;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  switch (ConvTy) {
 | 
						|
  case Compatible:
 | 
						|
      DiagnoseAssignmentEnum(DstType, SrcType, SrcExpr);
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case PointerToInt:
 | 
						|
    DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
 | 
						|
    ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
 | 
						|
    MayHaveConvFixit = true;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case IntToPointer:
 | 
						|
    DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
 | 
						|
    ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
 | 
						|
    MayHaveConvFixit = true;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case IncompatiblePointer:
 | 
						|
    if (Action == AA_Passing_CFAudited)
 | 
						|
      DiagKind = diag::err_arc_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
 | 
						|
    else if (SrcType->isFunctionPointerType() &&
 | 
						|
             DstType->isFunctionPointerType())
 | 
						|
      DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_function_pointer;
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    CheckInferredResultType = DstType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
 | 
						|
      SrcType->isObjCObjectPointerType();
 | 
						|
    if (Hint.isNull() && !CheckInferredResultType) {
 | 
						|
      ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    else if (CheckInferredResultType) {
 | 
						|
      SrcType = SrcType.getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
      DstType = DstType.getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    MayHaveConvFixit = true;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case IncompatiblePointerSign:
 | 
						|
    DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case FunctionVoidPointer:
 | 
						|
    DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: {
 | 
						|
    // Perform array-to-pointer decay if necessary.
 | 
						|
    if (SrcType->isArrayType()) SrcType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(SrcType);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    Qualifiers lhq = SrcType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers();
 | 
						|
    Qualifiers rhq = DstType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers();
 | 
						|
    if (lhq.getAddressSpace() != rhq.getAddressSpace()) {
 | 
						|
      DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_address_space;
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    } else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime()) {
 | 
						|
      DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_ownership;
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    llvm_unreachable("unknown error case for discarding qualifiers!");
 | 
						|
    // fallthrough
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
 | 
						|
    // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
 | 
						|
    // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
 | 
						|
    // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2).  FIXME:
 | 
						|
    // Ideally, this check would be performed in
 | 
						|
    // checkPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
 | 
						|
    // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
 | 
						|
    // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
 | 
						|
    // of a larger effort to fix checkPointerTypesForAssignment for
 | 
						|
    // C++ semantics.
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
 | 
						|
        IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
    DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
 | 
						|
    DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case IncompatibleNestedPointerAddressSpaceMismatch:
 | 
						|
    DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_nested_address_space;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case IntToBlockPointer:
 | 
						|
    DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
 | 
						|
    DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId: {
 | 
						|
    if (SrcType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
 | 
						|
      const ObjCObjectPointerType *srcOPT =
 | 
						|
                SrcType->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
 | 
						|
      for (auto *srcProto : srcOPT->quals()) {
 | 
						|
        PDecl = srcProto;
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT =
 | 
						|
            DstType->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType())
 | 
						|
        IFace = IFaceT->getDecl();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    else if (DstType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
 | 
						|
      const ObjCObjectPointerType *dstOPT =
 | 
						|
        DstType->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
 | 
						|
      for (auto *dstProto : dstOPT->quals()) {
 | 
						|
        PDecl = dstProto;
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT =
 | 
						|
            SrcType->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType())
 | 
						|
        IFace = IFaceT->getDecl();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  case IncompatibleVectors:
 | 
						|
    DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case IncompatibleObjCWeakRef:
 | 
						|
    DiagKind = diag::err_arc_weak_unavailable_assign;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  case Incompatible:
 | 
						|
    if (maybeDiagnoseAssignmentToFunction(*this, DstType, SrcExpr)) {
 | 
						|
      if (Complained)
 | 
						|
        *Complained = true;
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
 | 
						|
    ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
 | 
						|
    MayHaveConvFixit = true;
 | 
						|
    isInvalid = true;
 | 
						|
    MayHaveFunctionDiff = true;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  QualType FirstType, SecondType;
 | 
						|
  switch (Action) {
 | 
						|
  case AA_Assigning:
 | 
						|
  case AA_Initializing:
 | 
						|
    // The destination type comes first.
 | 
						|
    FirstType = DstType;
 | 
						|
    SecondType = SrcType;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case AA_Returning:
 | 
						|
  case AA_Passing:
 | 
						|
  case AA_Passing_CFAudited:
 | 
						|
  case AA_Converting:
 | 
						|
  case AA_Sending:
 | 
						|
  case AA_Casting:
 | 
						|
    // The source type comes first.
 | 
						|
    FirstType = SrcType;
 | 
						|
    SecondType = DstType;
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  PartialDiagnostic FDiag = PDiag(DiagKind);
 | 
						|
  if (Action == AA_Passing_CFAudited)
 | 
						|
    FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << AA_Passing << SrcExpr->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
  else
 | 
						|
    FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << Action << SrcExpr->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
 | 
						|
  assert(ConvHints.isNull() || Hint.isNull());
 | 
						|
  if (!ConvHints.isNull()) {
 | 
						|
    for (FixItHint &H : ConvHints.Hints)
 | 
						|
      FDiag << H;
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    FDiag << Hint;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (MayHaveConvFixit) { FDiag << (unsigned) (ConvHints.Kind); }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (MayHaveFunctionDiff)
 | 
						|
    HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(FDiag, SecondType, FirstType);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Diag(Loc, FDiag);
 | 
						|
  if (DiagKind == diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id &&
 | 
						|
      PDecl && IFace && !IFace->hasDefinition())
 | 
						|
      Diag(IFace->getLocation(), diag::note_incomplete_class_and_qualified_id)
 | 
						|
        << IFace << PDecl;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (SecondType == Context.OverloadTy)
 | 
						|
    NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr).Expression,
 | 
						|
                              FirstType, /*TakingAddress=*/true);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (CheckInferredResultType)
 | 
						|
    EmitRelatedResultTypeNote(SrcExpr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Action == AA_Returning && ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer)
 | 
						|
    EmitRelatedResultTypeNoteForReturn(DstType);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Complained)
 | 
						|
    *Complained = true;
 | 
						|
  return isInvalid;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E,
 | 
						|
                                                 llvm::APSInt *Result) {
 | 
						|
  class SimpleICEDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser {
 | 
						|
  public:
 | 
						|
    void diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange SR) override {
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_expr_not_ice) << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus << SR;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } Diagnoser;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E,
 | 
						|
                                                 llvm::APSInt *Result,
 | 
						|
                                                 unsigned DiagID,
 | 
						|
                                                 bool AllowFold) {
 | 
						|
  class IDDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser {
 | 
						|
    unsigned DiagID;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  public:
 | 
						|
    IDDiagnoser(unsigned DiagID)
 | 
						|
      : VerifyICEDiagnoser(DiagID == 0), DiagID(DiagID) { }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    void diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange SR) override {
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << SR;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } Diagnoser(DiagID);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser, AllowFold);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
void Sema::VerifyICEDiagnoser::diagnoseFold(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                            SourceRange SR) {
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_expr_not_ice) << SR << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result,
 | 
						|
                                      VerifyICEDiagnoser &Diagnoser,
 | 
						|
                                      bool AllowFold) {
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation DiagLoc = E->getBeginLoc();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
 | 
						|
    // C++11 [expr.const]p5:
 | 
						|
    //   If an expression of literal class type is used in a context where an
 | 
						|
    //   integral constant expression is required, then that class type shall
 | 
						|
    //   have a single non-explicit conversion function to an integral or
 | 
						|
    //   unscoped enumeration type
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Converted;
 | 
						|
    class CXX11ConvertDiagnoser : public ICEConvertDiagnoser {
 | 
						|
    public:
 | 
						|
      CXX11ConvertDiagnoser(bool Silent)
 | 
						|
          : ICEConvertDiagnoser(/*AllowScopedEnumerations*/false,
 | 
						|
                                Silent, true) {}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseNotInt(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                           QualType T) override {
 | 
						|
        return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_not_integral) << T;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseIncomplete(
 | 
						|
          Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
 | 
						|
        return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_incomplete_type) << T;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseExplicitConv(
 | 
						|
          Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override {
 | 
						|
        return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_explicit_conversion) << T << ConvTy;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteExplicitConv(
 | 
						|
          Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override {
 | 
						|
        return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here)
 | 
						|
                 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseAmbiguous(
 | 
						|
          Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
 | 
						|
        return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_ambiguous_conversion) << T;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteAmbiguous(
 | 
						|
          Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override {
 | 
						|
        return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here)
 | 
						|
                 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseConversion(
 | 
						|
          Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override {
 | 
						|
        llvm_unreachable("conversion functions are permitted");
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    } ConvertDiagnoser(Diagnoser.Suppress);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    Converted = PerformContextualImplicitConversion(DiagLoc, E,
 | 
						|
                                                    ConvertDiagnoser);
 | 
						|
    if (Converted.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return Converted;
 | 
						|
    E = Converted.get();
 | 
						|
    if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  } else if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
 | 
						|
    // An ICE must be of integral or unscoped enumeration type.
 | 
						|
    if (!Diagnoser.Suppress)
 | 
						|
      Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Circumvent ICE checking in C++11 to avoid evaluating the expression twice
 | 
						|
  // in the non-ICE case.
 | 
						|
  if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context)) {
 | 
						|
    if (Result)
 | 
						|
      *Result = E->EvaluateKnownConstIntCheckOverflow(Context);
 | 
						|
    if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(E))
 | 
						|
      E = ConstantExpr::Create(Context, E);
 | 
						|
    return E;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
 | 
						|
  SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
 | 
						|
  EvalResult.Diag = &Notes;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Try to evaluate the expression, and produce diagnostics explaining why it's
 | 
						|
  // not a constant expression as a side-effect.
 | 
						|
  bool Folded =
 | 
						|
      E->EvaluateAsRValue(EvalResult, Context, /*isConstantContext*/ true) &&
 | 
						|
      EvalResult.Val.isInt() && !EvalResult.HasSideEffects;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(E))
 | 
						|
    E = ConstantExpr::Create(Context, E, EvalResult.Val);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // In C++11, we can rely on diagnostics being produced for any expression
 | 
						|
  // which is not a constant expression. If no diagnostics were produced, then
 | 
						|
  // this is a constant expression.
 | 
						|
  if (Folded && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Notes.empty()) {
 | 
						|
    if (Result)
 | 
						|
      *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
 | 
						|
    return E;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If our only note is the usual "invalid subexpression" note, just point
 | 
						|
  // the caret at its location rather than producing an essentially
 | 
						|
  // redundant note.
 | 
						|
  if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() ==
 | 
						|
        diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) {
 | 
						|
    DiagLoc = Notes[0].first;
 | 
						|
    Notes.clear();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!Folded || !AllowFold) {
 | 
						|
    if (!Diagnoser.Suppress) {
 | 
						|
      Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
      for (const PartialDiagnosticAt &Note : Notes)
 | 
						|
        Diag(Note.first, Note.second);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Diagnoser.diagnoseFold(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange());
 | 
						|
  for (const PartialDiagnosticAt &Note : Notes)
 | 
						|
    Diag(Note.first, Note.second);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Result)
 | 
						|
    *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
 | 
						|
  return E;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
namespace {
 | 
						|
  // Handle the case where we conclude a expression which we speculatively
 | 
						|
  // considered to be unevaluated is actually evaluated.
 | 
						|
  class TransformToPE : public TreeTransform<TransformToPE> {
 | 
						|
    typedef TreeTransform<TransformToPE> BaseTransform;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  public:
 | 
						|
    TransformToPE(Sema &SemaRef) : BaseTransform(SemaRef) { }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Make sure we redo semantic analysis
 | 
						|
    bool AlwaysRebuild() { return true; }
 | 
						|
    bool ReplacingOriginal() { return true; }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // We need to special-case DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls which
 | 
						|
    // are not part of a member pointer formation; normal TreeTransforming
 | 
						|
    // doesn't catch this case because of the way we represent them in the AST.
 | 
						|
    // FIXME: This is a bit ugly; is it really the best way to handle this
 | 
						|
    // case?
 | 
						|
    //
 | 
						|
    // Error on DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls.
 | 
						|
    ExprResult TransformDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
 | 
						|
      if (isa<FieldDecl>(E->getDecl()) &&
 | 
						|
          !SemaRef.isUnevaluatedContext())
 | 
						|
        return SemaRef.Diag(E->getLocation(),
 | 
						|
                            diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
 | 
						|
            << E->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      return BaseTransform::TransformDeclRefExpr(E);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Exception: filter out member pointer formation
 | 
						|
    ExprResult TransformUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) {
 | 
						|
      if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && E->getType()->isMemberPointerType())
 | 
						|
        return E;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      return BaseTransform::TransformUnaryOperator(E);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // The body of a lambda-expression is in a separate expression evaluation
 | 
						|
    // context so never needs to be transformed.
 | 
						|
    // FIXME: Ideally we wouldn't transform the closure type either, and would
 | 
						|
    // just recreate the capture expressions and lambda expression.
 | 
						|
    StmtResult TransformLambdaBody(LambdaExpr *E, Stmt *Body) {
 | 
						|
      return SkipLambdaBody(E, Body);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  };
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  assert(isUnevaluatedContext() &&
 | 
						|
         "Should only transform unevaluated expressions");
 | 
						|
  ExprEvalContexts.back().Context =
 | 
						|
      ExprEvalContexts[ExprEvalContexts.size()-2].Context;
 | 
						|
  if (isUnevaluatedContext())
 | 
						|
    return E;
 | 
						|
  return TransformToPE(*this).TransformExpr(E);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
void
 | 
						|
Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(
 | 
						|
    ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, Decl *LambdaContextDecl,
 | 
						|
    ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::ExpressionKind ExprContext) {
 | 
						|
  ExprEvalContexts.emplace_back(NewContext, ExprCleanupObjects.size(), Cleanup,
 | 
						|
                                LambdaContextDecl, ExprContext);
 | 
						|
  Cleanup.reset();
 | 
						|
  if (!MaybeODRUseExprs.empty())
 | 
						|
    std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, ExprEvalContexts.back().SavedMaybeODRUseExprs);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
void
 | 
						|
Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(
 | 
						|
    ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, ReuseLambdaContextDecl_t,
 | 
						|
    ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::ExpressionKind ExprContext) {
 | 
						|
  Decl *ClosureContextDecl = ExprEvalContexts.back().ManglingContextDecl;
 | 
						|
  PushExpressionEvaluationContext(NewContext, ClosureContextDecl, ExprContext);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
namespace {
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
const DeclRefExpr *CheckPossibleDeref(Sema &S, const Expr *PossibleDeref) {
 | 
						|
  PossibleDeref = PossibleDeref->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
 | 
						|
  if (const auto *E = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(PossibleDeref)) {
 | 
						|
    if (E->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
 | 
						|
      return CheckPossibleDeref(S, E->getSubExpr());
 | 
						|
  } else if (const auto *E = dyn_cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(PossibleDeref)) {
 | 
						|
    return CheckPossibleDeref(S, E->getBase());
 | 
						|
  } else if (const auto *E = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(PossibleDeref)) {
 | 
						|
    return CheckPossibleDeref(S, E->getBase());
 | 
						|
  } else if (const auto E = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(PossibleDeref)) {
 | 
						|
    QualType Inner;
 | 
						|
    QualType Ty = E->getType();
 | 
						|
    if (const auto *Ptr = Ty->getAs<PointerType>())
 | 
						|
      Inner = Ptr->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
    else if (const auto *Arr = S.Context.getAsArrayType(Ty))
 | 
						|
      Inner = Arr->getElementType();
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      return nullptr;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (Inner->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref))
 | 
						|
      return E;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return nullptr;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
} // namespace
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
void Sema::WarnOnPendingNoDerefs(ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord &Rec) {
 | 
						|
  for (const Expr *E : Rec.PossibleDerefs) {
 | 
						|
    const DeclRefExpr *DeclRef = CheckPossibleDeref(*this, E);
 | 
						|
    if (DeclRef) {
 | 
						|
      const ValueDecl *Decl = DeclRef->getDecl();
 | 
						|
      Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_dereference_of_noderef_type)
 | 
						|
          << Decl->getName() << E->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << Decl->getName();
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_dereference_of_noderef_type_no_decl)
 | 
						|
          << E->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  Rec.PossibleDerefs.clear();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Check whether E, which is either a discarded-value expression or an
 | 
						|
/// unevaluated operand, is a simple-assignment to a volatlie-qualified lvalue,
 | 
						|
/// and if so, remove it from the list of volatile-qualified assignments that
 | 
						|
/// we are going to warn are deprecated.
 | 
						|
void Sema::CheckUnusedVolatileAssignment(Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  if (!E->getType().isVolatileQualified() || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Note: ignoring parens here is not justified by the standard rules, but
 | 
						|
  // ignoring parentheses seems like a more reasonable approach, and this only
 | 
						|
  // drives a deprecation warning so doesn't affect conformance.
 | 
						|
  if (auto *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParenImpCasts())) {
 | 
						|
    if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_Assign) {
 | 
						|
      auto &LHSs = ExprEvalContexts.back().VolatileAssignmentLHSs;
 | 
						|
      LHSs.erase(std::remove(LHSs.begin(), LHSs.end(), BO->getLHS()),
 | 
						|
                 LHSs.end());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
void Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
 | 
						|
  ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord& Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
 | 
						|
  unsigned NumTypos = Rec.NumTypos;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!Rec.Lambdas.empty()) {
 | 
						|
    using ExpressionKind = ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::ExpressionKind;
 | 
						|
    if (Rec.ExprContext == ExpressionKind::EK_TemplateArgument || Rec.isUnevaluated() ||
 | 
						|
        (Rec.isConstantEvaluated() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17)) {
 | 
						|
      unsigned D;
 | 
						|
      if (Rec.isUnevaluated()) {
 | 
						|
        // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p2:
 | 
						|
        //   A lambda-expression shall not appear in an unevaluated operand
 | 
						|
        //   (Clause 5).
 | 
						|
        D = diag::err_lambda_unevaluated_operand;
 | 
						|
      } else if (Rec.isConstantEvaluated() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17) {
 | 
						|
        // C++1y [expr.const]p2:
 | 
						|
        //   A conditional-expression e is a core constant expression unless the
 | 
						|
        //   evaluation of e, following the rules of the abstract machine, would
 | 
						|
        //   evaluate [...] a lambda-expression.
 | 
						|
        D = diag::err_lambda_in_constant_expression;
 | 
						|
      } else if (Rec.ExprContext == ExpressionKind::EK_TemplateArgument) {
 | 
						|
        // C++17 [expr.prim.lamda]p2:
 | 
						|
        // A lambda-expression shall not appear [...] in a template-argument.
 | 
						|
        D = diag::err_lambda_in_invalid_context;
 | 
						|
      } else
 | 
						|
        llvm_unreachable("Couldn't infer lambda error message.");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      for (const auto *L : Rec.Lambdas)
 | 
						|
        Diag(L->getBeginLoc(), D);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  WarnOnPendingNoDerefs(Rec);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Warn on any volatile-qualified simple-assignments that are not discarded-
 | 
						|
  // value expressions nor unevaluated operands (those cases get removed from
 | 
						|
  // this list by CheckUnusedVolatileAssignment).
 | 
						|
  for (auto *BO : Rec.VolatileAssignmentLHSs)
 | 
						|
    Diag(BO->getBeginLoc(), diag::warn_deprecated_simple_assign_volatile)
 | 
						|
        << BO->getType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
 | 
						|
  // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
 | 
						|
  // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
 | 
						|
  // will never be constructed.
 | 
						|
  if (Rec.isUnevaluated() || Rec.isConstantEvaluated()) {
 | 
						|
    ExprCleanupObjects.erase(ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + Rec.NumCleanupObjects,
 | 
						|
                             ExprCleanupObjects.end());
 | 
						|
    Cleanup = Rec.ParentCleanup;
 | 
						|
    CleanupVarDeclMarking();
 | 
						|
    std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs);
 | 
						|
  // Otherwise, merge the contexts together.
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    Cleanup.mergeFrom(Rec.ParentCleanup);
 | 
						|
    MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs.begin(),
 | 
						|
                            Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs.end());
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
 | 
						|
  ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The global expression evaluation context record is never popped.
 | 
						|
  ExprEvalContexts.back().NumTypos += NumTypos;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
void Sema::DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext() {
 | 
						|
  ExprCleanupObjects.erase(
 | 
						|
         ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects,
 | 
						|
         ExprCleanupObjects.end());
 | 
						|
  Cleanup.reset();
 | 
						|
  MaybeODRUseExprs.clear();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::HandleExprEvaluationContextForTypeof(Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
 | 
						|
  if (Result.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  E = Result.get();
 | 
						|
  if (!E->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType())
 | 
						|
    return E;
 | 
						|
  return TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Are we in a context that is potentially constant evaluated per C++20
 | 
						|
/// [expr.const]p12?
 | 
						|
static bool isPotentiallyConstantEvaluatedContext(Sema &SemaRef) {
 | 
						|
  /// C++2a [expr.const]p12:
 | 
						|
  //   An expression or conversion is potentially constant evaluated if it is
 | 
						|
  switch (SemaRef.ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
 | 
						|
    case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated:
 | 
						|
      // -- a manifestly constant-evaluated expression,
 | 
						|
    case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated:
 | 
						|
    case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
 | 
						|
    case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::DiscardedStatement:
 | 
						|
      // -- a potentially-evaluated expression,
 | 
						|
    case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedList:
 | 
						|
      // -- an immediate subexpression of a braced-init-list,
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // -- [FIXME] an expression of the form & cast-expression that occurs
 | 
						|
      //    within a templated entity
 | 
						|
      // -- a subexpression of one of the above that is not a subexpression of
 | 
						|
      // a nested unevaluated operand.
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated:
 | 
						|
    case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedAbstract:
 | 
						|
      // Expressions in this context are never evaluated.
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  llvm_unreachable("Invalid context");
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Return true if this function has a calling convention that requires mangling
 | 
						|
/// in the size of the parameter pack.
 | 
						|
static bool funcHasParameterSizeMangling(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD) {
 | 
						|
  // These manglings don't do anything on non-Windows or non-x86 platforms, so
 | 
						|
  // we don't need parameter type sizes.
 | 
						|
  const llvm::Triple &TT = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple();
 | 
						|
  if (!TT.isOSWindows() || !TT.isX86())
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If this is C++ and this isn't an extern "C" function, parameters do not
 | 
						|
  // need to be complete. In this case, C++ mangling will apply, which doesn't
 | 
						|
  // use the size of the parameters.
 | 
						|
  if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->isExternC())
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Stdcall, fastcall, and vectorcall need this special treatment.
 | 
						|
  CallingConv CC = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv();
 | 
						|
  switch (CC) {
 | 
						|
  case CC_X86StdCall:
 | 
						|
  case CC_X86FastCall:
 | 
						|
  case CC_X86VectorCall:
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  default:
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Require that all of the parameter types of function be complete. Normally,
 | 
						|
/// parameter types are only required to be complete when a function is called
 | 
						|
/// or defined, but to mangle functions with certain calling conventions, the
 | 
						|
/// mangler needs to know the size of the parameter list. In this situation,
 | 
						|
/// MSVC doesn't emit an error or instantiate templates. Instead, MSVC mangles
 | 
						|
/// the function as _foo@0, i.e. zero bytes of parameters, which will usually
 | 
						|
/// result in a linker error. Clang doesn't implement this behavior, and instead
 | 
						|
/// attempts to error at compile time.
 | 
						|
static void CheckCompleteParameterTypesForMangler(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD,
 | 
						|
                                                  SourceLocation Loc) {
 | 
						|
  class ParamIncompleteTypeDiagnoser : public Sema::TypeDiagnoser {
 | 
						|
    FunctionDecl *FD;
 | 
						|
    ParmVarDecl *Param;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  public:
 | 
						|
    ParamIncompleteTypeDiagnoser(FunctionDecl *FD, ParmVarDecl *Param)
 | 
						|
        : FD(FD), Param(Param) {}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
 | 
						|
      CallingConv CC = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv();
 | 
						|
      StringRef CCName;
 | 
						|
      switch (CC) {
 | 
						|
      case CC_X86StdCall:
 | 
						|
        CCName = "stdcall";
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      case CC_X86FastCall:
 | 
						|
        CCName = "fastcall";
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      case CC_X86VectorCall:
 | 
						|
        CCName = "vectorcall";
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      default:
 | 
						|
        llvm_unreachable("CC does not need mangling");
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_cconv_incomplete_param_type)
 | 
						|
          << Param->getDeclName() << FD->getDeclName() << CCName;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  };
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  for (ParmVarDecl *Param : FD->parameters()) {
 | 
						|
    ParamIncompleteTypeDiagnoser Diagnoser(FD, Param);
 | 
						|
    S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Param->getType(), Diagnoser);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
namespace {
 | 
						|
enum class OdrUseContext {
 | 
						|
  /// Declarations in this context are not odr-used.
 | 
						|
  None,
 | 
						|
  /// Declarations in this context are formally odr-used, but this is a
 | 
						|
  /// dependent context.
 | 
						|
  Dependent,
 | 
						|
  /// Declarations in this context are odr-used but not actually used (yet).
 | 
						|
  FormallyOdrUsed,
 | 
						|
  /// Declarations in this context are used.
 | 
						|
  Used
 | 
						|
};
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Are we within a context in which references to resolved functions or to
 | 
						|
/// variables result in odr-use?
 | 
						|
static OdrUseContext isOdrUseContext(Sema &SemaRef) {
 | 
						|
  OdrUseContext Result;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  switch (SemaRef.ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
 | 
						|
    case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated:
 | 
						|
    case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedList:
 | 
						|
    case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedAbstract:
 | 
						|
      return OdrUseContext::None;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated:
 | 
						|
    case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated:
 | 
						|
      Result = OdrUseContext::Used;
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::DiscardedStatement:
 | 
						|
      Result = OdrUseContext::FormallyOdrUsed;
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
 | 
						|
      // A default argument formally results in odr-use, but doesn't actually
 | 
						|
      // result in a use in any real sense until it itself is used.
 | 
						|
      Result = OdrUseContext::FormallyOdrUsed;
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (SemaRef.CurContext->isDependentContext())
 | 
						|
    return OdrUseContext::Dependent;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return Result;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static bool isImplicitlyDefinableConstexprFunction(FunctionDecl *Func) {
 | 
						|
  return Func->isConstexpr() &&
 | 
						|
         (Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable() || !Func->isUserProvided());
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Mark a function referenced, and check whether it is odr-used
 | 
						|
/// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3)
 | 
						|
void Sema::MarkFunctionReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, FunctionDecl *Func,
 | 
						|
                                  bool MightBeOdrUse) {
 | 
						|
  assert(Func && "No function?");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Func->setReferenced();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Recursive functions aren't really used until they're used from some other
 | 
						|
  // context.
 | 
						|
  bool IsRecursiveCall = CurContext == Func;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p3:
 | 
						|
  //   A function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated expression is
 | 
						|
  //   odr-used if it is the unique lookup result or the selected member of a
 | 
						|
  //   set of overloaded functions [...].
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // We (incorrectly) mark overload resolution as an unevaluated context, so we
 | 
						|
  // can just check that here.
 | 
						|
  OdrUseContext OdrUse =
 | 
						|
      MightBeOdrUse ? isOdrUseContext(*this) : OdrUseContext::None;
 | 
						|
  if (IsRecursiveCall && OdrUse == OdrUseContext::Used)
 | 
						|
    OdrUse = OdrUseContext::FormallyOdrUsed;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Trivial default constructors and destructors are never actually used.
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: What about other special members?
 | 
						|
  if (Func->isTrivial() && !Func->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>() &&
 | 
						|
      OdrUse == OdrUseContext::Used) {
 | 
						|
    if (auto *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func))
 | 
						|
      if (Constructor->isDefaultConstructor())
 | 
						|
        OdrUse = OdrUseContext::FormallyOdrUsed;
 | 
						|
    if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Func))
 | 
						|
      OdrUse = OdrUseContext::FormallyOdrUsed;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++20 [expr.const]p12:
 | 
						|
  //   A function [...] is needed for constant evaluation if it is [...] a
 | 
						|
  //   constexpr function that is named by an expression that is potentially
 | 
						|
  //   constant evaluated
 | 
						|
  bool NeededForConstantEvaluation =
 | 
						|
      isPotentiallyConstantEvaluatedContext(*this) &&
 | 
						|
      isImplicitlyDefinableConstexprFunction(Func);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Determine whether we require a function definition to exist, per
 | 
						|
  // C++11 [temp.inst]p3:
 | 
						|
  //   Unless a function template specialization has been explicitly
 | 
						|
  //   instantiated or explicitly specialized, the function template
 | 
						|
  //   specialization is implicitly instantiated when the specialization is
 | 
						|
  //   referenced in a context that requires a function definition to exist.
 | 
						|
  // C++20 [temp.inst]p7:
 | 
						|
  //   The existence of a definition of a [...] function is considered to
 | 
						|
  //   affect the semantics of the program if the [...] function is needed for
 | 
						|
  //   constant evaluation by an expression
 | 
						|
  // C++20 [basic.def.odr]p10:
 | 
						|
  //   Every program shall contain exactly one definition of every non-inline
 | 
						|
  //   function or variable that is odr-used in that program outside of a
 | 
						|
  //   discarded statement
 | 
						|
  // C++20 [special]p1:
 | 
						|
  //   The implementation will implicitly define [defaulted special members]
 | 
						|
  //   if they are odr-used or needed for constant evaluation.
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // Note that we skip the implicit instantiation of templates that are only
 | 
						|
  // used in unused default arguments or by recursive calls to themselves.
 | 
						|
  // This is formally non-conforming, but seems reasonable in practice.
 | 
						|
  bool NeedDefinition = !IsRecursiveCall && (OdrUse == OdrUseContext::Used ||
 | 
						|
                                             NeededForConstantEvaluation);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++14 [temp.expl.spec]p6:
 | 
						|
  //   If a template [...] is explicitly specialized then that specialization
 | 
						|
  //   shall be declared before the first use of that specialization that would
 | 
						|
  //   cause an implicit instantiation to take place, in every translation unit
 | 
						|
  //   in which such a use occurs
 | 
						|
  if (NeedDefinition &&
 | 
						|
      (Func->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_Undeclared ||
 | 
						|
       Func->getMemberSpecializationInfo()))
 | 
						|
    checkSpecializationVisibility(Loc, Func);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
 | 
						|
    CheckCUDACall(Loc, Func);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If we need a definition, try to create one.
 | 
						|
  if (NeedDefinition && !Func->getBody()) {
 | 
						|
    runWithSufficientStackSpace(Loc, [&] {
 | 
						|
      if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor =
 | 
						|
              dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
 | 
						|
        Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Constructor->getFirstDecl());
 | 
						|
        if (Constructor->isDefaulted() && !Constructor->isDeleted()) {
 | 
						|
          if (Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
 | 
						|
            if (Constructor->isTrivial() &&
 | 
						|
                !Constructor->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>())
 | 
						|
              return;
 | 
						|
            DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
 | 
						|
          } else if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor()) {
 | 
						|
            DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
 | 
						|
          } else if (Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) {
 | 
						|
            DefineImplicitMoveConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
 | 
						|
          }
 | 
						|
        } else if (Constructor->getInheritedConstructor()) {
 | 
						|
          DefineInheritingConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor =
 | 
						|
                     dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Func)) {
 | 
						|
        Destructor = cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Destructor->getFirstDecl());
 | 
						|
        if (Destructor->isDefaulted() && !Destructor->isDeleted()) {
 | 
						|
          if (Destructor->isTrivial() && !Destructor->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>())
 | 
						|
            return;
 | 
						|
          DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
        if (Destructor->isVirtual() && getLangOpts().AppleKext)
 | 
						|
          MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
 | 
						|
      } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func)) {
 | 
						|
        if (MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
 | 
						|
            MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
 | 
						|
          MethodDecl = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl());
 | 
						|
          if (MethodDecl->isDefaulted() && !MethodDecl->isDeleted()) {
 | 
						|
            if (MethodDecl->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
 | 
						|
              DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
 | 
						|
            else if (MethodDecl->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
 | 
						|
              DefineImplicitMoveAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
 | 
						|
          }
 | 
						|
        } else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl) &&
 | 
						|
                   MethodDecl->getParent()->isLambda()) {
 | 
						|
          CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
 | 
						|
              cast<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl());
 | 
						|
          if (Conversion->isLambdaToBlockPointerConversion())
 | 
						|
            DefineImplicitLambdaToBlockPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion);
 | 
						|
          else
 | 
						|
            DefineImplicitLambdaToFunctionPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion);
 | 
						|
        } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual() && getLangOpts().AppleKext)
 | 
						|
          MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (Func->isDefaulted() && !Func->isDeleted()) {
 | 
						|
        DefaultedComparisonKind DCK = getDefaultedComparisonKind(Func);
 | 
						|
        if (DCK != DefaultedComparisonKind::None)
 | 
						|
          DefineDefaultedComparison(Loc, Func, DCK);
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
 | 
						|
      // class templates.
 | 
						|
      if (Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
 | 
						|
        TemplateSpecializationKind TSK =
 | 
						|
            Func->getTemplateSpecializationKindForInstantiation();
 | 
						|
        SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = Func->getPointOfInstantiation();
 | 
						|
        bool FirstInstantiation = PointOfInstantiation.isInvalid();
 | 
						|
        if (FirstInstantiation) {
 | 
						|
          PointOfInstantiation = Loc;
 | 
						|
          Func->setTemplateSpecializationKind(TSK, PointOfInstantiation);
 | 
						|
        } else if (TSK != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
 | 
						|
          // Use the point of use as the point of instantiation, instead of the
 | 
						|
          // point of explicit instantiation (which we track as the actual point
 | 
						|
          // of instantiation). This gives better backtraces in diagnostics.
 | 
						|
          PointOfInstantiation = Loc;
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        if (FirstInstantiation || TSK != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
 | 
						|
            Func->isConstexpr()) {
 | 
						|
          if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()) &&
 | 
						|
              cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass() &&
 | 
						|
              CodeSynthesisContexts.size())
 | 
						|
            PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(
 | 
						|
                std::make_pair(Func, PointOfInstantiation));
 | 
						|
          else if (Func->isConstexpr())
 | 
						|
            // Do not defer instantiations of constexpr functions, to avoid the
 | 
						|
            // expression evaluator needing to call back into Sema if it sees a
 | 
						|
            // call to such a function.
 | 
						|
            InstantiateFunctionDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Func);
 | 
						|
          else {
 | 
						|
            Func->setInstantiationIsPending(true);
 | 
						|
            PendingInstantiations.push_back(
 | 
						|
                std::make_pair(Func, PointOfInstantiation));
 | 
						|
            // Notify the consumer that a function was implicitly instantiated.
 | 
						|
            Consumer.HandleCXXImplicitFunctionInstantiation(Func);
 | 
						|
          }
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      } else {
 | 
						|
        // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
 | 
						|
        for (auto i : Func->redecls()) {
 | 
						|
          if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
 | 
						|
            MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, i, MightBeOdrUse);
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    });
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++14 [except.spec]p17:
 | 
						|
  //   An exception-specification is considered to be needed when:
 | 
						|
  //   - the function is odr-used or, if it appears in an unevaluated operand,
 | 
						|
  //     would be odr-used if the expression were potentially-evaluated;
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // Note, we do this even if MightBeOdrUse is false. That indicates that the
 | 
						|
  // function is a pure virtual function we're calling, and in that case the
 | 
						|
  // function was selected by overload resolution and we need to resolve its
 | 
						|
  // exception specification for a different reason.
 | 
						|
  const FunctionProtoType *FPT = Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
 | 
						|
  if (FPT && isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType()))
 | 
						|
    ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If this is the first "real" use, act on that.
 | 
						|
  if (OdrUse == OdrUseContext::Used && !Func->isUsed(/*CheckUsedAttr=*/false)) {
 | 
						|
    // Keep track of used but undefined functions.
 | 
						|
    if (!Func->isDefined()) {
 | 
						|
      if (mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(Func))
 | 
						|
        UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc));
 | 
						|
      else if (Func->getMostRecentDecl()->isInlined() &&
 | 
						|
               !LangOpts.GNUInline &&
 | 
						|
               !Func->getMostRecentDecl()->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>())
 | 
						|
        UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc));
 | 
						|
      else if (isExternalWithNoLinkageType(Func))
 | 
						|
        UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc));
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Some x86 Windows calling conventions mangle the size of the parameter
 | 
						|
    // pack into the name. Computing the size of the parameters requires the
 | 
						|
    // parameter types to be complete. Check that now.
 | 
						|
    if (funcHasParameterSizeMangling(*this, Func))
 | 
						|
      CheckCompleteParameterTypesForMangler(*this, Func, Loc);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    Func->markUsed(Context);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (LangOpts.OpenMP) {
 | 
						|
    markOpenMPDeclareVariantFuncsReferenced(Loc, Func, MightBeOdrUse);
 | 
						|
    if (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice)
 | 
						|
      checkOpenMPDeviceFunction(Loc, Func);
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      checkOpenMPHostFunction(Loc, Func);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Directly mark a variable odr-used. Given a choice, prefer to use
 | 
						|
/// MarkVariableReferenced since it does additional checks and then
 | 
						|
/// calls MarkVarDeclODRUsed.
 | 
						|
/// If the variable must be captured:
 | 
						|
///  - if FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt is null, capture it in the CurContext
 | 
						|
///  - else capture it in the DeclContext that maps to the
 | 
						|
///    *FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt on the FunctionScopeInfo stack.
 | 
						|
static void
 | 
						|
MarkVarDeclODRUsed(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &SemaRef,
 | 
						|
                   const unsigned *const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt = nullptr) {
 | 
						|
  // Keep track of used but undefined variables.
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: We shouldn't suppress this warning for static data members.
 | 
						|
  if (Var->hasDefinition(SemaRef.Context) == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
 | 
						|
      (!Var->isExternallyVisible() || Var->isInline() ||
 | 
						|
       SemaRef.isExternalWithNoLinkageType(Var)) &&
 | 
						|
      !(Var->isStaticDataMember() && Var->hasInit())) {
 | 
						|
    SourceLocation &old = SemaRef.UndefinedButUsed[Var->getCanonicalDecl()];
 | 
						|
    if (old.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      old = Loc;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  QualType CaptureType, DeclRefType;
 | 
						|
  if (SemaRef.LangOpts.OpenMP)
 | 
						|
    SemaRef.tryCaptureOpenMPLambdas(Var);
 | 
						|
  SemaRef.tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, Sema::TryCapture_Implicit,
 | 
						|
    /*EllipsisLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
 | 
						|
    /*BuildAndDiagnose*/ true,
 | 
						|
    CaptureType, DeclRefType,
 | 
						|
    FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Var->markUsed(SemaRef.Context);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
void Sema::MarkCaptureUsedInEnclosingContext(VarDecl *Capture,
 | 
						|
                                             SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                             unsigned CapturingScopeIndex) {
 | 
						|
  MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Capture, Loc, *this, &CapturingScopeIndex);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void
 | 
						|
diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(Sema &S, SourceLocation loc,
 | 
						|
                                   ValueDecl *var, DeclContext *DC) {
 | 
						|
  DeclContext *VarDC = var->getDeclContext();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  //  If the parameter still belongs to the translation unit, then
 | 
						|
  //  we're actually just using one parameter in the declaration of
 | 
						|
  //  the next.
 | 
						|
  if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(var) &&
 | 
						|
      isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(VarDC))
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // For C code, don't diagnose about capture if we're not actually in code
 | 
						|
  // right now; it's impossible to write a non-constant expression outside of
 | 
						|
  // function context, so we'll get other (more useful) diagnostics later.
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // For C++, things get a bit more nasty... it would be nice to suppress this
 | 
						|
  // diagnostic for certain cases like using a local variable in an array bound
 | 
						|
  // for a member of a local class, but the correct predicate is not obvious.
 | 
						|
  if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !S.CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  unsigned ValueKind = isa<BindingDecl>(var) ? 1 : 0;
 | 
						|
  unsigned ContextKind = 3; // unknown
 | 
						|
  if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VarDC) &&
 | 
						|
      cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VarDC->getParent())->isLambda()) {
 | 
						|
    ContextKind = 2;
 | 
						|
  } else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(VarDC)) {
 | 
						|
    ContextKind = 0;
 | 
						|
  } else if (isa<BlockDecl>(VarDC)) {
 | 
						|
    ContextKind = 1;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_in_enclosing_context)
 | 
						|
    << var << ValueKind << ContextKind << VarDC;
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at)
 | 
						|
      << var;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: Add additional diagnostic info about class etc. which prevents
 | 
						|
  // capture.
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static bool isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, VarDecl *Var,
 | 
						|
                                      bool &SubCapturesAreNested,
 | 
						|
                                      QualType &CaptureType,
 | 
						|
                                      QualType &DeclRefType) {
 | 
						|
   // Check whether we've already captured it.
 | 
						|
  if (CSI->CaptureMap.count(Var)) {
 | 
						|
    // If we found a capture, any subcaptures are nested.
 | 
						|
    SubCapturesAreNested = true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Retrieve the capture type for this variable.
 | 
						|
    CaptureType = CSI->getCapture(Var).getCaptureType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Compute the type of an expression that refers to this variable.
 | 
						|
    DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Similarly to mutable captures in lambda, all the OpenMP captures by copy
 | 
						|
    // are mutable in the sense that user can change their value - they are
 | 
						|
    // private instances of the captured declarations.
 | 
						|
    const Capture &Cap = CSI->getCapture(Var);
 | 
						|
    if (Cap.isCopyCapture() &&
 | 
						|
        !(isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI) && cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Mutable) &&
 | 
						|
        !(isa<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI) &&
 | 
						|
          cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)->CapRegionKind == CR_OpenMP))
 | 
						|
      DeclRefType.addConst();
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can
 | 
						|
// capture; other scopes don't work.
 | 
						|
static DeclContext *getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DeclContext *DC, VarDecl *Var,
 | 
						|
                                 SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                 const bool Diagnose, Sema &S) {
 | 
						|
  if (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) || isa<CapturedDecl>(DC) || isLambdaCallOperator(DC))
 | 
						|
    return getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC);
 | 
						|
  else if (Var->hasLocalStorage()) {
 | 
						|
    if (Diagnose)
 | 
						|
       diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(S, Loc, Var, DC);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return nullptr;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture
 | 
						|
// certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.)
 | 
						|
// so check for eligibility.
 | 
						|
static bool isVariableCapturable(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, VarDecl *Var,
 | 
						|
                                 SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                 const bool Diagnose, Sema &S) {
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool IsBlock = isa<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI);
 | 
						|
  bool IsLambda = isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Lambdas are not allowed to capture unnamed variables
 | 
						|
  // (e.g. anonymous unions).
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: The C++11 rule don't actually state this explicitly, but I'm
 | 
						|
  // assuming that's the intent.
 | 
						|
  if (IsLambda && !Var->getDeclName()) {
 | 
						|
    if (Diagnose) {
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_anonymous_var);
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Prohibit variably-modified types in blocks; they're difficult to deal with.
 | 
						|
  if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType() && IsBlock) {
 | 
						|
    if (Diagnose) {
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
 | 
						|
        << Var->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  // Prohibit structs with flexible array members too.
 | 
						|
  // We cannot capture what is in the tail end of the struct.
 | 
						|
  if (const RecordType *VTTy = Var->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
 | 
						|
    if (VTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
 | 
						|
      if (Diagnose) {
 | 
						|
        if (IsBlock)
 | 
						|
          S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_flexarray_type);
 | 
						|
        else
 | 
						|
          S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_flexarray_type)
 | 
						|
            << Var->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
        S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
 | 
						|
          << Var->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>();
 | 
						|
  // Lambdas and captured statements are not allowed to capture __block
 | 
						|
  // variables; they don't support the expected semantics.
 | 
						|
  if (HasBlocksAttr && (IsLambda || isa<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI))) {
 | 
						|
    if (Diagnose) {
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_capture_block_variable)
 | 
						|
        << Var->getDeclName() << !IsLambda;
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
 | 
						|
        << Var->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5: Blocks cannot reference/capture other blocks
 | 
						|
  if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && IsBlock &&
 | 
						|
      Var->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (Diagnose)
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_block_ref_block);
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return true;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// Returns true if the capture by block was successful.
 | 
						|
static bool captureInBlock(BlockScopeInfo *BSI, VarDecl *Var,
 | 
						|
                                 SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                 const bool BuildAndDiagnose,
 | 
						|
                                 QualType &CaptureType,
 | 
						|
                                 QualType &DeclRefType,
 | 
						|
                                 const bool Nested,
 | 
						|
                                 Sema &S, bool Invalid) {
 | 
						|
  bool ByRef = false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Blocks are not allowed to capture arrays, excepting OpenCL.
 | 
						|
  // OpenCL v2.0 s1.12.5 (revision 40): arrays are captured by reference
 | 
						|
  // (decayed to pointers).
 | 
						|
  if (!Invalid && !S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && CaptureType->isArrayType()) {
 | 
						|
    if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
 | 
						|
      << Var->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
      Invalid = true;
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Forbid the block-capture of autoreleasing variables.
 | 
						|
  if (!Invalid &&
 | 
						|
      CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) {
 | 
						|
    if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture)
 | 
						|
        << /*block*/ 0;
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
 | 
						|
        << Var->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
      Invalid = true;
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      return false;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Warn about implicitly autoreleasing indirect parameters captured by blocks.
 | 
						|
  if (const auto *PT = CaptureType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
 | 
						|
    QualType PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (!Invalid && PointeeTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
 | 
						|
        PointeeTy.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing &&
 | 
						|
        !S.Context.hasDirectOwnershipQualifier(PointeeTy)) {
 | 
						|
      if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
 | 
						|
        SourceLocation VarLoc = Var->getLocation();
 | 
						|
        S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_block_capture_autoreleasing);
 | 
						|
        S.Diag(VarLoc, diag::note_declare_parameter_strong);
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>();
 | 
						|
  if (HasBlocksAttr || CaptureType->isReferenceType() ||
 | 
						|
      (S.getLangOpts().OpenMP && S.isOpenMPCapturedDecl(Var))) {
 | 
						|
    // Block capture by reference does not change the capture or
 | 
						|
    // declaration reference types.
 | 
						|
    ByRef = true;
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    // Block capture by copy introduces 'const'.
 | 
						|
    CaptureType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType().withConst();
 | 
						|
    DeclRefType = CaptureType;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Actually capture the variable.
 | 
						|
  if (BuildAndDiagnose)
 | 
						|
    BSI->addCapture(Var, HasBlocksAttr, ByRef, Nested, Loc, SourceLocation(),
 | 
						|
                    CaptureType, Invalid);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return !Invalid;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Capture the given variable in the captured region.
 | 
						|
static bool captureInCapturedRegion(CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI,
 | 
						|
                                    VarDecl *Var,
 | 
						|
                                    SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                    const bool BuildAndDiagnose,
 | 
						|
                                    QualType &CaptureType,
 | 
						|
                                    QualType &DeclRefType,
 | 
						|
                                    const bool RefersToCapturedVariable,
 | 
						|
                                    Sema &S, bool Invalid) {
 | 
						|
  // By default, capture variables by reference.
 | 
						|
  bool ByRef = true;
 | 
						|
  // Using an LValue reference type is consistent with Lambdas (see below).
 | 
						|
  if (S.getLangOpts().OpenMP && RSI->CapRegionKind == CR_OpenMP) {
 | 
						|
    if (S.isOpenMPCapturedDecl(Var)) {
 | 
						|
      bool HasConst = DeclRefType.isConstQualified();
 | 
						|
      DeclRefType = DeclRefType.getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
      // Don't lose diagnostics about assignments to const.
 | 
						|
      if (HasConst)
 | 
						|
        DeclRefType.addConst();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    ByRef = S.isOpenMPCapturedByRef(Var, RSI->OpenMPLevel,
 | 
						|
                                    RSI->OpenMPCaptureLevel);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (ByRef)
 | 
						|
    CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType);
 | 
						|
  else
 | 
						|
    CaptureType = DeclRefType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Actually capture the variable.
 | 
						|
  if (BuildAndDiagnose)
 | 
						|
    RSI->addCapture(Var, /*isBlock*/ false, ByRef, RefersToCapturedVariable,
 | 
						|
                    Loc, SourceLocation(), CaptureType, Invalid);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return !Invalid;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Capture the given variable in the lambda.
 | 
						|
static bool captureInLambda(LambdaScopeInfo *LSI,
 | 
						|
                            VarDecl *Var,
 | 
						|
                            SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                            const bool BuildAndDiagnose,
 | 
						|
                            QualType &CaptureType,
 | 
						|
                            QualType &DeclRefType,
 | 
						|
                            const bool RefersToCapturedVariable,
 | 
						|
                            const Sema::TryCaptureKind Kind,
 | 
						|
                            SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
 | 
						|
                            const bool IsTopScope,
 | 
						|
                            Sema &S, bool Invalid) {
 | 
						|
  // Determine whether we are capturing by reference or by value.
 | 
						|
  bool ByRef = false;
 | 
						|
  if (IsTopScope && Kind != Sema::TryCapture_Implicit) {
 | 
						|
    ByRef = (Kind == Sema::TryCapture_ExplicitByRef);
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    ByRef = (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == LambdaScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Compute the type of the field that will capture this variable.
 | 
						|
  if (ByRef) {
 | 
						|
    // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p15:
 | 
						|
    //   An entity is captured by reference if it is implicitly or
 | 
						|
    //   explicitly captured but not captured by copy. It is
 | 
						|
    //   unspecified whether additional unnamed non-static data
 | 
						|
    //   members are declared in the closure type for entities
 | 
						|
    //   captured by reference.
 | 
						|
    //
 | 
						|
    // FIXME: It is not clear whether we want to build an lvalue reference
 | 
						|
    // to the DeclRefType or to CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(). GCC appears
 | 
						|
    // to do the former, while EDG does the latter. Core issue 1249 will
 | 
						|
    // clarify, but for now we follow GCC because it's a more permissive and
 | 
						|
    // easily defensible position.
 | 
						|
    CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType);
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p14:
 | 
						|
    //   For each entity captured by copy, an unnamed non-static
 | 
						|
    //   data member is declared in the closure type. The
 | 
						|
    //   declaration order of these members is unspecified. The type
 | 
						|
    //   of such a data member is the type of the corresponding
 | 
						|
    //   captured entity if the entity is not a reference to an
 | 
						|
    //   object, or the referenced type otherwise. [Note: If the
 | 
						|
    //   captured entity is a reference to a function, the
 | 
						|
    //   corresponding data member is also a reference to a
 | 
						|
    //   function. - end note ]
 | 
						|
    if (const ReferenceType *RefType = CaptureType->getAs<ReferenceType>()){
 | 
						|
      if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
 | 
						|
        CaptureType = RefType->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Forbid the lambda copy-capture of autoreleasing variables.
 | 
						|
    if (!Invalid &&
 | 
						|
        CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) {
 | 
						|
      if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
 | 
						|
        S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture) << /*lambda*/ 1;
 | 
						|
        S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
 | 
						|
          << Var->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
        Invalid = true;
 | 
						|
      } else {
 | 
						|
        return false;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Make sure that by-copy captures are of a complete and non-abstract type.
 | 
						|
    if (!Invalid && BuildAndDiagnose) {
 | 
						|
      if (!CaptureType->isDependentType() &&
 | 
						|
          S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, CaptureType,
 | 
						|
                                diag::err_capture_of_incomplete_type,
 | 
						|
                                Var->getDeclName()))
 | 
						|
        Invalid = true;
 | 
						|
      else if (S.RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, CaptureType,
 | 
						|
                                        diag::err_capture_of_abstract_type))
 | 
						|
        Invalid = true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Compute the type of a reference to this captured variable.
 | 
						|
  if (ByRef)
 | 
						|
    DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType();
 | 
						|
  else {
 | 
						|
    // C++ [expr.prim.lambda]p5:
 | 
						|
    //   The closure type for a lambda-expression has a public inline
 | 
						|
    //   function call operator [...]. This function call operator is
 | 
						|
    //   declared const (9.3.1) if and only if the lambda-expression's
 | 
						|
    //   parameter-declaration-clause is not followed by mutable.
 | 
						|
    DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType();
 | 
						|
    if (!LSI->Mutable && !CaptureType->isReferenceType())
 | 
						|
      DeclRefType.addConst();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Add the capture.
 | 
						|
  if (BuildAndDiagnose)
 | 
						|
    LSI->addCapture(Var, /*isBlock=*/false, ByRef, RefersToCapturedVariable,
 | 
						|
                    Loc, EllipsisLoc, CaptureType, Invalid);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return !Invalid;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable(
 | 
						|
    VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation ExprLoc, TryCaptureKind Kind,
 | 
						|
    SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, bool BuildAndDiagnose, QualType &CaptureType,
 | 
						|
    QualType &DeclRefType, const unsigned *const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) {
 | 
						|
  // An init-capture is notionally from the context surrounding its
 | 
						|
  // declaration, but its parent DC is the lambda class.
 | 
						|
  DeclContext *VarDC = Var->getDeclContext();
 | 
						|
  if (Var->isInitCapture())
 | 
						|
    VarDC = VarDC->getParent();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  DeclContext *DC = CurContext;
 | 
						|
  const unsigned MaxFunctionScopesIndex = FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt
 | 
						|
      ? *FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt : FunctionScopes.size() - 1;
 | 
						|
  // We need to sync up the Declaration Context with the
 | 
						|
  // FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt
 | 
						|
  if (FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) {
 | 
						|
    unsigned FSIndex = FunctionScopes.size() - 1;
 | 
						|
    while (FSIndex != MaxFunctionScopesIndex) {
 | 
						|
      DC = getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC);
 | 
						|
      --FSIndex;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If the variable is declared in the current context, there is no need to
 | 
						|
  // capture it.
 | 
						|
  if (VarDC == DC) return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Capture global variables if it is required to use private copy of this
 | 
						|
  // variable.
 | 
						|
  bool IsGlobal = !Var->hasLocalStorage();
 | 
						|
  if (IsGlobal &&
 | 
						|
      !(LangOpts.OpenMP && isOpenMPCapturedDecl(Var, /*CheckScopeInfo=*/true,
 | 
						|
                                                MaxFunctionScopesIndex)))
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  Var = Var->getCanonicalDecl();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Walk up the stack to determine whether we can capture the variable,
 | 
						|
  // performing the "simple" checks that don't depend on type. We stop when
 | 
						|
  // we've either hit the declared scope of the variable or find an existing
 | 
						|
  // capture of that variable.  We start from the innermost capturing-entity
 | 
						|
  // (the DC) and ensure that all intervening capturing-entities
 | 
						|
  // (blocks/lambdas etc.) between the innermost capturer and the variable`s
 | 
						|
  // declcontext can either capture the variable or have already captured
 | 
						|
  // the variable.
 | 
						|
  CaptureType = Var->getType();
 | 
						|
  DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType();
 | 
						|
  bool Nested = false;
 | 
						|
  bool Explicit = (Kind != TryCapture_Implicit);
 | 
						|
  unsigned FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex;
 | 
						|
  do {
 | 
						|
    // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can
 | 
						|
    // capture; other scopes don't work.
 | 
						|
    DeclContext *ParentDC = getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DC, Var,
 | 
						|
                                                              ExprLoc,
 | 
						|
                                                              BuildAndDiagnose,
 | 
						|
                                                              *this);
 | 
						|
    // We need to check for the parent *first* because, if we *have*
 | 
						|
    // private-captured a global variable, we need to recursively capture it in
 | 
						|
    // intermediate blocks, lambdas, etc.
 | 
						|
    if (!ParentDC) {
 | 
						|
      if (IsGlobal) {
 | 
						|
        FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex - 1;
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    FunctionScopeInfo  *FSI = FunctionScopes[FunctionScopesIndex];
 | 
						|
    CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FSI);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Check whether we've already captured it.
 | 
						|
    if (isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CSI, Var, Nested, CaptureType,
 | 
						|
                                             DeclRefType)) {
 | 
						|
      CSI->getCapture(Var).markUsed(BuildAndDiagnose);
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator body,
 | 
						|
    // we do not want to capture new variables.  What was captured
 | 
						|
    // during either a lambdas transformation or initial parsing
 | 
						|
    // should be used.
 | 
						|
    if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(DC)) {
 | 
						|
      if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
 | 
						|
        LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI);
 | 
						|
        if (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None) {
 | 
						|
          Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
          Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
 | 
						|
             << Var->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
          Diag(LSI->Lambda->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_lambda_decl);
 | 
						|
        } else
 | 
						|
          diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(*this, ExprLoc, Var, DC);
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Try to capture variable-length arrays types.
 | 
						|
    if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
 | 
						|
      // We're going to walk down into the type and look for VLA
 | 
						|
      // expressions.
 | 
						|
      QualType QTy = Var->getType();
 | 
						|
      if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast_or_null<ParmVarDecl>(Var))
 | 
						|
        QTy = PVD->getOriginalType();
 | 
						|
      captureVariablyModifiedType(Context, QTy, CSI);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().OpenMP) {
 | 
						|
      if (auto *RSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) {
 | 
						|
        // OpenMP private variables should not be captured in outer scope, so
 | 
						|
        // just break here. Similarly, global variables that are captured in a
 | 
						|
        // target region should not be captured outside the scope of the region.
 | 
						|
        if (RSI->CapRegionKind == CR_OpenMP) {
 | 
						|
          bool IsOpenMPPrivateDecl = isOpenMPPrivateDecl(Var, RSI->OpenMPLevel);
 | 
						|
          // If the variable is private (i.e. not captured) and has variably
 | 
						|
          // modified type, we still need to capture the type for correct
 | 
						|
          // codegen in all regions, associated with the construct. Currently,
 | 
						|
          // it is captured in the innermost captured region only.
 | 
						|
          if (IsOpenMPPrivateDecl && Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
 | 
						|
            QualType QTy = Var->getType();
 | 
						|
            if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast_or_null<ParmVarDecl>(Var))
 | 
						|
              QTy = PVD->getOriginalType();
 | 
						|
            for (int I = 1, E = getNumberOfConstructScopes(RSI->OpenMPLevel);
 | 
						|
                 I < E; ++I) {
 | 
						|
              auto *OuterRSI = cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(
 | 
						|
                  FunctionScopes[FunctionScopesIndex - I]);
 | 
						|
              assert(RSI->OpenMPLevel == OuterRSI->OpenMPLevel &&
 | 
						|
                     "Wrong number of captured regions associated with the "
 | 
						|
                     "OpenMP construct.");
 | 
						|
              captureVariablyModifiedType(Context, QTy, OuterRSI);
 | 
						|
            }
 | 
						|
          }
 | 
						|
          bool IsTargetCap =
 | 
						|
              !IsOpenMPPrivateDecl &&
 | 
						|
              isOpenMPTargetCapturedDecl(Var, RSI->OpenMPLevel,
 | 
						|
                                         RSI->OpenMPCaptureLevel);
 | 
						|
          // When we detect target captures we are looking from inside the
 | 
						|
          // target region, therefore we need to propagate the capture from the
 | 
						|
          // enclosing region. Therefore, the capture is not initially nested.
 | 
						|
          if (IsTargetCap)
 | 
						|
            adjustOpenMPTargetScopeIndex(FunctionScopesIndex, RSI->OpenMPLevel);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
          if (IsTargetCap || IsOpenMPPrivateDecl) {
 | 
						|
            Nested = !IsTargetCap;
 | 
						|
            DeclRefType = DeclRefType.getUnqualifiedType();
 | 
						|
            CaptureType = Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType);
 | 
						|
            break;
 | 
						|
          }
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    if (CSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None && !Explicit) {
 | 
						|
      // No capture-default, and this is not an explicit capture
 | 
						|
      // so cannot capture this variable.
 | 
						|
      if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
 | 
						|
        Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
        Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
 | 
						|
          << Var->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
        if (cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Lambda)
 | 
						|
          Diag(cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Lambda->getBeginLoc(),
 | 
						|
               diag::note_lambda_decl);
 | 
						|
        // FIXME: If we error out because an outer lambda can not implicitly
 | 
						|
        // capture a variable that an inner lambda explicitly captures, we
 | 
						|
        // should have the inner lambda do the explicit capture - because
 | 
						|
        // it makes for cleaner diagnostics later.  This would purely be done
 | 
						|
        // so that the diagnostic does not misleadingly claim that a variable
 | 
						|
        // can not be captured by a lambda implicitly even though it is captured
 | 
						|
        // explicitly.  Suggestion:
 | 
						|
        //  - create const bool VariableCaptureWasInitiallyExplicit = Explicit
 | 
						|
        //    at the function head
 | 
						|
        //  - cache the StartingDeclContext - this must be a lambda
 | 
						|
        //  - captureInLambda in the innermost lambda the variable.
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    FunctionScopesIndex--;
 | 
						|
    DC = ParentDC;
 | 
						|
    Explicit = false;
 | 
						|
  } while (!VarDC->Equals(DC));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Walk back down the scope stack, (e.g. from outer lambda to inner lambda)
 | 
						|
  // computing the type of the capture at each step, checking type-specific
 | 
						|
  // requirements, and adding captures if requested.
 | 
						|
  // If the variable had already been captured previously, we start capturing
 | 
						|
  // at the lambda nested within that one.
 | 
						|
  bool Invalid = false;
 | 
						|
  for (unsigned I = ++FunctionScopesIndex, N = MaxFunctionScopesIndex + 1; I != N;
 | 
						|
       ++I) {
 | 
						|
    CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes[I]);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture
 | 
						|
    // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.)
 | 
						|
    // so check for eligibility.
 | 
						|
    if (!Invalid)
 | 
						|
      Invalid =
 | 
						|
          !isVariableCapturable(CSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, *this);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // After encountering an error, if we're actually supposed to capture, keep
 | 
						|
    // capturing in nested contexts to suppress any follow-on diagnostics.
 | 
						|
    if (Invalid && !BuildAndDiagnose)
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (BlockScopeInfo *BSI = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI)) {
 | 
						|
      Invalid = !captureInBlock(BSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType,
 | 
						|
                               DeclRefType, Nested, *this, Invalid);
 | 
						|
      Nested = true;
 | 
						|
    } else if (CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) {
 | 
						|
      Invalid = !captureInCapturedRegion(RSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose,
 | 
						|
                                         CaptureType, DeclRefType, Nested,
 | 
						|
                                         *this, Invalid);
 | 
						|
      Nested = true;
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI);
 | 
						|
      Invalid =
 | 
						|
          !captureInLambda(LSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType,
 | 
						|
                           DeclRefType, Nested, Kind, EllipsisLoc,
 | 
						|
                           /*IsTopScope*/ I == N - 1, *this, Invalid);
 | 
						|
      Nested = true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (Invalid && !BuildAndDiagnose)
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  return Invalid;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                              TryCaptureKind Kind, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc) {
 | 
						|
  QualType CaptureType;
 | 
						|
  QualType DeclRefType;
 | 
						|
  return tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, Kind, EllipsisLoc,
 | 
						|
                            /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/true, CaptureType,
 | 
						|
                            DeclRefType, nullptr);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
bool Sema::NeedToCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) {
 | 
						|
  QualType CaptureType;
 | 
						|
  QualType DeclRefType;
 | 
						|
  return !tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, TryCapture_Implicit, SourceLocation(),
 | 
						|
                             /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType,
 | 
						|
                             DeclRefType, nullptr);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
QualType Sema::getCapturedDeclRefType(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) {
 | 
						|
  QualType CaptureType;
 | 
						|
  QualType DeclRefType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Determine whether we can capture this variable.
 | 
						|
  if (tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, TryCapture_Implicit, SourceLocation(),
 | 
						|
                         /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType,
 | 
						|
                         DeclRefType, nullptr))
 | 
						|
    return QualType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return DeclRefType;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
namespace {
 | 
						|
// Helper to copy the template arguments from a DeclRefExpr or MemberExpr.
 | 
						|
// The produced TemplateArgumentListInfo* points to data stored within this
 | 
						|
// object, so should only be used in contexts where the pointer will not be
 | 
						|
// used after the CopiedTemplateArgs object is destroyed.
 | 
						|
class CopiedTemplateArgs {
 | 
						|
  bool HasArgs;
 | 
						|
  TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgStorage;
 | 
						|
public:
 | 
						|
  template<typename RefExpr>
 | 
						|
  CopiedTemplateArgs(RefExpr *E) : HasArgs(E->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
 | 
						|
    if (HasArgs)
 | 
						|
      E->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgStorage);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  operator TemplateArgumentListInfo*()
 | 
						|
#ifdef __has_cpp_attribute
 | 
						|
#if __has_cpp_attribute(clang::lifetimebound)
 | 
						|
  [[clang::lifetimebound]]
 | 
						|
#endif
 | 
						|
#endif
 | 
						|
  {
 | 
						|
    return HasArgs ? &TemplateArgStorage : nullptr;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
};
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Walk the set of potential results of an expression and mark them all as
 | 
						|
/// non-odr-uses if they satisfy the side-conditions of the NonOdrUseReason.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// \return A new expression if we found any potential results, ExprEmpty() if
 | 
						|
///         not, and ExprError() if we diagnosed an error.
 | 
						|
static ExprResult rebuildPotentialResultsAsNonOdrUsed(Sema &S, Expr *E,
 | 
						|
                                                      NonOdrUseReason NOUR) {
 | 
						|
  // Per C++11 [basic.def.odr], a variable is odr-used "unless it is
 | 
						|
  // an object that satisfies the requirements for appearing in a
 | 
						|
  // constant expression (5.19) and the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (4.1)
 | 
						|
  // is immediately applied."  This function handles the lvalue-to-rvalue
 | 
						|
  // conversion part.
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // If we encounter a node that claims to be an odr-use but shouldn't be, we
 | 
						|
  // transform it into the relevant kind of non-odr-use node and rebuild the
 | 
						|
  // tree of nodes leading to it.
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // This is a mini-TreeTransform that only transforms a restricted subset of
 | 
						|
  // nodes (and only certain operands of them).
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Rebuild a subexpression.
 | 
						|
  auto Rebuild = [&](Expr *Sub) {
 | 
						|
    return rebuildPotentialResultsAsNonOdrUsed(S, Sub, NOUR);
 | 
						|
  };
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Check whether a potential result satisfies the requirements of NOUR.
 | 
						|
  auto IsPotentialResultOdrUsed = [&](NamedDecl *D) {
 | 
						|
    // Any entity other than a VarDecl is always odr-used whenever it's named
 | 
						|
    // in a potentially-evaluated expression.
 | 
						|
    auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D);
 | 
						|
    if (!VD)
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // C++2a [basic.def.odr]p4:
 | 
						|
    //   A variable x whose name appears as a potentially-evalauted expression
 | 
						|
    //   e is odr-used by e unless
 | 
						|
    //   -- x is a reference that is usable in constant expressions, or
 | 
						|
    //   -- x is a variable of non-reference type that is usable in constant
 | 
						|
    //      expressions and has no mutable subobjects, and e is an element of
 | 
						|
    //      the set of potential results of an expression of
 | 
						|
    //      non-volatile-qualified non-class type to which the lvalue-to-rvalue
 | 
						|
    //      conversion is applied, or
 | 
						|
    //   -- x is a variable of non-reference type, and e is an element of the
 | 
						|
    //      set of potential results of a discarded-value expression to which
 | 
						|
    //      the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion is not applied
 | 
						|
    //
 | 
						|
    // We check the first bullet and the "potentially-evaluated" condition in
 | 
						|
    // BuildDeclRefExpr. We check the type requirements in the second bullet
 | 
						|
    // in CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand below.
 | 
						|
    switch (NOUR) {
 | 
						|
    case NOUR_None:
 | 
						|
    case NOUR_Unevaluated:
 | 
						|
      llvm_unreachable("unexpected non-odr-use-reason");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    case NOUR_Constant:
 | 
						|
      // Constant references were handled when they were built.
 | 
						|
      if (VD->getType()->isReferenceType())
 | 
						|
        return true;
 | 
						|
      if (auto *RD = VD->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
 | 
						|
        if (RD->hasMutableFields())
 | 
						|
          return true;
 | 
						|
      if (!VD->isUsableInConstantExpressions(S.Context))
 | 
						|
        return true;
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    case NOUR_Discarded:
 | 
						|
      if (VD->getType()->isReferenceType())
 | 
						|
        return true;
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
  };
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Mark that this expression does not constitute an odr-use.
 | 
						|
  auto MarkNotOdrUsed = [&] {
 | 
						|
    S.MaybeODRUseExprs.erase(E);
 | 
						|
    if (LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = S.getCurLambda())
 | 
						|
      LSI->markVariableExprAsNonODRUsed(E);
 | 
						|
  };
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++2a [basic.def.odr]p2:
 | 
						|
  //   The set of potential results of an expression e is defined as follows:
 | 
						|
  switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
 | 
						|
  //   -- If e is an id-expression, ...
 | 
						|
  case Expr::DeclRefExprClass: {
 | 
						|
    auto *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(E);
 | 
						|
    if (DRE->isNonOdrUse() || IsPotentialResultOdrUsed(DRE->getDecl()))
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Rebuild as a non-odr-use DeclRefExpr.
 | 
						|
    MarkNotOdrUsed();
 | 
						|
    return DeclRefExpr::Create(
 | 
						|
        S.Context, DRE->getQualifierLoc(), DRE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
 | 
						|
        DRE->getDecl(), DRE->refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture(),
 | 
						|
        DRE->getNameInfo(), DRE->getType(), DRE->getValueKind(),
 | 
						|
        DRE->getFoundDecl(), CopiedTemplateArgs(DRE), NOUR);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case Expr::FunctionParmPackExprClass: {
 | 
						|
    auto *FPPE = cast<FunctionParmPackExpr>(E);
 | 
						|
    // If any of the declarations in the pack is odr-used, then the expression
 | 
						|
    // as a whole constitutes an odr-use.
 | 
						|
    for (VarDecl *D : *FPPE)
 | 
						|
      if (IsPotentialResultOdrUsed(D))
 | 
						|
        return ExprEmpty();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // FIXME: Rebuild as a non-odr-use FunctionParmPackExpr? In practice,
 | 
						|
    // nothing cares about whether we marked this as an odr-use, but it might
 | 
						|
    // be useful for non-compiler tools.
 | 
						|
    MarkNotOdrUsed();
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  //   -- If e is a subscripting operation with an array operand...
 | 
						|
  case Expr::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
 | 
						|
    auto *ASE = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E);
 | 
						|
    Expr *OldBase = ASE->getBase()->IgnoreImplicit();
 | 
						|
    if (!OldBase->getType()->isArrayType())
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Base = Rebuild(OldBase);
 | 
						|
    if (!Base.isUsable())
 | 
						|
      return Base;
 | 
						|
    Expr *LHS = ASE->getBase() == ASE->getLHS() ? Base.get() : ASE->getLHS();
 | 
						|
    Expr *RHS = ASE->getBase() == ASE->getRHS() ? Base.get() : ASE->getRHS();
 | 
						|
    SourceLocation LBracketLoc = ASE->getBeginLoc(); // FIXME: Not stored.
 | 
						|
    return S.ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(nullptr, LHS, LBracketLoc, RHS,
 | 
						|
                                     ASE->getRBracketLoc());
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case Expr::MemberExprClass: {
 | 
						|
    auto *ME = cast<MemberExpr>(E);
 | 
						|
    // -- If e is a class member access expression [...] naming a non-static
 | 
						|
    //    data member...
 | 
						|
    if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
 | 
						|
      ExprResult Base = Rebuild(ME->getBase());
 | 
						|
      if (!Base.isUsable())
 | 
						|
        return Base;
 | 
						|
      return MemberExpr::Create(
 | 
						|
          S.Context, Base.get(), ME->isArrow(), ME->getOperatorLoc(),
 | 
						|
          ME->getQualifierLoc(), ME->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
 | 
						|
          ME->getMemberDecl(), ME->getFoundDecl(), ME->getMemberNameInfo(),
 | 
						|
          CopiedTemplateArgs(ME), ME->getType(), ME->getValueKind(),
 | 
						|
          ME->getObjectKind(), ME->isNonOdrUse());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (ME->getMemberDecl()->isCXXInstanceMember())
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // -- If e is a class member access expression naming a static data member,
 | 
						|
    //    ...
 | 
						|
    if (ME->isNonOdrUse() || IsPotentialResultOdrUsed(ME->getMemberDecl()))
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Rebuild as a non-odr-use MemberExpr.
 | 
						|
    MarkNotOdrUsed();
 | 
						|
    return MemberExpr::Create(
 | 
						|
        S.Context, ME->getBase(), ME->isArrow(), ME->getOperatorLoc(),
 | 
						|
        ME->getQualifierLoc(), ME->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), ME->getMemberDecl(),
 | 
						|
        ME->getFoundDecl(), ME->getMemberNameInfo(), CopiedTemplateArgs(ME),
 | 
						|
        ME->getType(), ME->getValueKind(), ME->getObjectKind(), NOUR);
 | 
						|
    return ExprEmpty();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case Expr::BinaryOperatorClass: {
 | 
						|
    auto *BO = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
 | 
						|
    Expr *LHS = BO->getLHS();
 | 
						|
    Expr *RHS = BO->getRHS();
 | 
						|
    // -- If e is a pointer-to-member expression of the form e1 .* e2 ...
 | 
						|
    if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD) {
 | 
						|
      ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(LHS);
 | 
						|
      if (!Sub.isUsable())
 | 
						|
        return Sub;
 | 
						|
      LHS = Sub.get();
 | 
						|
    //   -- If e is a comma expression, ...
 | 
						|
    } else if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_Comma) {
 | 
						|
      ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(RHS);
 | 
						|
      if (!Sub.isUsable())
 | 
						|
        return Sub;
 | 
						|
      RHS = Sub.get();
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    return S.BuildBinOp(nullptr, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getOpcode(),
 | 
						|
                        LHS, RHS);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  //   -- If e has the form (e1)...
 | 
						|
  case Expr::ParenExprClass: {
 | 
						|
    auto *PE = cast<ParenExpr>(E);
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(PE->getSubExpr());
 | 
						|
    if (!Sub.isUsable())
 | 
						|
      return Sub;
 | 
						|
    return S.ActOnParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), Sub.get());
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  //   -- If e is a glvalue conditional expression, ...
 | 
						|
  // We don't apply this to a binary conditional operator. FIXME: Should we?
 | 
						|
  case Expr::ConditionalOperatorClass: {
 | 
						|
    auto *CO = cast<ConditionalOperator>(E);
 | 
						|
    ExprResult LHS = Rebuild(CO->getLHS());
 | 
						|
    if (LHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    ExprResult RHS = Rebuild(CO->getRHS());
 | 
						|
    if (RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    if (!LHS.isUsable() && !RHS.isUsable())
 | 
						|
      return ExprEmpty();
 | 
						|
    if (!LHS.isUsable())
 | 
						|
      LHS = CO->getLHS();
 | 
						|
    if (!RHS.isUsable())
 | 
						|
      RHS = CO->getRHS();
 | 
						|
    return S.ActOnConditionalOp(CO->getQuestionLoc(), CO->getColonLoc(),
 | 
						|
                                CO->getCond(), LHS.get(), RHS.get());
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // [Clang extension]
 | 
						|
  //   -- If e has the form __extension__ e1...
 | 
						|
  case Expr::UnaryOperatorClass: {
 | 
						|
    auto *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
 | 
						|
    if (UO->getOpcode() != UO_Extension)
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(UO->getSubExpr());
 | 
						|
    if (!Sub.isUsable())
 | 
						|
      return Sub;
 | 
						|
    return S.BuildUnaryOp(nullptr, UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO_Extension,
 | 
						|
                          Sub.get());
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // [Clang extension]
 | 
						|
  //   -- If e has the form _Generic(...), the set of potential results is the
 | 
						|
  //      union of the sets of potential results of the associated expressions.
 | 
						|
  case Expr::GenericSelectionExprClass: {
 | 
						|
    auto *GSE = cast<GenericSelectionExpr>(E);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    SmallVector<Expr *, 4> AssocExprs;
 | 
						|
    bool AnyChanged = false;
 | 
						|
    for (Expr *OrigAssocExpr : GSE->getAssocExprs()) {
 | 
						|
      ExprResult AssocExpr = Rebuild(OrigAssocExpr);
 | 
						|
      if (AssocExpr.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      if (AssocExpr.isUsable()) {
 | 
						|
        AssocExprs.push_back(AssocExpr.get());
 | 
						|
        AnyChanged = true;
 | 
						|
      } else {
 | 
						|
        AssocExprs.push_back(OrigAssocExpr);
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return AnyChanged ? S.CreateGenericSelectionExpr(
 | 
						|
                            GSE->getGenericLoc(), GSE->getDefaultLoc(),
 | 
						|
                            GSE->getRParenLoc(), GSE->getControllingExpr(),
 | 
						|
                            GSE->getAssocTypeSourceInfos(), AssocExprs)
 | 
						|
                      : ExprEmpty();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // [Clang extension]
 | 
						|
  //   -- If e has the form __builtin_choose_expr(...), the set of potential
 | 
						|
  //      results is the union of the sets of potential results of the
 | 
						|
  //      second and third subexpressions.
 | 
						|
  case Expr::ChooseExprClass: {
 | 
						|
    auto *CE = cast<ChooseExpr>(E);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult LHS = Rebuild(CE->getLHS());
 | 
						|
    if (LHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult RHS = Rebuild(CE->getLHS());
 | 
						|
    if (RHS.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (!LHS.get() && !RHS.get())
 | 
						|
      return ExprEmpty();
 | 
						|
    if (!LHS.isUsable())
 | 
						|
      LHS = CE->getLHS();
 | 
						|
    if (!RHS.isUsable())
 | 
						|
      RHS = CE->getRHS();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    return S.ActOnChooseExpr(CE->getBuiltinLoc(), CE->getCond(), LHS.get(),
 | 
						|
                             RHS.get(), CE->getRParenLoc());
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Step through non-syntactic nodes.
 | 
						|
  case Expr::ConstantExprClass: {
 | 
						|
    auto *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(E);
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(CE->getSubExpr());
 | 
						|
    if (!Sub.isUsable())
 | 
						|
      return Sub;
 | 
						|
    return ConstantExpr::Create(S.Context, Sub.get());
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // We could mostly rely on the recursive rebuilding to rebuild implicit
 | 
						|
  // casts, but not at the top level, so rebuild them here.
 | 
						|
  case Expr::ImplicitCastExprClass: {
 | 
						|
    auto *ICE = cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E);
 | 
						|
    // Only step through the narrow set of cast kinds we expect to encounter.
 | 
						|
    // Anything else suggests we've left the region in which potential results
 | 
						|
    // can be found.
 | 
						|
    switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
 | 
						|
    case CK_NoOp:
 | 
						|
    case CK_DerivedToBase:
 | 
						|
    case CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase: {
 | 
						|
      ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(ICE->getSubExpr());
 | 
						|
      if (!Sub.isUsable())
 | 
						|
        return Sub;
 | 
						|
      CXXCastPath Path(ICE->path());
 | 
						|
      return S.ImpCastExprToType(Sub.get(), ICE->getType(), ICE->getCastKind(),
 | 
						|
                                 ICE->getValueKind(), &Path);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    default:
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  default:
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Can't traverse through this node. Nothing to do.
 | 
						|
  return ExprEmpty();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand(Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  // Check whether the operand is or contains an object of non-trivial C union
 | 
						|
  // type.
 | 
						|
  if (E->getType().isVolatileQualified() &&
 | 
						|
      (E->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() ||
 | 
						|
       E->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()))
 | 
						|
    checkNonTrivialCUnion(E->getType(), E->getExprLoc(),
 | 
						|
                          Sema::NTCUC_LValueToRValueVolatile,
 | 
						|
                          NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++2a [basic.def.odr]p4:
 | 
						|
  //   [...] an expression of non-volatile-qualified non-class type to which
 | 
						|
  //   the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion is applied [...]
 | 
						|
  if (E->getType().isVolatileQualified() || E->getType()->getAs<RecordType>())
 | 
						|
    return E;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ExprResult Result =
 | 
						|
      rebuildPotentialResultsAsNonOdrUsed(*this, E, NOUR_Constant);
 | 
						|
  if (Result.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  return Result.get() ? Result : E;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnConstantExpression(ExprResult Res) {
 | 
						|
  Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Res);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!Res.isUsable())
 | 
						|
    return Res;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If a constant-expression is a reference to a variable where we delay
 | 
						|
  // deciding whether it is an odr-use, just assume we will apply the
 | 
						|
  // lvalue-to-rvalue conversion.  In the one case where this doesn't happen
 | 
						|
  // (a non-type template argument), we have special handling anyway.
 | 
						|
  return CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand(Res.get());
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
void Sema::CleanupVarDeclMarking() {
 | 
						|
  // Iterate through a local copy in case MarkVarDeclODRUsed makes a recursive
 | 
						|
  // call.
 | 
						|
  MaybeODRUseExprSet LocalMaybeODRUseExprs;
 | 
						|
  std::swap(LocalMaybeODRUseExprs, MaybeODRUseExprs);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  for (Expr *E : LocalMaybeODRUseExprs) {
 | 
						|
    if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
      MarkVarDeclODRUsed(cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl()),
 | 
						|
                         DRE->getLocation(), *this);
 | 
						|
    } else if (auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
      MarkVarDeclODRUsed(cast<VarDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()), ME->getMemberLoc(),
 | 
						|
                         *this);
 | 
						|
    } else if (auto *FP = dyn_cast<FunctionParmPackExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
      for (VarDecl *VD : *FP)
 | 
						|
        MarkVarDeclODRUsed(VD, FP->getParameterPackLocation(), *this);
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      llvm_unreachable("Unexpected expression");
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  assert(MaybeODRUseExprs.empty() &&
 | 
						|
         "MarkVarDeclODRUsed failed to cleanup MaybeODRUseExprs?");
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                    VarDecl *Var, Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  assert((!E || isa<DeclRefExpr>(E) || isa<MemberExpr>(E) ||
 | 
						|
          isa<FunctionParmPackExpr>(E)) &&
 | 
						|
         "Invalid Expr argument to DoMarkVarDeclReferenced");
 | 
						|
  Var->setReferenced();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (Var->isInvalidDecl())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  auto *MSI = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
 | 
						|
  TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = MSI ? MSI->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
 | 
						|
                                       : Var->getTemplateSpecializationKind();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  OdrUseContext OdrUse = isOdrUseContext(SemaRef);
 | 
						|
  bool UsableInConstantExpr =
 | 
						|
      Var->mightBeUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++20 [expr.const]p12:
 | 
						|
  //   A variable [...] is needed for constant evaluation if it is [...] a
 | 
						|
  //   variable whose name appears as a potentially constant evaluated
 | 
						|
  //   expression that is either a contexpr variable or is of non-volatile
 | 
						|
  //   const-qualified integral type or of reference type
 | 
						|
  bool NeededForConstantEvaluation =
 | 
						|
      isPotentiallyConstantEvaluatedContext(SemaRef) && UsableInConstantExpr;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  bool NeedDefinition =
 | 
						|
      OdrUse == OdrUseContext::Used || NeededForConstantEvaluation;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *VarSpec =
 | 
						|
      dyn_cast<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var);
 | 
						|
  assert(!isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Var) &&
 | 
						|
         "Can't instantiate a partial template specialization.");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If this might be a member specialization of a static data member, check
 | 
						|
  // the specialization is visible. We already did the checks for variable
 | 
						|
  // template specializations when we created them.
 | 
						|
  if (NeedDefinition && TSK != TSK_Undeclared &&
 | 
						|
      !isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var))
 | 
						|
    SemaRef.checkSpecializationVisibility(Loc, Var);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Perform implicit instantiation of static data members, static data member
 | 
						|
  // templates of class templates, and variable template specializations. Delay
 | 
						|
  // instantiations of variable templates, except for those that could be used
 | 
						|
  // in a constant expression.
 | 
						|
  if (NeedDefinition && isTemplateInstantiation(TSK)) {
 | 
						|
    // Per C++17 [temp.explicit]p10, we may instantiate despite an explicit
 | 
						|
    // instantiation declaration if a variable is usable in a constant
 | 
						|
    // expression (among other cases).
 | 
						|
    bool TryInstantiating =
 | 
						|
        TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
 | 
						|
        (TSK == TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration && UsableInConstantExpr);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (TryInstantiating) {
 | 
						|
      SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation =
 | 
						|
          MSI ? MSI->getPointOfInstantiation() : Var->getPointOfInstantiation();
 | 
						|
      bool FirstInstantiation = PointOfInstantiation.isInvalid();
 | 
						|
      if (FirstInstantiation) {
 | 
						|
        PointOfInstantiation = Loc;
 | 
						|
        if (MSI)
 | 
						|
          MSI->setPointOfInstantiation(PointOfInstantiation);
 | 
						|
        else
 | 
						|
          Var->setTemplateSpecializationKind(TSK, PointOfInstantiation);
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      bool InstantiationDependent = false;
 | 
						|
      bool IsNonDependent =
 | 
						|
          VarSpec ? !TemplateSpecializationType::anyDependentTemplateArguments(
 | 
						|
                        VarSpec->getTemplateArgsInfo(), InstantiationDependent)
 | 
						|
                  : true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Do not instantiate specializations that are still type-dependent.
 | 
						|
      if (IsNonDependent) {
 | 
						|
        if (UsableInConstantExpr) {
 | 
						|
          // Do not defer instantiations of variables that could be used in a
 | 
						|
          // constant expression.
 | 
						|
          SemaRef.runWithSufficientStackSpace(PointOfInstantiation, [&] {
 | 
						|
            SemaRef.InstantiateVariableDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Var);
 | 
						|
          });
 | 
						|
        } else if (FirstInstantiation ||
 | 
						|
                   isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var)) {
 | 
						|
          // FIXME: For a specialization of a variable template, we don't
 | 
						|
          // distinguish between "declaration and type implicitly instantiated"
 | 
						|
          // and "implicit instantiation of definition requested", so we have
 | 
						|
          // no direct way to avoid enqueueing the pending instantiation
 | 
						|
          // multiple times.
 | 
						|
          SemaRef.PendingInstantiations
 | 
						|
              .push_back(std::make_pair(Var, PointOfInstantiation));
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // C++2a [basic.def.odr]p4:
 | 
						|
  //   A variable x whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated expression e
 | 
						|
  //   is odr-used by e unless
 | 
						|
  //   -- x is a reference that is usable in constant expressions
 | 
						|
  //   -- x is a variable of non-reference type that is usable in constant
 | 
						|
  //      expressions and has no mutable subobjects [FIXME], and e is an
 | 
						|
  //      element of the set of potential results of an expression of
 | 
						|
  //      non-volatile-qualified non-class type to which the lvalue-to-rvalue
 | 
						|
  //      conversion is applied
 | 
						|
  //   -- x is a variable of non-reference type, and e is an element of the set
 | 
						|
  //      of potential results of a discarded-value expression to which the
 | 
						|
  //      lvalue-to-rvalue conversion is not applied [FIXME]
 | 
						|
  //
 | 
						|
  // We check the first part of the second bullet here, and
 | 
						|
  // Sema::CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand deals with the second part.
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: To get the third bullet right, we need to delay this even for
 | 
						|
  // variables that are not usable in constant expressions.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If we already know this isn't an odr-use, there's nothing more to do.
 | 
						|
  if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast_or_null<DeclRefExpr>(E))
 | 
						|
    if (DRE->isNonOdrUse())
 | 
						|
      return;
 | 
						|
  if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast_or_null<MemberExpr>(E))
 | 
						|
    if (ME->isNonOdrUse())
 | 
						|
      return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  switch (OdrUse) {
 | 
						|
  case OdrUseContext::None:
 | 
						|
    assert((!E || isa<FunctionParmPackExpr>(E)) &&
 | 
						|
           "missing non-odr-use marking for unevaluated decl ref");
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case OdrUseContext::FormallyOdrUsed:
 | 
						|
    // FIXME: Ignoring formal odr-uses results in incorrect lambda capture
 | 
						|
    // behavior.
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case OdrUseContext::Used:
 | 
						|
    // If we might later find that this expression isn't actually an odr-use,
 | 
						|
    // delay the marking.
 | 
						|
    if (E && Var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context))
 | 
						|
      SemaRef.MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(E);
 | 
						|
    else
 | 
						|
      MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Var, Loc, SemaRef);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case OdrUseContext::Dependent:
 | 
						|
    // If this is a dependent context, we don't need to mark variables as
 | 
						|
    // odr-used, but we may still need to track them for lambda capture.
 | 
						|
    // FIXME: Do we also need to do this inside dependent typeid expressions
 | 
						|
    // (which are modeled as unevaluated at this point)?
 | 
						|
    const bool RefersToEnclosingScope =
 | 
						|
        (SemaRef.CurContext != Var->getDeclContext() &&
 | 
						|
         Var->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() && Var->hasLocalStorage());
 | 
						|
    if (RefersToEnclosingScope) {
 | 
						|
      LambdaScopeInfo *const LSI =
 | 
						|
          SemaRef.getCurLambda(/*IgnoreNonLambdaCapturingScope=*/true);
 | 
						|
      if (LSI && (!LSI->CallOperator ||
 | 
						|
                  !LSI->CallOperator->Encloses(Var->getDeclContext()))) {
 | 
						|
        // If a variable could potentially be odr-used, defer marking it so
 | 
						|
        // until we finish analyzing the full expression for any
 | 
						|
        // lvalue-to-rvalue
 | 
						|
        // or discarded value conversions that would obviate odr-use.
 | 
						|
        // Add it to the list of potential captures that will be analyzed
 | 
						|
        // later (ActOnFinishFullExpr) for eventual capture and odr-use marking
 | 
						|
        // unless the variable is a reference that was initialized by a constant
 | 
						|
        // expression (this will never need to be captured or odr-used).
 | 
						|
        //
 | 
						|
        // FIXME: We can simplify this a lot after implementing P0588R1.
 | 
						|
        assert(E && "Capture variable should be used in an expression.");
 | 
						|
        if (!Var->getType()->isReferenceType() ||
 | 
						|
            !Var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context))
 | 
						|
          LSI->addPotentialCapture(E->IgnoreParens());
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Mark a variable referenced, and check whether it is odr-used
 | 
						|
/// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3).  Note that this should not be
 | 
						|
/// used directly for normal expressions referring to VarDecl.
 | 
						|
void Sema::MarkVariableReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, VarDecl *Var) {
 | 
						|
  DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(*this, Loc, Var, nullptr);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static void MarkExprReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                               Decl *D, Expr *E, bool MightBeOdrUse) {
 | 
						|
  if (SemaRef.isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext())
 | 
						|
    SemaRef.checkDeclIsAllowedInOpenMPTarget(E, D);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
    DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(SemaRef, Loc, Var, E);
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, MightBeOdrUse);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If this is a call to a method via a cast, also mark the method in the
 | 
						|
  // derived class used in case codegen can devirtualize the call.
 | 
						|
  const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E);
 | 
						|
  if (!ME)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl());
 | 
						|
  if (!MD)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  // Only attempt to devirtualize if this is truly a virtual call.
 | 
						|
  bool IsVirtualCall = MD->isVirtual() &&
 | 
						|
                          ME->performsVirtualDispatch(SemaRef.getLangOpts());
 | 
						|
  if (!IsVirtualCall)
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If it's possible to devirtualize the call, mark the called function
 | 
						|
  // referenced.
 | 
						|
  CXXMethodDecl *DM = MD->getDevirtualizedMethod(
 | 
						|
      ME->getBase(), SemaRef.getLangOpts().AppleKext);
 | 
						|
  if (DM)
 | 
						|
    SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, DM, MightBeOdrUse);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a DeclRefExpr.
 | 
						|
void Sema::MarkDeclRefReferenced(DeclRefExpr *E, const Expr *Base) {
 | 
						|
  // TODO: update this with DR# once a defect report is filed.
 | 
						|
  // C++11 defect. The address of a pure member should not be an ODR use, even
 | 
						|
  // if it's a qualified reference.
 | 
						|
  bool OdrUse = true;
 | 
						|
  if (const CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getDecl()))
 | 
						|
    if (Method->isVirtual() &&
 | 
						|
        !Method->getDevirtualizedMethod(Base, getLangOpts().AppleKext))
 | 
						|
      OdrUse = false;
 | 
						|
  MarkExprReferenced(*this, E->getLocation(), E->getDecl(), E, OdrUse);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a MemberExpr.
 | 
						|
void Sema::MarkMemberReferenced(MemberExpr *E) {
 | 
						|
  // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p2:
 | 
						|
  //   A non-overloaded function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated
 | 
						|
  //   expression or a member of a set of candidate functions, if selected by
 | 
						|
  //   overload resolution when referred to from a potentially-evaluated
 | 
						|
  //   expression, is odr-used, unless it is a pure virtual function and its
 | 
						|
  //   name is not explicitly qualified.
 | 
						|
  bool MightBeOdrUse = true;
 | 
						|
  if (E->performsVirtualDispatch(getLangOpts())) {
 | 
						|
    if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl()))
 | 
						|
      if (Method->isPure())
 | 
						|
        MightBeOdrUse = false;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation Loc =
 | 
						|
      E->getMemberLoc().isValid() ? E->getMemberLoc() : E->getBeginLoc();
 | 
						|
  MarkExprReferenced(*this, Loc, E->getMemberDecl(), E, MightBeOdrUse);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a FunctionParmPackExpr.
 | 
						|
void Sema::MarkFunctionParmPackReferenced(FunctionParmPackExpr *E) {
 | 
						|
  for (VarDecl *VD : *E)
 | 
						|
    MarkExprReferenced(*this, E->getParameterPackLocation(), VD, E, true);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Perform marking for a reference to an arbitrary declaration.  It
 | 
						|
/// marks the declaration referenced, and performs odr-use checking for
 | 
						|
/// functions and variables. This method should not be used when building a
 | 
						|
/// normal expression which refers to a variable.
 | 
						|
void Sema::MarkAnyDeclReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D,
 | 
						|
                                 bool MightBeOdrUse) {
 | 
						|
  if (MightBeOdrUse) {
 | 
						|
    if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
      MarkVariableReferenced(Loc, VD);
 | 
						|
      return;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
 | 
						|
    MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, FD, MightBeOdrUse);
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  D->setReferenced();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
namespace {
 | 
						|
  // Mark all of the declarations used by a type as referenced.
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
 | 
						|
  // of when we're entering a context we should not recurse into.
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: This is and EvaluatedExprMarker are more-or-less equivalent to
 | 
						|
  // TreeTransforms rebuilding the type in a new context. Rather than
 | 
						|
  // duplicating the TreeTransform logic, we should consider reusing it here.
 | 
						|
  // Currently that causes problems when rebuilding LambdaExprs.
 | 
						|
  class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
 | 
						|
    Sema &S;
 | 
						|
    SourceLocation Loc;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  public:
 | 
						|
    typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
 | 
						|
  };
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
 | 
						|
    const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
 | 
						|
  {
 | 
						|
    // A non-type template argument is a constant-evaluated context.
 | 
						|
    EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Evaluated(
 | 
						|
        S, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated);
 | 
						|
    if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
 | 
						|
      if (Decl *D = Arg.getAsDecl())
 | 
						|
        S.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, true);
 | 
						|
    } else if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Expression) {
 | 
						|
      S.MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Arg.getAsExpr(), false);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
 | 
						|
  MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
 | 
						|
  Marker.TraverseType(T);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
namespace {
 | 
						|
  /// Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
 | 
						|
  /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
 | 
						|
  class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
 | 
						|
    Sema &S;
 | 
						|
    bool SkipLocalVariables;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  public:
 | 
						|
    typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S, bool SkipLocalVariables)
 | 
						|
      : Inherited(S.Context), S(S), SkipLocalVariables(SkipLocalVariables) { }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
 | 
						|
      // If we were asked not to visit local variables, don't.
 | 
						|
      if (SkipLocalVariables) {
 | 
						|
        if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(E->getDecl()))
 | 
						|
          if (VD->hasLocalStorage())
 | 
						|
            return;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(E);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
 | 
						|
      S.MarkMemberReferenced(E);
 | 
						|
      Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    void VisitCXXBindTemporaryExpr(CXXBindTemporaryExpr *E) {
 | 
						|
      S.MarkFunctionReferenced(
 | 
						|
          E->getBeginLoc(),
 | 
						|
          const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl *>(E->getTemporary()->getDestructor()));
 | 
						|
      Visit(E->getSubExpr());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
 | 
						|
      if (E->getOperatorNew())
 | 
						|
        S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getBeginLoc(), E->getOperatorNew());
 | 
						|
      if (E->getOperatorDelete())
 | 
						|
        S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getBeginLoc(), E->getOperatorDelete());
 | 
						|
      Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
 | 
						|
      if (E->getOperatorDelete())
 | 
						|
        S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getBeginLoc(), E->getOperatorDelete());
 | 
						|
      QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
 | 
						|
      if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
 | 
						|
        CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
 | 
						|
        S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getBeginLoc(), S.LookupDestructor(Record));
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
 | 
						|
      S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getBeginLoc(), E->getConstructor());
 | 
						|
      Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) {
 | 
						|
      Visit(E->getExpr());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  };
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
 | 
						|
/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// \param SkipLocalVariables If true, don't mark local variables as
 | 
						|
/// 'referenced'.
 | 
						|
void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E,
 | 
						|
                                            bool SkipLocalVariables) {
 | 
						|
  EvaluatedExprMarker(*this, SkipLocalVariables).Visit(E);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
 | 
						|
/// of the program being compiled.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
 | 
						|
/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
 | 
						|
/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
 | 
						|
/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
 | 
						|
/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
 | 
						|
/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
 | 
						|
/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
 | 
						|
/// later.
 | 
						|
///
 | 
						|
/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
 | 
						|
/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
 | 
						|
/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
 | 
						|
/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
 | 
						|
bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc, ArrayRef<const Stmt*> Stmts,
 | 
						|
                               const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
 | 
						|
  switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
 | 
						|
  case ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated:
 | 
						|
  case ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedList:
 | 
						|
  case ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedAbstract:
 | 
						|
  case ExpressionEvaluationContext::DiscardedStatement:
 | 
						|
    // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated:
 | 
						|
    // Relevant diagnostics should be produced by constant evaluation.
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated:
 | 
						|
  case ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
 | 
						|
    if (!Stmts.empty() && getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl()) {
 | 
						|
      FunctionScopes.back()->PossiblyUnreachableDiags.
 | 
						|
        push_back(sema::PossiblyUnreachableDiag(PD, Loc, Stmts));
 | 
						|
      return true;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // The initializer of a constexpr variable or of the first declaration of a
 | 
						|
    // static data member is not syntactically a constant evaluated constant,
 | 
						|
    // but nonetheless is always required to be a constant expression, so we
 | 
						|
    // can skip diagnosing.
 | 
						|
    // FIXME: Using the mangling context here is a hack.
 | 
						|
    if (auto *VD = dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(
 | 
						|
            ExprEvalContexts.back().ManglingContextDecl)) {
 | 
						|
      if (VD->isConstexpr() ||
 | 
						|
          (VD->isStaticDataMember() && VD->isFirstDecl() && !VD->isInline()))
 | 
						|
        break;
 | 
						|
      // FIXME: For any other kind of variable, we should build a CFG for its
 | 
						|
      // initializer and check whether the context in question is reachable.
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    Diag(Loc, PD);
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc, const Stmt *Statement,
 | 
						|
                               const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
 | 
						|
  return DiagRuntimeBehavior(
 | 
						|
      Loc, Statement ? llvm::makeArrayRef(Statement) : llvm::None, PD);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                               CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
 | 
						|
  if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // If we're inside a decltype's expression, don't check for a valid return
 | 
						|
  // type or construct temporaries until we know whether this is the last call.
 | 
						|
  if (ExprEvalContexts.back().ExprContext ==
 | 
						|
      ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::EK_Decltype) {
 | 
						|
    ExprEvalContexts.back().DelayedDecltypeCalls.push_back(CE);
 | 
						|
    return false;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  class CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser : public TypeDiagnoser {
 | 
						|
    FunctionDecl *FD;
 | 
						|
    CallExpr *CE;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  public:
 | 
						|
    CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser(FunctionDecl *FD, CallExpr *CE)
 | 
						|
      : FD(FD), CE(CE) { }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
 | 
						|
      if (!FD) {
 | 
						|
        S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
 | 
						|
          << T << CE->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
        return;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
 | 
						|
        << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() << T;
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at)
 | 
						|
          << FD->getDeclName();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } Diagnoser(FD, CE);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType, Diagnoser))
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
// Diagnose the s/=/==/ and s/\|=/!=/ typos. Note that adding parentheses
 | 
						|
// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
 | 
						|
void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation Loc;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
 | 
						|
  bool IsOrAssign = false;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
 | 
						|
    if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign && Op->getOpcode() != BO_OrAssign)
 | 
						|
      return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    IsOrAssign = Op->getOpcode() == BO_OrAssign;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
 | 
						|
    if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
 | 
						|
          = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
 | 
						|
      Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // self = [<foo> init...]
 | 
						|
      if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS()) && ME->getMethodFamily() == OMF_init)
 | 
						|
        diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
 | 
						|
      else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() && Sel.getNameForSlot(0) == "nextObject")
 | 
						|
        diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
 | 
						|
  } else if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
    if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal && Op->getOperator() != OO_PipeEqual)
 | 
						|
      return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    IsOrAssign = Op->getOperator() == OO_PipeEqual;
 | 
						|
    Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
 | 
						|
  } else if (PseudoObjectExpr *POE = dyn_cast<PseudoObjectExpr>(E))
 | 
						|
    return DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(POE->getSyntacticForm());
 | 
						|
  else {
 | 
						|
    // Not an assignment.
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation Open = E->getBeginLoc();
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation Close = getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
 | 
						|
  Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
 | 
						|
        << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
 | 
						|
        << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (IsOrAssign)
 | 
						|
    Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_or_assign_to_comparison)
 | 
						|
      << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "!=");
 | 
						|
  else
 | 
						|
    Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
 | 
						|
      << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Redundant parentheses over an equality comparison can indicate
 | 
						|
/// that the user intended an assignment used as condition.
 | 
						|
void Sema::DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(ParenExpr *ParenE) {
 | 
						|
  // Don't warn if the parens came from a macro.
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation parenLoc = ParenE->getBeginLoc();
 | 
						|
  if (parenLoc.isInvalid() || parenLoc.isMacroID())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
  // Don't warn for dependent expressions.
 | 
						|
  if (ParenE->isTypeDependent())
 | 
						|
    return;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  Expr *E = ParenE->IgnoreParens();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (BinaryOperator *opE = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E))
 | 
						|
    if (opE->getOpcode() == BO_EQ &&
 | 
						|
        opE->getLHS()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->isModifiableLvalue(Context)
 | 
						|
                                                           == Expr::MLV_Valid) {
 | 
						|
      SourceLocation Loc = opE->getOperatorLoc();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      Diag(Loc, diag::warn_equality_with_extra_parens) << E->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      SourceRange ParenERange = ParenE->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_silence)
 | 
						|
        << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getBegin())
 | 
						|
        << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getEnd());
 | 
						|
      Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_to_assign)
 | 
						|
        << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "=");
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *E,
 | 
						|
                                       bool IsConstexpr) {
 | 
						|
  DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
 | 
						|
  if (ParenExpr *parenE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E))
 | 
						|
    DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(parenE);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
 | 
						|
  if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  E = result.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
 | 
						|
    if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
 | 
						|
      return CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E, IsConstexpr); // C++ 6.4p4
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult ERes = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
 | 
						|
    if (ERes.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    E = ERes.get();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    QualType T = E->getType();
 | 
						|
    if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
 | 
						|
      Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
 | 
						|
        << T << E->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    CheckBoolLikeConversion(E, Loc);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return E;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
Sema::ConditionResult Sema::ActOnCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
 | 
						|
                                           Expr *SubExpr, ConditionKind CK) {
 | 
						|
  // Empty conditions are valid in for-statements.
 | 
						|
  if (!SubExpr)
 | 
						|
    return ConditionResult();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  ExprResult Cond;
 | 
						|
  switch (CK) {
 | 
						|
  case ConditionKind::Boolean:
 | 
						|
    Cond = CheckBooleanCondition(Loc, SubExpr);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case ConditionKind::ConstexprIf:
 | 
						|
    Cond = CheckBooleanCondition(Loc, SubExpr, true);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case ConditionKind::Switch:
 | 
						|
    Cond = CheckSwitchCondition(Loc, SubExpr);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (Cond.isInvalid())
 | 
						|
    return ConditionError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // FIXME: FullExprArg doesn't have an invalid bit, so check nullness instead.
 | 
						|
  FullExprArg FullExpr = MakeFullExpr(Cond.get(), Loc);
 | 
						|
  if (!FullExpr.get())
 | 
						|
    return ConditionError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return ConditionResult(*this, nullptr, FullExpr,
 | 
						|
                         CK == ConditionKind::ConstexprIf);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
namespace {
 | 
						|
  /// A visitor for rebuilding a call to an __unknown_any expression
 | 
						|
  /// to have an appropriate type.
 | 
						|
  struct RebuildUnknownAnyFunction
 | 
						|
    : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyFunction, ExprResult> {
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    Sema &S;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) {
 | 
						|
      llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!");
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_call)
 | 
						|
        << E->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another
 | 
						|
    /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of.
 | 
						|
    template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) {
 | 
						|
      ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
 | 
						|
      if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get();
 | 
						|
      E->setSubExpr(SubExpr);
 | 
						|
      E->setType(SubExpr->getType());
 | 
						|
      E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind());
 | 
						|
      assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
 | 
						|
      return E;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) {
 | 
						|
      return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) {
 | 
						|
      return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) {
 | 
						|
      ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
 | 
						|
      if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get();
 | 
						|
      E->setSubExpr(SubExpr);
 | 
						|
      E->setType(S.Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()));
 | 
						|
      assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
 | 
						|
      assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
 | 
						|
      return E;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) {
 | 
						|
      if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(VD)) return VisitExpr(E);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      E->setType(VD->getType());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
 | 
						|
      if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
 | 
						|
          !(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VD) &&
 | 
						|
            cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isInstance()))
 | 
						|
        E->setValueKind(VK_LValue);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      return E;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
 | 
						|
      return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
 | 
						|
      return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  };
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it
 | 
						|
/// to have a function type.
 | 
						|
static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *FunctionExpr) {
 | 
						|
  ExprResult Result = RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(S).Visit(FunctionExpr);
 | 
						|
  if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  return S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Result.get());
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
namespace {
 | 
						|
  /// A visitor for rebuilding an expression of type __unknown_anytype
 | 
						|
  /// into one which resolves the type directly on the referring
 | 
						|
  /// expression.  Strict preservation of the original source
 | 
						|
  /// structure is not a goal.
 | 
						|
  struct RebuildUnknownAnyExpr
 | 
						|
    : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyExpr, ExprResult> {
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    Sema &S;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    /// The current destination type.
 | 
						|
    QualType DestType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, QualType CastType)
 | 
						|
      : S(S), DestType(CastType) {}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) {
 | 
						|
      llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!");
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr)
 | 
						|
        << E->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E);
 | 
						|
    ExprResult VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another
 | 
						|
    /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of.
 | 
						|
    template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) {
 | 
						|
      ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
 | 
						|
      if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get();
 | 
						|
      E->setSubExpr(SubExpr);
 | 
						|
      E->setType(SubExpr->getType());
 | 
						|
      E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind());
 | 
						|
      assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
 | 
						|
      return E;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) {
 | 
						|
      return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) {
 | 
						|
      return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) {
 | 
						|
      const PointerType *Ptr = DestType->getAs<PointerType>();
 | 
						|
      if (!Ptr) {
 | 
						|
        S.Diag(E->getOperatorLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_addrof)
 | 
						|
          << E->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      if (isa<CallExpr>(E->getSubExpr())) {
 | 
						|
        S.Diag(E->getOperatorLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_addrof_call)
 | 
						|
          << E->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
        return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
 | 
						|
      assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
 | 
						|
      E->setType(DestType);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
      // Build the sub-expression as if it were an object of the pointee type.
 | 
						|
      DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
      ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
 | 
						|
      if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      E->setSubExpr(SubResult.get());
 | 
						|
      return E;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
 | 
						|
      return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
 | 
						|
      return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl());
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  };
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Rebuilds a call expression which yielded __unknown_anytype.
 | 
						|
ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) {
 | 
						|
  Expr *CalleeExpr = E->getCallee();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  enum FnKind {
 | 
						|
    FK_MemberFunction,
 | 
						|
    FK_FunctionPointer,
 | 
						|
    FK_BlockPointer
 | 
						|
  };
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  FnKind Kind;
 | 
						|
  QualType CalleeType = CalleeExpr->getType();
 | 
						|
  if (CalleeType == S.Context.BoundMemberTy) {
 | 
						|
    assert(isa<CXXMemberCallExpr>(E) || isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E));
 | 
						|
    Kind = FK_MemberFunction;
 | 
						|
    CalleeType = Expr::findBoundMemberType(CalleeExpr);
 | 
						|
  } else if (const PointerType *Ptr = CalleeType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
 | 
						|
    CalleeType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
    Kind = FK_FunctionPointer;
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    CalleeType = CalleeType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
    Kind = FK_BlockPointer;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  const FunctionType *FnType = CalleeType->castAs<FunctionType>();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Verify that this is a legal result type of a function.
 | 
						|
  if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) {
 | 
						|
    unsigned diagID = diag::err_func_returning_array_function;
 | 
						|
    if (Kind == FK_BlockPointer)
 | 
						|
      diagID = diag::err_block_returning_array_function;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diagID)
 | 
						|
      << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType;
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Otherwise, go ahead and set DestType as the call's result.
 | 
						|
  E->setType(DestType.getNonLValueExprType(S.Context));
 | 
						|
  E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType));
 | 
						|
  assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Rebuild the function type, replacing the result type with DestType.
 | 
						|
  const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FnType);
 | 
						|
  if (Proto) {
 | 
						|
    // __unknown_anytype(...) is a special case used by the debugger when
 | 
						|
    // it has no idea what a function's signature is.
 | 
						|
    //
 | 
						|
    // We want to build this call essentially under the K&R
 | 
						|
    // unprototyped rules, but making a FunctionNoProtoType in C++
 | 
						|
    // would foul up all sorts of assumptions.  However, we cannot
 | 
						|
    // simply pass all arguments as variadic arguments, nor can we
 | 
						|
    // portably just call the function under a non-variadic type; see
 | 
						|
    // the comment on IR-gen's TargetInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic.
 | 
						|
    // However, it turns out that in practice it is generally safe to
 | 
						|
    // call a function declared as "A foo(B,C,D);" under the prototype
 | 
						|
    // "A foo(B,C,D,...);".  The only known exception is with the
 | 
						|
    // Windows ABI, where any variadic function is implicitly cdecl
 | 
						|
    // regardless of its normal CC.  Therefore we change the parameter
 | 
						|
    // types to match the types of the arguments.
 | 
						|
    //
 | 
						|
    // This is a hack, but it is far superior to moving the
 | 
						|
    // corresponding target-specific code from IR-gen to Sema/AST.
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes = Proto->getParamTypes();
 | 
						|
    SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
 | 
						|
    if (ParamTypes.empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) { // the special case
 | 
						|
      ArgTypes.reserve(E->getNumArgs());
 | 
						|
      for (unsigned i = 0, e = E->getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i) {
 | 
						|
        Expr *Arg = E->getArg(i);
 | 
						|
        QualType ArgType = Arg->getType();
 | 
						|
        if (E->isLValue()) {
 | 
						|
          ArgType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ArgType);
 | 
						|
        } else if (E->isXValue()) {
 | 
						|
          ArgType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(ArgType);
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
        ArgTypes.push_back(ArgType);
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
      ParamTypes = ArgTypes;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    DestType = S.Context.getFunctionType(DestType, ParamTypes,
 | 
						|
                                         Proto->getExtProtoInfo());
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    DestType = S.Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(DestType,
 | 
						|
                                                FnType->getExtInfo());
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Rebuild the appropriate pointer-to-function type.
 | 
						|
  switch (Kind) {
 | 
						|
  case FK_MemberFunction:
 | 
						|
    // Nothing to do.
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case FK_FunctionPointer:
 | 
						|
    DestType = S.Context.getPointerType(DestType);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case FK_BlockPointer:
 | 
						|
    DestType = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(DestType);
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Finally, we can recurse.
 | 
						|
  ExprResult CalleeResult = Visit(CalleeExpr);
 | 
						|
  if (!CalleeResult.isUsable()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  E->setCallee(CalleeResult.get());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Bind a temporary if necessary.
 | 
						|
  return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) {
 | 
						|
  // Verify that this is a legal result type of a call.
 | 
						|
  if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_func_returning_array_function)
 | 
						|
      << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType;
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Rewrite the method result type if available.
 | 
						|
  if (ObjCMethodDecl *Method = E->getMethodDecl()) {
 | 
						|
    assert(Method->getReturnType() == S.Context.UnknownAnyTy);
 | 
						|
    Method->setReturnType(DestType);
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Change the type of the message.
 | 
						|
  E->setType(DestType.getNonReferenceType());
 | 
						|
  E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) {
 | 
						|
  // The only case we should ever see here is a function-to-pointer decay.
 | 
						|
  if (E->getCastKind() == CK_FunctionToPointerDecay) {
 | 
						|
    assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
 | 
						|
    assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    E->setType(DestType);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Rebuild the sub-expression as the pointee (function) type.
 | 
						|
    DestType = DestType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
 | 
						|
    if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    E->setSubExpr(Result.get());
 | 
						|
    return E;
 | 
						|
  } else if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) {
 | 
						|
    assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
 | 
						|
    assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    assert(isa<BlockPointerType>(E->getType()));
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    E->setType(DestType);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // The sub-expression has to be a lvalue reference, so rebuild it as such.
 | 
						|
    DestType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DestType);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
 | 
						|
    if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    E->setSubExpr(Result.get());
 | 
						|
    return E;
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    llvm_unreachable("Unhandled cast type!");
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) {
 | 
						|
  ExprValueKind ValueKind = VK_LValue;
 | 
						|
  QualType Type = DestType;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // We know how to make this work for certain kinds of decls:
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  //  - functions
 | 
						|
  if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)) {
 | 
						|
    if (const PointerType *Ptr = Type->getAs<PointerType>()) {
 | 
						|
      DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
      ExprResult Result = resolveDecl(E, VD);
 | 
						|
      if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
      return S.ImpCastExprToType(Result.get(), Type,
 | 
						|
                                 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, VK_RValue);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (!Type->isFunctionType()) {
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_function)
 | 
						|
        << VD << E->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = Type->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
 | 
						|
      // We must match the FunctionDecl's type to the hack introduced in
 | 
						|
      // RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr to vararg functions of unknown
 | 
						|
      // type. See the lengthy commentary in that routine.
 | 
						|
      QualType FDT = FD->getType();
 | 
						|
      const FunctionType *FnType = FDT->castAs<FunctionType>();
 | 
						|
      const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionProtoType>(FnType);
 | 
						|
      DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E);
 | 
						|
      if (DRE && Proto && Proto->getParamTypes().empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) {
 | 
						|
        SourceLocation Loc = FD->getLocation();
 | 
						|
        FunctionDecl *NewFD = FunctionDecl::Create(
 | 
						|
            S.Context, FD->getDeclContext(), Loc, Loc,
 | 
						|
            FD->getNameInfo().getName(), DestType, FD->getTypeSourceInfo(),
 | 
						|
            SC_None, false /*isInlineSpecified*/, FD->hasPrototype(),
 | 
						|
            /*ConstexprKind*/ CSK_unspecified);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        if (FD->getQualifier())
 | 
						|
          NewFD->setQualifierInfo(FD->getQualifierLoc());
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
        SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params;
 | 
						|
        for (const auto &AI : FT->param_types()) {
 | 
						|
          ParmVarDecl *Param =
 | 
						|
            S.BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(FD, Loc, AI);
 | 
						|
          Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size());
 | 
						|
          Params.push_back(Param);
 | 
						|
        }
 | 
						|
        NewFD->setParams(Params);
 | 
						|
        DRE->setDecl(NewFD);
 | 
						|
        VD = DRE->getDecl();
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD))
 | 
						|
      if (MD->isInstance()) {
 | 
						|
        ValueKind = VK_RValue;
 | 
						|
        Type = S.Context.BoundMemberTy;
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // Function references aren't l-values in C.
 | 
						|
    if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
 | 
						|
      ValueKind = VK_RValue;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  //  - variables
 | 
						|
  } else if (isa<VarDecl>(VD)) {
 | 
						|
    if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
 | 
						|
      Type = RefTy->getPointeeType();
 | 
						|
    } else if (Type->isFunctionType()) {
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_var_function_type)
 | 
						|
        << VD << E->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  //  - nothing else
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_decl)
 | 
						|
      << VD << E->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Modifying the declaration like this is friendly to IR-gen but
 | 
						|
  // also really dangerous.
 | 
						|
  VD->setType(DestType);
 | 
						|
  E->setType(Type);
 | 
						|
  E->setValueKind(ValueKind);
 | 
						|
  return E;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Check a cast of an unknown-any type.  We intentionally only
 | 
						|
/// trigger this for C-style casts.
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyCast(SourceRange TypeRange, QualType CastType,
 | 
						|
                                     Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &CastKind,
 | 
						|
                                     ExprValueKind &VK, CXXCastPath &Path) {
 | 
						|
  // The type we're casting to must be either void or complete.
 | 
						|
  if (!CastType->isVoidType() &&
 | 
						|
      RequireCompleteType(TypeRange.getBegin(), CastType,
 | 
						|
                          diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Rewrite the casted expression from scratch.
 | 
						|
  ExprResult result = RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, CastType).Visit(CastExpr);
 | 
						|
  if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  CastExpr = result.get();
 | 
						|
  VK = CastExpr->getValueKind();
 | 
						|
  CastKind = CK_NoOp;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return CastExpr;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::forceUnknownAnyToType(Expr *E, QualType ToType) {
 | 
						|
  return RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, ToType).Visit(E);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyArg(SourceLocation callLoc,
 | 
						|
                                    Expr *arg, QualType ¶mType) {
 | 
						|
  // If the syntactic form of the argument is not an explicit cast of
 | 
						|
  // any sort, just do default argument promotion.
 | 
						|
  ExplicitCastExpr *castArg = dyn_cast<ExplicitCastExpr>(arg->IgnoreParens());
 | 
						|
  if (!castArg) {
 | 
						|
    ExprResult result = DefaultArgumentPromotion(arg);
 | 
						|
    if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    paramType = result.get()->getType();
 | 
						|
    return result;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Otherwise, use the type that was written in the explicit cast.
 | 
						|
  assert(!arg->hasPlaceholderType());
 | 
						|
  paramType = castArg->getTypeAsWritten();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Copy-initialize a parameter of that type.
 | 
						|
  InitializedEntity entity =
 | 
						|
    InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, paramType,
 | 
						|
                                           /*consumed*/ false);
 | 
						|
  return PerformCopyInitialization(entity, callLoc, arg);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
static ExprResult diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  Expr *orig = E;
 | 
						|
  unsigned diagID = diag::err_uncasted_use_of_unknown_any;
 | 
						|
  while (true) {
 | 
						|
    E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
 | 
						|
    if (CallExpr *call = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
      E = call->getCallee();
 | 
						|
      diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any;
 | 
						|
    } else {
 | 
						|
      break;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  SourceLocation loc;
 | 
						|
  NamedDecl *d;
 | 
						|
  if (DeclRefExpr *ref = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
    loc = ref->getLocation();
 | 
						|
    d = ref->getDecl();
 | 
						|
  } else if (MemberExpr *mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
    loc = mem->getMemberLoc();
 | 
						|
    d = mem->getMemberDecl();
 | 
						|
  } else if (ObjCMessageExpr *msg = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(E)) {
 | 
						|
    diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any;
 | 
						|
    loc = msg->getSelectorStartLoc();
 | 
						|
    d = msg->getMethodDecl();
 | 
						|
    if (!d) {
 | 
						|
      S.Diag(loc, diag::err_uncasted_send_to_unknown_any_method)
 | 
						|
        << static_cast<unsigned>(msg->isClassMessage()) << msg->getSelector()
 | 
						|
        << orig->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
      return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  } else {
 | 
						|
    S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr)
 | 
						|
      << E->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  S.Diag(loc, diagID) << d << orig->getSourceRange();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Never recoverable.
 | 
						|
  return ExprError();
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
 | 
						|
/// Returns ExprError() if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
 | 
						|
    // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes on either side of a binop because it
 | 
						|
    // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have
 | 
						|
    // been dealt with before checking the operands.
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Result = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(E);
 | 
						|
    if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
 | 
						|
    E = Result.get();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  const BuiltinType *placeholderType = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType();
 | 
						|
  if (!placeholderType) return E;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  switch (placeholderType->getKind()) {
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Overloaded expressions.
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::Overload: {
 | 
						|
    // Try to resolve a single function template specialization.
 | 
						|
    // This is obligatory.
 | 
						|
    ExprResult Result = E;
 | 
						|
    if (ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Result, false))
 | 
						|
      return Result;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // No guarantees that ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization
 | 
						|
    // leaves Result unchanged on failure.
 | 
						|
    Result = E;
 | 
						|
    if (resolveAndFixAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(Result))
 | 
						|
      return Result;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    // If that failed, try to recover with a call.
 | 
						|
    tryToRecoverWithCall(Result, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_unresolvable),
 | 
						|
                         /*complain*/ true);
 | 
						|
    return Result;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Bound member functions.
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::BoundMember: {
 | 
						|
    ExprResult result = E;
 | 
						|
    const Expr *BME = E->IgnoreParens();
 | 
						|
    PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::err_bound_member_function);
 | 
						|
    // Try to give a nicer diagnostic if it is a bound member that we recognize.
 | 
						|
    if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(BME)) {
 | 
						|
      PD = PDiag(diag::err_dtor_expr_without_call) << /*pseudo-destructor*/ 1;
 | 
						|
    } else if (const auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(BME)) {
 | 
						|
      if (ME->getMemberNameInfo().getName().getNameKind() ==
 | 
						|
          DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName)
 | 
						|
        PD = PDiag(diag::err_dtor_expr_without_call) << /*destructor*/ 0;
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
    tryToRecoverWithCall(result, PD,
 | 
						|
                         /*complain*/ true);
 | 
						|
    return result;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // ARC unbridged casts.
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast: {
 | 
						|
    Expr *realCast = stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
 | 
						|
    diagnoseARCUnbridgedCast(realCast);
 | 
						|
    return realCast;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Expressions of unknown type.
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::UnknownAny:
 | 
						|
    return diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(*this, E);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Pseudo-objects.
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::PseudoObject:
 | 
						|
    return checkPseudoObjectRValue(E);
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn: {
 | 
						|
    // Accept __noop without parens by implicitly converting it to a call expr.
 | 
						|
    auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
 | 
						|
    if (DRE) {
 | 
						|
      auto *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
 | 
						|
      if (FD->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__noop) {
 | 
						|
        E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(FD->getType()),
 | 
						|
                              CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr)
 | 
						|
                .get();
 | 
						|
        return CallExpr::Create(Context, E, /*Args=*/{}, Context.IntTy,
 | 
						|
                                VK_RValue, SourceLocation());
 | 
						|
      }
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
    Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_builtin_fn_use);
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Expressions of unknown type.
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::OMPArraySection:
 | 
						|
    Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_omp_array_section_use);
 | 
						|
    return ExprError();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // Everything else should be impossible.
 | 
						|
#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::Id:
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
 | 
						|
#define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::Id:
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def"
 | 
						|
#define SVE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) \
 | 
						|
  case BuiltinType::Id:
 | 
						|
#include "clang/Basic/AArch64SVEACLETypes.def"
 | 
						|
#define BUILTIN_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id:
 | 
						|
#define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(Id, SingletonId)
 | 
						|
#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
 | 
						|
    break;
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  llvm_unreachable("invalid placeholder type!");
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
bool Sema::CheckCaseExpression(Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  if (E->isTypeDependent())
 | 
						|
    return true;
 | 
						|
  if (E->isValueDependent() || E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context))
 | 
						|
    return E->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType();
 | 
						|
  return false;
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
/// ActOnObjCBoolLiteral - Parse {__objc_yes,__objc_no} literals.
 | 
						|
ExprResult
 | 
						|
Sema::ActOnObjCBoolLiteral(SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind Kind) {
 | 
						|
  assert((Kind == tok::kw___objc_yes || Kind == tok::kw___objc_no) &&
 | 
						|
         "Unknown Objective-C Boolean value!");
 | 
						|
  QualType BoolT = Context.ObjCBuiltinBoolTy;
 | 
						|
  if (!Context.getBOOLDecl()) {
 | 
						|
    LookupResult Result(*this, &Context.Idents.get("BOOL"), OpLoc,
 | 
						|
                        Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
 | 
						|
    if (LookupName(Result, getCurScope()) && Result.isSingleResult()) {
 | 
						|
      NamedDecl *ND = Result.getFoundDecl();
 | 
						|
      if (TypedefDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefDecl>(ND))
 | 
						|
        Context.setBOOLDecl(TD);
 | 
						|
    }
 | 
						|
  }
 | 
						|
  if (Context.getBOOLDecl())
 | 
						|
    BoolT = Context.getBOOLType();
 | 
						|
  return new (Context)
 | 
						|
      ObjCBoolLiteralExpr(Kind == tok::kw___objc_yes, BoolT, OpLoc);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
ExprResult Sema::ActOnObjCAvailabilityCheckExpr(
 | 
						|
    llvm::ArrayRef<AvailabilitySpec> AvailSpecs, SourceLocation AtLoc,
 | 
						|
    SourceLocation RParen) {
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  StringRef Platform = getASTContext().getTargetInfo().getPlatformName();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  auto Spec = llvm::find_if(AvailSpecs, [&](const AvailabilitySpec &Spec) {
 | 
						|
    return Spec.getPlatform() == Platform;
 | 
						|
  });
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  VersionTuple Version;
 | 
						|
  if (Spec != AvailSpecs.end())
 | 
						|
    Version = Spec->getVersion();
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  // The use of `@available` in the enclosing function should be analyzed to
 | 
						|
  // warn when it's used inappropriately (i.e. not if(@available)).
 | 
						|
  if (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl())
 | 
						|
    getEnclosingFunction()->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations = true;
 | 
						|
  else if (getCurBlock() || getCurLambda())
 | 
						|
    getCurFunction()->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations = true;
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
  return new (Context)
 | 
						|
      ObjCAvailabilityCheckExpr(Version, AtLoc, RParen, Context.BoolTy);
 | 
						|
}
 | 
						|
 | 
						|
bool Sema::IsDependentFunctionNameExpr(Expr *E) {
 | 
						|
  assert(E->isTypeDependent());
 | 
						|
  return isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E);
 | 
						|
}
 |